summaryrefslogtreecommitdiffstats
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
authorPatrick Uiterwijk <puiterwijk@redhat.com>2017-08-16 17:39:23 +0000
committerPatrick Uiterwijk <puiterwijk@redhat.com>2017-08-16 17:39:23 +0000
commite43e0e06b17788709d2919618efef3cefeae9e40 (patch)
tree5d7b79f07c0a816fbbd01f5fa503cce4d9e73909
parent0ad754978857381c216a26a349f40a49e28de46f (diff)
downloadansible-e43e0e06b17788709d2919618efef3cefeae9e40.tar.gz
ansible-e43e0e06b17788709d2919618efef3cefeae9e40.tar.xz
ansible-e43e0e06b17788709d2919618efef3cefeae9e40.zip
Move SSH setup to its own role
Signed-off-by: Patrick Uiterwijk <puiterwijk@redhat.com>
-rw-r--r--roles/base/handlers/main.yml3
-rw-r--r--roles/base/tasks/main.yml46
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/README4
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/ansible-pub-key1
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/blacklist-cdc_ether.conf1
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/common-scripts/conditional-reload.sh26
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/common-scripts/conditional-restart.sh20
-rwxr-xr-xroles/basessh/files/common-scripts/hardware-reinstall228
-rwxr-xr-xroles/basessh/files/common-scripts/lock-wrapper41
-rwxr-xr-xroles/basessh/files/common-scripts/nag-once108
-rwxr-xr-xroles/basessh/files/common-scripts/needs-reboot.py36
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/common-scripts/proxy-conditional-reload.sh25
-rwxr-xr-xroles/basessh/files/common-scripts/syncFiles.sh50
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/digicert-intermediate.pem29
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf687
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.209.132.184.113686
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.collab03.fedoraproject.org687
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.copr687
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.gateway747
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.hosted-lists01.fedoraproject.org689
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.hosted03.fedoraproject.org687
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.hosted04.fedoraproject.org687
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.jenkins.fedorainfracloud.org687
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.kojibuilder687
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.lists-dev.cloud.fedoraproject.org694
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.lists-dev.fedorainfracloud.org693
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.mailman696
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.mailman01.stg.phx2.fedoraproject.org694
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.noc02.fedoraproject.org698
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.norelay686
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.openstack-compute687
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.phx687
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.phx2687
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.rdu686
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.releng686
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.sign686
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.smtp-mm741
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.staging687
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.upstreamfirst.fedorainfracloud.org687
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.vpn687
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.vpn.pagure690
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.vpn.pagure-stg690
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/master.cf/master.cf96
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/master.cf/master.cf.gateway96
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/master.cf/master.cf.hosted-lists0197
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/master.cf/master.cf.mailman102
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/master.cf/master.cf.noc02.fedoraproject.org97
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/tls_policy0
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/transports.gateway33
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/transports.mm-smtp5
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/postfix/transports.noc02.fedoraproject.org30
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/cloud4
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/cloud-noc01.cloud.fedoraproject.org4
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/coloamer4
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/dedicatedsolutions4
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/fed-cloud09.cloud.fedoraproject.org4
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/fedorainfracloud4
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/host1plus5
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/ibiblio4
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/internetx4
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/jenkins-master3
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/jenkins-slave3
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/kojibuilder6
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/osuosl4
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/phx26
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/qa6
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/rdu4
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/resolv.conf4
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/serverbeach4
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/staging4
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/telia4
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/tummy4
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/merged-rsyslog11
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog-audit.conf13
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog-disablerate.conf3
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog-limits.conf2
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog-log014
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog-log01-nolocal44
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog-log024
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog-log02-nolocal44
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog.conf.default89
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog.conf.el680
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog.conf.f2091
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog.conf.log01.phx2.fedoraproject.org215
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/selinux/rsyslog-audit.ppbin0 -> 7609 bytes
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/selinux/rsyslog-audit.te12
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/setprodps1.sh3
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/setstgps1.sh3
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/ssh/sshd_config.7 (renamed from roles/base/files/ssh/sshd_config.7)0
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/ssh/sshd_config.buildhw (renamed from roles/base/files/ssh/sshd_config.buildhw)0
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/ssh/sshd_config.default (renamed from roles/base/files/ssh/sshd_config.default)0
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/ssh/sshd_config.el6 (renamed from roles/base/files/ssh/sshd_config.el6)0
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/ssh/sshd_config.kojibuilder (renamed from roles/base/files/ssh/sshd_config.kojibuilder)0
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/ssh/sshd_config.noc01.phx2.fedoraproject.org (renamed from roles/base/files/ssh/sshd_config.noc01.phx2.fedoraproject.org)0
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/ssh/sshd_config.pkgs (renamed from roles/base/files/ssh/sshd_config.pkgs)0
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/ssh/sshd_config.qa-prod (renamed from roles/base/files/ssh/sshd_config.qa-prod)0
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/ssh/sshd_config.qa-stg (renamed from roles/base/files/ssh/sshd_config.qa-stg)0
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/ssh/sshd_config.releng (renamed from roles/base/files/ssh/sshd_config.releng)0
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/syncHttpLogs.sh92
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/files/watchdog.conf3
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/handlers/main.yml3
-rw-r--r--roles/basessh/tasks/main.yml (renamed from roles/base/tasks/sshcerts.yml)41
102 files changed, 21287 insertions, 46 deletions
diff --git a/roles/base/handlers/main.yml b/roles/base/handlers/main.yml
index 5852fa8b7..bf3b26f2c 100644
--- a/roles/base/handlers/main.yml
+++ b/roles/base/handlers/main.yml
@@ -24,9 +24,6 @@
- name: restart rsyslog
service: name=rsyslog state=restarted
-- name: restart sshd
- service: name=sshd state=restarted
-
- name: restart watchdog
service: name=watchdog state=restarted
diff --git a/roles/base/tasks/main.yml b/roles/base/tasks/main.yml
index d486885a4..80897d55f 100644
--- a/roles/base/tasks/main.yml
+++ b/roles/base/tasks/main.yml
@@ -104,52 +104,12 @@
- base
when: ansible_distribution_major_version|int > 21 and ansible_cmdline.ostree is not defined
+- name: Set up SSH
+ include_role: basessh
+
- name: make sure hostname is set right on rhel7 hosts
hostname: name="{{inventory_hostname}}"
-- name: check if sshd port is already known by selinux
- shell: semanage port -l | grep ssh
- register: sshd_selinux_port
- check_mode: no
- changed_when: false
- tags:
- - sshd_config
- - config
- - sshd
- - selinux
- - base
-
-- name: allow alternate sshd port
- command: semanage port -a -t ssh_port_t -p tcp {{ sshd_port }}
- when: sshd_selinux_port.stdout.find('{{ sshd_port }}') == -1
- tags:
- - sshd_config
- - config
- - sshd
- - selinux
- - base
-
-- name: Set up SSH certificates
- include: sshcerts.yml
-
-- name: sshd_config
- copy: src={{ item }} dest=/etc/ssh/sshd_config mode=0600
- with_first_found:
- - "{{ sshd_config }}"
- - ssh/sshd_config.{{ inventory_hostname }}
- - ssh/sshd_config.{{ host_group }}
- - ssh/sshd_config.{{ dist_tag }}
- - ssh/sshd_config.{{ ansible_distribution }}
- - ssh/sshd_config.{{ ansible_distribution_version }}
- - ssh/sshd_config.default
- notify:
- - restart sshd
- tags:
- - sshd_config
- - config
- - sshd
- - base
-
- name: set root passwd
user: name=root password={{ rootpw }} state=present
tags:
diff --git a/roles/basessh/README b/roles/basessh/README
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..317ef0414
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/README
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+This role is the base setup for all our machines.
+
+If there's something that shouldn't be run on every single
+machine, it should be in another role.
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/ansible-pub-key b/roles/basessh/files/ansible-pub-key
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..49c8e0020
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/ansible-pub-key
@@ -0,0 +1 @@
+ssh-rsa AAAAB3NzaC1yc2EAAAABIwAAAQEAmS3g5fSXizcCqKMI1n5WPFrfMyu7BMrMkMYyck07rB/cf2orO8kKj5schjILA8NYJFStlv2CGRXmQlendj523FPzPmzxvTP/OT4qdywa4LKGvAxOkRGCMMxWzVFLdEMzsLUE/+FLX+xd1US9UPLGRsbMkdz4ORCc0G8gqTr835H56mQPI+/zPFeQjHoHGYtQA1wnJH/0LCuFFfU82IfzrXzFDIBAA5i2S+eEOk7/SA4Ciek1CthNtqPX27M6UqkJMBmVpnAdeDz2noWMvlzAAUQ7dHL84CiXbUnF3hhYrHDbmD+kEK+KiRrYh3PT+5YfEPVI/xiDJ2fdHGxY7Dr2TQ== root@lockbox01.phx2.fedoraproject.org
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/blacklist-cdc_ether.conf b/roles/basessh/files/blacklist-cdc_ether.conf
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..415db6393
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/blacklist-cdc_ether.conf
@@ -0,0 +1 @@
+blacklist cdc_ether
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/common-scripts/conditional-reload.sh b/roles/basessh/files/common-scripts/conditional-reload.sh
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..988a08b05
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/common-scripts/conditional-reload.sh
@@ -0,0 +1,26 @@
+#!/bin/bash
+# reload SERVICE only if PACKAGE is installed.
+# We use this throughout handlers/restart_services.yml
+
+SERVICE=$1
+PACKAGE=$2
+
+rpm -q $PACKAGE
+
+INSTALLED=$?
+
+if [ $INSTALLED -eq 0 ]; then
+ echo "Checking if $SERVICE is running"
+ /sbin/service $SERVICE status >& /dev/null
+ if [ $? == 0 ]; then
+ echo "Package $PACKAGE installed and running. Attempting reload of $SERVICE."
+ /sbin/service $SERVICE reload
+ exit $? # Exit with the /sbin/service status code
+ fi
+ echo "Package $PACKAGE is install, but $SERVICE is not running, skipping..."
+ exit 0
+fi
+
+# If the package wasn't installed, then pretend everything is fine.
+echo "Package $PACKAGE not installed. Skipping reload of $SERVICE."
+exit 0
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/common-scripts/conditional-restart.sh b/roles/basessh/files/common-scripts/conditional-restart.sh
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..f95ef741d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/common-scripts/conditional-restart.sh
@@ -0,0 +1,20 @@
+#!/bin/bash
+# Restart SERVICE only if PACKAGE is installed.
+# We use this throughout handlers/restart_services.yml
+
+SERVICE=$1
+PACKAGE=$2
+
+rpm -q $PACKAGE
+
+INSTALLED=$?
+
+if [ $INSTALLED -eq 0 ]; then
+ echo "Package $PACKAGE installed. Attempting restart of $SERVICE."
+ /sbin/service $SERVICE restart
+ exit $? # Exit with the /sbin/service status code
+fi
+
+# If the package wasn't installed, then pretend everything is fine.
+echo "Package $PACKAGE not installed. Skipping restart of $SERVICE."
+exit 0
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/common-scripts/hardware-reinstall b/roles/basessh/files/common-scripts/hardware-reinstall
new file mode 100755
index 000000000..794be0215
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/common-scripts/hardware-reinstall
@@ -0,0 +1,228 @@
+#!/usr/bin/env python
+# hardware-reinstall - Prepare a physical box in FI for re-install.
+# (c) 2012 Red Hat, Inc.
+# Ricky Elrod <codeblock@fedoraproject.org>
+# GPLv2+
+
+import os
+import sys
+import urllib
+import socket
+import subprocess
+import shlex
+import platform
+from optparse import OptionParser
+
+parser = OptionParser(
+ description='Prepare a physical box in FI for re-install.')
+parser.add_option('-n',
+ '--noop',
+ action='store_true',
+ help="Don't actually modify/download anything, just "
+ "output stuff.")
+parser.add_option('-y',
+ '--yes',
+ action='store_true',
+ default=False,
+ dest="yes",
+ help="Don't prompt to confirm, just do it.")
+parser.add_option('--ip',
+ help="Override the IP of the box (passed to Grubby)")
+parser.add_option('--gw',
+ help="Override the Gateway of the box (passed to Grubby)",
+ dest='gateway')
+parser.add_option('--nm',
+ help="Override the Netmask of the box (passed to Grubby)",
+ dest='netmask')
+parser.add_option('--dns',
+ help="Comma-delimited list of DNS resolvers (passed to "
+ "Grubby)",
+ dest='dns_resolvers')
+parser.add_option('--ks-file',
+ help="Set the kickstart file to use (default:"
+ "hardware-rhel-6-nohd)",
+ default='hardware-rhel-6-nohd',
+ dest='ks_file')
+(options, args) = parser.parse_args()
+
+if options.yes and options.noop:
+ print "Don't ask AND don't do anything? Cmon"
+ sys.exit(1)
+
+# 0. Get our hostname/primary ip
+# Get our primary IP by resolving our hostname.
+if options.ip:
+ if not options.netmask:
+ print 'You gave a custom IP and should specify a custom netmask too.'
+ sys.exit(1)
+ primary_ip = options.ip
+else:
+ primary_ip = socket.gethostbyname(socket.gethostname())
+
+# so - anaconda sometimes doesn't seem to listen to our dns
+# when fetching kickstarts, etc - so if we give the ip of the host
+# if we're in 10.5.X network (phx2) then things just work.
+if primary_ip.startswith('10.5.'):
+ basehost = "http://10.5.126.23/"
+else:
+ basehost = "http://infrastructure.fedoraproject.org/"
+
+arch = platform.machine()
+VMLINUZ_URL = '%srepo/rhel/RHEL6-%s/images/pxeboot/vmlinuz' % (basehost, arch)
+INITRD_URL = '%srepo/rhel/RHEL6-%s/images/pxeboot/initrd.img' % (basehost,
+ arch)
+
+# 1. Grab initrd and vmlinuz and throw them in /boot
+# FIXME - more error catching here
+if not options.noop:
+ print 'Fetching vmlinuz'
+ urllib.urlretrieve(VMLINUZ_URL, "/boot/vmlinuz-install")
+
+ print 'Fetching initrd'
+ urllib.urlretrieve(INITRD_URL, "/boot/initrd-install.img")
+
+
+# 2. Find our network info.
+if options.netmask:
+ primary_netmask = options.netmask
+
+# We still have to get the MAC address, of the primary NIC
+# even if we specify a custom IP/NM.
+cmd = subprocess.Popen('/sbin/ifconfig', stdout=subprocess.PIPE)
+stdout = cmd.communicate()[0]
+i = 0
+lines = stdout.split("\n")
+for line in lines:
+ if socket.gethostbyname(socket.gethostname()) in line:
+ # Somewhere between EL6 and F17, ifconfig output has changed.
+ # We accommodate for both.
+ if ':' in line:
+ # We are EL6
+ if not options.netmask:
+ # inet addr:10.5.127.51 Bcast:10.5.127.255 Mask:255.255.255.0
+ primary_netmask = line.split('Mask:')[1]
+
+ # On EL6 MAC addr is always one line before the IP address line
+ primary_mac = lines[i - 1].split('HWaddr ')[1]
+ else:
+ # We are likely something newer
+ if not options.netmask:
+ # inet 10.10.10.113 netmask 255.255.255.0 broadcast
+ # 10.10.10.255 # (cont. from above comment)
+ primary_netmask = line.split('netmask ')[1].split(' ')[0]
+
+ # On newer things, life gets harder. We have to continue
+ # parsing lines until we get one with 'ether ' in it.
+ # The range is the line we're on now -> the last line.
+ for y in xrange(i, len(lines) - 1):
+ if 'ether ' in lines[y]:
+ primary_mac = lines[y].split('ether ')[1].split(' ')[0]
+ break
+ break
+ i += 1
+
+# Gateway
+if options.gateway:
+ primary_gateway = options.gateway
+else:
+ cmd = subprocess.Popen(['/sbin/ip', 'route'], stdout=subprocess.PIPE)
+ stdout = cmd.communicate()[0]
+ for line in stdout.split("\n"):
+ if 'default' in line:
+ # default via 10.10.10.1 dev wlan0 proto static
+ primary_gateway = line.split('via ')[1].split(' ')[0]
+ break
+
+# And DNS servers
+if options.dns_resolvers:
+ dns_resolvers = options.dns_resolvers
+else:
+ dns_servers = []
+ with open('/etc/resolv.conf', 'r') as f:
+ for line in f.readlines():
+ if 'nameserver' in line:
+ dns = line.split(' ')
+ if len(dns) == 2:
+ dns_servers.append(dns[1].strip())
+ dns_resolvers = ','.join(dns_servers)
+
+print '-' * 30
+print 'Primary IP: ' + primary_ip
+print 'Primary Netmask: ' + primary_netmask
+print 'Primary Gateway: ' + primary_gateway
+print 'Primary MAC Address: ' + primary_mac
+print 'DNS Resolvers: ' + dns_resolvers
+print '-' * 30
+
+# 3. Construct the grubby line.
+# grubby --add-kernel=/boot/vmlinuz-install \
+# --args="ks=http://infrastructure.fedoraproject.org/\
+# repo/rhel/ks/hardware-rhel-6-nohd \
+# repo=http://infrastructure.fedoraproject.org/repo/rhel/RHEL6-x86_64/ \
+# ksdevice=link ip=$IP gateway=$GATEWAY netmask=$NETMASK dns=$DNS" \
+# --title="install el6" --initrd=/boot/initrd-install.img
+grubby_command = '/sbin/grubby --add-kernel=/boot/vmlinuz-install ' \
+ '--args="ks=%srepo/rhel/ks/%s ksdevice=%s ' \
+ 'ip=%s gateway=%s netmask=%s dns=%s repo=%srepo/rhel/RHEL6-x86_64/" ' \
+ '--title="install el6" --initrd=/boot/initrd-install.img' % (basehost,
+ options.ks_file,
+ primary_mac,
+ primary_ip,
+ primary_gateway,
+ primary_netmask,
+ dns_resolvers,
+ basehost)
+
+print 'This grubby command seems like it will work:'
+print '-' * 30
+print grubby_command
+print '-' * 30
+print 'Check the command and be sure that it looks correct.'
+
+if not options.noop:
+ if not options.yes:
+ print 'Type yes to continue, anything else to abort.'
+ print 'By continuing, I will run the above command.'
+ if raw_input('> ') != 'yes':
+ print 'Removing downloaded files.'
+ os.unlink('/boot/vmlinuz-install')
+ os.unlink('/boot/initrd-install.img')
+ print 'Aborting.'
+ sys.exit(1)
+
+ cmd = subprocess.Popen(shlex.split(grubby_command),
+ stdout=subprocess.PIPE,
+ stderr=subprocess.PIPE)
+ stdout, stderr = cmd.communicate()
+ if stdout:
+ print stdout
+ if stderr:
+ print "[STDERR output]"
+ print stderr
+
+ if not options.yes:
+ raw_input(
+ 'Examine the above output, if it looks sane, press enter to '
+ 'continue.')
+print 'The next command I will run is:'
+print 'echo "savedefault --default=0 --once" | grub --batch'
+
+if not options.noop:
+ cmd = subprocess.Popen(['/sbin/grub', '--batch'],
+ stdin=subprocess.PIPE,
+ stdout=subprocess.PIPE,
+ stderr=subprocess.STDOUT)
+ stdout = cmd.communicate(input='savedefault --default=0 --once\n')
+ print stdout[0]
+
+print 'Done.'
+print 'When you are ready, run: `shutdown -r now` to reboot.'
+print 'Go here:'
+print 'http://infrastructure.fedoraproject.org/infra/docs/kickstarts.txt'
+print 'And control-f for "Installation" (no quotes). Continue from there.'
+
+if options.noop:
+ print '-' * 30
+ print 'Script was run in "no-op" mode - none of the above commands ' \
+ 'actually ran.'
+ print '-' * 30
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/common-scripts/lock-wrapper b/roles/basessh/files/common-scripts/lock-wrapper
new file mode 100755
index 000000000..f990f635e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/common-scripts/lock-wrapper
@@ -0,0 +1,41 @@
+#!/bin/bash
+
+if [ $# -lt 2 ]; then
+ echo "Usage: $0 [name] [script]"
+ exit 1;
+fi
+
+NAME=$1
+SCRIPT=$2
+
+LOCKDIR="/var/tmp/$NAME"
+PIDFILE="$LOCKDIR/pid"
+
+function cleanup {
+ rm -rf "$LOCKDIR"
+}
+
+RESTORE_UMASK=$(umask -p)
+umask 0077
+if ! mkdir "$LOCKDIR"; then
+ echo "$LOCKDIR already exists"
+ PID=$(cat "$PIDFILE")
+ if [ -n "$PID" ] && /bin/ps $PID > /dev/null
+ then
+ echo "$PID is still running"
+ /bin/ps -o user,pid,start,time,comm $PID
+ exit 1;
+ else
+ echo "$LOCKDIR exists but $PID is dead"
+ echo "Removing lockdir and re-running"
+ /bin/rm -rf $LOCKDIR
+ mkdir $LOCKDIR || exit
+ fi
+fi
+
+trap cleanup EXIT SIGQUIT SIGHUP SIGTERM
+echo $$ > "$PIDFILE"
+
+$RESTORE_UMASK
+eval "$SCRIPT"
+
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/common-scripts/nag-once b/roles/basessh/files/common-scripts/nag-once
new file mode 100755
index 000000000..992023cac
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/common-scripts/nag-once
@@ -0,0 +1,108 @@
+#!/usr/bin/python -tt
+# nag once
+# take stdin and arguments: commandid time-to-ignore-same-output
+# if we encounter any kind of error just output whatever we're given
+# and prepend our own errors
+# so we don't hurt things any worse :)
+# copyright (c) 2011 Red Hat, inc
+# gpl v2 blah blah
+# skvidal - skvidal@fedoraproject.org
+
+import tempfile
+import sys
+import time
+import os
+import stat
+import glob
+
+
+def translate_tti(tti):
+ # translate 1w, 2d, 3d, 1m, 2h, 55m etc to seconds here
+
+ if tti is None:
+ return None
+
+ seconds_per_unit = {"s": 1, "m": 60, "h": 3600, "d": 86400, "w": 604800,}
+ if tti.isdigit():# just seconds
+ return int(tti)
+ return int(tti[:-1]) * seconds_per_unit[tti[-1]]
+
+
+
+def get_cmdid_dir(cmdid):
+ """return a path to a valid and safe cachedir"""
+ tmpdir="/var/tmp"
+ prefix = "nag-once:" + cmdid + "#"
+ dirpath = '%s/%s*' % (tmpdir, prefix)
+ cachedirs = sorted(glob.glob(dirpath))
+ for thisdir in cachedirs:
+ stats = os.lstat(thisdir)
+ if stat.S_ISDIR(stats[0]) and stat.S_IMODE(stats[0]) == 448 and stats[4] == os.getuid():
+ return thisdir
+
+ # make the dir (tempfile.mkdtemp())
+ cachedir = tempfile.mkdtemp(prefix=prefix, dir=tmpdir)
+ return cachedir
+
+
+
+def main():
+
+ if len(sys.argv) < 2:
+ raise Exception("Usage: nag-once cmdid [time-to-ignore]")
+
+ cmdid = sys.argv[1]
+ # go through and remove stupid shit from cmdid
+ cmdid = cmdid.replace('/', '')
+ cmdid = cmdid.replace('#', '')
+ cmdid = cmdid.replace('..', '')
+ cmdid = cmdid.replace(';', '')
+ cmdid = cmdid.replace('|', '')
+ cmdid = cmdid.replace('&', '')
+ cmdid = cmdid.replace('\\', '')
+
+ now = time.time()
+ tti = None
+ if len(sys.argv) > 2:
+ tti = sys.argv[2]
+
+ tti = translate_tti(tti)
+
+ # make up or find our tempdir
+ mydir = get_cmdid_dir(cmdid)
+
+ old_output = None
+ old_date = 0
+ if os.path.exists(mydir + '/output'):
+ old_output = open(mydir + '/output').read()
+ old_date = os.lstat(mydir + '/output')[stat.ST_MTIME]
+
+ # take from stdin
+ #
+ theinput = sys.stdin.read()
+ try:
+ # at this point we have to handle any outputs more ourself b/c we've just read
+ # out of sys.stdin :(
+
+ if theinput != old_output or (tti and now - old_date > tti):
+ if theinput.strip(): # if there is nothing here, don't output and don't drop a \n on the end of it
+ print theinput,
+ fo = open(mydir + '/output', 'w')
+ fo.write(theinput)
+ fo.flush()
+ fo.close()
+
+
+ except Exception, e:
+ print >> sys.stderr, e
+ print >> sys.stderr, theinput
+
+if __name__ == '__main__':
+ try:
+ main()
+ except Exception, e:
+ print >> sys.stderr, e
+ if not sys.stdin.isatty():
+ print >> sys.stderr, sys.stdin.read()
+
+
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/common-scripts/needs-reboot.py b/roles/basessh/files/common-scripts/needs-reboot.py
new file mode 100755
index 000000000..a39c9ea78
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/common-scripts/needs-reboot.py
@@ -0,0 +1,36 @@
+#!/usr/bin/python -tt
+
+import yum
+import sys
+import time
+import fnmatch
+
+result = 0
+now = time.time()
+uptime = float(open('/proc/uptime', 'r').read().split()[0])
+
+rebootcausers = ('glibc', 'kernel*')
+
+my = yum.YumBase()
+my.preconf.init_plugins=False
+my.preconf.debuglevel=1
+my.preconf.errorlevel=1
+pkgs = my.rpmdb.returnPackages(patterns=rebootcausers)
+
+does='no'
+for pkg in pkgs:
+ if (now - pkg.installtime) < uptime:
+ does='yes'
+ break
+
+if len(sys.argv) > 1 and sys.argv[1] == 'after-updates':
+ for (n, a, e, v, r) in my.up.getUpdatesList():
+ for i in rebootcausers:
+ if fnmatch.fnmatch(n, i):
+ does='yes'
+
+
+print does
+sys.exit(0)
+
+
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/common-scripts/proxy-conditional-reload.sh b/roles/basessh/files/common-scripts/proxy-conditional-reload.sh
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..ef600875f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/common-scripts/proxy-conditional-reload.sh
@@ -0,0 +1,25 @@
+#!/bin/bash
+# reload SERVICE only if PACKAGE is installed.
+# We use this throughout handlers/restart_services.yml
+
+SERVICE=$1
+PACKAGE=$2
+
+rpm -q $PACKAGE
+
+INSTALLED=$?
+
+if [ ! -f /etc/httpd/ticketkey_*.tkey ]; then
+ # This host is not configured yet, do not try and restart httpd
+ exit 0
+fi
+
+if [ $INSTALLED -eq 0 ]; then
+ echo "Package $PACKAGE installed. Attempting reload of $SERVICE."
+ /sbin/service $SERVICE reload
+ exit $? # Exit with the /sbin/service status code
+fi
+
+# If the package wasn't installed, then pretend everything is fine.
+echo "Package $PACKAGE not installed. Skipping reload of $SERVICE."
+exit 0
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/common-scripts/syncFiles.sh b/roles/basessh/files/common-scripts/syncFiles.sh
new file mode 100755
index 000000000..39a2c53de
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/common-scripts/syncFiles.sh
@@ -0,0 +1,50 @@
+#!/bin/bash
+# this script lets us sync files off of lockbox via rsync with locking and relatively niceness
+# look in rsyncd.conf on lockbox for what's available here
+
+set +e
+
+HOST=batcave01
+
+function cleanlock()
+{
+ /bin/rm -f /var/lock/$1.lock
+}
+
+
+function quit()
+{
+ echo $1
+ if [ $2 ]
+ then
+ cleanlock $2
+ fi
+ exit 2
+}
+
+function newlock()
+{
+ if [ -f /var/lock/$1.lock ]
+ then
+ quit "Lockfile exists.. Remove /var/lock/$1.lock"
+ else
+ touch /var/lock/$1.lock
+ fi
+}
+
+# General help
+if [ $3 ] || [ ! $2 ]
+then
+ quit "$0 source dest"
+fi
+
+lockname=`basename $1`
+newlock $lockname
+if [ ! -d $2 ]
+then
+ mkdir $2
+fi
+/usr/bin/rsync -a $HOST::$1/* $2
+cleanlock $lockname
+
+
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/digicert-intermediate.pem b/roles/basessh/files/digicert-intermediate.pem
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..cef3b9327
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/digicert-intermediate.pem
@@ -0,0 +1,29 @@
+-----BEGIN CERTIFICATE-----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+-----END CERTIFICATE-----
+
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..c8f2706da
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf
@@ -0,0 +1,687 @@
+# "false"
+# Global Postfix configuration file. This file lists only a subset
+# of all parameters. For the syntax, and for a complete parameter
+# list, see the postconf(5) manual page (command: "man 5 postconf").
+#
+# For common configuration examples, see BASIC_CONFIGURATION_README
+# and STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README. To find these documents, use
+# the command "postconf html_directory readme_directory", or go to
+# http://www.postfix.org/.
+#
+# For best results, change no more than 2-3 parameters at a time,
+# and test if Postfix still works after every change.
+
+# SOFT BOUNCE
+#
+# The soft_bounce parameter provides a limited safety net for
+# testing. When soft_bounce is enabled, mail will remain queued that
+# would otherwise bounce. This parameter disables locally-generated
+# bounces, and prevents the SMTP server from rejecting mail permanently
+# (by changing 5xx replies into 4xx replies). However, soft_bounce
+# is no cure for address rewriting mistakes or mail routing mistakes.
+#
+#soft_bounce = no
+
+# LOCAL PATHNAME INFORMATION
+#
+# The queue_directory specifies the location of the Postfix queue.
+# This is also the root directory of Postfix daemons that run chrooted.
+# See the files in examples/chroot-setup for setting up Postfix chroot
+# environments on different UNIX systems.
+#
+queue_directory = /var/spool/postfix
+
+# The command_directory parameter specifies the location of all
+# postXXX commands.
+#
+command_directory = /usr/sbin
+
+# The daemon_directory parameter specifies the location of all Postfix
+# daemon programs (i.e. programs listed in the master.cf file). This
+# directory must be owned by root.
+#
+daemon_directory = /usr/libexec/postfix
+
+# QUEUE AND PROCESS OWNERSHIP
+#
+# The mail_owner parameter specifies the owner of the Postfix queue
+# and of most Postfix daemon processes. Specify the name of a user
+# account THAT DOES NOT SHARE ITS USER OR GROUP ID WITH OTHER ACCOUNTS
+# AND THAT OWNS NO OTHER FILES OR PROCESSES ON THE SYSTEM. In
+# particular, don't specify nobody or daemon. PLEASE USE A DEDICATED
+# USER.
+#
+mail_owner = postfix
+
+# The default_privs parameter specifies the default rights used by
+# the local delivery agent for delivery to external file or command.
+# These rights are used in the absence of a recipient user context.
+# DO NOT SPECIFY A PRIVILEGED USER OR THE POSTFIX OWNER.
+#
+#default_privs = nobody
+
+# INTERNET HOST AND DOMAIN NAMES
+#
+# The myhostname parameter specifies the internet hostname of this
+# mail system. The default is to use the fully-qualified domain name
+# from gethostname(). $myhostname is used as a default value for many
+# other configuration parameters.
+#
+#myhostname = host.domain.tld
+#myhostname = virtual.domain.tld
+
+# The mydomain parameter specifies the local internet domain name.
+# The default is to use $myhostname minus the first component.
+# $mydomain is used as a default value for many other configuration
+# parameters.
+#
+#mydomain = domain.tld
+
+# SENDING MAIL
+#
+# The myorigin parameter specifies the domain that locally-posted
+# mail appears to come from. The default is to append $myhostname,
+# which is fine for small sites. If you run a domain with multiple
+# machines, you should (1) change this to $mydomain and (2) set up
+# a domain-wide alias database that aliases each user to
+# user@that.users.mailhost.
+#
+# For the sake of consistency between sender and recipient addresses,
+# myorigin also specifies the default domain name that is appended
+# to recipient addresses that have no @domain part.
+#
+#myorigin = $myhostname
+#myorigin = $mydomain
+
+mydomain = fedoraproject.org
+myorigin = fedoraproject.org
+
+# RECEIVING MAIL
+
+# The inet_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on. By default,
+# the software claims all active interfaces on the machine. The
+# parameter also controls delivery of mail to user@[ip.address].
+#
+# See also the proxy_interfaces parameter, for network addresses that
+# are forwarded to us via a proxy or network address translator.
+#
+# Note: you need to stop/start Postfix when this parameter changes.
+#
+#inet_interfaces = all
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname, localhost
+inet_interfaces = all
+
+# The proxy_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on by way of a
+# proxy or network address translation unit. This setting extends
+# the address list specified with the inet_interfaces parameter.
+#
+# You must specify your proxy/NAT addresses when your system is a
+# backup MX host for other domains, otherwise mail delivery loops
+# will happen when the primary MX host is down.
+#
+#proxy_interfaces =
+#proxy_interfaces = 1.2.3.4
+
+# The mydestination parameter specifies the list of domains that this
+# machine considers itself the final destination for.
+#
+# These domains are routed to the delivery agent specified with the
+# local_transport parameter setting. By default, that is the UNIX
+# compatible delivery agent that lookups all recipients in /etc/passwd
+# and /etc/aliases or their equivalent.
+#
+# The default is $myhostname + localhost.$mydomain. On a mail domain
+# gateway, you should also include $mydomain.
+#
+# Do not specify the names of virtual domains - those domains are
+# specified elsewhere (see VIRTUAL_README).
+#
+# Do not specify the names of domains that this machine is backup MX
+# host for. Specify those names via the relay_domains settings for
+# the SMTP server, or use permit_mx_backup if you are lazy (see
+# STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README).
+#
+# The local machine is always the final destination for mail addressed
+# to user@[the.net.work.address] of an interface that the mail system
+# receives mail on (see the inet_interfaces parameter).
+#
+# Specify a list of host or domain names, /file/name or type:table
+# patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. A /file/name
+# pattern is replaced by its contents; a type:table is matched when
+# a name matches a lookup key (the right-hand side is ignored).
+# Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.
+#
+# See also below, section "REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS".
+#
+mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, fedora.redhat.com, localhost
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain,
+# mail.$mydomain, www.$mydomain, ftp.$mydomain
+
+# REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS
+#
+# The local_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all names or addresses of users that are local with respect
+# to $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown local users. This parameter is defined by default.
+#
+# To turn off local recipient checking in the SMTP server, specify
+# local_recipient_maps = (i.e. empty).
+#
+# The default setting assumes that you use the default Postfix local
+# delivery agent for local delivery. You need to update the
+# local_recipient_maps setting if:
+#
+# - You define $mydestination domain recipients in files other than
+# /etc/passwd, /etc/aliases, or the $virtual_alias_maps files.
+# For example, you define $mydestination domain recipients in
+# the $virtual_mailbox_maps files.
+#
+# - You redefine the local delivery agent in master.cf.
+#
+# - You redefine the "local_transport" setting in main.cf.
+#
+# - You use the "luser_relay", "mailbox_transport", or "fallback_transport"
+# feature of the Postfix local delivery agent (see local(8)).
+#
+# Details are described in the LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README file.
+#
+# Beware: if the Postfix SMTP server runs chrooted, you probably have
+# to access the passwd file via the proxymap service, in order to
+# overcome chroot restrictions. The alternative, having a copy of
+# the system passwd file in the chroot jail is just not practical.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify a bare username, an @domain.tld
+# wild-card, or specify a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#local_recipient_maps = unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps = proxy:unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps =
+
+# The unknown_local_recipient_reject_code specifies the SMTP server
+# response code when a recipient domain matches $mydestination or
+# ${proxy,inet}_interfaces, while $local_recipient_maps is non-empty
+# and the recipient address or address local-part is not found.
+#
+# The default setting is 550 (reject mail) but it is safer to start
+# with 450 (try again later) until you are certain that your
+# local_recipient_maps settings are OK.
+#
+unknown_local_recipient_reject_code = 550
+
+# TRUST AND RELAY CONTROL
+
+# The mynetworks parameter specifies the list of "trusted" SMTP
+# clients that have more privileges than "strangers".
+#
+# In particular, "trusted" SMTP clients are allowed to relay mail
+# through Postfix. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions parameter
+# in postconf(5).
+#
+# You can specify the list of "trusted" network addresses by hand
+# or you can let Postfix do it for you (which is the default).
+#
+# By default (mynetworks_style = subnet), Postfix "trusts" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP subnetworks as the local machine.
+# On Linux, this does works correctly only with interfaces specified
+# with the "ifconfig" command.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = class" when Postfix should "trust" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP class A/B/C networks as the local machine.
+# Don't do this with a dialup site - it would cause Postfix to "trust"
+# your entire provider's network. Instead, specify an explicit
+# mynetworks list by hand, as described below.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = host" when Postfix should "trust"
+# only the local machine.
+#
+#mynetworks_style = class
+#mynetworks_style = subnet
+#mynetworks_style = host
+
+# Alternatively, you can specify the mynetworks list by hand, in
+# which case Postfix ignores the mynetworks_style setting.
+#
+# Specify an explicit list of network/netmask patterns, where the
+# mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host
+# address.
+#
+# You can also specify the absolute pathname of a pattern file instead
+# of listing the patterns here. Specify type:table for table-based lookups
+# (the value on the table right-hand side is not used).
+#
+#mynetworks = 168.100.189.0/28, 127.0.0.0/8
+#mynetworks = $config_directory/mynetworks
+#mynetworks = hash:/etc/postfix/network_table
+
+
+# The relay_domains parameter restricts what destinations this system will
+# relay mail to. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions description in
+# postconf(5) for detailed information.
+#
+# By default, Postfix relays mail
+# - from "trusted" clients (IP address matches $mynetworks) to any destination,
+# - from "untrusted" clients to destinations that match $relay_domains or
+# subdomains thereof, except addresses with sender-specified routing.
+# The default relay_domains value is $mydestination.
+#
+# In addition to the above, the Postfix SMTP server by default accepts mail
+# that Postfix is final destination for:
+# - destinations that match $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces,
+# - destinations that match $mydestination
+# - destinations that match $virtual_alias_domains,
+# - destinations that match $virtual_mailbox_domains.
+# These destinations do not need to be listed in $relay_domains.
+#
+# Specify a list of hosts or domains, /file/name patterns or type:name
+# lookup tables, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue
+# long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. A file name
+# is replaced by its contents; a type:name table is matched when a
+# (parent) domain appears as lookup key.
+#
+# NOTE: Postfix will not automatically forward mail for domains that
+# list this system as their primary or backup MX host. See the
+# permit_mx_backup restriction description in postconf(5).
+#
+#relay_domains = $mydestination
+
+
+
+# INTERNET OR INTRANET
+
+# The relayhost parameter specifies the default host to send mail to
+# when no entry is matched in the optional transport(5) table. When
+# no relayhost is given, mail is routed directly to the destination.
+#
+# On an intranet, specify the organizational domain name. If your
+# internal DNS uses no MX records, specify the name of the intranet
+# gateway host instead.
+#
+# In the case of SMTP, specify a domain, host, host:port, [host]:port,
+# [address] or [address]:port; the form [host] turns off MX lookups.
+#
+# If you're connected via UUCP, see also the default_transport parameter.
+#
+#relayhost = $mydomain
+#relayhost = [gateway.my.domain]
+#relayhost = [mailserver.isp.tld]
+#relayhost = uucphost
+#relayhost = [an.ip.add.ress]
+relayhost = bastion
+
+
+# REJECTING UNKNOWN RELAY USERS
+#
+# The relay_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all addresses in the domains that match $relay_domains.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown relay users. This feature is off by default.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify an @domain.tld wild-card, or specify
+# a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#relay_recipient_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_recipients
+
+# INPUT RATE CONTROL
+#
+# The in_flow_delay configuration parameter implements mail input
+# flow control. This feature is turned on by default, although it
+# still needs further development (it's disabled on SCO UNIX due
+# to an SCO bug).
+#
+# A Postfix process will pause for $in_flow_delay seconds before
+# accepting a new message, when the message arrival rate exceeds the
+# message delivery rate. With the default 100 SMTP server process
+# limit, this limits the mail inflow to 100 messages a second more
+# than the number of messages delivered per second.
+#
+# Specify 0 to disable the feature. Valid delays are 0..10.
+#
+#in_flow_delay = 1s
+
+# ADDRESS REWRITING
+#
+# The ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document gives information about
+# address masquerading or other forms of address rewriting including
+# username->Firstname.Lastname mapping.
+
+masquerade_domains = redhat.com
+masquerade_exceptions = root apache
+
+# ADDRESS REDIRECTION (VIRTUAL DOMAIN)
+#
+# The VIRTUAL_README document gives information about the many forms
+# of domain hosting that Postfix supports.
+
+# "USER HAS MOVED" BOUNCE MESSAGES
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# TRANSPORT MAP
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# ALIAS DATABASE
+#
+# The alias_maps parameter specifies the list of alias databases used
+# by the local delivery agent. The default list is system dependent.
+#
+# On systems with NIS, the default is to search the local alias
+# database, then the NIS alias database. See aliases(5) for syntax
+# details.
+#
+# If you change the alias database, run "postalias /etc/aliases" (or
+# wherever your system stores the mail alias file), or simply run
+# "newaliases" to build the necessary DBM or DB file.
+#
+# It will take a minute or so before changes become visible. Use
+# "postfix reload" to eliminate the delay.
+#
+#alias_maps = dbm:/etc/aliases
+alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, nis:mail.aliases
+#alias_maps = netinfo:/aliases
+
+# The alias_database parameter specifies the alias database(s) that
+# are built with "newaliases" or "sendmail -bi". This is a separate
+# configuration parameter, because alias_maps (see above) may specify
+# tables that are not necessarily all under control by Postfix.
+#
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/mail/aliases
+alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases, hash:/opt/majordomo/aliases
+
+# ADDRESS EXTENSIONS (e.g., user+foo)
+#
+# The recipient_delimiter parameter specifies the separator between
+# user names and address extensions (user+foo). See canonical(5),
+# local(8), relocated(5) and virtual(5) for the effects this has on
+# aliases, canonical, virtual, relocated and .forward file lookups.
+# Basically, the software tries user+foo and .forward+foo before
+# trying user and .forward.
+#
+recipient_delimiter = +
+
+# DELIVERY TO MAILBOX
+#
+# The home_mailbox parameter specifies the optional pathname of a
+# mailbox file relative to a user's home directory. The default
+# mailbox file is /var/spool/mail/user or /var/mail/user. Specify
+# "Maildir/" for qmail-style delivery (the / is required).
+#
+#home_mailbox = Mailbox
+#home_mailbox = Maildir/
+
+# The mail_spool_directory parameter specifies the directory where
+# UNIX-style mailboxes are kept. The default setting depends on the
+# system type.
+#
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/mail
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/spool/mail
+
+# The mailbox_command parameter specifies the optional external
+# command to use instead of mailbox delivery. The command is run as
+# the recipient with proper HOME, SHELL and LOGNAME environment settings.
+# Exception: delivery for root is done as $default_user.
+#
+# Other environment variables of interest: USER (recipient username),
+# EXTENSION (address extension), DOMAIN (domain part of address),
+# and LOCAL (the address localpart).
+#
+# Unlike other Postfix configuration parameters, the mailbox_command
+# parameter is not subjected to $parameter substitutions. This is to
+# make it easier to specify shell syntax (see example below).
+#
+# Avoid shell meta characters because they will force Postfix to run
+# an expensive shell process. Procmail alone is expensive enough.
+#
+# IF YOU USE THIS TO DELIVER MAIL SYSTEM-WIDE, YOU MUST SET UP AN
+# ALIAS THAT FORWARDS MAIL FOR ROOT TO A REAL USER.
+#
+#mailbox_command = /usr/bin/procmail
+#mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail -a "$EXTENSION"
+
+# The mailbox_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use after processing aliases and .forward files. This parameter
+# has precedence over the mailbox_command, fallback_transport and
+# luser_relay parameters.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+
+# If using the cyrus-imapd IMAP server deliver local mail to the IMAP
+# server using LMTP (Local Mail Transport Protocol), this is prefered
+# over the older cyrus deliver program by setting the
+# mailbox_transport as below:
+#
+# mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#
+# The efficiency of LMTP delivery for cyrus-imapd can be enhanced via
+# these settings.
+#
+# local_destination_recipient_limit = 300
+# local_destination_concurrency_limit = 5
+#
+# Of course you should adjust these settings as appropriate for the
+# capacity of the hardware you are using. The recipient limit setting
+# can be used to take advantage of the single instance message store
+# capability of Cyrus. The concurrency limit can be used to control
+# how many simultaneous LMTP sessions will be permitted to the Cyrus
+# message store.
+#
+# To use the old cyrus deliver program you have to set:
+#mailbox_transport = cyrus
+
+# The fallback_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use for recipients that are not found in the UNIX passwd database.
+# This parameter has precedence over the luser_relay parameter.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#fallback_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#fallback_transport =
+
+#transport_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/transport
+# The luser_relay parameter specifies an optional destination address
+# for unknown recipients. By default, mail for unknown@$mydestination,
+# unknown@[$inet_interfaces] or unknown@[$proxy_interfaces] is returned
+# as undeliverable.
+#
+# The following expansions are done on luser_relay: $user (recipient
+# username), $shell (recipient shell), $home (recipient home directory),
+# $recipient (full recipient address), $extension (recipient address
+# extension), $domain (recipient domain), $local (entire recipient
+# localpart), $recipient_delimiter. Specify ${name?value} or
+# ${name:value} to expand value only when $name does (does not) exist.
+#
+# luser_relay works only for the default Postfix local delivery agent.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must specify "local_recipient_maps =" (i.e. empty) in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#luser_relay = $user@other.host
+#luser_relay = $local@other.host
+#luser_relay = admin+$local
+
+# JUNK MAIL CONTROLS
+#
+# The controls listed here are only a very small subset. The file
+# SMTPD_ACCESS_README provides an overview.
+
+# The header_checks parameter specifies an optional table with patterns
+# that each logical message header is matched against, including
+# headers that span multiple physical lines.
+#
+# By default, these patterns also apply to MIME headers and to the
+# headers of attached messages. With older Postfix versions, MIME and
+# attached message headers were treated as body text.
+#
+# For details, see "man header_checks".
+#
+header_checks = regexp:/etc/postfix/header_checks
+
+# FAST ETRN SERVICE
+#
+# Postfix maintains per-destination logfiles with information about
+# deferred mail, so that mail can be flushed quickly with the SMTP
+# "ETRN domain.tld" command, or by executing "sendmail -qRdomain.tld".
+# See the ETRN_README document for a detailed description.
+#
+# The fast_flush_domains parameter controls what destinations are
+# eligible for this service. By default, they are all domains that
+# this server is willing to relay mail to.
+#
+#fast_flush_domains = $relay_domains
+
+# SHOW SOFTWARE VERSION OR NOT
+#
+# The smtpd_banner parameter specifies the text that follows the 220
+# code in the SMTP server's greeting banner. Some people like to see
+# the mail version advertised. By default, Postfix shows no version.
+#
+# You MUST specify $myhostname at the start of the text. That is an
+# RFC requirement. Postfix itself does not care.
+#
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name ($mail_version)
+
+# PARALLEL DELIVERY TO THE SAME DESTINATION
+#
+# How many parallel deliveries to the same user or domain? With local
+# delivery, it does not make sense to do massively parallel delivery
+# to the same user, because mailbox updates must happen sequentially,
+# and expensive pipelines in .forward files can cause disasters when
+# too many are run at the same time. With SMTP deliveries, 10
+# simultaneous connections to the same domain could be sufficient to
+# raise eyebrows.
+#
+# Each message delivery transport has its XXX_destination_concurrency_limit
+# parameter. The default is $default_destination_concurrency_limit for
+# most delivery transports. For the local delivery agent the default is 2.
+
+#local_destination_concurrency_limit = 2
+#default_destination_concurrency_limit = 20
+
+# DEBUGGING CONTROL
+#
+# The debug_peer_level parameter specifies the increment in verbose
+# logging level when an SMTP client or server host name or address
+# matches a pattern in the debug_peer_list parameter.
+#
+debug_peer_level = 2
+
+# The debug_peer_list parameter specifies an optional list of domain
+# or network patterns, /file/name patterns or type:name tables. When
+# an SMTP client or server host name or address matches a pattern,
+# increase the verbose logging level by the amount specified in the
+# debug_peer_level parameter.
+#
+#debug_peer_list = 127.0.0.1
+#debug_peer_list = some.domain
+
+# The debugger_command specifies the external command that is executed
+# when a Postfix daemon program is run with the -D option.
+#
+# Use "command .. & sleep 5" so that the debugger can attach before
+# the process marches on. If you use an X-based debugger, be sure to
+# set up your XAUTHORITY environment variable before starting Postfix.
+#
+debugger_command =
+ PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin:/usr/X11R6/bin
+ xxgdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id & sleep 5
+
+# If you can't use X, use this to capture the call stack when a
+# daemon crashes. The result is in a file in the configuration
+# directory, and is named after the process name and the process ID.
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin; export PATH; (echo cont;
+# echo where) | gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id 2>&1
+# >$config_directory/$process_name.$process_id.log & sleep 5
+#
+# Another possibility is to run gdb under a detached screen session.
+# To attach to the screen sesssion, su root and run "screen -r
+# <id_string>" where <id_string> uniquely matches one of the detached
+# sessions (from "screen -list").
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/sbin:/usr/sbin; export PATH; screen
+# -dmS $process_name gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name
+# $process_id & sleep 1
+
+# INSTALL-TIME CONFIGURATION INFORMATION
+#
+# The following parameters are used when installing a new Postfix version.
+#
+# sendmail_path: The full pathname of the Postfix sendmail command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible mail posting interface.
+#
+sendmail_path = /usr/sbin/sendmail.postfix
+
+# newaliases_path: The full pathname of the Postfix newaliases command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible command to build alias databases.
+#
+newaliases_path = /usr/bin/newaliases.postfix
+
+# mailq_path: The full pathname of the Postfix mailq command. This
+# is the Sendmail-compatible mail queue listing command.
+#
+mailq_path = /usr/bin/mailq.postfix
+
+# setgid_group: The group for mail submission and queue management
+# commands. This must be a group name with a numerical group ID that
+# is not shared with other accounts, not even with the Postfix account.
+#
+setgid_group = postdrop
+
+# html_directory: The location of the Postfix HTML documentation.
+#
+html_directory = no
+
+# manpage_directory: The location of the Postfix on-line manual pages.
+#
+manpage_directory = /usr/share/man
+
+# sample_directory: The location of the Postfix sample configuration files.
+# This parameter is obsolete as of Postfix 2.1.
+#
+sample_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/samples
+
+# readme_directory: The location of the Postfix README files.
+#
+readme_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/README_FILES
+
+# add this to new postfix to get it to add proper message-id and other
+# headers to outgoing emails via the gateway.
+
+
+message_size_limit = 20971520
+#inet_protocols = ipv4
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.209.132.184.113 b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.209.132.184.113
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..358a8de31
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.209.132.184.113
@@ -0,0 +1,686 @@
+# "false"
+# Global Postfix configuration file. This file lists only a subset
+# of all parameters. For the syntax, and for a complete parameter
+# list, see the postconf(5) manual page (command: "man 5 postconf").
+#
+# For common configuration examples, see BASIC_CONFIGURATION_README
+# and STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README. To find these documents, use
+# the command "postconf html_directory readme_directory", or go to
+# http://www.postfix.org/.
+#
+# For best results, change no more than 2-3 parameters at a time,
+# and test if Postfix still works after every change.
+
+# SOFT BOUNCE
+#
+# The soft_bounce parameter provides a limited safety net for
+# testing. When soft_bounce is enabled, mail will remain queued that
+# would otherwise bounce. This parameter disables locally-generated
+# bounces, and prevents the SMTP server from rejecting mail permanently
+# (by changing 5xx replies into 4xx replies). However, soft_bounce
+# is no cure for address rewriting mistakes or mail routing mistakes.
+#
+#soft_bounce = no
+
+# LOCAL PATHNAME INFORMATION
+#
+# The queue_directory specifies the location of the Postfix queue.
+# This is also the root directory of Postfix daemons that run chrooted.
+# See the files in examples/chroot-setup for setting up Postfix chroot
+# environments on different UNIX systems.
+#
+queue_directory = /var/spool/postfix
+
+# The command_directory parameter specifies the location of all
+# postXXX commands.
+#
+command_directory = /usr/sbin
+
+# The daemon_directory parameter specifies the location of all Postfix
+# daemon programs (i.e. programs listed in the master.cf file). This
+# directory must be owned by root.
+#
+daemon_directory = /usr/libexec/postfix
+
+# QUEUE AND PROCESS OWNERSHIP
+#
+# The mail_owner parameter specifies the owner of the Postfix queue
+# and of most Postfix daemon processes. Specify the name of a user
+# account THAT DOES NOT SHARE ITS USER OR GROUP ID WITH OTHER ACCOUNTS
+# AND THAT OWNS NO OTHER FILES OR PROCESSES ON THE SYSTEM. In
+# particular, don't specify nobody or daemon. PLEASE USE A DEDICATED
+# USER.
+#
+mail_owner = postfix
+
+# The default_privs parameter specifies the default rights used by
+# the local delivery agent for delivery to external file or command.
+# These rights are used in the absence of a recipient user context.
+# DO NOT SPECIFY A PRIVILEGED USER OR THE POSTFIX OWNER.
+#
+#default_privs = nobody
+
+# INTERNET HOST AND DOMAIN NAMES
+#
+# The myhostname parameter specifies the internet hostname of this
+# mail system. The default is to use the fully-qualified domain name
+# from gethostname(). $myhostname is used as a default value for many
+# other configuration parameters.
+#
+#myhostname = host.domain.tld
+#myhostname = virtual.domain.tld
+
+# The mydomain parameter specifies the local internet domain name.
+# The default is to use $myhostname minus the first component.
+# $mydomain is used as a default value for many other configuration
+# parameters.
+#
+#mydomain = domain.tld
+
+# SENDING MAIL
+#
+# The myorigin parameter specifies the domain that locally-posted
+# mail appears to come from. The default is to append $myhostname,
+# which is fine for small sites. If you run a domain with multiple
+# machines, you should (1) change this to $mydomain and (2) set up
+# a domain-wide alias database that aliases each user to
+# user@that.users.mailhost.
+#
+# For the sake of consistency between sender and recipient addresses,
+# myorigin also specifies the default domain name that is appended
+# to recipient addresses that have no @domain part.
+#
+#myorigin = $myhostname
+#myorigin = $mydomain
+
+mydomain = fedoraproject.org
+myorigin = fedoraproject.org
+
+# RECEIVING MAIL
+
+# The inet_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on. By default,
+# the software claims all active interfaces on the machine. The
+# parameter also controls delivery of mail to user@[ip.address].
+#
+# See also the proxy_interfaces parameter, for network addresses that
+# are forwarded to us via a proxy or network address translator.
+#
+# Note: you need to stop/start Postfix when this parameter changes.
+#
+#inet_interfaces = all
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname, localhost
+inet_interfaces = all
+
+# The proxy_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on by way of a
+# proxy or network address translation unit. This setting extends
+# the address list specified with the inet_interfaces parameter.
+#
+# You must specify your proxy/NAT addresses when your system is a
+# backup MX host for other domains, otherwise mail delivery loops
+# will happen when the primary MX host is down.
+#
+#proxy_interfaces =
+#proxy_interfaces = 1.2.3.4
+
+# The mydestination parameter specifies the list of domains that this
+# machine considers itself the final destination for.
+#
+# These domains are routed to the delivery agent specified with the
+# local_transport parameter setting. By default, that is the UNIX
+# compatible delivery agent that lookups all recipients in /etc/passwd
+# and /etc/aliases or their equivalent.
+#
+# The default is $myhostname + localhost.$mydomain. On a mail domain
+# gateway, you should also include $mydomain.
+#
+# Do not specify the names of virtual domains - those domains are
+# specified elsewhere (see VIRTUAL_README).
+#
+# Do not specify the names of domains that this machine is backup MX
+# host for. Specify those names via the relay_domains settings for
+# the SMTP server, or use permit_mx_backup if you are lazy (see
+# STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README).
+#
+# The local machine is always the final destination for mail addressed
+# to user@[the.net.work.address] of an interface that the mail system
+# receives mail on (see the inet_interfaces parameter).
+#
+# Specify a list of host or domain names, /file/name or type:table
+# patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. A /file/name
+# pattern is replaced by its contents; a type:table is matched when
+# a name matches a lookup key (the right-hand side is ignored).
+# Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.
+#
+# See also below, section "REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS".
+#
+mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, fedora.redhat.com, localhost
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain,
+# mail.$mydomain, www.$mydomain, ftp.$mydomain
+
+# REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS
+#
+# The local_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all names or addresses of users that are local with respect
+# to $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown local users. This parameter is defined by default.
+#
+# To turn off local recipient checking in the SMTP server, specify
+# local_recipient_maps = (i.e. empty).
+#
+# The default setting assumes that you use the default Postfix local
+# delivery agent for local delivery. You need to update the
+# local_recipient_maps setting if:
+#
+# - You define $mydestination domain recipients in files other than
+# /etc/passwd, /etc/aliases, or the $virtual_alias_maps files.
+# For example, you define $mydestination domain recipients in
+# the $virtual_mailbox_maps files.
+#
+# - You redefine the local delivery agent in master.cf.
+#
+# - You redefine the "local_transport" setting in main.cf.
+#
+# - You use the "luser_relay", "mailbox_transport", or "fallback_transport"
+# feature of the Postfix local delivery agent (see local(8)).
+#
+# Details are described in the LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README file.
+#
+# Beware: if the Postfix SMTP server runs chrooted, you probably have
+# to access the passwd file via the proxymap service, in order to
+# overcome chroot restrictions. The alternative, having a copy of
+# the system passwd file in the chroot jail is just not practical.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify a bare username, an @domain.tld
+# wild-card, or specify a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#local_recipient_maps = unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps = proxy:unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps =
+
+# The unknown_local_recipient_reject_code specifies the SMTP server
+# response code when a recipient domain matches $mydestination or
+# ${proxy,inet}_interfaces, while $local_recipient_maps is non-empty
+# and the recipient address or address local-part is not found.
+#
+# The default setting is 550 (reject mail) but it is safer to start
+# with 450 (try again later) until you are certain that your
+# local_recipient_maps settings are OK.
+#
+unknown_local_recipient_reject_code = 550
+
+# TRUST AND RELAY CONTROL
+
+# The mynetworks parameter specifies the list of "trusted" SMTP
+# clients that have more privileges than "strangers".
+#
+# In particular, "trusted" SMTP clients are allowed to relay mail
+# through Postfix. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions parameter
+# in postconf(5).
+#
+# You can specify the list of "trusted" network addresses by hand
+# or you can let Postfix do it for you (which is the default).
+#
+# By default (mynetworks_style = subnet), Postfix "trusts" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP subnetworks as the local machine.
+# On Linux, this does works correctly only with interfaces specified
+# with the "ifconfig" command.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = class" when Postfix should "trust" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP class A/B/C networks as the local machine.
+# Don't do this with a dialup site - it would cause Postfix to "trust"
+# your entire provider's network. Instead, specify an explicit
+# mynetworks list by hand, as described below.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = host" when Postfix should "trust"
+# only the local machine.
+#
+#mynetworks_style = class
+#mynetworks_style = subnet
+#mynetworks_style = host
+
+# Alternatively, you can specify the mynetworks list by hand, in
+# which case Postfix ignores the mynetworks_style setting.
+#
+# Specify an explicit list of network/netmask patterns, where the
+# mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host
+# address.
+#
+# You can also specify the absolute pathname of a pattern file instead
+# of listing the patterns here. Specify type:table for table-based lookups
+# (the value on the table right-hand side is not used).
+#
+#mynetworks = 168.100.189.0/28, 127.0.0.0/8
+#mynetworks = $config_directory/mynetworks
+#mynetworks = hash:/etc/postfix/network_table
+
+
+# The relay_domains parameter restricts what destinations this system will
+# relay mail to. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions description in
+# postconf(5) for detailed information.
+#
+# By default, Postfix relays mail
+# - from "trusted" clients (IP address matches $mynetworks) to any destination,
+# - from "untrusted" clients to destinations that match $relay_domains or
+# subdomains thereof, except addresses with sender-specified routing.
+# The default relay_domains value is $mydestination.
+#
+# In addition to the above, the Postfix SMTP server by default accepts mail
+# that Postfix is final destination for:
+# - destinations that match $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces,
+# - destinations that match $mydestination
+# - destinations that match $virtual_alias_domains,
+# - destinations that match $virtual_mailbox_domains.
+# These destinations do not need to be listed in $relay_domains.
+#
+# Specify a list of hosts or domains, /file/name patterns or type:name
+# lookup tables, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue
+# long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. A file name
+# is replaced by its contents; a type:name table is matched when a
+# (parent) domain appears as lookup key.
+#
+# NOTE: Postfix will not automatically forward mail for domains that
+# list this system as their primary or backup MX host. See the
+# permit_mx_backup restriction description in postconf(5).
+#
+#relay_domains = $mydestination
+
+
+
+# INTERNET OR INTRANET
+
+# The relayhost parameter specifies the default host to send mail to
+# when no entry is matched in the optional transport(5) table. When
+# no relayhost is given, mail is routed directly to the destination.
+#
+# On an intranet, specify the organizational domain name. If your
+# internal DNS uses no MX records, specify the name of the intranet
+# gateway host instead.
+#
+# In the case of SMTP, specify a domain, host, host:port, [host]:port,
+# [address] or [address]:port; the form [host] turns off MX lookups.
+#
+# If you're connected via UUCP, see also the default_transport parameter.
+#
+#relayhost = $mydomain
+#relayhost = [gateway.my.domain]
+#relayhost = [mailserver.isp.tld]
+#relayhost = uucphost
+#relayhost = [an.ip.add.ress]
+relayhost =
+
+
+# REJECTING UNKNOWN RELAY USERS
+#
+# The relay_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all addresses in the domains that match $relay_domains.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown relay users. This feature is off by default.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify an @domain.tld wild-card, or specify
+# a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#relay_recipient_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_recipients
+
+# INPUT RATE CONTROL
+#
+# The in_flow_delay configuration parameter implements mail input
+# flow control. This feature is turned on by default, although it
+# still needs further development (it's disabled on SCO UNIX due
+# to an SCO bug).
+#
+# A Postfix process will pause for $in_flow_delay seconds before
+# accepting a new message, when the message arrival rate exceeds the
+# message delivery rate. With the default 100 SMTP server process
+# limit, this limits the mail inflow to 100 messages a second more
+# than the number of messages delivered per second.
+#
+# Specify 0 to disable the feature. Valid delays are 0..10.
+#
+#in_flow_delay = 1s
+
+# ADDRESS REWRITING
+#
+# The ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document gives information about
+# address masquerading or other forms of address rewriting including
+# username->Firstname.Lastname mapping.
+
+masquerade_domains = redhat.com
+masquerade_exceptions = root apache
+
+# ADDRESS REDIRECTION (VIRTUAL DOMAIN)
+#
+# The VIRTUAL_README document gives information about the many forms
+# of domain hosting that Postfix supports.
+
+# "USER HAS MOVED" BOUNCE MESSAGES
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# TRANSPORT MAP
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# ALIAS DATABASE
+#
+# The alias_maps parameter specifies the list of alias databases used
+# by the local delivery agent. The default list is system dependent.
+#
+# On systems with NIS, the default is to search the local alias
+# database, then the NIS alias database. See aliases(5) for syntax
+# details.
+#
+# If you change the alias database, run "postalias /etc/aliases" (or
+# wherever your system stores the mail alias file), or simply run
+# "newaliases" to build the necessary DBM or DB file.
+#
+# It will take a minute or so before changes become visible. Use
+# "postfix reload" to eliminate the delay.
+#
+#alias_maps = dbm:/etc/aliases
+alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, nis:mail.aliases
+#alias_maps = netinfo:/aliases
+
+# The alias_database parameter specifies the alias database(s) that
+# are built with "newaliases" or "sendmail -bi". This is a separate
+# configuration parameter, because alias_maps (see above) may specify
+# tables that are not necessarily all under control by Postfix.
+#
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/mail/aliases
+alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases, hash:/opt/majordomo/aliases
+
+# ADDRESS EXTENSIONS (e.g., user+foo)
+#
+# The recipient_delimiter parameter specifies the separator between
+# user names and address extensions (user+foo). See canonical(5),
+# local(8), relocated(5) and virtual(5) for the effects this has on
+# aliases, canonical, virtual, relocated and .forward file lookups.
+# Basically, the software tries user+foo and .forward+foo before
+# trying user and .forward.
+#
+recipient_delimiter = +
+
+# DELIVERY TO MAILBOX
+#
+# The home_mailbox parameter specifies the optional pathname of a
+# mailbox file relative to a user's home directory. The default
+# mailbox file is /var/spool/mail/user or /var/mail/user. Specify
+# "Maildir/" for qmail-style delivery (the / is required).
+#
+#home_mailbox = Mailbox
+#home_mailbox = Maildir/
+
+# The mail_spool_directory parameter specifies the directory where
+# UNIX-style mailboxes are kept. The default setting depends on the
+# system type.
+#
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/mail
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/spool/mail
+
+# The mailbox_command parameter specifies the optional external
+# command to use instead of mailbox delivery. The command is run as
+# the recipient with proper HOME, SHELL and LOGNAME environment settings.
+# Exception: delivery for root is done as $default_user.
+#
+# Other environment variables of interest: USER (recipient username),
+# EXTENSION (address extension), DOMAIN (domain part of address),
+# and LOCAL (the address localpart).
+#
+# Unlike other Postfix configuration parameters, the mailbox_command
+# parameter is not subjected to $parameter substitutions. This is to
+# make it easier to specify shell syntax (see example below).
+#
+# Avoid shell meta characters because they will force Postfix to run
+# an expensive shell process. Procmail alone is expensive enough.
+#
+# IF YOU USE THIS TO DELIVER MAIL SYSTEM-WIDE, YOU MUST SET UP AN
+# ALIAS THAT FORWARDS MAIL FOR ROOT TO A REAL USER.
+#
+#mailbox_command = /usr/bin/procmail
+#mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail -a "$EXTENSION"
+
+# The mailbox_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use after processing aliases and .forward files. This parameter
+# has precedence over the mailbox_command, fallback_transport and
+# luser_relay parameters.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+
+# If using the cyrus-imapd IMAP server deliver local mail to the IMAP
+# server using LMTP (Local Mail Transport Protocol), this is prefered
+# over the older cyrus deliver program by setting the
+# mailbox_transport as below:
+#
+# mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#
+# The efficiency of LMTP delivery for cyrus-imapd can be enhanced via
+# these settings.
+#
+# local_destination_recipient_limit = 300
+# local_destination_concurrency_limit = 5
+#
+# Of course you should adjust these settings as appropriate for the
+# capacity of the hardware you are using. The recipient limit setting
+# can be used to take advantage of the single instance message store
+# capability of Cyrus. The concurrency limit can be used to control
+# how many simultaneous LMTP sessions will be permitted to the Cyrus
+# message store.
+#
+# To use the old cyrus deliver program you have to set:
+#mailbox_transport = cyrus
+
+# The fallback_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use for recipients that are not found in the UNIX passwd database.
+# This parameter has precedence over the luser_relay parameter.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#fallback_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#fallback_transport =
+
+#transport_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/transport
+# The luser_relay parameter specifies an optional destination address
+# for unknown recipients. By default, mail for unknown@$mydestination,
+# unknown@[$inet_interfaces] or unknown@[$proxy_interfaces] is returned
+# as undeliverable.
+#
+# The following expansions are done on luser_relay: $user (recipient
+# username), $shell (recipient shell), $home (recipient home directory),
+# $recipient (full recipient address), $extension (recipient address
+# extension), $domain (recipient domain), $local (entire recipient
+# localpart), $recipient_delimiter. Specify ${name?value} or
+# ${name:value} to expand value only when $name does (does not) exist.
+#
+# luser_relay works only for the default Postfix local delivery agent.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must specify "local_recipient_maps =" (i.e. empty) in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#luser_relay = $user@other.host
+#luser_relay = $local@other.host
+#luser_relay = admin+$local
+
+# JUNK MAIL CONTROLS
+#
+# The controls listed here are only a very small subset. The file
+# SMTPD_ACCESS_README provides an overview.
+
+# The header_checks parameter specifies an optional table with patterns
+# that each logical message header is matched against, including
+# headers that span multiple physical lines.
+#
+# By default, these patterns also apply to MIME headers and to the
+# headers of attached messages. With older Postfix versions, MIME and
+# attached message headers were treated as body text.
+#
+# For details, see "man header_checks".
+#
+header_checks = regexp:/etc/postfix/header_checks
+
+# FAST ETRN SERVICE
+#
+# Postfix maintains per-destination logfiles with information about
+# deferred mail, so that mail can be flushed quickly with the SMTP
+# "ETRN domain.tld" command, or by executing "sendmail -qRdomain.tld".
+# See the ETRN_README document for a detailed description.
+#
+# The fast_flush_domains parameter controls what destinations are
+# eligible for this service. By default, they are all domains that
+# this server is willing to relay mail to.
+#
+#fast_flush_domains = $relay_domains
+
+# SHOW SOFTWARE VERSION OR NOT
+#
+# The smtpd_banner parameter specifies the text that follows the 220
+# code in the SMTP server's greeting banner. Some people like to see
+# the mail version advertised. By default, Postfix shows no version.
+#
+# You MUST specify $myhostname at the start of the text. That is an
+# RFC requirement. Postfix itself does not care.
+#
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name ($mail_version)
+
+# PARALLEL DELIVERY TO THE SAME DESTINATION
+#
+# How many parallel deliveries to the same user or domain? With local
+# delivery, it does not make sense to do massively parallel delivery
+# to the same user, because mailbox updates must happen sequentially,
+# and expensive pipelines in .forward files can cause disasters when
+# too many are run at the same time. With SMTP deliveries, 10
+# simultaneous connections to the same domain could be sufficient to
+# raise eyebrows.
+#
+# Each message delivery transport has its XXX_destination_concurrency_limit
+# parameter. The default is $default_destination_concurrency_limit for
+# most delivery transports. For the local delivery agent the default is 2.
+
+#local_destination_concurrency_limit = 2
+#default_destination_concurrency_limit = 20
+
+# DEBUGGING CONTROL
+#
+# The debug_peer_level parameter specifies the increment in verbose
+# logging level when an SMTP client or server host name or address
+# matches a pattern in the debug_peer_list parameter.
+#
+debug_peer_level = 2
+
+# The debug_peer_list parameter specifies an optional list of domain
+# or network patterns, /file/name patterns or type:name tables. When
+# an SMTP client or server host name or address matches a pattern,
+# increase the verbose logging level by the amount specified in the
+# debug_peer_level parameter.
+#
+#debug_peer_list = 127.0.0.1
+#debug_peer_list = some.domain
+
+# The debugger_command specifies the external command that is executed
+# when a Postfix daemon program is run with the -D option.
+#
+# Use "command .. & sleep 5" so that the debugger can attach before
+# the process marches on. If you use an X-based debugger, be sure to
+# set up your XAUTHORITY environment variable before starting Postfix.
+#
+debugger_command =
+ PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin:/usr/X11R6/bin
+ xxgdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id & sleep 5
+
+# If you can't use X, use this to capture the call stack when a
+# daemon crashes. The result is in a file in the configuration
+# directory, and is named after the process name and the process ID.
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin; export PATH; (echo cont;
+# echo where) | gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id 2>&1
+# >$config_directory/$process_name.$process_id.log & sleep 5
+#
+# Another possibility is to run gdb under a detached screen session.
+# To attach to the screen sesssion, su root and run "screen -r
+# <id_string>" where <id_string> uniquely matches one of the detached
+# sessions (from "screen -list").
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/sbin:/usr/sbin; export PATH; screen
+# -dmS $process_name gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name
+# $process_id & sleep 1
+
+# INSTALL-TIME CONFIGURATION INFORMATION
+#
+# The following parameters are used when installing a new Postfix version.
+#
+# sendmail_path: The full pathname of the Postfix sendmail command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible mail posting interface.
+#
+sendmail_path = /usr/sbin/sendmail.postfix
+
+# newaliases_path: The full pathname of the Postfix newaliases command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible command to build alias databases.
+#
+newaliases_path = /usr/bin/newaliases.postfix
+
+# mailq_path: The full pathname of the Postfix mailq command. This
+# is the Sendmail-compatible mail queue listing command.
+#
+mailq_path = /usr/bin/mailq.postfix
+
+# setgid_group: The group for mail submission and queue management
+# commands. This must be a group name with a numerical group ID that
+# is not shared with other accounts, not even with the Postfix account.
+#
+setgid_group = postdrop
+
+# html_directory: The location of the Postfix HTML documentation.
+#
+html_directory = no
+
+# manpage_directory: The location of the Postfix on-line manual pages.
+#
+manpage_directory = /usr/share/man
+
+# sample_directory: The location of the Postfix sample configuration files.
+# This parameter is obsolete as of Postfix 2.1.
+#
+sample_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/samples
+
+# readme_directory: The location of the Postfix README files.
+#
+readme_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/README_FILES
+
+# add this to new postfix to get it to add proper message-id and other
+# headers to outgoing emails via the gateway.
+
+
+message_size_limit = 20971520
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.collab03.fedoraproject.org b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.collab03.fedoraproject.org
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..1fe2b5e08
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.collab03.fedoraproject.org
@@ -0,0 +1,687 @@
+# "false"
+# Global Postfix configuration file. This file lists only a subset
+# of all parameters. For the syntax, and for a complete parameter
+# list, see the postconf(5) manual page (command: "man 5 postconf").
+#
+# For common configuration examples, see BASIC_CONFIGURATION_README
+# and STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README. To find these documents, use
+# the command "postconf html_directory readme_directory", or go to
+# http://www.postfix.org/.
+#
+# For best results, change no more than 2-3 parameters at a time,
+# and test if Postfix still works after every change.
+
+# SOFT BOUNCE
+#
+# The soft_bounce parameter provides a limited safety net for
+# testing. When soft_bounce is enabled, mail will remain queued that
+# would otherwise bounce. This parameter disables locally-generated
+# bounces, and prevents the SMTP server from rejecting mail permanently
+# (by changing 5xx replies into 4xx replies). However, soft_bounce
+# is no cure for address rewriting mistakes or mail routing mistakes.
+#
+#soft_bounce = no
+
+# LOCAL PATHNAME INFORMATION
+#
+# The queue_directory specifies the location of the Postfix queue.
+# This is also the root directory of Postfix daemons that run chrooted.
+# See the files in examples/chroot-setup for setting up Postfix chroot
+# environments on different UNIX systems.
+#
+queue_directory = /var/spool/postfix
+
+# The command_directory parameter specifies the location of all
+# postXXX commands.
+#
+command_directory = /usr/sbin
+
+# The daemon_directory parameter specifies the location of all Postfix
+# daemon programs (i.e. programs listed in the master.cf file). This
+# directory must be owned by root.
+#
+daemon_directory = /usr/libexec/postfix
+
+# QUEUE AND PROCESS OWNERSHIP
+#
+# The mail_owner parameter specifies the owner of the Postfix queue
+# and of most Postfix daemon processes. Specify the name of a user
+# account THAT DOES NOT SHARE ITS USER OR GROUP ID WITH OTHER ACCOUNTS
+# AND THAT OWNS NO OTHER FILES OR PROCESSES ON THE SYSTEM. In
+# particular, don't specify nobody or daemon. PLEASE USE A DEDICATED
+# USER.
+#
+mail_owner = postfix
+
+# The default_privs parameter specifies the default rights used by
+# the local delivery agent for delivery to external file or command.
+# These rights are used in the absence of a recipient user context.
+# DO NOT SPECIFY A PRIVILEGED USER OR THE POSTFIX OWNER.
+#
+#default_privs = nobody
+
+# INTERNET HOST AND DOMAIN NAMES
+#
+# The myhostname parameter specifies the internet hostname of this
+# mail system. The default is to use the fully-qualified domain name
+# from gethostname(). $myhostname is used as a default value for many
+# other configuration parameters.
+#
+#myhostname = host.domain.tld
+#myhostname = virtual.domain.tld
+
+# The mydomain parameter specifies the local internet domain name.
+# The default is to use $myhostname minus the first component.
+# $mydomain is used as a default value for many other configuration
+# parameters.
+#
+#mydomain = domain.tld
+
+# SENDING MAIL
+#
+# The myorigin parameter specifies the domain that locally-posted
+# mail appears to come from. The default is to append $myhostname,
+# which is fine for small sites. If you run a domain with multiple
+# machines, you should (1) change this to $mydomain and (2) set up
+# a domain-wide alias database that aliases each user to
+# user@that.users.mailhost.
+#
+# For the sake of consistency between sender and recipient addresses,
+# myorigin also specifies the default domain name that is appended
+# to recipient addresses that have no @domain part.
+#
+#myorigin = $myhostname
+#myorigin = $mydomain
+
+myhostname = lists.fedoraproject.org
+myorigin = lists.fedoraproject.org
+
+# RECEIVING MAIL
+
+# The inet_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on. By default,
+# the software claims all active interfaces on the machine. The
+# parameter also controls delivery of mail to user@[ip.address].
+#
+# See also the proxy_interfaces parameter, for network addresses that
+# are forwarded to us via a proxy or network address translator.
+#
+# Note: you need to stop/start Postfix when this parameter changes.
+#
+#inet_interfaces = all
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname, localhost
+inet_interfaces = all
+
+# The proxy_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on by way of a
+# proxy or network address translation unit. This setting extends
+# the address list specified with the inet_interfaces parameter.
+#
+# You must specify your proxy/NAT addresses when your system is a
+# backup MX host for other domains, otherwise mail delivery loops
+# will happen when the primary MX host is down.
+#
+#proxy_interfaces =
+#proxy_interfaces = 1.2.3.4
+
+# The mydestination parameter specifies the list of domains that this
+# machine considers itself the final destination for.
+#
+# These domains are routed to the delivery agent specified with the
+# local_transport parameter setting. By default, that is the UNIX
+# compatible delivery agent that lookups all recipients in /etc/passwd
+# and /etc/aliases or their equivalent.
+#
+# The default is $myhostname + localhost.$mydomain. On a mail domain
+# gateway, you should also include $mydomain.
+#
+# Do not specify the names of virtual domains - those domains are
+# specified elsewhere (see VIRTUAL_README).
+#
+# Do not specify the names of domains that this machine is backup MX
+# host for. Specify those names via the relay_domains settings for
+# the SMTP server, or use permit_mx_backup if you are lazy (see
+# STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README).
+#
+# The local machine is always the final destination for mail addressed
+# to user@[the.net.work.address] of an interface that the mail system
+# receives mail on (see the inet_interfaces parameter).
+#
+# Specify a list of host or domain names, /file/name or type:table
+# patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. A /file/name
+# pattern is replaced by its contents; a type:table is matched when
+# a name matches a lookup key (the right-hand side is ignored).
+# Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.
+#
+# See also below, section "REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS".
+#
+mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, fedora.redhat.com, localhost
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain,
+# mail.$mydomain, www.$mydomain, ftp.$mydomain
+
+# REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS
+#
+# The local_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all names or addresses of users that are local with respect
+# to $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown local users. This parameter is defined by default.
+#
+# To turn off local recipient checking in the SMTP server, specify
+# local_recipient_maps = (i.e. empty).
+#
+# The default setting assumes that you use the default Postfix local
+# delivery agent for local delivery. You need to update the
+# local_recipient_maps setting if:
+#
+# - You define $mydestination domain recipients in files other than
+# /etc/passwd, /etc/aliases, or the $virtual_alias_maps files.
+# For example, you define $mydestination domain recipients in
+# the $virtual_mailbox_maps files.
+#
+# - You redefine the local delivery agent in master.cf.
+#
+# - You redefine the "local_transport" setting in main.cf.
+#
+# - You use the "luser_relay", "mailbox_transport", or "fallback_transport"
+# feature of the Postfix local delivery agent (see local(8)).
+#
+# Details are described in the LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README file.
+#
+# Beware: if the Postfix SMTP server runs chrooted, you probably have
+# to access the passwd file via the proxymap service, in order to
+# overcome chroot restrictions. The alternative, having a copy of
+# the system passwd file in the chroot jail is just not practical.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify a bare username, an @domain.tld
+# wild-card, or specify a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+local_recipient_maps = $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps = unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps = proxy:unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps =
+
+# The unknown_local_recipient_reject_code specifies the SMTP server
+# response code when a recipient domain matches $mydestination or
+# ${proxy,inet}_interfaces, while $local_recipient_maps is non-empty
+# and the recipient address or address local-part is not found.
+#
+# The default setting is 550 (reject mail) but it is safer to start
+# with 450 (try again later) until you are certain that your
+# local_recipient_maps settings are OK.
+#
+unknown_local_recipient_reject_code = 550
+
+# TRUST AND RELAY CONTROL
+
+# The mynetworks parameter specifies the list of "trusted" SMTP
+# clients that have more privileges than "strangers".
+#
+# In particular, "trusted" SMTP clients are allowed to relay mail
+# through Postfix. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions parameter
+# in postconf(5).
+#
+# You can specify the list of "trusted" network addresses by hand
+# or you can let Postfix do it for you (which is the default).
+#
+# By default (mynetworks_style = subnet), Postfix "trusts" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP subnetworks as the local machine.
+# On Linux, this does works correctly only with interfaces specified
+# with the "ifconfig" command.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = class" when Postfix should "trust" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP class A/B/C networks as the local machine.
+# Don't do this with a dialup site - it would cause Postfix to "trust"
+# your entire provider's network. Instead, specify an explicit
+# mynetworks list by hand, as described below.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = host" when Postfix should "trust"
+# only the local machine.
+#
+#mynetworks_style = class
+#mynetworks_style = subnet
+#mynetworks_style = host
+
+# Alternatively, you can specify the mynetworks list by hand, in
+# which case Postfix ignores the mynetworks_style setting.
+#
+# Specify an explicit list of network/netmask patterns, where the
+# mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host
+# address.
+#
+# You can also specify the absolute pathname of a pattern file instead
+# of listing the patterns here. Specify type:table for table-based lookups
+# (the value on the table right-hand side is not used).
+#
+#mynetworks = 168.100.189.0/28, 127.0.0.0/8
+#mynetworks = $config_directory/mynetworks
+#mynetworks = hash:/etc/postfix/network_table
+
+
+# The relay_domains parameter restricts what destinations this system will
+# relay mail to. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions description in
+# postconf(5) for detailed information.
+#
+# By default, Postfix relays mail
+# - from "trusted" clients (IP address matches $mynetworks) to any destination,
+# - from "untrusted" clients to destinations that match $relay_domains or
+# subdomains thereof, except addresses with sender-specified routing.
+# The default relay_domains value is $mydestination.
+#
+# In addition to the above, the Postfix SMTP server by default accepts mail
+# that Postfix is final destination for:
+# - destinations that match $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces,
+# - destinations that match $mydestination
+# - destinations that match $virtual_alias_domains,
+# - destinations that match $virtual_mailbox_domains.
+# These destinations do not need to be listed in $relay_domains.
+#
+# Specify a list of hosts or domains, /file/name patterns or type:name
+# lookup tables, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue
+# long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. A file name
+# is replaced by its contents; a type:name table is matched when a
+# (parent) domain appears as lookup key.
+#
+# NOTE: Postfix will not automatically forward mail for domains that
+# list this system as their primary or backup MX host. See the
+# permit_mx_backup restriction description in postconf(5).
+#
+#relay_domains = $mydestination
+
+
+
+# INTERNET OR INTRANET
+
+# The relayhost parameter specifies the default host to send mail to
+# when no entry is matched in the optional transport(5) table. When
+# no relayhost is given, mail is routed directly to the destination.
+#
+# On an intranet, specify the organizational domain name. If your
+# internal DNS uses no MX records, specify the name of the intranet
+# gateway host instead.
+#
+# In the case of SMTP, specify a domain, host, host:port, [host]:port,
+# [address] or [address]:port; the form [host] turns off MX lookups.
+#
+# If you're connected via UUCP, see also the default_transport parameter.
+#
+#relayhost = $mydomain
+#relayhost = [gateway.my.domain]
+#relayhost = [mailserver.isp.tld]
+#relayhost = uucphost
+#relayhost = [an.ip.add.ress]
+relayhost = [192.168.0.1]
+
+
+# REJECTING UNKNOWN RELAY USERS
+#
+# The relay_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all addresses in the domains that match $relay_domains.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown relay users. This feature is off by default.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify an @domain.tld wild-card, or specify
+# a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#relay_recipient_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_recipients
+
+# INPUT RATE CONTROL
+#
+# The in_flow_delay configuration parameter implements mail input
+# flow control. This feature is turned on by default, although it
+# still needs further development (it's disabled on SCO UNIX due
+# to an SCO bug).
+#
+# A Postfix process will pause for $in_flow_delay seconds before
+# accepting a new message, when the message arrival rate exceeds the
+# message delivery rate. With the default 100 SMTP server process
+# limit, this limits the mail inflow to 100 messages a second more
+# than the number of messages delivered per second.
+#
+# Specify 0 to disable the feature. Valid delays are 0..10.
+#
+#in_flow_delay = 1s
+
+# ADDRESS REWRITING
+#
+# The ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document gives information about
+# address masquerading or other forms of address rewriting including
+# username->Firstname.Lastname mapping.
+
+masquerade_domains = redhat.com
+masquerade_exceptions = root apache
+
+# ADDRESS REDIRECTION (VIRTUAL DOMAIN)
+#
+# The VIRTUAL_README document gives information about the many forms
+# of domain hosting that Postfix supports.
+
+# "USER HAS MOVED" BOUNCE MESSAGES
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# TRANSPORT MAP
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# ALIAS DATABASE
+#
+# The alias_maps parameter specifies the list of alias databases used
+# by the local delivery agent. The default list is system dependent.
+#
+# On systems with NIS, the default is to search the local alias
+# database, then the NIS alias database. See aliases(5) for syntax
+# details.
+#
+# If you change the alias database, run "postalias /etc/aliases" (or
+# wherever your system stores the mail alias file), or simply run
+# "newaliases" to build the necessary DBM or DB file.
+#
+# It will take a minute or so before changes become visible. Use
+# "postfix reload" to eliminate the delay.
+#
+#alias_maps = dbm:/etc/aliases
+alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, hash:/etc/mailman/aliases
+#alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, nis:mail.aliases
+#alias_maps = netinfo:/aliases
+
+# The alias_database parameter specifies the alias database(s) that
+# are built with "newaliases" or "sendmail -bi". This is a separate
+# configuration parameter, because alias_maps (see above) may specify
+# tables that are not necessarily all under control by Postfix.
+#
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/mail/aliases
+alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases, hash:/opt/majordomo/aliases
+
+# ADDRESS EXTENSIONS (e.g., user+foo)
+#
+# The recipient_delimiter parameter specifies the separator between
+# user names and address extensions (user+foo). See canonical(5),
+# local(8), relocated(5) and virtual(5) for the effects this has on
+# aliases, canonical, virtual, relocated and .forward file lookups.
+# Basically, the software tries user+foo and .forward+foo before
+# trying user and .forward.
+#
+recipient_delimiter = +
+
+# DELIVERY TO MAILBOX
+#
+# The home_mailbox parameter specifies the optional pathname of a
+# mailbox file relative to a user's home directory. The default
+# mailbox file is /var/spool/mail/user or /var/mail/user. Specify
+# "Maildir/" for qmail-style delivery (the / is required).
+#
+#home_mailbox = Mailbox
+#home_mailbox = Maildir/
+
+# The mail_spool_directory parameter specifies the directory where
+# UNIX-style mailboxes are kept. The default setting depends on the
+# system type.
+#
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/mail
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/spool/mail
+
+# The mailbox_command parameter specifies the optional external
+# command to use instead of mailbox delivery. The command is run as
+# the recipient with proper HOME, SHELL and LOGNAME environment settings.
+# Exception: delivery for root is done as $default_user.
+#
+# Other environment variables of interest: USER (recipient username),
+# EXTENSION (address extension), DOMAIN (domain part of address),
+# and LOCAL (the address localpart).
+#
+# Unlike other Postfix configuration parameters, the mailbox_command
+# parameter is not subjected to $parameter substitutions. This is to
+# make it easier to specify shell syntax (see example below).
+#
+# Avoid shell meta characters because they will force Postfix to run
+# an expensive shell process. Procmail alone is expensive enough.
+#
+# IF YOU USE THIS TO DELIVER MAIL SYSTEM-WIDE, YOU MUST SET UP AN
+# ALIAS THAT FORWARDS MAIL FOR ROOT TO A REAL USER.
+#
+#mailbox_command = /usr/bin/procmail
+#mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail -a "$EXTENSION"
+
+# The mailbox_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use after processing aliases and .forward files. This parameter
+# has precedence over the mailbox_command, fallback_transport and
+# luser_relay parameters.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+
+# If using the cyrus-imapd IMAP server deliver local mail to the IMAP
+# server using LMTP (Local Mail Transport Protocol), this is prefered
+# over the older cyrus deliver program by setting the
+# mailbox_transport as below:
+#
+# mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#
+# The efficiency of LMTP delivery for cyrus-imapd can be enhanced via
+# these settings.
+#
+# local_destination_recipient_limit = 300
+# local_destination_concurrency_limit = 5
+#
+# Of course you should adjust these settings as appropriate for the
+# capacity of the hardware you are using. The recipient limit setting
+# can be used to take advantage of the single instance message store
+# capability of Cyrus. The concurrency limit can be used to control
+# how many simultaneous LMTP sessions will be permitted to the Cyrus
+# message store.
+#
+# To use the old cyrus deliver program you have to set:
+#mailbox_transport = cyrus
+
+# The fallback_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use for recipients that are not found in the UNIX passwd database.
+# This parameter has precedence over the luser_relay parameter.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#fallback_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#fallback_transport =
+
+#transport_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/transport
+# The luser_relay parameter specifies an optional destination address
+# for unknown recipients. By default, mail for unknown@$mydestination,
+# unknown@[$inet_interfaces] or unknown@[$proxy_interfaces] is returned
+# as undeliverable.
+#
+# The following expansions are done on luser_relay: $user (recipient
+# username), $shell (recipient shell), $home (recipient home directory),
+# $recipient (full recipient address), $extension (recipient address
+# extension), $domain (recipient domain), $local (entire recipient
+# localpart), $recipient_delimiter. Specify ${name?value} or
+# ${name:value} to expand value only when $name does (does not) exist.
+#
+# luser_relay works only for the default Postfix local delivery agent.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must specify "local_recipient_maps =" (i.e. empty) in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#luser_relay = $user@other.host
+#luser_relay = $local@other.host
+#luser_relay = admin+$local
+
+# JUNK MAIL CONTROLS
+#
+# The controls listed here are only a very small subset. The file
+# SMTPD_ACCESS_README provides an overview.
+
+# The header_checks parameter specifies an optional table with patterns
+# that each logical message header is matched against, including
+# headers that span multiple physical lines.
+#
+# By default, these patterns also apply to MIME headers and to the
+# headers of attached messages. With older Postfix versions, MIME and
+# attached message headers were treated as body text.
+#
+# For details, see "man header_checks".
+#
+header_checks = regexp:/etc/postfix/header_checks
+
+# FAST ETRN SERVICE
+#
+# Postfix maintains per-destination logfiles with information about
+# deferred mail, so that mail can be flushed quickly with the SMTP
+# "ETRN domain.tld" command, or by executing "sendmail -qRdomain.tld".
+# See the ETRN_README document for a detailed description.
+#
+# The fast_flush_domains parameter controls what destinations are
+# eligible for this service. By default, they are all domains that
+# this server is willing to relay mail to.
+#
+#fast_flush_domains = $relay_domains
+
+# SHOW SOFTWARE VERSION OR NOT
+#
+# The smtpd_banner parameter specifies the text that follows the 220
+# code in the SMTP server's greeting banner. Some people like to see
+# the mail version advertised. By default, Postfix shows no version.
+#
+# You MUST specify $myhostname at the start of the text. That is an
+# RFC requirement. Postfix itself does not care.
+#
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name ($mail_version)
+
+# PARALLEL DELIVERY TO THE SAME DESTINATION
+#
+# How many parallel deliveries to the same user or domain? With local
+# delivery, it does not make sense to do massively parallel delivery
+# to the same user, because mailbox updates must happen sequentially,
+# and expensive pipelines in .forward files can cause disasters when
+# too many are run at the same time. With SMTP deliveries, 10
+# simultaneous connections to the same domain could be sufficient to
+# raise eyebrows.
+#
+# Each message delivery transport has its XXX_destination_concurrency_limit
+# parameter. The default is $default_destination_concurrency_limit for
+# most delivery transports. For the local delivery agent the default is 2.
+
+#local_destination_concurrency_limit = 2
+#default_destination_concurrency_limit = 20
+
+# DEBUGGING CONTROL
+#
+# The debug_peer_level parameter specifies the increment in verbose
+# logging level when an SMTP client or server host name or address
+# matches a pattern in the debug_peer_list parameter.
+#
+debug_peer_level = 2
+
+# The debug_peer_list parameter specifies an optional list of domain
+# or network patterns, /file/name patterns or type:name tables. When
+# an SMTP client or server host name or address matches a pattern,
+# increase the verbose logging level by the amount specified in the
+# debug_peer_level parameter.
+#
+#debug_peer_list = 127.0.0.1
+#debug_peer_list = some.domain
+
+# The debugger_command specifies the external command that is executed
+# when a Postfix daemon program is run with the -D option.
+#
+# Use "command .. & sleep 5" so that the debugger can attach before
+# the process marches on. If you use an X-based debugger, be sure to
+# set up your XAUTHORITY environment variable before starting Postfix.
+#
+debugger_command =
+ PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin:/usr/X11R6/bin
+ xxgdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id & sleep 5
+
+# If you can't use X, use this to capture the call stack when a
+# daemon crashes. The result is in a file in the configuration
+# directory, and is named after the process name and the process ID.
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin; export PATH; (echo cont;
+# echo where) | gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id 2>&1
+# >$config_directory/$process_name.$process_id.log & sleep 5
+#
+# Another possibility is to run gdb under a detached screen session.
+# To attach to the screen sesssion, su root and run "screen -r
+# <id_string>" where <id_string> uniquely matches one of the detached
+# sessions (from "screen -list").
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/sbin:/usr/sbin; export PATH; screen
+# -dmS $process_name gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name
+# $process_id & sleep 1
+
+# INSTALL-TIME CONFIGURATION INFORMATION
+#
+# The following parameters are used when installing a new Postfix version.
+#
+# sendmail_path: The full pathname of the Postfix sendmail command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible mail posting interface.
+#
+sendmail_path = /usr/sbin/sendmail.postfix
+
+# newaliases_path: The full pathname of the Postfix newaliases command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible command to build alias databases.
+#
+newaliases_path = /usr/bin/newaliases.postfix
+
+# mailq_path: The full pathname of the Postfix mailq command. This
+# is the Sendmail-compatible mail queue listing command.
+#
+mailq_path = /usr/bin/mailq.postfix
+
+# setgid_group: The group for mail submission and queue management
+# commands. This must be a group name with a numerical group ID that
+# is not shared with other accounts, not even with the Postfix account.
+#
+setgid_group = postdrop
+
+# html_directory: The location of the Postfix HTML documentation.
+#
+html_directory = no
+
+# manpage_directory: The location of the Postfix on-line manual pages.
+#
+manpage_directory = /usr/share/man
+
+# sample_directory: The location of the Postfix sample configuration files.
+# This parameter is obsolete as of Postfix 2.1.
+#
+sample_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/samples
+
+# readme_directory: The location of the Postfix README files.
+#
+readme_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/README_FILES
+
+# add this to new postfix to get it to add proper message-id and other
+# headers to outgoing emails via the gateway.
+
+smtp_host_lookup = dns,native
+message_size_limit = 20971520
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.copr b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.copr
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..f15bc63d5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.copr
@@ -0,0 +1,687 @@
+# "false"
+# Global Postfix configuration file. This file lists only a subset
+# of all parameters. For the syntax, and for a complete parameter
+# list, see the postconf(5) manual page (command: "man 5 postconf").
+#
+# For common configuration examples, see BASIC_CONFIGURATION_README
+# and STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README. To find these documents, use
+# the command "postconf html_directory readme_directory", or go to
+# http://www.postfix.org/.
+#
+# For best results, change no more than 2-3 parameters at a time,
+# and test if Postfix still works after every change.
+
+# SOFT BOUNCE
+#
+# The soft_bounce parameter provides a limited safety net for
+# testing. When soft_bounce is enabled, mail will remain queued that
+# would otherwise bounce. This parameter disables locally-generated
+# bounces, and prevents the SMTP server from rejecting mail permanently
+# (by changing 5xx replies into 4xx replies). However, soft_bounce
+# is no cure for address rewriting mistakes or mail routing mistakes.
+#
+#soft_bounce = no
+
+# LOCAL PATHNAME INFORMATION
+#
+# The queue_directory specifies the location of the Postfix queue.
+# This is also the root directory of Postfix daemons that run chrooted.
+# See the files in examples/chroot-setup for setting up Postfix chroot
+# environments on different UNIX systems.
+#
+queue_directory = /var/spool/postfix
+
+# The command_directory parameter specifies the location of all
+# postXXX commands.
+#
+command_directory = /usr/sbin
+
+# The daemon_directory parameter specifies the location of all Postfix
+# daemon programs (i.e. programs listed in the master.cf file). This
+# directory must be owned by root.
+#
+daemon_directory = /usr/libexec/postfix
+
+# QUEUE AND PROCESS OWNERSHIP
+#
+# The mail_owner parameter specifies the owner of the Postfix queue
+# and of most Postfix daemon processes. Specify the name of a user
+# account THAT DOES NOT SHARE ITS USER OR GROUP ID WITH OTHER ACCOUNTS
+# AND THAT OWNS NO OTHER FILES OR PROCESSES ON THE SYSTEM. In
+# particular, don't specify nobody or daemon. PLEASE USE A DEDICATED
+# USER.
+#
+mail_owner = postfix
+
+# The default_privs parameter specifies the default rights used by
+# the local delivery agent for delivery to external file or command.
+# These rights are used in the absence of a recipient user context.
+# DO NOT SPECIFY A PRIVILEGED USER OR THE POSTFIX OWNER.
+#
+#default_privs = nobody
+
+# INTERNET HOST AND DOMAIN NAMES
+#
+# The myhostname parameter specifies the internet hostname of this
+# mail system. The default is to use the fully-qualified domain name
+# from gethostname(). $myhostname is used as a default value for many
+# other configuration parameters.
+#
+#myhostname = host.domain.tld
+#myhostname = virtual.domain.tld
+
+# The mydomain parameter specifies the local internet domain name.
+# The default is to use $myhostname minus the first component.
+# $mydomain is used as a default value for many other configuration
+# parameters.
+#
+#mydomain = domain.tld
+
+# SENDING MAIL
+#
+# The myorigin parameter specifies the domain that locally-posted
+# mail appears to come from. The default is to append $myhostname,
+# which is fine for small sites. If you run a domain with multiple
+# machines, you should (1) change this to $mydomain and (2) set up
+# a domain-wide alias database that aliases each user to
+# user@that.users.mailhost.
+#
+# For the sake of consistency between sender and recipient addresses,
+# myorigin also specifies the default domain name that is appended
+# to recipient addresses that have no @domain part.
+#
+#myorigin = $myhostname
+#myorigin = $mydomain
+
+mydomain = fedoraproject.org
+myorigin = fedoraproject.org
+
+# RECEIVING MAIL
+
+# The inet_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on. By default,
+# the software claims all active interfaces on the machine. The
+# parameter also controls delivery of mail to user@[ip.address].
+#
+# See also the proxy_interfaces parameter, for network addresses that
+# are forwarded to us via a proxy or network address translator.
+#
+# Note: you need to stop/start Postfix when this parameter changes.
+#
+#inet_interfaces = all
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname, localhost
+inet_interfaces = all
+
+# The proxy_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on by way of a
+# proxy or network address translation unit. This setting extends
+# the address list specified with the inet_interfaces parameter.
+#
+# You must specify your proxy/NAT addresses when your system is a
+# backup MX host for other domains, otherwise mail delivery loops
+# will happen when the primary MX host is down.
+#
+#proxy_interfaces =
+#proxy_interfaces = 1.2.3.4
+
+# The mydestination parameter specifies the list of domains that this
+# machine considers itself the final destination for.
+#
+# These domains are routed to the delivery agent specified with the
+# local_transport parameter setting. By default, that is the UNIX
+# compatible delivery agent that lookups all recipients in /etc/passwd
+# and /etc/aliases or their equivalent.
+#
+# The default is $myhostname + localhost.$mydomain. On a mail domain
+# gateway, you should also include $mydomain.
+#
+# Do not specify the names of virtual domains - those domains are
+# specified elsewhere (see VIRTUAL_README).
+#
+# Do not specify the names of domains that this machine is backup MX
+# host for. Specify those names via the relay_domains settings for
+# the SMTP server, or use permit_mx_backup if you are lazy (see
+# STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README).
+#
+# The local machine is always the final destination for mail addressed
+# to user@[the.net.work.address] of an interface that the mail system
+# receives mail on (see the inet_interfaces parameter).
+#
+# Specify a list of host or domain names, /file/name or type:table
+# patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. A /file/name
+# pattern is replaced by its contents; a type:table is matched when
+# a name matches a lookup key (the right-hand side is ignored).
+# Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.
+#
+# See also below, section "REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS".
+#
+mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, fedora.redhat.com, localhost
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain,
+# mail.$mydomain, www.$mydomain, ftp.$mydomain
+
+# REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS
+#
+# The local_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all names or addresses of users that are local with respect
+# to $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown local users. This parameter is defined by default.
+#
+# To turn off local recipient checking in the SMTP server, specify
+# local_recipient_maps = (i.e. empty).
+#
+# The default setting assumes that you use the default Postfix local
+# delivery agent for local delivery. You need to update the
+# local_recipient_maps setting if:
+#
+# - You define $mydestination domain recipients in files other than
+# /etc/passwd, /etc/aliases, or the $virtual_alias_maps files.
+# For example, you define $mydestination domain recipients in
+# the $virtual_mailbox_maps files.
+#
+# - You redefine the local delivery agent in master.cf.
+#
+# - You redefine the "local_transport" setting in main.cf.
+#
+# - You use the "luser_relay", "mailbox_transport", or "fallback_transport"
+# feature of the Postfix local delivery agent (see local(8)).
+#
+# Details are described in the LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README file.
+#
+# Beware: if the Postfix SMTP server runs chrooted, you probably have
+# to access the passwd file via the proxymap service, in order to
+# overcome chroot restrictions. The alternative, having a copy of
+# the system passwd file in the chroot jail is just not practical.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify a bare username, an @domain.tld
+# wild-card, or specify a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#local_recipient_maps = unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps = proxy:unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps =
+
+# The unknown_local_recipient_reject_code specifies the SMTP server
+# response code when a recipient domain matches $mydestination or
+# ${proxy,inet}_interfaces, while $local_recipient_maps is non-empty
+# and the recipient address or address local-part is not found.
+#
+# The default setting is 550 (reject mail) but it is safer to start
+# with 450 (try again later) until you are certain that your
+# local_recipient_maps settings are OK.
+#
+unknown_local_recipient_reject_code = 550
+
+# TRUST AND RELAY CONTROL
+
+# The mynetworks parameter specifies the list of "trusted" SMTP
+# clients that have more privileges than "strangers".
+#
+# In particular, "trusted" SMTP clients are allowed to relay mail
+# through Postfix. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions parameter
+# in postconf(5).
+#
+# You can specify the list of "trusted" network addresses by hand
+# or you can let Postfix do it for you (which is the default).
+#
+# By default (mynetworks_style = subnet), Postfix "trusts" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP subnetworks as the local machine.
+# On Linux, this does works correctly only with interfaces specified
+# with the "ifconfig" command.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = class" when Postfix should "trust" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP class A/B/C networks as the local machine.
+# Don't do this with a dialup site - it would cause Postfix to "trust"
+# your entire provider's network. Instead, specify an explicit
+# mynetworks list by hand, as described below.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = host" when Postfix should "trust"
+# only the local machine.
+#
+#mynetworks_style = class
+#mynetworks_style = subnet
+#mynetworks_style = host
+
+# Alternatively, you can specify the mynetworks list by hand, in
+# which case Postfix ignores the mynetworks_style setting.
+#
+# Specify an explicit list of network/netmask patterns, where the
+# mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host
+# address.
+#
+# You can also specify the absolute pathname of a pattern file instead
+# of listing the patterns here. Specify type:table for table-based lookups
+# (the value on the table right-hand side is not used).
+#
+#mynetworks = 168.100.189.0/28, 127.0.0.0/8
+#mynetworks = $config_directory/mynetworks
+#mynetworks = hash:/etc/postfix/network_table
+
+
+# The relay_domains parameter restricts what destinations this system will
+# relay mail to. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions description in
+# postconf(5) for detailed information.
+#
+# By default, Postfix relays mail
+# - from "trusted" clients (IP address matches $mynetworks) to any destination,
+# - from "untrusted" clients to destinations that match $relay_domains or
+# subdomains thereof, except addresses with sender-specified routing.
+# The default relay_domains value is $mydestination.
+#
+# In addition to the above, the Postfix SMTP server by default accepts mail
+# that Postfix is final destination for:
+# - destinations that match $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces,
+# - destinations that match $mydestination
+# - destinations that match $virtual_alias_domains,
+# - destinations that match $virtual_mailbox_domains.
+# These destinations do not need to be listed in $relay_domains.
+#
+# Specify a list of hosts or domains, /file/name patterns or type:name
+# lookup tables, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue
+# long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. A file name
+# is replaced by its contents; a type:name table is matched when a
+# (parent) domain appears as lookup key.
+#
+# NOTE: Postfix will not automatically forward mail for domains that
+# list this system as their primary or backup MX host. See the
+# permit_mx_backup restriction description in postconf(5).
+#
+#relay_domains = $mydestination
+
+
+
+# INTERNET OR INTRANET
+
+# The relayhost parameter specifies the default host to send mail to
+# when no entry is matched in the optional transport(5) table. When
+# no relayhost is given, mail is routed directly to the destination.
+#
+# On an intranet, specify the organizational domain name. If your
+# internal DNS uses no MX records, specify the name of the intranet
+# gateway host instead.
+#
+# In the case of SMTP, specify a domain, host, host:port, [host]:port,
+# [address] or [address]:port; the form [host] turns off MX lookups.
+#
+# If you're connected via UUCP, see also the default_transport parameter.
+#
+#relayhost = $mydomain
+#relayhost = [gateway.my.domain]
+#relayhost = [mailserver.isp.tld]
+#relayhost = uucphost
+#relayhost = [an.ip.add.ress]
+#relayhost = mx1.redhat.com
+
+
+# REJECTING UNKNOWN RELAY USERS
+#
+# The relay_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all addresses in the domains that match $relay_domains.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown relay users. This feature is off by default.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify an @domain.tld wild-card, or specify
+# a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#relay_recipient_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_recipients
+
+# INPUT RATE CONTROL
+#
+# The in_flow_delay configuration parameter implements mail input
+# flow control. This feature is turned on by default, although it
+# still needs further development (it's disabled on SCO UNIX due
+# to an SCO bug).
+#
+# A Postfix process will pause for $in_flow_delay seconds before
+# accepting a new message, when the message arrival rate exceeds the
+# message delivery rate. With the default 100 SMTP server process
+# limit, this limits the mail inflow to 100 messages a second more
+# than the number of messages delivered per second.
+#
+# Specify 0 to disable the feature. Valid delays are 0..10.
+#
+#in_flow_delay = 1s
+
+# ADDRESS REWRITING
+#
+# The ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document gives information about
+# address masquerading or other forms of address rewriting including
+# username->Firstname.Lastname mapping.
+
+#masquerade_domains = redhat.com
+#masquerade_exceptions = root apache
+
+# ADDRESS REDIRECTION (VIRTUAL DOMAIN)
+#
+# The VIRTUAL_README document gives information about the many forms
+# of domain hosting that Postfix supports.
+
+# "USER HAS MOVED" BOUNCE MESSAGES
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# TRANSPORT MAP
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# ALIAS DATABASE
+#
+# The alias_maps parameter specifies the list of alias databases used
+# by the local delivery agent. The default list is system dependent.
+#
+# On systems with NIS, the default is to search the local alias
+# database, then the NIS alias database. See aliases(5) for syntax
+# details.
+#
+# If you change the alias database, run "postalias /etc/aliases" (or
+# wherever your system stores the mail alias file), or simply run
+# "newaliases" to build the necessary DBM or DB file.
+#
+# It will take a minute or so before changes become visible. Use
+# "postfix reload" to eliminate the delay.
+#
+#alias_maps = dbm:/etc/aliases
+alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, nis:mail.aliases
+#alias_maps = netinfo:/aliases
+
+# The alias_database parameter specifies the alias database(s) that
+# are built with "newaliases" or "sendmail -bi". This is a separate
+# configuration parameter, because alias_maps (see above) may specify
+# tables that are not necessarily all under control by Postfix.
+#
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/mail/aliases
+alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases, hash:/opt/majordomo/aliases
+
+# ADDRESS EXTENSIONS (e.g., user+foo)
+#
+# The recipient_delimiter parameter specifies the separator between
+# user names and address extensions (user+foo). See canonical(5),
+# local(8), relocated(5) and virtual(5) for the effects this has on
+# aliases, canonical, virtual, relocated and .forward file lookups.
+# Basically, the software tries user+foo and .forward+foo before
+# trying user and .forward.
+#
+recipient_delimiter = +
+
+# DELIVERY TO MAILBOX
+#
+# The home_mailbox parameter specifies the optional pathname of a
+# mailbox file relative to a user's home directory. The default
+# mailbox file is /var/spool/mail/user or /var/mail/user. Specify
+# "Maildir/" for qmail-style delivery (the / is required).
+#
+#home_mailbox = Mailbox
+#home_mailbox = Maildir/
+
+# The mail_spool_directory parameter specifies the directory where
+# UNIX-style mailboxes are kept. The default setting depends on the
+# system type.
+#
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/mail
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/spool/mail
+
+# The mailbox_command parameter specifies the optional external
+# command to use instead of mailbox delivery. The command is run as
+# the recipient with proper HOME, SHELL and LOGNAME environment settings.
+# Exception: delivery for root is done as $default_user.
+#
+# Other environment variables of interest: USER (recipient username),
+# EXTENSION (address extension), DOMAIN (domain part of address),
+# and LOCAL (the address localpart).
+#
+# Unlike other Postfix configuration parameters, the mailbox_command
+# parameter is not subjected to $parameter substitutions. This is to
+# make it easier to specify shell syntax (see example below).
+#
+# Avoid shell meta characters because they will force Postfix to run
+# an expensive shell process. Procmail alone is expensive enough.
+#
+# IF YOU USE THIS TO DELIVER MAIL SYSTEM-WIDE, YOU MUST SET UP AN
+# ALIAS THAT FORWARDS MAIL FOR ROOT TO A REAL USER.
+#
+#mailbox_command = /usr/bin/procmail
+#mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail -a "$EXTENSION"
+
+# The mailbox_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use after processing aliases and .forward files. This parameter
+# has precedence over the mailbox_command, fallback_transport and
+# luser_relay parameters.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+
+# If using the cyrus-imapd IMAP server deliver local mail to the IMAP
+# server using LMTP (Local Mail Transport Protocol), this is prefered
+# over the older cyrus deliver program by setting the
+# mailbox_transport as below:
+#
+# mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#
+# The efficiency of LMTP delivery for cyrus-imapd can be enhanced via
+# these settings.
+#
+# local_destination_recipient_limit = 300
+# local_destination_concurrency_limit = 5
+#
+# Of course you should adjust these settings as appropriate for the
+# capacity of the hardware you are using. The recipient limit setting
+# can be used to take advantage of the single instance message store
+# capability of Cyrus. The concurrency limit can be used to control
+# how many simultaneous LMTP sessions will be permitted to the Cyrus
+# message store.
+#
+# To use the old cyrus deliver program you have to set:
+#mailbox_transport = cyrus
+
+# The fallback_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use for recipients that are not found in the UNIX passwd database.
+# This parameter has precedence over the luser_relay parameter.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#fallback_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#fallback_transport =
+
+#transport_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/transport
+# The luser_relay parameter specifies an optional destination address
+# for unknown recipients. By default, mail for unknown@$mydestination,
+# unknown@[$inet_interfaces] or unknown@[$proxy_interfaces] is returned
+# as undeliverable.
+#
+# The following expansions are done on luser_relay: $user (recipient
+# username), $shell (recipient shell), $home (recipient home directory),
+# $recipient (full recipient address), $extension (recipient address
+# extension), $domain (recipient domain), $local (entire recipient
+# localpart), $recipient_delimiter. Specify ${name?value} or
+# ${name:value} to expand value only when $name does (does not) exist.
+#
+# luser_relay works only for the default Postfix local delivery agent.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must specify "local_recipient_maps =" (i.e. empty) in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#luser_relay = $user@other.host
+#luser_relay = $local@other.host
+#luser_relay = admin+$local
+
+# JUNK MAIL CONTROLS
+#
+# The controls listed here are only a very small subset. The file
+# SMTPD_ACCESS_README provides an overview.
+
+# The header_checks parameter specifies an optional table with patterns
+# that each logical message header is matched against, including
+# headers that span multiple physical lines.
+#
+# By default, these patterns also apply to MIME headers and to the
+# headers of attached messages. With older Postfix versions, MIME and
+# attached message headers were treated as body text.
+#
+# For details, see "man header_checks".
+#
+header_checks = regexp:/etc/postfix/header_checks
+
+# FAST ETRN SERVICE
+#
+# Postfix maintains per-destination logfiles with information about
+# deferred mail, so that mail can be flushed quickly with the SMTP
+# "ETRN domain.tld" command, or by executing "sendmail -qRdomain.tld".
+# See the ETRN_README document for a detailed description.
+#
+# The fast_flush_domains parameter controls what destinations are
+# eligible for this service. By default, they are all domains that
+# this server is willing to relay mail to.
+#
+#fast_flush_domains = $relay_domains
+
+# SHOW SOFTWARE VERSION OR NOT
+#
+# The smtpd_banner parameter specifies the text that follows the 220
+# code in the SMTP server's greeting banner. Some people like to see
+# the mail version advertised. By default, Postfix shows no version.
+#
+# You MUST specify $myhostname at the start of the text. That is an
+# RFC requirement. Postfix itself does not care.
+#
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name ($mail_version)
+
+# PARALLEL DELIVERY TO THE SAME DESTINATION
+#
+# How many parallel deliveries to the same user or domain? With local
+# delivery, it does not make sense to do massively parallel delivery
+# to the same user, because mailbox updates must happen sequentially,
+# and expensive pipelines in .forward files can cause disasters when
+# too many are run at the same time. With SMTP deliveries, 10
+# simultaneous connections to the same domain could be sufficient to
+# raise eyebrows.
+#
+# Each message delivery transport has its XXX_destination_concurrency_limit
+# parameter. The default is $default_destination_concurrency_limit for
+# most delivery transports. For the local delivery agent the default is 2.
+
+#local_destination_concurrency_limit = 2
+#default_destination_concurrency_limit = 20
+
+# DEBUGGING CONTROL
+#
+# The debug_peer_level parameter specifies the increment in verbose
+# logging level when an SMTP client or server host name or address
+# matches a pattern in the debug_peer_list parameter.
+#
+debug_peer_level = 2
+
+# The debug_peer_list parameter specifies an optional list of domain
+# or network patterns, /file/name patterns or type:name tables. When
+# an SMTP client or server host name or address matches a pattern,
+# increase the verbose logging level by the amount specified in the
+# debug_peer_level parameter.
+#
+#debug_peer_list = 127.0.0.1
+#debug_peer_list = some.domain
+
+# The debugger_command specifies the external command that is executed
+# when a Postfix daemon program is run with the -D option.
+#
+# Use "command .. & sleep 5" so that the debugger can attach before
+# the process marches on. If you use an X-based debugger, be sure to
+# set up your XAUTHORITY environment variable before starting Postfix.
+#
+debugger_command =
+ PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin:/usr/X11R6/bin
+ xxgdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id & sleep 5
+
+# If you can't use X, use this to capture the call stack when a
+# daemon crashes. The result is in a file in the configuration
+# directory, and is named after the process name and the process ID.
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin; export PATH; (echo cont;
+# echo where) | gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id 2>&1
+# >$config_directory/$process_name.$process_id.log & sleep 5
+#
+# Another possibility is to run gdb under a detached screen session.
+# To attach to the screen sesssion, su root and run "screen -r
+# <id_string>" where <id_string> uniquely matches one of the detached
+# sessions (from "screen -list").
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/sbin:/usr/sbin; export PATH; screen
+# -dmS $process_name gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name
+# $process_id & sleep 1
+
+# INSTALL-TIME CONFIGURATION INFORMATION
+#
+# The following parameters are used when installing a new Postfix version.
+#
+# sendmail_path: The full pathname of the Postfix sendmail command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible mail posting interface.
+#
+sendmail_path = /usr/sbin/sendmail.postfix
+
+# newaliases_path: The full pathname of the Postfix newaliases command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible command to build alias databases.
+#
+newaliases_path = /usr/bin/newaliases.postfix
+
+# mailq_path: The full pathname of the Postfix mailq command. This
+# is the Sendmail-compatible mail queue listing command.
+#
+mailq_path = /usr/bin/mailq.postfix
+
+# setgid_group: The group for mail submission and queue management
+# commands. This must be a group name with a numerical group ID that
+# is not shared with other accounts, not even with the Postfix account.
+#
+setgid_group = postdrop
+
+# html_directory: The location of the Postfix HTML documentation.
+#
+html_directory = no
+
+# manpage_directory: The location of the Postfix on-line manual pages.
+#
+manpage_directory = /usr/share/man
+
+# sample_directory: The location of the Postfix sample configuration files.
+# This parameter is obsolete as of Postfix 2.1.
+#
+sample_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/samples
+
+# readme_directory: The location of the Postfix README files.
+#
+readme_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/README_FILES
+
+# add this to new postfix to get it to add proper message-id and other
+# headers to outgoing emails via the gateway.
+
+
+message_size_limit = 20971520
+inet_protocols = ipv4
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.gateway b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.gateway
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..c86e5b9c7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.gateway
@@ -0,0 +1,747 @@
+# Global Postfix configuration file. This file lists only a subset
+# of all parameters. For the syntax, and for a complete parameter
+# list, see the postconf(5) manual page (command: "man 5 postconf").
+#
+# For common configuration examples, see BASIC_CONFIGURATION_README
+# and STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README. To find these documents, use
+# the command "postconf html_directory readme_directory", or go to
+# http://www.postfix.org/.
+#
+# For best results, change no more than 2-3 parameters at a time,
+# and test if Postfix still works after every change.
+
+# Custom rules
+
+# SOFT BOUNCE
+#
+# The soft_bounce parameter provides a limited safety net for
+# testing. When soft_bounce is enabled, mail will remain queued that
+# would otherwise bounce. This parameter disables locally-generated
+# bounces, and prevents the SMTP server from rejecting mail permanently
+# (by changing 5xx replies into 4xx replies). However, soft_bounce
+# is no cure for address rewriting mistakes or mail routing mistakes.
+#
+#soft_bounce = no
+
+# LOCAL PATHNAME INFORMATION
+#
+# The queue_directory specifies the location of the Postfix queue.
+# This is also the root directory of Postfix daemons that run chrooted.
+# See the files in examples/chroot-setup for setting up Postfix chroot
+# environments on different UNIX systems.
+#
+queue_directory = /var/spool/postfix
+
+# The command_directory parameter specifies the location of all
+# postXXX commands.
+#
+command_directory = /usr/sbin
+
+# The daemon_directory parameter specifies the location of all Postfix
+# daemon programs (i.e. programs listed in the master.cf file). This
+# directory must be owned by root.
+#
+daemon_directory = /usr/libexec/postfix
+
+# The data_directory parameter specifies the location of Postfix-writable
+# data files (caches, random numbers). This directory must be owned
+# by the mail_owner account (see below).
+#
+data_directory = /var/lib/postfix
+
+# QUEUE AND PROCESS OWNERSHIP
+#
+# The mail_owner parameter specifies the owner of the Postfix queue
+# and of most Postfix daemon processes. Specify the name of a user
+# account THAT DOES NOT SHARE ITS USER OR GROUP ID WITH OTHER ACCOUNTS
+# AND THAT OWNS NO OTHER FILES OR PROCESSES ON THE SYSTEM. In
+# particular, don't specify nobody or daemon. PLEASE USE A DEDICATED
+# USER.
+#
+mail_owner = postfix
+
+# The default_privs parameter specifies the default rights used by
+# the local delivery agent for delivery to external file or command.
+# These rights are used in the absence of a recipient user context.
+# DO NOT SPECIFY A PRIVILEGED USER OR THE POSTFIX OWNER.
+#
+#default_privs = nobody
+
+# INTERNET HOST AND DOMAIN NAMES
+#
+# The myhostname parameter specifies the internet hostname of this
+# mail system. The default is to use the fully-qualified domain name
+# from gethostname(). $myhostname is used as a default value for many
+# other configuration parameters.
+#
+#myhostname = host.domain.tld
+#myhostname = virtual.domain.tld
+
+
+smtp_helo_name = bastion.fedoraproject.org
+
+# The mydomain parameter specifies the local internet domain name.
+# The default is to use $myhostname minus the first component.
+# $mydomain is used as a default value for many other configuration
+# parameters.
+#
+#mydomain = domain.tld
+
+mydomain = fedoraproject.org
+
+# SENDING MAIL
+#
+# The myorigin parameter specifies the domain that locally-posted
+# mail appears to come from. The default is to append $myhostname,
+# which is fine for small sites. If you run a domain with multiple
+# machines, you should (1) change this to $mydomain and (2) set up
+# a domain-wide alias database that aliases each user to
+# user@that.users.mailhost.
+#
+# For the sake of consistency between sender and recipient addresses,
+# myorigin also specifies the default domain name that is appended
+# to recipient addresses that have no @domain part.
+#
+#myorigin = $myhostname
+#myorigin = $mydomain
+
+myorigin = fedoraproject.org
+
+# RECEIVING MAIL
+
+# The inet_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on. By default,
+# the software claims all active interfaces on the machine. The
+# parameter also controls delivery of mail to user@[ip.address].
+#
+# See also the proxy_interfaces parameter, for network addresses that
+# are forwarded to us via a proxy or network address translator.
+#
+# Note: you need to stop/start Postfix when this parameter changes.
+#
+#inet_interfaces = all
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname, localhost
+
+inet_interfaces = all
+
+# The proxy_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on by way of a
+# proxy or network address translation unit. This setting extends
+# the address list specified with the inet_interfaces parameter.
+#
+# You must specify your proxy/NAT addresses when your system is a
+# backup MX host for other domains, otherwise mail delivery loops
+# will happen when the primary MX host is down.
+#
+#proxy_interfaces =
+#proxy_interfaces = 1.2.3.4
+
+# The mydestination parameter specifies the list of domains that this
+# machine considers itself the final destination for.
+#
+# These domains are routed to the delivery agent specified with the
+# local_transport parameter setting. By default, that is the UNIX
+# compatible delivery agent that lookups all recipients in /etc/passwd
+# and /etc/aliases or their equivalent.
+#
+# The default is $myhostname + localhost.$mydomain. On a mail domain
+# gateway, you should also include $mydomain.
+#
+# Do not specify the names of virtual domains - those domains are
+# specified elsewhere (see VIRTUAL_README).
+#
+# Do not specify the names of domains that this machine is backup MX
+# host for. Specify those names via the relay_domains settings for
+# the SMTP server, or use permit_mx_backup if you are lazy (see
+# STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README).
+#
+# The local machine is always the final destination for mail addressed
+# to user@[the.net.work.address] of an interface that the mail system
+# receives mail on (see the inet_interfaces parameter).
+#
+# Specify a list of host or domain names, /file/name or type:table
+# patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. A /file/name
+# pattern is replaced by its contents; a type:table is matched when
+# a name matches a lookup key (the right-hand side is ignored).
+# Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.
+#
+# See also below, section "REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS".
+#
+
+mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, fedora.redhat.com, localhost , $mydomain, stg.fedoraproject.org, fedorahosted.org
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain,
+# mail.$mydomain, www.$mydomain, ftp.$mydomain
+
+# REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS
+#
+# The local_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all names or addresses of users that are local with respect
+# to $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown local users. This parameter is defined by default.
+#
+# To turn off local recipient checking in the SMTP server, specify
+# local_recipient_maps = (i.e. empty).
+#
+# The default setting assumes that you use the default Postfix local
+# delivery agent for local delivery. You need to update the
+# local_recipient_maps setting if:
+#
+# - You define $mydestination domain recipients in files other than
+# /etc/passwd, /etc/aliases, or the $virtual_alias_maps files.
+# For example, you define $mydestination domain recipients in
+# the $virtual_mailbox_maps files.
+#
+# - You redefine the local delivery agent in master.cf.
+#
+# - You redefine the "local_transport" setting in main.cf.
+#
+# - You use the "luser_relay", "mailbox_transport", or "fallback_transport"
+# feature of the Postfix local delivery agent (see local(8)).
+#
+# Details are described in the LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README file.
+#
+# Beware: if the Postfix SMTP server runs chrooted, you probably have
+# to access the passwd file via the proxymap service, in order to
+# overcome chroot restrictions. The alternative, having a copy of
+# the system passwd file in the chroot jail is just not practical.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify a bare username, an @domain.tld
+# wild-card, or specify a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#local_recipient_maps = unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps = proxy:unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps =
+local_recipient_maps = $alias_maps hash:/etc/postfix/relay_recipient_maps
+
+# The unknown_local_recipient_reject_code specifies the SMTP server
+# response code when a recipient domain matches $mydestination or
+# ${proxy,inet}_interfaces, while $local_recipient_maps is non-empty
+# and the recipient address or address local-part is not found.
+#
+# The default setting is 550 (reject mail) but it is safer to start
+# with 450 (try again later) until you are certain that your
+# local_recipient_maps settings are OK.
+#
+unknown_local_recipient_reject_code = 550
+
+# TRUST AND RELAY CONTROL
+
+# The mynetworks parameter specifies the list of "trusted" SMTP
+# clients that have more privileges than "strangers".
+#
+# In particular, "trusted" SMTP clients are allowed to relay mail
+# through Postfix. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions parameter
+# in postconf(5).
+#
+# You can specify the list of "trusted" network addresses by hand
+# or you can let Postfix do it for you (which is the default).
+#
+# By default (mynetworks_style = subnet), Postfix "trusts" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP subnetworks as the local machine.
+# On Linux, this does works correctly only with interfaces specified
+# with the "ifconfig" command.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = class" when Postfix should "trust" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP class A/B/C networks as the local machine.
+# Don't do this with a dialup site - it would cause Postfix to "trust"
+# your entire provider's network. Instead, specify an explicit
+# mynetworks list by hand, as described below.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = host" when Postfix should "trust"
+# only the local machine.
+#
+#mynetworks_style = class
+#mynetworks_style = subnet
+#mynetworks_style = host
+
+
+# Alternatively, you can specify the mynetworks list by hand, in
+# which case Postfix ignores the mynetworks_style setting.
+#
+# Specify an explicit list of network/netmask patterns, where the
+# mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host
+# address.
+#
+# You can also specify the absolute pathname of a pattern file instead
+# of listing the patterns here. Specify type:table for table-based lookups
+# (the value on the table right-hand side is not used).
+#
+#mynetworks = 168.100.189.0/28, 127.0.0.0/8
+#mynetworks = $config_directory/mynetworks
+#mynetworks = hash:/etc/postfix/network_table
+
+mynetworks = localhost.localdomain, localhost, 127.0.0.1, 10.5.124.128/25, 10.5.125.0/24, 10.5.126.0/24, 10.5.127.0/24, 10.5.128.0/24, 10.5.129.0/24, 10.5.130.0/24, 10.5.131.0/24, 10.5.78.0/24, 10.5.79.0/24, 192.168.0.0/16
+
+# The relay_domains parameter restricts what destinations this system will
+# relay mail to. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions description in
+# postconf(5) for detailed information.
+#
+# By default, Postfix relays mail
+# - from "trusted" clients (IP address matches $mynetworks) to any destination,
+# - from "untrusted" clients to destinations that match $relay_domains or
+# subdomains thereof, except addresses with sender-specified routing.
+# The default relay_domains value is $mydestination.
+#
+# In addition to the above, the Postfix SMTP server by default accepts mail
+# that Postfix is final destination for:
+# - destinations that match $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces,
+# - destinations that match $mydestination
+# - destinations that match $virtual_alias_domains,
+# - destinations that match $virtual_mailbox_domains.
+# These destinations do not need to be listed in $relay_domains.
+#
+# Specify a list of hosts or domains, /file/name patterns or type:name
+# lookup tables, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue
+# long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. A file name
+# is replaced by its contents; a type:name table is matched when a
+# (parent) domain appears as lookup key.
+#
+# NOTE: Postfix will not automatically forward mail for domains that
+# list this system as their primary or backup MX host. See the
+# permit_mx_backup restriction description in postconf(5).
+#
+#relay_domains = $mydestination
+
+relay_domains = $mydestination fedora.phx.redhat.com
+
+# INTERNET OR INTRANET
+
+# The relayhost parameter specifies the default host to send mail to
+# when no entry is matched in the optional transport(5) table. When
+# no relayhost is given, mail is routed directly to the destination.
+#
+# On an intranet, specify the organizational domain name. If your
+# internal DNS uses no MX records, specify the name of the intranet
+# gateway host instead.
+#
+# In the case of SMTP, specify a domain, host, host:port, [host]:port,
+# [address] or [address]:port; the form [host] turns off MX lookups.
+#
+# If you're connected via UUCP, see also the default_transport parameter.
+#
+#relayhost = $mydomain
+#relayhost = [gateway.my.domain]
+#relayhost = [mailserver.isp.tld]
+#relayhost = uucphost
+#relayhost = [an.ip.add.ress]
+
+
+# REJECTING UNKNOWN RELAY USERS
+#
+# The relay_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all addresses in the domains that match $relay_domains.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown relay users. This feature is off by default.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify an @domain.tld wild-card, or specify
+# a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#relay_recipient_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_recipients
+
+# INPUT RATE CONTROL
+#
+# The in_flow_delay configuration parameter implements mail input
+# flow control. This feature is turned on by default, although it
+# still needs further development (it's disabled on SCO UNIX due
+# to an SCO bug).
+#
+# A Postfix process will pause for $in_flow_delay seconds before
+# accepting a new message, when the message arrival rate exceeds the
+# message delivery rate. With the default 100 SMTP server process
+# limit, this limits the mail inflow to 100 messages a second more
+# than the number of messages delivered per second.
+#
+# Specify 0 to disable the feature. Valid delays are 0..10.
+#
+#in_flow_delay = 1s
+
+# ADDRESS REWRITING
+#
+# The ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document gives information about
+# address masquerading or other forms of address rewriting including
+# username->Firstname.Lastname mapping.
+
+# ADDRESS REDIRECTION (VIRTUAL DOMAIN)
+#
+# The VIRTUAL_README document gives information about the many forms
+# of domain hosting that Postfix supports.
+
+# "USER HAS MOVED" BOUNCE MESSAGES
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# TRANSPORT MAP
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# ALIAS DATABASE
+#
+# The alias_maps parameter specifies the list of alias databases used
+# by the local delivery agent. The default list is system dependent.
+#
+# On systems with NIS, the default is to search the local alias
+# database, then the NIS alias database. See aliases(5) for syntax
+# details.
+#
+# If you change the alias database, run "postalias /etc/aliases" (or
+# wherever your system stores the mail alias file), or simply run
+# "newaliases" to build the necessary DBM or DB file.
+#
+# It will take a minute or so before changes become visible. Use
+# "postfix reload" to eliminate the delay.
+#
+#alias_maps = dbm:/etc/aliases
+alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases
+alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, hash:/etc/postfix/package-owner
+#alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, nis:mail.aliases
+#alias_maps = netinfo:/aliases
+
+# The alias_database parameter specifies the alias database(s) that
+# are built with "newaliases" or "sendmail -bi". This is a separate
+# configuration parameter, because alias_maps (see above) may specify
+# tables that are not necessarily all under control by Postfix.
+#
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/mail/aliases
+alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases, hash:/opt/majordomo/aliases
+
+# ADDRESS EXTENSIONS (e.g., user+foo)
+#
+# The recipient_delimiter parameter specifies the separator between
+# user names and address extensions (user+foo). See canonical(5),
+# local(8), relocated(5) and virtual(5) for the effects this has on
+# aliases, canonical, virtual, relocated and .forward file lookups.
+# Basically, the software tries user+foo and .forward+foo before
+# trying user and .forward.
+#
+recipient_delimiter = +
+
+# DELIVERY TO MAILBOX
+#
+# The home_mailbox parameter specifies the optional pathname of a
+# mailbox file relative to a user's home directory. The default
+# mailbox file is /var/spool/mail/user or /var/mail/user. Specify
+# "Maildir/" for qmail-style delivery (the / is required).
+#
+#home_mailbox = Mailbox
+#home_mailbox = Maildir/
+
+# The mail_spool_directory parameter specifies the directory where
+# UNIX-style mailboxes are kept. The default setting depends on the
+# system type.
+#
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/mail
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/spool/mail
+
+# The mailbox_command parameter specifies the optional external
+# command to use instead of mailbox delivery. The command is run as
+# the recipient with proper HOME, SHELL and LOGNAME environment settings.
+# Exception: delivery for root is done as $default_user.
+#
+# Other environment variables of interest: USER (recipient username),
+# EXTENSION (address extension), DOMAIN (domain part of address),
+# and LOCAL (the address localpart).
+#
+# Unlike other Postfix configuration parameters, the mailbox_command
+# parameter is not subjected to $parameter substitutions. This is to
+# make it easier to specify shell syntax (see example below).
+#
+# Avoid shell meta characters because they will force Postfix to run
+# an expensive shell process. Procmail alone is expensive enough.
+#
+# IF YOU USE THIS TO DELIVER MAIL SYSTEM-WIDE, YOU MUST SET UP AN
+# ALIAS THAT FORWARDS MAIL FOR ROOT TO A REAL USER.
+#
+#mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail
+#mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail -a "$EXTENSION"
+
+# The mailbox_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use after processing aliases and .forward files. This parameter
+# has precedence over the mailbox_command, fallback_transport and
+# luser_relay parameters.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+
+# If using the cyrus-imapd IMAP server deliver local mail to the IMAP
+# server using LMTP (Local Mail Transport Protocol), this is prefered
+# over the older cyrus deliver program by setting the
+# mailbox_transport as below:
+#
+# mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#
+# The efficiency of LMTP delivery for cyrus-imapd can be enhanced via
+# these settings.
+#
+# local_destination_recipient_limit = 300
+# local_destination_concurrency_limit = 5
+#
+# Of course you should adjust these settings as appropriate for the
+# capacity of the hardware you are using. The recipient limit setting
+# can be used to take advantage of the single instance message store
+# capability of Cyrus. The concurrency limit can be used to control
+# how many simultaneous LMTP sessions will be permitted to the Cyrus
+# message store.
+#
+# To use the old cyrus deliver program you have to set:
+#mailbox_transport = cyrus
+
+
+#mailbox_transport = lmtp:10.5.126.73:2003
+
+# The fallback_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use for recipients that are not found in the UNIX passwd database.
+# This parameter has precedence over the luser_relay parameter.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#fallback_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#fallback_transport =
+
+# The luser_relay parameter specifies an optional destination address
+# for unknown recipients. By default, mail for unknown@$mydestination,
+# unknown@[$inet_interfaces] or unknown@[$proxy_interfaces] is returned
+# as undeliverable.
+#
+# The following expansions are done on luser_relay: $user (recipient
+# username), $shell (recipient shell), $home (recipient home directory),
+# $recipient (full recipient address), $extension (recipient address
+# extension), $domain (recipient domain), $local (entire recipient
+# localpart), $recipient_delimiter. Specify ${name?value} or
+# ${name:value} to expand value only when $name does (does not) exist.
+#
+# luser_relay works only for the default Postfix local delivery agent.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must specify "local_recipient_maps =" (i.e. empty) in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#luser_relay = $user@other.host
+#luser_relay = $local@other.host
+#luser_relay = admin+$local
+
+# JUNK MAIL CONTROLS
+#
+# The controls listed here are only a very small subset. The file
+# SMTPD_ACCESS_README provides an overview.
+
+# The header_checks parameter specifies an optional table with patterns
+# that each logical message header is matched against, including
+# headers that span multiple physical lines.
+#
+# By default, these patterns also apply to MIME headers and to the
+# headers of attached messages. With older Postfix versions, MIME and
+# attached message headers were treated as body text.
+#
+# For details, see "man header_checks".
+#
+#header_checks = regexp:/etc/postfix/header_checks
+
+# FAST ETRN SERVICE
+#
+# Postfix maintains per-destination logfiles with information about
+# deferred mail, so that mail can be flushed quickly with the SMTP
+# "ETRN domain.tld" command, or by executing "sendmail -qRdomain.tld".
+# See the ETRN_README document for a detailed description.
+#
+# The fast_flush_domains parameter controls what destinations are
+# eligible for this service. By default, they are all domains that
+# this server is willing to relay mail to.
+#
+#fast_flush_domains = $relay_domains
+
+# SHOW SOFTWARE VERSION OR NOT
+#
+# The smtpd_banner parameter specifies the text that follows the 220
+# code in the SMTP server's greeting banner. Some people like to see
+# the mail version advertised. By default, Postfix shows no version.
+#
+# You MUST specify $myhostname at the start of the text. That is an
+# RFC requirement. Postfix itself does not care.
+#
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name ($mail_version)
+
+# PARALLEL DELIVERY TO THE SAME DESTINATION
+#
+# How many parallel deliveries to the same user or domain? With local
+# delivery, it does not make sense to do massively parallel delivery
+# to the same user, because mailbox updates must happen sequentially,
+# and expensive pipelines in .forward files can cause disasters when
+# too many are run at the same time. With SMTP deliveries, 10
+# simultaneous connections to the same domain could be sufficient to
+# raise eyebrows.
+#
+# Each message delivery transport has its XXX_destination_concurrency_limit
+# parameter. The default is $default_destination_concurrency_limit for
+# most delivery transports. For the local delivery agent the default is 2.
+
+#local_destination_concurrency_limit = 2
+#default_destination_concurrency_limit = 20
+
+# DEBUGGING CONTROL
+#
+# The debug_peer_level parameter specifies the increment in verbose
+# logging level when an SMTP client or server host name or address
+# matches a pattern in the debug_peer_list parameter.
+#
+debug_peer_level = 2
+
+# The debug_peer_list parameter specifies an optional list of domain
+# or network patterns, /file/name patterns or type:name tables. When
+# an SMTP client or server host name or address matches a pattern,
+# increase the verbose logging level by the amount specified in the
+# debug_peer_level parameter.
+#
+#debug_peer_list = 127.0.0.1
+#debug_peer_list = some.domain
+
+# The debugger_command specifies the external command that is executed
+# when a Postfix daemon program is run with the -D option.
+#
+# Use "command .. & sleep 5" so that the debugger can attach before
+# the process marches on. If you use an X-based debugger, be sure to
+# set up your XAUTHORITY environment variable before starting Postfix.
+#
+debugger_command =
+ PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin:/usr/X11R6/bin
+ ddd $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id & sleep 5
+
+# If you can't use X, use this to capture the call stack when a
+# daemon crashes. The result is in a file in the configuration
+# directory, and is named after the process name and the process ID.
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin; export PATH; (echo cont;
+# echo where) | gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id 2>&1
+# >$config_directory/$process_name.$process_id.log & sleep 5
+#
+# Another possibility is to run gdb under a detached screen session.
+# To attach to the screen sesssion, su root and run "screen -r
+# <id_string>" where <id_string> uniquely matches one of the detached
+# sessions (from "screen -list").
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/sbin:/usr/sbin; export PATH; screen
+# -dmS $process_name gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name
+# $process_id & sleep 1
+
+# INSTALL-TIME CONFIGURATION INFORMATION
+#
+# The following parameters are used when installing a new Postfix version.
+#
+# sendmail_path: The full pathname of the Postfix sendmail command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible mail posting interface.
+#
+sendmail_path = /usr/sbin/sendmail.postfix
+
+# newaliases_path: The full pathname of the Postfix newaliases command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible command to build alias databases.
+#
+newaliases_path = /usr/bin/newaliases.postfix
+
+# mailq_path: The full pathname of the Postfix mailq command. This
+# is the Sendmail-compatible mail queue listing command.
+#
+mailq_path = /usr/bin/mailq.postfix
+
+# setgid_group: The group for mail submission and queue management
+# commands. This must be a group name with a numerical group ID that
+# is not shared with other accounts, not even with the Postfix account.
+#
+setgid_group = postdrop
+
+# html_directory: The location of the Postfix HTML documentation.
+#
+html_directory = no
+
+# manpage_directory: The location of the Postfix on-line manual pages.
+#
+manpage_directory = /usr/share/man
+
+# sample_directory: The location of the Postfix sample configuration files.
+# This parameter is obsolete as of Postfix 2.1.
+#
+sample_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.5.6/samples
+
+# readme_directory: The location of the Postfix README files.
+#
+readme_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.5.6/README_FILES
+# Enable IPv4, and IPv6 if supported
+#inet_protocols = ipv4
+
+# mapping so we know where to go for .redhat.com mail
+
+transport_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/transport
+local_header_rewrite_clients = static:all
+
+
+message_size_limit = 20971520
+
+
+## TLS
+# enable opportunistic TLS support in the SMTP server
+smtpd_use_tls = yes
+smtpd_tls_security_level = may
+smtpd_tls_auth_only = yes
+smtpd_tls_mandatory_protocols = !SSLv2, !SSLv3
+smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers = high
+smtpd_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers = aNULL, MD5, RC4
+#tls_ssl_options = no_ticket, no_compression
+
+smtpd_tls_loglevel = 1
+smtpd_tls_cert_file = /etc/pki/tls/certs/gateway.crt
+smtpd_tls_key_file = /etc/pki/tls/private/gateway.key
+smtpd_tls_CAfile = /etc/pki/tls/certs/ca-bundle.crt
+smtpd_tls_session_cache_timeout = 3600s
+smtpd_tls_session_cache_database = btree:${queue_directory}/smtpd_scache
+smtpd_tls_received_header = yes
+smtpd_tls_ask_ccert = yes
+smtpd_tls_received_header = yes
+tls_random_source = dev:/dev/urandom
+smtpd_tls_eecdh_grade = ultra
+tls_eecdh_strong_curve = prime256v1
+tls_eecdh_ultra_curve = secp384r1
+# TLS end
+#TLS Client
+smtp_tls_fingerprint_digest=sha1
+smtp_tls_note_starttls_offer = yes
+smtp_tls_policy_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/tls_policy
+smtp_tls_security_level = may
+smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols = !SSLv2,!SSLv3
+smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers = high
+smtp_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers= aNULL, MD5, RC4
+smtp_tls_loglevel = 1
+smtp_tls_cert_file = /etc/pki/tls/certs/gateway.crt
+smtp_tls_key_file = /etc/pki/tls/private/gateway.key
+smtp_tls_CAfile = /etc/pki/tls/certs/ca-bundle.crt
+
+smtpd_milters = inet:localhost:8891
+milter_default_action = accept
+inet_protocols = ipv4
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.hosted-lists01.fedoraproject.org b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.hosted-lists01.fedoraproject.org
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..9f10d76d4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.hosted-lists01.fedoraproject.org
@@ -0,0 +1,689 @@
+# "false"
+# Global Postfix configuration file. This file lists only a subset
+# of all parameters. For the syntax, and for a complete parameter
+# list, see the postconf(5) manual page (command: "man 5 postconf").
+#
+# For common configuration examples, see BASIC_CONFIGURATION_README
+# and STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README. To find these documents, use
+# the command "postconf html_directory readme_directory", or go to
+# http://www.postfix.org/.
+#
+# For best results, change no more than 2-3 parameters at a time,
+# and test if Postfix still works after every change.
+
+# SOFT BOUNCE
+#
+# The soft_bounce parameter provides a limited safety net for
+# testing. When soft_bounce is enabled, mail will remain queued that
+# would otherwise bounce. This parameter disables locally-generated
+# bounces, and prevents the SMTP server from rejecting mail permanently
+# (by changing 5xx replies into 4xx replies). However, soft_bounce
+# is no cure for address rewriting mistakes or mail routing mistakes.
+#
+#soft_bounce = no
+
+# LOCAL PATHNAME INFORMATION
+#
+# The queue_directory specifies the location of the Postfix queue.
+# This is also the root directory of Postfix daemons that run chrooted.
+# See the files in examples/chroot-setup for setting up Postfix chroot
+# environments on different UNIX systems.
+#
+queue_directory = /var/spool/postfix
+
+# The command_directory parameter specifies the location of all
+# postXXX commands.
+#
+command_directory = /usr/sbin
+
+# The daemon_directory parameter specifies the location of all Postfix
+# daemon programs (i.e. programs listed in the master.cf file). This
+# directory must be owned by root.
+#
+daemon_directory = /usr/libexec/postfix
+
+# QUEUE AND PROCESS OWNERSHIP
+#
+# The mail_owner parameter specifies the owner of the Postfix queue
+# and of most Postfix daemon processes. Specify the name of a user
+# account THAT DOES NOT SHARE ITS USER OR GROUP ID WITH OTHER ACCOUNTS
+# AND THAT OWNS NO OTHER FILES OR PROCESSES ON THE SYSTEM. In
+# particular, don't specify nobody or daemon. PLEASE USE A DEDICATED
+# USER.
+#
+mail_owner = postfix
+
+# The default_privs parameter specifies the default rights used by
+# the local delivery agent for delivery to external file or command.
+# These rights are used in the absence of a recipient user context.
+# DO NOT SPECIFY A PRIVILEGED USER OR THE POSTFIX OWNER.
+#
+#default_privs = nobody
+
+# INTERNET HOST AND DOMAIN NAMES
+#
+# The myhostname parameter specifies the internet hostname of this
+# mail system. The default is to use the fully-qualified domain name
+# from gethostname(). $myhostname is used as a default value for many
+# other configuration parameters.
+#
+#myhostname = host.domain.tld
+#myhostname = virtual.domain.tld
+
+# The mydomain parameter specifies the local internet domain name.
+# The default is to use $myhostname minus the first component.
+# $mydomain is used as a default value for many other configuration
+# parameters.
+#
+#mydomain = domain.tld
+
+# SENDING MAIL
+#
+# The myorigin parameter specifies the domain that locally-posted
+# mail appears to come from. The default is to append $myhostname,
+# which is fine for small sites. If you run a domain with multiple
+# machines, you should (1) change this to $mydomain and (2) set up
+# a domain-wide alias database that aliases each user to
+# user@that.users.mailhost.
+#
+# For the sake of consistency between sender and recipient addresses,
+# myorigin also specifies the default domain name that is appended
+# to recipient addresses that have no @domain part.
+#
+#myorigin = $myhostname
+#myorigin = $mydomain
+
+myhostname = lists.fedorahosted.org
+myorigin = lists.fedorahosted.org
+
+# RECEIVING MAIL
+
+# The inet_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on. By default,
+# the software claims all active interfaces on the machine. The
+# parameter also controls delivery of mail to user@[ip.address].
+#
+# See also the proxy_interfaces parameter, for network addresses that
+# are forwarded to us via a proxy or network address translator.
+#
+# Note: you need to stop/start Postfix when this parameter changes.
+#
+#inet_interfaces = all
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname, localhost
+inet_interfaces = all
+
+# The proxy_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on by way of a
+# proxy or network address translation unit. This setting extends
+# the address list specified with the inet_interfaces parameter.
+#
+# You must specify your proxy/NAT addresses when your system is a
+# backup MX host for other domains, otherwise mail delivery loops
+# will happen when the primary MX host is down.
+#
+#proxy_interfaces =
+#proxy_interfaces = 1.2.3.4
+
+# The mydestination parameter specifies the list of domains that this
+# machine considers itself the final destination for.
+#
+# These domains are routed to the delivery agent specified with the
+# local_transport parameter setting. By default, that is the UNIX
+# compatible delivery agent that lookups all recipients in /etc/passwd
+# and /etc/aliases or their equivalent.
+#
+# The default is $myhostname + localhost.$mydomain. On a mail domain
+# gateway, you should also include $mydomain.
+#
+# Do not specify the names of virtual domains - those domains are
+# specified elsewhere (see VIRTUAL_README).
+#
+# Do not specify the names of domains that this machine is backup MX
+# host for. Specify those names via the relay_domains settings for
+# the SMTP server, or use permit_mx_backup if you are lazy (see
+# STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README).
+#
+# The local machine is always the final destination for mail addressed
+# to user@[the.net.work.address] of an interface that the mail system
+# receives mail on (see the inet_interfaces parameter).
+#
+# Specify a list of host or domain names, /file/name or type:table
+# patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. A /file/name
+# pattern is replaced by its contents; a type:table is matched when
+# a name matches a lookup key (the right-hand side is ignored).
+# Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.
+#
+# See also below, section "REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS".
+#
+mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, fedora.redhat.com, localhost, fedorahosted.org
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain,
+# mail.$mydomain, www.$mydomain, ftp.$mydomain
+
+# REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS
+#
+# The local_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all names or addresses of users that are local with respect
+# to $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown local users. This parameter is defined by default.
+#
+# To turn off local recipient checking in the SMTP server, specify
+# local_recipient_maps = (i.e. empty).
+#
+# The default setting assumes that you use the default Postfix local
+# delivery agent for local delivery. You need to update the
+# local_recipient_maps setting if:
+#
+# - You define $mydestination domain recipients in files other than
+# /etc/passwd, /etc/aliases, or the $virtual_alias_maps files.
+# For example, you define $mydestination domain recipients in
+# the $virtual_mailbox_maps files.
+#
+# - You redefine the local delivery agent in master.cf.
+#
+# - You redefine the "local_transport" setting in main.cf.
+#
+# - You use the "luser_relay", "mailbox_transport", or "fallback_transport"
+# feature of the Postfix local delivery agent (see local(8)).
+#
+# Details are described in the LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README file.
+#
+# Beware: if the Postfix SMTP server runs chrooted, you probably have
+# to access the passwd file via the proxymap service, in order to
+# overcome chroot restrictions. The alternative, having a copy of
+# the system passwd file in the chroot jail is just not practical.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify a bare username, an @domain.tld
+# wild-card, or specify a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+local_recipient_maps = $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps = unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps = proxy:unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps =
+
+# The unknown_local_recipient_reject_code specifies the SMTP server
+# response code when a recipient domain matches $mydestination or
+# ${proxy,inet}_interfaces, while $local_recipient_maps is non-empty
+# and the recipient address or address local-part is not found.
+#
+# The default setting is 550 (reject mail) but it is safer to start
+# with 450 (try again later) until you are certain that your
+# local_recipient_maps settings are OK.
+#
+unknown_local_recipient_reject_code = 550
+
+# TRUST AND RELAY CONTROL
+
+# The mynetworks parameter specifies the list of "trusted" SMTP
+# clients that have more privileges than "strangers".
+#
+# In particular, "trusted" SMTP clients are allowed to relay mail
+# through Postfix. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions parameter
+# in postconf(5).
+#
+# You can specify the list of "trusted" network addresses by hand
+# or you can let Postfix do it for you (which is the default).
+#
+# By default (mynetworks_style = subnet), Postfix "trusts" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP subnetworks as the local machine.
+# On Linux, this does works correctly only with interfaces specified
+# with the "ifconfig" command.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = class" when Postfix should "trust" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP class A/B/C networks as the local machine.
+# Don't do this with a dialup site - it would cause Postfix to "trust"
+# your entire provider's network. Instead, specify an explicit
+# mynetworks list by hand, as described below.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = host" when Postfix should "trust"
+# only the local machine.
+#
+#mynetworks_style = class
+#mynetworks_style = subnet
+#mynetworks_style = host
+
+# Alternatively, you can specify the mynetworks list by hand, in
+# which case Postfix ignores the mynetworks_style setting.
+#
+# Specify an explicit list of network/netmask patterns, where the
+# mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host
+# address.
+#
+# You can also specify the absolute pathname of a pattern file instead
+# of listing the patterns here. Specify type:table for table-based lookups
+# (the value on the table right-hand side is not used).
+#
+#mynetworks = 168.100.189.0/28, 127.0.0.0/8
+#mynetworks = $config_directory/mynetworks
+#mynetworks = hash:/etc/postfix/network_table
+
+
+# The relay_domains parameter restricts what destinations this system will
+# relay mail to. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions description in
+# postconf(5) for detailed information.
+#
+# By default, Postfix relays mail
+# - from "trusted" clients (IP address matches $mynetworks) to any destination,
+# - from "untrusted" clients to destinations that match $relay_domains or
+# subdomains thereof, except addresses with sender-specified routing.
+# The default relay_domains value is $mydestination.
+#
+# In addition to the above, the Postfix SMTP server by default accepts mail
+# that Postfix is final destination for:
+# - destinations that match $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces,
+# - destinations that match $mydestination
+# - destinations that match $virtual_alias_domains,
+# - destinations that match $virtual_mailbox_domains.
+# These destinations do not need to be listed in $relay_domains.
+#
+# Specify a list of hosts or domains, /file/name patterns or type:name
+# lookup tables, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue
+# long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. A file name
+# is replaced by its contents; a type:name table is matched when a
+# (parent) domain appears as lookup key.
+#
+# NOTE: Postfix will not automatically forward mail for domains that
+# list this system as their primary or backup MX host. See the
+# permit_mx_backup restriction description in postconf(5).
+#
+#relay_domains = $mydestination
+
+
+
+# INTERNET OR INTRANET
+
+# The relayhost parameter specifies the default host to send mail to
+# when no entry is matched in the optional transport(5) table. When
+# no relayhost is given, mail is routed directly to the destination.
+#
+# On an intranet, specify the organizational domain name. If your
+# internal DNS uses no MX records, specify the name of the intranet
+# gateway host instead.
+#
+# In the case of SMTP, specify a domain, host, host:port, [host]:port,
+# [address] or [address]:port; the form [host] turns off MX lookups.
+#
+# If you're connected via UUCP, see also the default_transport parameter.
+#
+#relayhost = $mydomain
+#relayhost = [gateway.my.domain]
+#relayhost = [mailserver.isp.tld]
+#relayhost = uucphost
+#relayhost = [an.ip.add.ress]
+relayhost = bastion
+
+
+# REJECTING UNKNOWN RELAY USERS
+#
+# The relay_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all addresses in the domains that match $relay_domains.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown relay users. This feature is off by default.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify an @domain.tld wild-card, or specify
+# a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#relay_recipient_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_recipients
+
+# INPUT RATE CONTROL
+#
+# The in_flow_delay configuration parameter implements mail input
+# flow control. This feature is turned on by default, although it
+# still needs further development (it's disabled on SCO UNIX due
+# to an SCO bug).
+#
+# A Postfix process will pause for $in_flow_delay seconds before
+# accepting a new message, when the message arrival rate exceeds the
+# message delivery rate. With the default 100 SMTP server process
+# limit, this limits the mail inflow to 100 messages a second more
+# than the number of messages delivered per second.
+#
+# Specify 0 to disable the feature. Valid delays are 0..10.
+#
+#in_flow_delay = 1s
+
+# ADDRESS REWRITING
+#
+# The ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document gives information about
+# address masquerading or other forms of address rewriting including
+# username->Firstname.Lastname mapping.
+
+masquerade_domains = redhat.com
+masquerade_exceptions = root apache
+
+# ADDRESS REDIRECTION (VIRTUAL DOMAIN)
+#
+# The VIRTUAL_README document gives information about the many forms
+# of domain hosting that Postfix supports.
+
+# "USER HAS MOVED" BOUNCE MESSAGES
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# TRANSPORT MAP
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# ALIAS DATABASE
+#
+# The alias_maps parameter specifies the list of alias databases used
+# by the local delivery agent. The default list is system dependent.
+#
+# On systems with NIS, the default is to search the local alias
+# database, then the NIS alias database. See aliases(5) for syntax
+# details.
+#
+# If you change the alias database, run "postalias /etc/aliases" (or
+# wherever your system stores the mail alias file), or simply run
+# "newaliases" to build the necessary DBM or DB file.
+#
+# It will take a minute or so before changes become visible. Use
+# "postfix reload" to eliminate the delay.
+#
+#alias_maps = dbm:/etc/aliases
+alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, hash:/etc/mailman/aliases
+#alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, nis:mail.aliases
+#alias_maps = netinfo:/aliases
+
+# The alias_database parameter specifies the alias database(s) that
+# are built with "newaliases" or "sendmail -bi". This is a separate
+# configuration parameter, because alias_maps (see above) may specify
+# tables that are not necessarily all under control by Postfix.
+#
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/mail/aliases
+alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases, hash:/opt/majordomo/aliases
+
+# ADDRESS EXTENSIONS (e.g., user+foo)
+#
+# The recipient_delimiter parameter specifies the separator between
+# user names and address extensions (user+foo). See canonical(5),
+# local(8), relocated(5) and virtual(5) for the effects this has on
+# aliases, canonical, virtual, relocated and .forward file lookups.
+# Basically, the software tries user+foo and .forward+foo before
+# trying user and .forward.
+#
+recipient_delimiter = +
+
+# DELIVERY TO MAILBOX
+#
+# The home_mailbox parameter specifies the optional pathname of a
+# mailbox file relative to a user's home directory. The default
+# mailbox file is /var/spool/mail/user or /var/mail/user. Specify
+# "Maildir/" for qmail-style delivery (the / is required).
+#
+#home_mailbox = Mailbox
+#home_mailbox = Maildir/
+
+# The mail_spool_directory parameter specifies the directory where
+# UNIX-style mailboxes are kept. The default setting depends on the
+# system type.
+#
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/mail
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/spool/mail
+
+# The mailbox_command parameter specifies the optional external
+# command to use instead of mailbox delivery. The command is run as
+# the recipient with proper HOME, SHELL and LOGNAME environment settings.
+# Exception: delivery for root is done as $default_user.
+#
+# Other environment variables of interest: USER (recipient username),
+# EXTENSION (address extension), DOMAIN (domain part of address),
+# and LOCAL (the address localpart).
+#
+# Unlike other Postfix configuration parameters, the mailbox_command
+# parameter is not subjected to $parameter substitutions. This is to
+# make it easier to specify shell syntax (see example below).
+#
+# Avoid shell meta characters because they will force Postfix to run
+# an expensive shell process. Procmail alone is expensive enough.
+#
+# IF YOU USE THIS TO DELIVER MAIL SYSTEM-WIDE, YOU MUST SET UP AN
+# ALIAS THAT FORWARDS MAIL FOR ROOT TO A REAL USER.
+#
+#mailbox_command = /usr/bin/procmail
+#mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail -a "$EXTENSION"
+
+# The mailbox_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use after processing aliases and .forward files. This parameter
+# has precedence over the mailbox_command, fallback_transport and
+# luser_relay parameters.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+
+# If using the cyrus-imapd IMAP server deliver local mail to the IMAP
+# server using LMTP (Local Mail Transport Protocol), this is prefered
+# over the older cyrus deliver program by setting the
+# mailbox_transport as below:
+#
+# mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#
+# The efficiency of LMTP delivery for cyrus-imapd can be enhanced via
+# these settings.
+#
+# local_destination_recipient_limit = 300
+# local_destination_concurrency_limit = 5
+#
+# Of course you should adjust these settings as appropriate for the
+# capacity of the hardware you are using. The recipient limit setting
+# can be used to take advantage of the single instance message store
+# capability of Cyrus. The concurrency limit can be used to control
+# how many simultaneous LMTP sessions will be permitted to the Cyrus
+# message store.
+#
+# To use the old cyrus deliver program you have to set:
+#mailbox_transport = cyrus
+
+# The fallback_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use for recipients that are not found in the UNIX passwd database.
+# This parameter has precedence over the luser_relay parameter.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#fallback_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#fallback_transport =
+
+#transport_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/transport
+#transport_maps = hash:/etc/mailman/mailman3-transport
+
+# The luser_relay parameter specifies an optional destination address
+# for unknown recipients. By default, mail for unknown@$mydestination,
+# unknown@[$inet_interfaces] or unknown@[$proxy_interfaces] is returned
+# as undeliverable.
+#
+# The following expansions are done on luser_relay: $user (recipient
+# username), $shell (recipient shell), $home (recipient home directory),
+# $recipient (full recipient address), $extension (recipient address
+# extension), $domain (recipient domain), $local (entire recipient
+# localpart), $recipient_delimiter. Specify ${name?value} or
+# ${name:value} to expand value only when $name does (does not) exist.
+#
+# luser_relay works only for the default Postfix local delivery agent.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must specify "local_recipient_maps =" (i.e. empty) in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#luser_relay = $user@other.host
+#luser_relay = $local@other.host
+#luser_relay = admin+$local
+
+# JUNK MAIL CONTROLS
+#
+# The controls listed here are only a very small subset. The file
+# SMTPD_ACCESS_README provides an overview.
+
+# The header_checks parameter specifies an optional table with patterns
+# that each logical message header is matched against, including
+# headers that span multiple physical lines.
+#
+# By default, these patterns also apply to MIME headers and to the
+# headers of attached messages. With older Postfix versions, MIME and
+# attached message headers were treated as body text.
+#
+# For details, see "man header_checks".
+#
+header_checks = regexp:/etc/postfix/header_checks
+
+# FAST ETRN SERVICE
+#
+# Postfix maintains per-destination logfiles with information about
+# deferred mail, so that mail can be flushed quickly with the SMTP
+# "ETRN domain.tld" command, or by executing "sendmail -qRdomain.tld".
+# See the ETRN_README document for a detailed description.
+#
+# The fast_flush_domains parameter controls what destinations are
+# eligible for this service. By default, they are all domains that
+# this server is willing to relay mail to.
+#
+#fast_flush_domains = $relay_domains
+
+# SHOW SOFTWARE VERSION OR NOT
+#
+# The smtpd_banner parameter specifies the text that follows the 220
+# code in the SMTP server's greeting banner. Some people like to see
+# the mail version advertised. By default, Postfix shows no version.
+#
+# You MUST specify $myhostname at the start of the text. That is an
+# RFC requirement. Postfix itself does not care.
+#
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name ($mail_version)
+
+# PARALLEL DELIVERY TO THE SAME DESTINATION
+#
+# How many parallel deliveries to the same user or domain? With local
+# delivery, it does not make sense to do massively parallel delivery
+# to the same user, because mailbox updates must happen sequentially,
+# and expensive pipelines in .forward files can cause disasters when
+# too many are run at the same time. With SMTP deliveries, 10
+# simultaneous connections to the same domain could be sufficient to
+# raise eyebrows.
+#
+# Each message delivery transport has its XXX_destination_concurrency_limit
+# parameter. The default is $default_destination_concurrency_limit for
+# most delivery transports. For the local delivery agent the default is 2.
+
+#local_destination_concurrency_limit = 2
+#default_destination_concurrency_limit = 20
+
+# DEBUGGING CONTROL
+#
+# The debug_peer_level parameter specifies the increment in verbose
+# logging level when an SMTP client or server host name or address
+# matches a pattern in the debug_peer_list parameter.
+#
+debug_peer_level = 2
+
+# The debug_peer_list parameter specifies an optional list of domain
+# or network patterns, /file/name patterns or type:name tables. When
+# an SMTP client or server host name or address matches a pattern,
+# increase the verbose logging level by the amount specified in the
+# debug_peer_level parameter.
+#
+#debug_peer_list = 127.0.0.1
+#debug_peer_list = some.domain
+
+# The debugger_command specifies the external command that is executed
+# when a Postfix daemon program is run with the -D option.
+#
+# Use "command .. & sleep 5" so that the debugger can attach before
+# the process marches on. If you use an X-based debugger, be sure to
+# set up your XAUTHORITY environment variable before starting Postfix.
+#
+debugger_command =
+ PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin:/usr/X11R6/bin
+ xxgdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id & sleep 5
+
+# If you can't use X, use this to capture the call stack when a
+# daemon crashes. The result is in a file in the configuration
+# directory, and is named after the process name and the process ID.
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin; export PATH; (echo cont;
+# echo where) | gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id 2>&1
+# >$config_directory/$process_name.$process_id.log & sleep 5
+#
+# Another possibility is to run gdb under a detached screen session.
+# To attach to the screen sesssion, su root and run "screen -r
+# <id_string>" where <id_string> uniquely matches one of the detached
+# sessions (from "screen -list").
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/sbin:/usr/sbin; export PATH; screen
+# -dmS $process_name gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name
+# $process_id & sleep 1
+
+# INSTALL-TIME CONFIGURATION INFORMATION
+#
+# The following parameters are used when installing a new Postfix version.
+#
+# sendmail_path: The full pathname of the Postfix sendmail command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible mail posting interface.
+#
+sendmail_path = /usr/sbin/sendmail.postfix
+
+# newaliases_path: The full pathname of the Postfix newaliases command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible command to build alias databases.
+#
+newaliases_path = /usr/bin/newaliases.postfix
+
+# mailq_path: The full pathname of the Postfix mailq command. This
+# is the Sendmail-compatible mail queue listing command.
+#
+mailq_path = /usr/bin/mailq.postfix
+
+# setgid_group: The group for mail submission and queue management
+# commands. This must be a group name with a numerical group ID that
+# is not shared with other accounts, not even with the Postfix account.
+#
+setgid_group = postdrop
+
+# html_directory: The location of the Postfix HTML documentation.
+#
+html_directory = no
+
+# manpage_directory: The location of the Postfix on-line manual pages.
+#
+manpage_directory = /usr/share/man
+
+# sample_directory: The location of the Postfix sample configuration files.
+# This parameter is obsolete as of Postfix 2.1.
+#
+sample_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/samples
+
+# readme_directory: The location of the Postfix README files.
+#
+readme_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/README_FILES
+
+# add this to new postfix to get it to add proper message-id and other
+# headers to outgoing emails via the gateway.
+
+
+message_size_limit = 20971520
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.hosted03.fedoraproject.org b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.hosted03.fedoraproject.org
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..740a9358c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.hosted03.fedoraproject.org
@@ -0,0 +1,687 @@
+# "false"
+# Global Postfix configuration file. This file lists only a subset
+# of all parameters. For the syntax, and for a complete parameter
+# list, see the postconf(5) manual page (command: "man 5 postconf").
+#
+# For common configuration examples, see BASIC_CONFIGURATION_README
+# and STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README. To find these documents, use
+# the command "postconf html_directory readme_directory", or go to
+# http://www.postfix.org/.
+#
+# For best results, change no more than 2-3 parameters at a time,
+# and test if Postfix still works after every change.
+
+# SOFT BOUNCE
+#
+# The soft_bounce parameter provides a limited safety net for
+# testing. When soft_bounce is enabled, mail will remain queued that
+# would otherwise bounce. This parameter disables locally-generated
+# bounces, and prevents the SMTP server from rejecting mail permanently
+# (by changing 5xx replies into 4xx replies). However, soft_bounce
+# is no cure for address rewriting mistakes or mail routing mistakes.
+#
+#soft_bounce = no
+
+# LOCAL PATHNAME INFORMATION
+#
+# The queue_directory specifies the location of the Postfix queue.
+# This is also the root directory of Postfix daemons that run chrooted.
+# See the files in examples/chroot-setup for setting up Postfix chroot
+# environments on different UNIX systems.
+#
+queue_directory = /var/spool/postfix
+
+# The command_directory parameter specifies the location of all
+# postXXX commands.
+#
+command_directory = /usr/sbin
+
+# The daemon_directory parameter specifies the location of all Postfix
+# daemon programs (i.e. programs listed in the master.cf file). This
+# directory must be owned by root.
+#
+daemon_directory = /usr/libexec/postfix
+
+# QUEUE AND PROCESS OWNERSHIP
+#
+# The mail_owner parameter specifies the owner of the Postfix queue
+# and of most Postfix daemon processes. Specify the name of a user
+# account THAT DOES NOT SHARE ITS USER OR GROUP ID WITH OTHER ACCOUNTS
+# AND THAT OWNS NO OTHER FILES OR PROCESSES ON THE SYSTEM. In
+# particular, don't specify nobody or daemon. PLEASE USE A DEDICATED
+# USER.
+#
+mail_owner = postfix
+
+# The default_privs parameter specifies the default rights used by
+# the local delivery agent for delivery to external file or command.
+# These rights are used in the absence of a recipient user context.
+# DO NOT SPECIFY A PRIVILEGED USER OR THE POSTFIX OWNER.
+#
+#default_privs = nobody
+
+# INTERNET HOST AND DOMAIN NAMES
+#
+# The myhostname parameter specifies the internet hostname of this
+# mail system. The default is to use the fully-qualified domain name
+# from gethostname(). $myhostname is used as a default value for many
+# other configuration parameters.
+#
+#myhostname = host.domain.tld
+#myhostname = virtual.domain.tld
+
+# The mydomain parameter specifies the local internet domain name.
+# The default is to use $myhostname minus the first component.
+# $mydomain is used as a default value for many other configuration
+# parameters.
+#
+#mydomain = domain.tld
+
+# SENDING MAIL
+#
+# The myorigin parameter specifies the domain that locally-posted
+# mail appears to come from. The default is to append $myhostname,
+# which is fine for small sites. If you run a domain with multiple
+# machines, you should (1) change this to $mydomain and (2) set up
+# a domain-wide alias database that aliases each user to
+# user@that.users.mailhost.
+#
+# For the sake of consistency between sender and recipient addresses,
+# myorigin also specifies the default domain name that is appended
+# to recipient addresses that have no @domain part.
+#
+#myorigin = $myhostname
+#myorigin = $mydomain
+
+myhostname = fedorahosted.org
+myorigin = fedoraproject.org
+
+# RECEIVING MAIL
+
+# The inet_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on. By default,
+# the software claims all active interfaces on the machine. The
+# parameter also controls delivery of mail to user@[ip.address].
+#
+# See also the proxy_interfaces parameter, for network addresses that
+# are forwarded to us via a proxy or network address translator.
+#
+# Note: you need to stop/start Postfix when this parameter changes.
+#
+#inet_interfaces = all
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname, localhost
+inet_interfaces = all
+
+# The proxy_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on by way of a
+# proxy or network address translation unit. This setting extends
+# the address list specified with the inet_interfaces parameter.
+#
+# You must specify your proxy/NAT addresses when your system is a
+# backup MX host for other domains, otherwise mail delivery loops
+# will happen when the primary MX host is down.
+#
+#proxy_interfaces =
+#proxy_interfaces = 1.2.3.4
+
+# The mydestination parameter specifies the list of domains that this
+# machine considers itself the final destination for.
+#
+# These domains are routed to the delivery agent specified with the
+# local_transport parameter setting. By default, that is the UNIX
+# compatible delivery agent that lookups all recipients in /etc/passwd
+# and /etc/aliases or their equivalent.
+#
+# The default is $myhostname + localhost.$mydomain. On a mail domain
+# gateway, you should also include $mydomain.
+#
+# Do not specify the names of virtual domains - those domains are
+# specified elsewhere (see VIRTUAL_README).
+#
+# Do not specify the names of domains that this machine is backup MX
+# host for. Specify those names via the relay_domains settings for
+# the SMTP server, or use permit_mx_backup if you are lazy (see
+# STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README).
+#
+# The local machine is always the final destination for mail addressed
+# to user@[the.net.work.address] of an interface that the mail system
+# receives mail on (see the inet_interfaces parameter).
+#
+# Specify a list of host or domain names, /file/name or type:table
+# patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. A /file/name
+# pattern is replaced by its contents; a type:table is matched when
+# a name matches a lookup key (the right-hand side is ignored).
+# Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.
+#
+# See also below, section "REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS".
+#
+mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, fedora.redhat.com, localhost, fedorahosted.org
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain,
+# mail.$mydomain, www.$mydomain, ftp.$mydomain
+
+# REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS
+#
+# The local_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all names or addresses of users that are local with respect
+# to $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown local users. This parameter is defined by default.
+#
+# To turn off local recipient checking in the SMTP server, specify
+# local_recipient_maps = (i.e. empty).
+#
+# The default setting assumes that you use the default Postfix local
+# delivery agent for local delivery. You need to update the
+# local_recipient_maps setting if:
+#
+# - You define $mydestination domain recipients in files other than
+# /etc/passwd, /etc/aliases, or the $virtual_alias_maps files.
+# For example, you define $mydestination domain recipients in
+# the $virtual_mailbox_maps files.
+#
+# - You redefine the local delivery agent in master.cf.
+#
+# - You redefine the "local_transport" setting in main.cf.
+#
+# - You use the "luser_relay", "mailbox_transport", or "fallback_transport"
+# feature of the Postfix local delivery agent (see local(8)).
+#
+# Details are described in the LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README file.
+#
+# Beware: if the Postfix SMTP server runs chrooted, you probably have
+# to access the passwd file via the proxymap service, in order to
+# overcome chroot restrictions. The alternative, having a copy of
+# the system passwd file in the chroot jail is just not practical.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify a bare username, an @domain.tld
+# wild-card, or specify a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+local_recipient_maps = $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps = unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps = proxy:unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps =
+
+# The unknown_local_recipient_reject_code specifies the SMTP server
+# response code when a recipient domain matches $mydestination or
+# ${proxy,inet}_interfaces, while $local_recipient_maps is non-empty
+# and the recipient address or address local-part is not found.
+#
+# The default setting is 550 (reject mail) but it is safer to start
+# with 450 (try again later) until you are certain that your
+# local_recipient_maps settings are OK.
+#
+unknown_local_recipient_reject_code = 550
+
+# TRUST AND RELAY CONTROL
+
+# The mynetworks parameter specifies the list of "trusted" SMTP
+# clients that have more privileges than "strangers".
+#
+# In particular, "trusted" SMTP clients are allowed to relay mail
+# through Postfix. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions parameter
+# in postconf(5).
+#
+# You can specify the list of "trusted" network addresses by hand
+# or you can let Postfix do it for you (which is the default).
+#
+# By default (mynetworks_style = subnet), Postfix "trusts" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP subnetworks as the local machine.
+# On Linux, this does works correctly only with interfaces specified
+# with the "ifconfig" command.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = class" when Postfix should "trust" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP class A/B/C networks as the local machine.
+# Don't do this with a dialup site - it would cause Postfix to "trust"
+# your entire provider's network. Instead, specify an explicit
+# mynetworks list by hand, as described below.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = host" when Postfix should "trust"
+# only the local machine.
+#
+#mynetworks_style = class
+#mynetworks_style = subnet
+#mynetworks_style = host
+
+# Alternatively, you can specify the mynetworks list by hand, in
+# which case Postfix ignores the mynetworks_style setting.
+#
+# Specify an explicit list of network/netmask patterns, where the
+# mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host
+# address.
+#
+# You can also specify the absolute pathname of a pattern file instead
+# of listing the patterns here. Specify type:table for table-based lookups
+# (the value on the table right-hand side is not used).
+#
+#mynetworks = 168.100.189.0/28, 127.0.0.0/8
+#mynetworks = $config_directory/mynetworks
+#mynetworks = hash:/etc/postfix/network_table
+
+
+# The relay_domains parameter restricts what destinations this system will
+# relay mail to. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions description in
+# postconf(5) for detailed information.
+#
+# By default, Postfix relays mail
+# - from "trusted" clients (IP address matches $mynetworks) to any destination,
+# - from "untrusted" clients to destinations that match $relay_domains or
+# subdomains thereof, except addresses with sender-specified routing.
+# The default relay_domains value is $mydestination.
+#
+# In addition to the above, the Postfix SMTP server by default accepts mail
+# that Postfix is final destination for:
+# - destinations that match $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces,
+# - destinations that match $mydestination
+# - destinations that match $virtual_alias_domains,
+# - destinations that match $virtual_mailbox_domains.
+# These destinations do not need to be listed in $relay_domains.
+#
+# Specify a list of hosts or domains, /file/name patterns or type:name
+# lookup tables, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue
+# long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. A file name
+# is replaced by its contents; a type:name table is matched when a
+# (parent) domain appears as lookup key.
+#
+# NOTE: Postfix will not automatically forward mail for domains that
+# list this system as their primary or backup MX host. See the
+# permit_mx_backup restriction description in postconf(5).
+#
+#relay_domains = $mydestination
+
+
+
+# INTERNET OR INTRANET
+
+# The relayhost parameter specifies the default host to send mail to
+# when no entry is matched in the optional transport(5) table. When
+# no relayhost is given, mail is routed directly to the destination.
+#
+# On an intranet, specify the organizational domain name. If your
+# internal DNS uses no MX records, specify the name of the intranet
+# gateway host instead.
+#
+# In the case of SMTP, specify a domain, host, host:port, [host]:port,
+# [address] or [address]:port; the form [host] turns off MX lookups.
+#
+# If you're connected via UUCP, see also the default_transport parameter.
+#
+#relayhost = $mydomain
+#relayhost = [gateway.my.domain]
+#relayhost = [mailserver.isp.tld]
+#relayhost = uucphost
+#relayhost = [an.ip.add.ress]
+relayhost = bastion
+
+
+# REJECTING UNKNOWN RELAY USERS
+#
+# The relay_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all addresses in the domains that match $relay_domains.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown relay users. This feature is off by default.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify an @domain.tld wild-card, or specify
+# a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#relay_recipient_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_recipients
+
+# INPUT RATE CONTROL
+#
+# The in_flow_delay configuration parameter implements mail input
+# flow control. This feature is turned on by default, although it
+# still needs further development (it's disabled on SCO UNIX due
+# to an SCO bug).
+#
+# A Postfix process will pause for $in_flow_delay seconds before
+# accepting a new message, when the message arrival rate exceeds the
+# message delivery rate. With the default 100 SMTP server process
+# limit, this limits the mail inflow to 100 messages a second more
+# than the number of messages delivered per second.
+#
+# Specify 0 to disable the feature. Valid delays are 0..10.
+#
+#in_flow_delay = 1s
+
+# ADDRESS REWRITING
+#
+# The ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document gives information about
+# address masquerading or other forms of address rewriting including
+# username->Firstname.Lastname mapping.
+
+masquerade_domains = redhat.com
+masquerade_exceptions = root apache
+
+# ADDRESS REDIRECTION (VIRTUAL DOMAIN)
+#
+# The VIRTUAL_README document gives information about the many forms
+# of domain hosting that Postfix supports.
+
+# "USER HAS MOVED" BOUNCE MESSAGES
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# TRANSPORT MAP
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# ALIAS DATABASE
+#
+# The alias_maps parameter specifies the list of alias databases used
+# by the local delivery agent. The default list is system dependent.
+#
+# On systems with NIS, the default is to search the local alias
+# database, then the NIS alias database. See aliases(5) for syntax
+# details.
+#
+# If you change the alias database, run "postalias /etc/aliases" (or
+# wherever your system stores the mail alias file), or simply run
+# "newaliases" to build the necessary DBM or DB file.
+#
+# It will take a minute or so before changes become visible. Use
+# "postfix reload" to eliminate the delay.
+#
+#alias_maps = dbm:/etc/aliases
+alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, nis:mail.aliases
+#alias_maps = netinfo:/aliases
+
+# The alias_database parameter specifies the alias database(s) that
+# are built with "newaliases" or "sendmail -bi". This is a separate
+# configuration parameter, because alias_maps (see above) may specify
+# tables that are not necessarily all under control by Postfix.
+#
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/mail/aliases
+alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases, hash:/opt/majordomo/aliases
+
+# ADDRESS EXTENSIONS (e.g., user+foo)
+#
+# The recipient_delimiter parameter specifies the separator between
+# user names and address extensions (user+foo). See canonical(5),
+# local(8), relocated(5) and virtual(5) for the effects this has on
+# aliases, canonical, virtual, relocated and .forward file lookups.
+# Basically, the software tries user+foo and .forward+foo before
+# trying user and .forward.
+#
+recipient_delimiter = +
+
+# DELIVERY TO MAILBOX
+#
+# The home_mailbox parameter specifies the optional pathname of a
+# mailbox file relative to a user's home directory. The default
+# mailbox file is /var/spool/mail/user or /var/mail/user. Specify
+# "Maildir/" for qmail-style delivery (the / is required).
+#
+#home_mailbox = Mailbox
+#home_mailbox = Maildir/
+
+# The mail_spool_directory parameter specifies the directory where
+# UNIX-style mailboxes are kept. The default setting depends on the
+# system type.
+#
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/mail
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/spool/mail
+
+# The mailbox_command parameter specifies the optional external
+# command to use instead of mailbox delivery. The command is run as
+# the recipient with proper HOME, SHELL and LOGNAME environment settings.
+# Exception: delivery for root is done as $default_user.
+#
+# Other environment variables of interest: USER (recipient username),
+# EXTENSION (address extension), DOMAIN (domain part of address),
+# and LOCAL (the address localpart).
+#
+# Unlike other Postfix configuration parameters, the mailbox_command
+# parameter is not subjected to $parameter substitutions. This is to
+# make it easier to specify shell syntax (see example below).
+#
+# Avoid shell meta characters because they will force Postfix to run
+# an expensive shell process. Procmail alone is expensive enough.
+#
+# IF YOU USE THIS TO DELIVER MAIL SYSTEM-WIDE, YOU MUST SET UP AN
+# ALIAS THAT FORWARDS MAIL FOR ROOT TO A REAL USER.
+#
+#mailbox_command = /usr/bin/procmail
+#mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail -a "$EXTENSION"
+
+# The mailbox_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use after processing aliases and .forward files. This parameter
+# has precedence over the mailbox_command, fallback_transport and
+# luser_relay parameters.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+
+# If using the cyrus-imapd IMAP server deliver local mail to the IMAP
+# server using LMTP (Local Mail Transport Protocol), this is prefered
+# over the older cyrus deliver program by setting the
+# mailbox_transport as below:
+#
+# mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#
+# The efficiency of LMTP delivery for cyrus-imapd can be enhanced via
+# these settings.
+#
+# local_destination_recipient_limit = 300
+# local_destination_concurrency_limit = 5
+#
+# Of course you should adjust these settings as appropriate for the
+# capacity of the hardware you are using. The recipient limit setting
+# can be used to take advantage of the single instance message store
+# capability of Cyrus. The concurrency limit can be used to control
+# how many simultaneous LMTP sessions will be permitted to the Cyrus
+# message store.
+#
+# To use the old cyrus deliver program you have to set:
+#mailbox_transport = cyrus
+
+# The fallback_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use for recipients that are not found in the UNIX passwd database.
+# This parameter has precedence over the luser_relay parameter.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#fallback_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#fallback_transport =
+
+#transport_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/transport
+# The luser_relay parameter specifies an optional destination address
+# for unknown recipients. By default, mail for unknown@$mydestination,
+# unknown@[$inet_interfaces] or unknown@[$proxy_interfaces] is returned
+# as undeliverable.
+#
+# The following expansions are done on luser_relay: $user (recipient
+# username), $shell (recipient shell), $home (recipient home directory),
+# $recipient (full recipient address), $extension (recipient address
+# extension), $domain (recipient domain), $local (entire recipient
+# localpart), $recipient_delimiter. Specify ${name?value} or
+# ${name:value} to expand value only when $name does (does not) exist.
+#
+# luser_relay works only for the default Postfix local delivery agent.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must specify "local_recipient_maps =" (i.e. empty) in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#luser_relay = $user@other.host
+#luser_relay = $local@other.host
+#luser_relay = admin+$local
+
+# JUNK MAIL CONTROLS
+#
+# The controls listed here are only a very small subset. The file
+# SMTPD_ACCESS_README provides an overview.
+
+# The header_checks parameter specifies an optional table with patterns
+# that each logical message header is matched against, including
+# headers that span multiple physical lines.
+#
+# By default, these patterns also apply to MIME headers and to the
+# headers of attached messages. With older Postfix versions, MIME and
+# attached message headers were treated as body text.
+#
+# For details, see "man header_checks".
+#
+header_checks = regexp:/etc/postfix/header_checks
+
+# FAST ETRN SERVICE
+#
+# Postfix maintains per-destination logfiles with information about
+# deferred mail, so that mail can be flushed quickly with the SMTP
+# "ETRN domain.tld" command, or by executing "sendmail -qRdomain.tld".
+# See the ETRN_README document for a detailed description.
+#
+# The fast_flush_domains parameter controls what destinations are
+# eligible for this service. By default, they are all domains that
+# this server is willing to relay mail to.
+#
+#fast_flush_domains = $relay_domains
+
+# SHOW SOFTWARE VERSION OR NOT
+#
+# The smtpd_banner parameter specifies the text that follows the 220
+# code in the SMTP server's greeting banner. Some people like to see
+# the mail version advertised. By default, Postfix shows no version.
+#
+# You MUST specify $myhostname at the start of the text. That is an
+# RFC requirement. Postfix itself does not care.
+#
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name ($mail_version)
+
+# PARALLEL DELIVERY TO THE SAME DESTINATION
+#
+# How many parallel deliveries to the same user or domain? With local
+# delivery, it does not make sense to do massively parallel delivery
+# to the same user, because mailbox updates must happen sequentially,
+# and expensive pipelines in .forward files can cause disasters when
+# too many are run at the same time. With SMTP deliveries, 10
+# simultaneous connections to the same domain could be sufficient to
+# raise eyebrows.
+#
+# Each message delivery transport has its XXX_destination_concurrency_limit
+# parameter. The default is $default_destination_concurrency_limit for
+# most delivery transports. For the local delivery agent the default is 2.
+
+#local_destination_concurrency_limit = 2
+#default_destination_concurrency_limit = 20
+
+# DEBUGGING CONTROL
+#
+# The debug_peer_level parameter specifies the increment in verbose
+# logging level when an SMTP client or server host name or address
+# matches a pattern in the debug_peer_list parameter.
+#
+debug_peer_level = 2
+
+# The debug_peer_list parameter specifies an optional list of domain
+# or network patterns, /file/name patterns or type:name tables. When
+# an SMTP client or server host name or address matches a pattern,
+# increase the verbose logging level by the amount specified in the
+# debug_peer_level parameter.
+#
+#debug_peer_list = 127.0.0.1
+#debug_peer_list = some.domain
+
+# The debugger_command specifies the external command that is executed
+# when a Postfix daemon program is run with the -D option.
+#
+# Use "command .. & sleep 5" so that the debugger can attach before
+# the process marches on. If you use an X-based debugger, be sure to
+# set up your XAUTHORITY environment variable before starting Postfix.
+#
+debugger_command =
+ PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin:/usr/X11R6/bin
+ xxgdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id & sleep 5
+
+# If you can't use X, use this to capture the call stack when a
+# daemon crashes. The result is in a file in the configuration
+# directory, and is named after the process name and the process ID.
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin; export PATH; (echo cont;
+# echo where) | gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id 2>&1
+# >$config_directory/$process_name.$process_id.log & sleep 5
+#
+# Another possibility is to run gdb under a detached screen session.
+# To attach to the screen sesssion, su root and run "screen -r
+# <id_string>" where <id_string> uniquely matches one of the detached
+# sessions (from "screen -list").
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/sbin:/usr/sbin; export PATH; screen
+# -dmS $process_name gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name
+# $process_id & sleep 1
+
+# INSTALL-TIME CONFIGURATION INFORMATION
+#
+# The following parameters are used when installing a new Postfix version.
+#
+# sendmail_path: The full pathname of the Postfix sendmail command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible mail posting interface.
+#
+sendmail_path = /usr/sbin/sendmail.postfix
+
+# newaliases_path: The full pathname of the Postfix newaliases command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible command to build alias databases.
+#
+newaliases_path = /usr/bin/newaliases.postfix
+
+# mailq_path: The full pathname of the Postfix mailq command. This
+# is the Sendmail-compatible mail queue listing command.
+#
+mailq_path = /usr/bin/mailq.postfix
+
+# setgid_group: The group for mail submission and queue management
+# commands. This must be a group name with a numerical group ID that
+# is not shared with other accounts, not even with the Postfix account.
+#
+setgid_group = postdrop
+
+# html_directory: The location of the Postfix HTML documentation.
+#
+html_directory = no
+
+# manpage_directory: The location of the Postfix on-line manual pages.
+#
+manpage_directory = /usr/share/man
+
+# sample_directory: The location of the Postfix sample configuration files.
+# This parameter is obsolete as of Postfix 2.1.
+#
+sample_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/samples
+
+# readme_directory: The location of the Postfix README files.
+#
+readme_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/README_FILES
+
+# add this to new postfix to get it to add proper message-id and other
+# headers to outgoing emails via the gateway.
+
+
+message_size_limit = 20971520
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.hosted04.fedoraproject.org b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.hosted04.fedoraproject.org
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..740a9358c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.hosted04.fedoraproject.org
@@ -0,0 +1,687 @@
+# "false"
+# Global Postfix configuration file. This file lists only a subset
+# of all parameters. For the syntax, and for a complete parameter
+# list, see the postconf(5) manual page (command: "man 5 postconf").
+#
+# For common configuration examples, see BASIC_CONFIGURATION_README
+# and STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README. To find these documents, use
+# the command "postconf html_directory readme_directory", or go to
+# http://www.postfix.org/.
+#
+# For best results, change no more than 2-3 parameters at a time,
+# and test if Postfix still works after every change.
+
+# SOFT BOUNCE
+#
+# The soft_bounce parameter provides a limited safety net for
+# testing. When soft_bounce is enabled, mail will remain queued that
+# would otherwise bounce. This parameter disables locally-generated
+# bounces, and prevents the SMTP server from rejecting mail permanently
+# (by changing 5xx replies into 4xx replies). However, soft_bounce
+# is no cure for address rewriting mistakes or mail routing mistakes.
+#
+#soft_bounce = no
+
+# LOCAL PATHNAME INFORMATION
+#
+# The queue_directory specifies the location of the Postfix queue.
+# This is also the root directory of Postfix daemons that run chrooted.
+# See the files in examples/chroot-setup for setting up Postfix chroot
+# environments on different UNIX systems.
+#
+queue_directory = /var/spool/postfix
+
+# The command_directory parameter specifies the location of all
+# postXXX commands.
+#
+command_directory = /usr/sbin
+
+# The daemon_directory parameter specifies the location of all Postfix
+# daemon programs (i.e. programs listed in the master.cf file). This
+# directory must be owned by root.
+#
+daemon_directory = /usr/libexec/postfix
+
+# QUEUE AND PROCESS OWNERSHIP
+#
+# The mail_owner parameter specifies the owner of the Postfix queue
+# and of most Postfix daemon processes. Specify the name of a user
+# account THAT DOES NOT SHARE ITS USER OR GROUP ID WITH OTHER ACCOUNTS
+# AND THAT OWNS NO OTHER FILES OR PROCESSES ON THE SYSTEM. In
+# particular, don't specify nobody or daemon. PLEASE USE A DEDICATED
+# USER.
+#
+mail_owner = postfix
+
+# The default_privs parameter specifies the default rights used by
+# the local delivery agent for delivery to external file or command.
+# These rights are used in the absence of a recipient user context.
+# DO NOT SPECIFY A PRIVILEGED USER OR THE POSTFIX OWNER.
+#
+#default_privs = nobody
+
+# INTERNET HOST AND DOMAIN NAMES
+#
+# The myhostname parameter specifies the internet hostname of this
+# mail system. The default is to use the fully-qualified domain name
+# from gethostname(). $myhostname is used as a default value for many
+# other configuration parameters.
+#
+#myhostname = host.domain.tld
+#myhostname = virtual.domain.tld
+
+# The mydomain parameter specifies the local internet domain name.
+# The default is to use $myhostname minus the first component.
+# $mydomain is used as a default value for many other configuration
+# parameters.
+#
+#mydomain = domain.tld
+
+# SENDING MAIL
+#
+# The myorigin parameter specifies the domain that locally-posted
+# mail appears to come from. The default is to append $myhostname,
+# which is fine for small sites. If you run a domain with multiple
+# machines, you should (1) change this to $mydomain and (2) set up
+# a domain-wide alias database that aliases each user to
+# user@that.users.mailhost.
+#
+# For the sake of consistency between sender and recipient addresses,
+# myorigin also specifies the default domain name that is appended
+# to recipient addresses that have no @domain part.
+#
+#myorigin = $myhostname
+#myorigin = $mydomain
+
+myhostname = fedorahosted.org
+myorigin = fedoraproject.org
+
+# RECEIVING MAIL
+
+# The inet_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on. By default,
+# the software claims all active interfaces on the machine. The
+# parameter also controls delivery of mail to user@[ip.address].
+#
+# See also the proxy_interfaces parameter, for network addresses that
+# are forwarded to us via a proxy or network address translator.
+#
+# Note: you need to stop/start Postfix when this parameter changes.
+#
+#inet_interfaces = all
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname, localhost
+inet_interfaces = all
+
+# The proxy_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on by way of a
+# proxy or network address translation unit. This setting extends
+# the address list specified with the inet_interfaces parameter.
+#
+# You must specify your proxy/NAT addresses when your system is a
+# backup MX host for other domains, otherwise mail delivery loops
+# will happen when the primary MX host is down.
+#
+#proxy_interfaces =
+#proxy_interfaces = 1.2.3.4
+
+# The mydestination parameter specifies the list of domains that this
+# machine considers itself the final destination for.
+#
+# These domains are routed to the delivery agent specified with the
+# local_transport parameter setting. By default, that is the UNIX
+# compatible delivery agent that lookups all recipients in /etc/passwd
+# and /etc/aliases or their equivalent.
+#
+# The default is $myhostname + localhost.$mydomain. On a mail domain
+# gateway, you should also include $mydomain.
+#
+# Do not specify the names of virtual domains - those domains are
+# specified elsewhere (see VIRTUAL_README).
+#
+# Do not specify the names of domains that this machine is backup MX
+# host for. Specify those names via the relay_domains settings for
+# the SMTP server, or use permit_mx_backup if you are lazy (see
+# STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README).
+#
+# The local machine is always the final destination for mail addressed
+# to user@[the.net.work.address] of an interface that the mail system
+# receives mail on (see the inet_interfaces parameter).
+#
+# Specify a list of host or domain names, /file/name or type:table
+# patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. A /file/name
+# pattern is replaced by its contents; a type:table is matched when
+# a name matches a lookup key (the right-hand side is ignored).
+# Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.
+#
+# See also below, section "REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS".
+#
+mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, fedora.redhat.com, localhost, fedorahosted.org
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain,
+# mail.$mydomain, www.$mydomain, ftp.$mydomain
+
+# REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS
+#
+# The local_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all names or addresses of users that are local with respect
+# to $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown local users. This parameter is defined by default.
+#
+# To turn off local recipient checking in the SMTP server, specify
+# local_recipient_maps = (i.e. empty).
+#
+# The default setting assumes that you use the default Postfix local
+# delivery agent for local delivery. You need to update the
+# local_recipient_maps setting if:
+#
+# - You define $mydestination domain recipients in files other than
+# /etc/passwd, /etc/aliases, or the $virtual_alias_maps files.
+# For example, you define $mydestination domain recipients in
+# the $virtual_mailbox_maps files.
+#
+# - You redefine the local delivery agent in master.cf.
+#
+# - You redefine the "local_transport" setting in main.cf.
+#
+# - You use the "luser_relay", "mailbox_transport", or "fallback_transport"
+# feature of the Postfix local delivery agent (see local(8)).
+#
+# Details are described in the LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README file.
+#
+# Beware: if the Postfix SMTP server runs chrooted, you probably have
+# to access the passwd file via the proxymap service, in order to
+# overcome chroot restrictions. The alternative, having a copy of
+# the system passwd file in the chroot jail is just not practical.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify a bare username, an @domain.tld
+# wild-card, or specify a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+local_recipient_maps = $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps = unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps = proxy:unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps =
+
+# The unknown_local_recipient_reject_code specifies the SMTP server
+# response code when a recipient domain matches $mydestination or
+# ${proxy,inet}_interfaces, while $local_recipient_maps is non-empty
+# and the recipient address or address local-part is not found.
+#
+# The default setting is 550 (reject mail) but it is safer to start
+# with 450 (try again later) until you are certain that your
+# local_recipient_maps settings are OK.
+#
+unknown_local_recipient_reject_code = 550
+
+# TRUST AND RELAY CONTROL
+
+# The mynetworks parameter specifies the list of "trusted" SMTP
+# clients that have more privileges than "strangers".
+#
+# In particular, "trusted" SMTP clients are allowed to relay mail
+# through Postfix. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions parameter
+# in postconf(5).
+#
+# You can specify the list of "trusted" network addresses by hand
+# or you can let Postfix do it for you (which is the default).
+#
+# By default (mynetworks_style = subnet), Postfix "trusts" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP subnetworks as the local machine.
+# On Linux, this does works correctly only with interfaces specified
+# with the "ifconfig" command.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = class" when Postfix should "trust" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP class A/B/C networks as the local machine.
+# Don't do this with a dialup site - it would cause Postfix to "trust"
+# your entire provider's network. Instead, specify an explicit
+# mynetworks list by hand, as described below.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = host" when Postfix should "trust"
+# only the local machine.
+#
+#mynetworks_style = class
+#mynetworks_style = subnet
+#mynetworks_style = host
+
+# Alternatively, you can specify the mynetworks list by hand, in
+# which case Postfix ignores the mynetworks_style setting.
+#
+# Specify an explicit list of network/netmask patterns, where the
+# mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host
+# address.
+#
+# You can also specify the absolute pathname of a pattern file instead
+# of listing the patterns here. Specify type:table for table-based lookups
+# (the value on the table right-hand side is not used).
+#
+#mynetworks = 168.100.189.0/28, 127.0.0.0/8
+#mynetworks = $config_directory/mynetworks
+#mynetworks = hash:/etc/postfix/network_table
+
+
+# The relay_domains parameter restricts what destinations this system will
+# relay mail to. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions description in
+# postconf(5) for detailed information.
+#
+# By default, Postfix relays mail
+# - from "trusted" clients (IP address matches $mynetworks) to any destination,
+# - from "untrusted" clients to destinations that match $relay_domains or
+# subdomains thereof, except addresses with sender-specified routing.
+# The default relay_domains value is $mydestination.
+#
+# In addition to the above, the Postfix SMTP server by default accepts mail
+# that Postfix is final destination for:
+# - destinations that match $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces,
+# - destinations that match $mydestination
+# - destinations that match $virtual_alias_domains,
+# - destinations that match $virtual_mailbox_domains.
+# These destinations do not need to be listed in $relay_domains.
+#
+# Specify a list of hosts or domains, /file/name patterns or type:name
+# lookup tables, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue
+# long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. A file name
+# is replaced by its contents; a type:name table is matched when a
+# (parent) domain appears as lookup key.
+#
+# NOTE: Postfix will not automatically forward mail for domains that
+# list this system as their primary or backup MX host. See the
+# permit_mx_backup restriction description in postconf(5).
+#
+#relay_domains = $mydestination
+
+
+
+# INTERNET OR INTRANET
+
+# The relayhost parameter specifies the default host to send mail to
+# when no entry is matched in the optional transport(5) table. When
+# no relayhost is given, mail is routed directly to the destination.
+#
+# On an intranet, specify the organizational domain name. If your
+# internal DNS uses no MX records, specify the name of the intranet
+# gateway host instead.
+#
+# In the case of SMTP, specify a domain, host, host:port, [host]:port,
+# [address] or [address]:port; the form [host] turns off MX lookups.
+#
+# If you're connected via UUCP, see also the default_transport parameter.
+#
+#relayhost = $mydomain
+#relayhost = [gateway.my.domain]
+#relayhost = [mailserver.isp.tld]
+#relayhost = uucphost
+#relayhost = [an.ip.add.ress]
+relayhost = bastion
+
+
+# REJECTING UNKNOWN RELAY USERS
+#
+# The relay_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all addresses in the domains that match $relay_domains.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown relay users. This feature is off by default.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify an @domain.tld wild-card, or specify
+# a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#relay_recipient_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_recipients
+
+# INPUT RATE CONTROL
+#
+# The in_flow_delay configuration parameter implements mail input
+# flow control. This feature is turned on by default, although it
+# still needs further development (it's disabled on SCO UNIX due
+# to an SCO bug).
+#
+# A Postfix process will pause for $in_flow_delay seconds before
+# accepting a new message, when the message arrival rate exceeds the
+# message delivery rate. With the default 100 SMTP server process
+# limit, this limits the mail inflow to 100 messages a second more
+# than the number of messages delivered per second.
+#
+# Specify 0 to disable the feature. Valid delays are 0..10.
+#
+#in_flow_delay = 1s
+
+# ADDRESS REWRITING
+#
+# The ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document gives information about
+# address masquerading or other forms of address rewriting including
+# username->Firstname.Lastname mapping.
+
+masquerade_domains = redhat.com
+masquerade_exceptions = root apache
+
+# ADDRESS REDIRECTION (VIRTUAL DOMAIN)
+#
+# The VIRTUAL_README document gives information about the many forms
+# of domain hosting that Postfix supports.
+
+# "USER HAS MOVED" BOUNCE MESSAGES
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# TRANSPORT MAP
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# ALIAS DATABASE
+#
+# The alias_maps parameter specifies the list of alias databases used
+# by the local delivery agent. The default list is system dependent.
+#
+# On systems with NIS, the default is to search the local alias
+# database, then the NIS alias database. See aliases(5) for syntax
+# details.
+#
+# If you change the alias database, run "postalias /etc/aliases" (or
+# wherever your system stores the mail alias file), or simply run
+# "newaliases" to build the necessary DBM or DB file.
+#
+# It will take a minute or so before changes become visible. Use
+# "postfix reload" to eliminate the delay.
+#
+#alias_maps = dbm:/etc/aliases
+alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, nis:mail.aliases
+#alias_maps = netinfo:/aliases
+
+# The alias_database parameter specifies the alias database(s) that
+# are built with "newaliases" or "sendmail -bi". This is a separate
+# configuration parameter, because alias_maps (see above) may specify
+# tables that are not necessarily all under control by Postfix.
+#
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/mail/aliases
+alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases, hash:/opt/majordomo/aliases
+
+# ADDRESS EXTENSIONS (e.g., user+foo)
+#
+# The recipient_delimiter parameter specifies the separator between
+# user names and address extensions (user+foo). See canonical(5),
+# local(8), relocated(5) and virtual(5) for the effects this has on
+# aliases, canonical, virtual, relocated and .forward file lookups.
+# Basically, the software tries user+foo and .forward+foo before
+# trying user and .forward.
+#
+recipient_delimiter = +
+
+# DELIVERY TO MAILBOX
+#
+# The home_mailbox parameter specifies the optional pathname of a
+# mailbox file relative to a user's home directory. The default
+# mailbox file is /var/spool/mail/user or /var/mail/user. Specify
+# "Maildir/" for qmail-style delivery (the / is required).
+#
+#home_mailbox = Mailbox
+#home_mailbox = Maildir/
+
+# The mail_spool_directory parameter specifies the directory where
+# UNIX-style mailboxes are kept. The default setting depends on the
+# system type.
+#
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/mail
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/spool/mail
+
+# The mailbox_command parameter specifies the optional external
+# command to use instead of mailbox delivery. The command is run as
+# the recipient with proper HOME, SHELL and LOGNAME environment settings.
+# Exception: delivery for root is done as $default_user.
+#
+# Other environment variables of interest: USER (recipient username),
+# EXTENSION (address extension), DOMAIN (domain part of address),
+# and LOCAL (the address localpart).
+#
+# Unlike other Postfix configuration parameters, the mailbox_command
+# parameter is not subjected to $parameter substitutions. This is to
+# make it easier to specify shell syntax (see example below).
+#
+# Avoid shell meta characters because they will force Postfix to run
+# an expensive shell process. Procmail alone is expensive enough.
+#
+# IF YOU USE THIS TO DELIVER MAIL SYSTEM-WIDE, YOU MUST SET UP AN
+# ALIAS THAT FORWARDS MAIL FOR ROOT TO A REAL USER.
+#
+#mailbox_command = /usr/bin/procmail
+#mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail -a "$EXTENSION"
+
+# The mailbox_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use after processing aliases and .forward files. This parameter
+# has precedence over the mailbox_command, fallback_transport and
+# luser_relay parameters.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+
+# If using the cyrus-imapd IMAP server deliver local mail to the IMAP
+# server using LMTP (Local Mail Transport Protocol), this is prefered
+# over the older cyrus deliver program by setting the
+# mailbox_transport as below:
+#
+# mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#
+# The efficiency of LMTP delivery for cyrus-imapd can be enhanced via
+# these settings.
+#
+# local_destination_recipient_limit = 300
+# local_destination_concurrency_limit = 5
+#
+# Of course you should adjust these settings as appropriate for the
+# capacity of the hardware you are using. The recipient limit setting
+# can be used to take advantage of the single instance message store
+# capability of Cyrus. The concurrency limit can be used to control
+# how many simultaneous LMTP sessions will be permitted to the Cyrus
+# message store.
+#
+# To use the old cyrus deliver program you have to set:
+#mailbox_transport = cyrus
+
+# The fallback_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use for recipients that are not found in the UNIX passwd database.
+# This parameter has precedence over the luser_relay parameter.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#fallback_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#fallback_transport =
+
+#transport_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/transport
+# The luser_relay parameter specifies an optional destination address
+# for unknown recipients. By default, mail for unknown@$mydestination,
+# unknown@[$inet_interfaces] or unknown@[$proxy_interfaces] is returned
+# as undeliverable.
+#
+# The following expansions are done on luser_relay: $user (recipient
+# username), $shell (recipient shell), $home (recipient home directory),
+# $recipient (full recipient address), $extension (recipient address
+# extension), $domain (recipient domain), $local (entire recipient
+# localpart), $recipient_delimiter. Specify ${name?value} or
+# ${name:value} to expand value only when $name does (does not) exist.
+#
+# luser_relay works only for the default Postfix local delivery agent.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must specify "local_recipient_maps =" (i.e. empty) in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#luser_relay = $user@other.host
+#luser_relay = $local@other.host
+#luser_relay = admin+$local
+
+# JUNK MAIL CONTROLS
+#
+# The controls listed here are only a very small subset. The file
+# SMTPD_ACCESS_README provides an overview.
+
+# The header_checks parameter specifies an optional table with patterns
+# that each logical message header is matched against, including
+# headers that span multiple physical lines.
+#
+# By default, these patterns also apply to MIME headers and to the
+# headers of attached messages. With older Postfix versions, MIME and
+# attached message headers were treated as body text.
+#
+# For details, see "man header_checks".
+#
+header_checks = regexp:/etc/postfix/header_checks
+
+# FAST ETRN SERVICE
+#
+# Postfix maintains per-destination logfiles with information about
+# deferred mail, so that mail can be flushed quickly with the SMTP
+# "ETRN domain.tld" command, or by executing "sendmail -qRdomain.tld".
+# See the ETRN_README document for a detailed description.
+#
+# The fast_flush_domains parameter controls what destinations are
+# eligible for this service. By default, they are all domains that
+# this server is willing to relay mail to.
+#
+#fast_flush_domains = $relay_domains
+
+# SHOW SOFTWARE VERSION OR NOT
+#
+# The smtpd_banner parameter specifies the text that follows the 220
+# code in the SMTP server's greeting banner. Some people like to see
+# the mail version advertised. By default, Postfix shows no version.
+#
+# You MUST specify $myhostname at the start of the text. That is an
+# RFC requirement. Postfix itself does not care.
+#
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name ($mail_version)
+
+# PARALLEL DELIVERY TO THE SAME DESTINATION
+#
+# How many parallel deliveries to the same user or domain? With local
+# delivery, it does not make sense to do massively parallel delivery
+# to the same user, because mailbox updates must happen sequentially,
+# and expensive pipelines in .forward files can cause disasters when
+# too many are run at the same time. With SMTP deliveries, 10
+# simultaneous connections to the same domain could be sufficient to
+# raise eyebrows.
+#
+# Each message delivery transport has its XXX_destination_concurrency_limit
+# parameter. The default is $default_destination_concurrency_limit for
+# most delivery transports. For the local delivery agent the default is 2.
+
+#local_destination_concurrency_limit = 2
+#default_destination_concurrency_limit = 20
+
+# DEBUGGING CONTROL
+#
+# The debug_peer_level parameter specifies the increment in verbose
+# logging level when an SMTP client or server host name or address
+# matches a pattern in the debug_peer_list parameter.
+#
+debug_peer_level = 2
+
+# The debug_peer_list parameter specifies an optional list of domain
+# or network patterns, /file/name patterns or type:name tables. When
+# an SMTP client or server host name or address matches a pattern,
+# increase the verbose logging level by the amount specified in the
+# debug_peer_level parameter.
+#
+#debug_peer_list = 127.0.0.1
+#debug_peer_list = some.domain
+
+# The debugger_command specifies the external command that is executed
+# when a Postfix daemon program is run with the -D option.
+#
+# Use "command .. & sleep 5" so that the debugger can attach before
+# the process marches on. If you use an X-based debugger, be sure to
+# set up your XAUTHORITY environment variable before starting Postfix.
+#
+debugger_command =
+ PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin:/usr/X11R6/bin
+ xxgdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id & sleep 5
+
+# If you can't use X, use this to capture the call stack when a
+# daemon crashes. The result is in a file in the configuration
+# directory, and is named after the process name and the process ID.
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin; export PATH; (echo cont;
+# echo where) | gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id 2>&1
+# >$config_directory/$process_name.$process_id.log & sleep 5
+#
+# Another possibility is to run gdb under a detached screen session.
+# To attach to the screen sesssion, su root and run "screen -r
+# <id_string>" where <id_string> uniquely matches one of the detached
+# sessions (from "screen -list").
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/sbin:/usr/sbin; export PATH; screen
+# -dmS $process_name gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name
+# $process_id & sleep 1
+
+# INSTALL-TIME CONFIGURATION INFORMATION
+#
+# The following parameters are used when installing a new Postfix version.
+#
+# sendmail_path: The full pathname of the Postfix sendmail command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible mail posting interface.
+#
+sendmail_path = /usr/sbin/sendmail.postfix
+
+# newaliases_path: The full pathname of the Postfix newaliases command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible command to build alias databases.
+#
+newaliases_path = /usr/bin/newaliases.postfix
+
+# mailq_path: The full pathname of the Postfix mailq command. This
+# is the Sendmail-compatible mail queue listing command.
+#
+mailq_path = /usr/bin/mailq.postfix
+
+# setgid_group: The group for mail submission and queue management
+# commands. This must be a group name with a numerical group ID that
+# is not shared with other accounts, not even with the Postfix account.
+#
+setgid_group = postdrop
+
+# html_directory: The location of the Postfix HTML documentation.
+#
+html_directory = no
+
+# manpage_directory: The location of the Postfix on-line manual pages.
+#
+manpage_directory = /usr/share/man
+
+# sample_directory: The location of the Postfix sample configuration files.
+# This parameter is obsolete as of Postfix 2.1.
+#
+sample_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/samples
+
+# readme_directory: The location of the Postfix README files.
+#
+readme_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/README_FILES
+
+# add this to new postfix to get it to add proper message-id and other
+# headers to outgoing emails via the gateway.
+
+
+message_size_limit = 20971520
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.jenkins.fedorainfracloud.org b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.jenkins.fedorainfracloud.org
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..293c0c165
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.jenkins.fedorainfracloud.org
@@ -0,0 +1,687 @@
+# "false"
+# Global Postfix configuration file. This file lists only a subset
+# of all parameters. For the syntax, and for a complete parameter
+# list, see the postconf(5) manual page (command: "man 5 postconf").
+#
+# For common configuration examples, see BASIC_CONFIGURATION_README
+# and STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README. To find these documents, use
+# the command "postconf html_directory readme_directory", or go to
+# http://www.postfix.org/.
+#
+# For best results, change no more than 2-3 parameters at a time,
+# and test if Postfix still works after every change.
+
+# SOFT BOUNCE
+#
+# The soft_bounce parameter provides a limited safety net for
+# testing. When soft_bounce is enabled, mail will remain queued that
+# would otherwise bounce. This parameter disables locally-generated
+# bounces, and prevents the SMTP server from rejecting mail permanently
+# (by changing 5xx replies into 4xx replies). However, soft_bounce
+# is no cure for address rewriting mistakes or mail routing mistakes.
+#
+#soft_bounce = no
+
+# LOCAL PATHNAME INFORMATION
+#
+# The queue_directory specifies the location of the Postfix queue.
+# This is also the root directory of Postfix daemons that run chrooted.
+# See the files in examples/chroot-setup for setting up Postfix chroot
+# environments on different UNIX systems.
+#
+queue_directory = /var/spool/postfix
+
+# The command_directory parameter specifies the location of all
+# postXXX commands.
+#
+command_directory = /usr/sbin
+
+# The daemon_directory parameter specifies the location of all Postfix
+# daemon programs (i.e. programs listed in the master.cf file). This
+# directory must be owned by root.
+#
+daemon_directory = /usr/libexec/postfix
+
+# QUEUE AND PROCESS OWNERSHIP
+#
+# The mail_owner parameter specifies the owner of the Postfix queue
+# and of most Postfix daemon processes. Specify the name of a user
+# account THAT DOES NOT SHARE ITS USER OR GROUP ID WITH OTHER ACCOUNTS
+# AND THAT OWNS NO OTHER FILES OR PROCESSES ON THE SYSTEM. In
+# particular, don't specify nobody or daemon. PLEASE USE A DEDICATED
+# USER.
+#
+mail_owner = postfix
+
+# The default_privs parameter specifies the default rights used by
+# the local delivery agent for delivery to external file or command.
+# These rights are used in the absence of a recipient user context.
+# DO NOT SPECIFY A PRIVILEGED USER OR THE POSTFIX OWNER.
+#
+#default_privs = nobody
+
+# INTERNET HOST AND DOMAIN NAMES
+#
+# The myhostname parameter specifies the internet hostname of this
+# mail system. The default is to use the fully-qualified domain name
+# from gethostname(). $myhostname is used as a default value for many
+# other configuration parameters.
+#
+#myhostname = host.domain.tld
+#myhostname = virtual.domain.tld
+
+# The mydomain parameter specifies the local internet domain name.
+# The default is to use $myhostname minus the first component.
+# $mydomain is used as a default value for many other configuration
+# parameters.
+#
+#mydomain = domain.tld
+
+# SENDING MAIL
+#
+# The myorigin parameter specifies the domain that locally-posted
+# mail appears to come from. The default is to append $myhostname,
+# which is fine for small sites. If you run a domain with multiple
+# machines, you should (1) change this to $mydomain and (2) set up
+# a domain-wide alias database that aliases each user to
+# user@that.users.mailhost.
+#
+# For the sake of consistency between sender and recipient addresses,
+# myorigin also specifies the default domain name that is appended
+# to recipient addresses that have no @domain part.
+#
+#myorigin = $myhostname
+#myorigin = $mydomain
+
+mydomain = fedoraproject.org
+myorigin = fedoraproject.org
+
+# RECEIVING MAIL
+
+# The inet_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on. By default,
+# the software claims all active interfaces on the machine. The
+# parameter also controls delivery of mail to user@[ip.address].
+#
+# See also the proxy_interfaces parameter, for network addresses that
+# are forwarded to us via a proxy or network address translator.
+#
+# Note: you need to stop/start Postfix when this parameter changes.
+#
+#inet_interfaces = all
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname, localhost
+inet_interfaces = all
+
+# The proxy_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on by way of a
+# proxy or network address translation unit. This setting extends
+# the address list specified with the inet_interfaces parameter.
+#
+# You must specify your proxy/NAT addresses when your system is a
+# backup MX host for other domains, otherwise mail delivery loops
+# will happen when the primary MX host is down.
+#
+#proxy_interfaces =
+#proxy_interfaces = 1.2.3.4
+
+# The mydestination parameter specifies the list of domains that this
+# machine considers itself the final destination for.
+#
+# These domains are routed to the delivery agent specified with the
+# local_transport parameter setting. By default, that is the UNIX
+# compatible delivery agent that lookups all recipients in /etc/passwd
+# and /etc/aliases or their equivalent.
+#
+# The default is $myhostname + localhost.$mydomain. On a mail domain
+# gateway, you should also include $mydomain.
+#
+# Do not specify the names of virtual domains - those domains are
+# specified elsewhere (see VIRTUAL_README).
+#
+# Do not specify the names of domains that this machine is backup MX
+# host for. Specify those names via the relay_domains settings for
+# the SMTP server, or use permit_mx_backup if you are lazy (see
+# STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README).
+#
+# The local machine is always the final destination for mail addressed
+# to user@[the.net.work.address] of an interface that the mail system
+# receives mail on (see the inet_interfaces parameter).
+#
+# Specify a list of host or domain names, /file/name or type:table
+# patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. A /file/name
+# pattern is replaced by its contents; a type:table is matched when
+# a name matches a lookup key (the right-hand side is ignored).
+# Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.
+#
+# See also below, section "REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS".
+#
+mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, fedora.redhat.com, localhost
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain,
+# mail.$mydomain, www.$mydomain, ftp.$mydomain
+
+# REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS
+#
+# The local_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all names or addresses of users that are local with respect
+# to $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown local users. This parameter is defined by default.
+#
+# To turn off local recipient checking in the SMTP server, specify
+# local_recipient_maps = (i.e. empty).
+#
+# The default setting assumes that you use the default Postfix local
+# delivery agent for local delivery. You need to update the
+# local_recipient_maps setting if:
+#
+# - You define $mydestination domain recipients in files other than
+# /etc/passwd, /etc/aliases, or the $virtual_alias_maps files.
+# For example, you define $mydestination domain recipients in
+# the $virtual_mailbox_maps files.
+#
+# - You redefine the local delivery agent in master.cf.
+#
+# - You redefine the "local_transport" setting in main.cf.
+#
+# - You use the "luser_relay", "mailbox_transport", or "fallback_transport"
+# feature of the Postfix local delivery agent (see local(8)).
+#
+# Details are described in the LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README file.
+#
+# Beware: if the Postfix SMTP server runs chrooted, you probably have
+# to access the passwd file via the proxymap service, in order to
+# overcome chroot restrictions. The alternative, having a copy of
+# the system passwd file in the chroot jail is just not practical.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify a bare username, an @domain.tld
+# wild-card, or specify a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#local_recipient_maps = unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps = proxy:unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps =
+
+# The unknown_local_recipient_reject_code specifies the SMTP server
+# response code when a recipient domain matches $mydestination or
+# ${proxy,inet}_interfaces, while $local_recipient_maps is non-empty
+# and the recipient address or address local-part is not found.
+#
+# The default setting is 550 (reject mail) but it is safer to start
+# with 450 (try again later) until you are certain that your
+# local_recipient_maps settings are OK.
+#
+unknown_local_recipient_reject_code = 550
+
+# TRUST AND RELAY CONTROL
+
+# The mynetworks parameter specifies the list of "trusted" SMTP
+# clients that have more privileges than "strangers".
+#
+# In particular, "trusted" SMTP clients are allowed to relay mail
+# through Postfix. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions parameter
+# in postconf(5).
+#
+# You can specify the list of "trusted" network addresses by hand
+# or you can let Postfix do it for you (which is the default).
+#
+# By default (mynetworks_style = subnet), Postfix "trusts" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP subnetworks as the local machine.
+# On Linux, this does works correctly only with interfaces specified
+# with the "ifconfig" command.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = class" when Postfix should "trust" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP class A/B/C networks as the local machine.
+# Don't do this with a dialup site - it would cause Postfix to "trust"
+# your entire provider's network. Instead, specify an explicit
+# mynetworks list by hand, as described below.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = host" when Postfix should "trust"
+# only the local machine.
+#
+#mynetworks_style = class
+#mynetworks_style = subnet
+#mynetworks_style = host
+
+# Alternatively, you can specify the mynetworks list by hand, in
+# which case Postfix ignores the mynetworks_style setting.
+#
+# Specify an explicit list of network/netmask patterns, where the
+# mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host
+# address.
+#
+# You can also specify the absolute pathname of a pattern file instead
+# of listing the patterns here. Specify type:table for table-based lookups
+# (the value on the table right-hand side is not used).
+#
+#mynetworks = 168.100.189.0/28, 127.0.0.0/8
+#mynetworks = $config_directory/mynetworks
+#mynetworks = hash:/etc/postfix/network_table
+
+
+# The relay_domains parameter restricts what destinations this system will
+# relay mail to. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions description in
+# postconf(5) for detailed information.
+#
+# By default, Postfix relays mail
+# - from "trusted" clients (IP address matches $mynetworks) to any destination,
+# - from "untrusted" clients to destinations that match $relay_domains or
+# subdomains thereof, except addresses with sender-specified routing.
+# The default relay_domains value is $mydestination.
+#
+# In addition to the above, the Postfix SMTP server by default accepts mail
+# that Postfix is final destination for:
+# - destinations that match $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces,
+# - destinations that match $mydestination
+# - destinations that match $virtual_alias_domains,
+# - destinations that match $virtual_mailbox_domains.
+# These destinations do not need to be listed in $relay_domains.
+#
+# Specify a list of hosts or domains, /file/name patterns or type:name
+# lookup tables, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue
+# long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. A file name
+# is replaced by its contents; a type:name table is matched when a
+# (parent) domain appears as lookup key.
+#
+# NOTE: Postfix will not automatically forward mail for domains that
+# list this system as their primary or backup MX host. See the
+# permit_mx_backup restriction description in postconf(5).
+#
+#relay_domains = $mydestination
+
+
+
+# INTERNET OR INTRANET
+
+# The relayhost parameter specifies the default host to send mail to
+# when no entry is matched in the optional transport(5) table. When
+# no relayhost is given, mail is routed directly to the destination.
+#
+# On an intranet, specify the organizational domain name. If your
+# internal DNS uses no MX records, specify the name of the intranet
+# gateway host instead.
+#
+# In the case of SMTP, specify a domain, host, host:port, [host]:port,
+# [address] or [address]:port; the form [host] turns off MX lookups.
+#
+# If you're connected via UUCP, see also the default_transport parameter.
+#
+#relayhost = $mydomain
+#relayhost = [gateway.my.domain]
+#relayhost = [mailserver.isp.tld]
+#relayhost = uucphost
+#relayhost = [an.ip.add.ress]
+#relayhost = bastion
+
+
+# REJECTING UNKNOWN RELAY USERS
+#
+# The relay_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all addresses in the domains that match $relay_domains.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown relay users. This feature is off by default.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify an @domain.tld wild-card, or specify
+# a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#relay_recipient_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_recipients
+
+# INPUT RATE CONTROL
+#
+# The in_flow_delay configuration parameter implements mail input
+# flow control. This feature is turned on by default, although it
+# still needs further development (it's disabled on SCO UNIX due
+# to an SCO bug).
+#
+# A Postfix process will pause for $in_flow_delay seconds before
+# accepting a new message, when the message arrival rate exceeds the
+# message delivery rate. With the default 100 SMTP server process
+# limit, this limits the mail inflow to 100 messages a second more
+# than the number of messages delivered per second.
+#
+# Specify 0 to disable the feature. Valid delays are 0..10.
+#
+#in_flow_delay = 1s
+
+# ADDRESS REWRITING
+#
+# The ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document gives information about
+# address masquerading or other forms of address rewriting including
+# username->Firstname.Lastname mapping.
+
+masquerade_domains = redhat.com
+masquerade_exceptions = root apache
+
+# ADDRESS REDIRECTION (VIRTUAL DOMAIN)
+#
+# The VIRTUAL_README document gives information about the many forms
+# of domain hosting that Postfix supports.
+
+# "USER HAS MOVED" BOUNCE MESSAGES
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# TRANSPORT MAP
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# ALIAS DATABASE
+#
+# The alias_maps parameter specifies the list of alias databases used
+# by the local delivery agent. The default list is system dependent.
+#
+# On systems with NIS, the default is to search the local alias
+# database, then the NIS alias database. See aliases(5) for syntax
+# details.
+#
+# If you change the alias database, run "postalias /etc/aliases" (or
+# wherever your system stores the mail alias file), or simply run
+# "newaliases" to build the necessary DBM or DB file.
+#
+# It will take a minute or so before changes become visible. Use
+# "postfix reload" to eliminate the delay.
+#
+#alias_maps = dbm:/etc/aliases
+alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, nis:mail.aliases
+#alias_maps = netinfo:/aliases
+
+# The alias_database parameter specifies the alias database(s) that
+# are built with "newaliases" or "sendmail -bi". This is a separate
+# configuration parameter, because alias_maps (see above) may specify
+# tables that are not necessarily all under control by Postfix.
+#
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/mail/aliases
+alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases, hash:/opt/majordomo/aliases
+
+# ADDRESS EXTENSIONS (e.g., user+foo)
+#
+# The recipient_delimiter parameter specifies the separator between
+# user names and address extensions (user+foo). See canonical(5),
+# local(8), relocated(5) and virtual(5) for the effects this has on
+# aliases, canonical, virtual, relocated and .forward file lookups.
+# Basically, the software tries user+foo and .forward+foo before
+# trying user and .forward.
+#
+recipient_delimiter = +
+
+# DELIVERY TO MAILBOX
+#
+# The home_mailbox parameter specifies the optional pathname of a
+# mailbox file relative to a user's home directory. The default
+# mailbox file is /var/spool/mail/user or /var/mail/user. Specify
+# "Maildir/" for qmail-style delivery (the / is required).
+#
+#home_mailbox = Mailbox
+#home_mailbox = Maildir/
+
+# The mail_spool_directory parameter specifies the directory where
+# UNIX-style mailboxes are kept. The default setting depends on the
+# system type.
+#
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/mail
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/spool/mail
+
+# The mailbox_command parameter specifies the optional external
+# command to use instead of mailbox delivery. The command is run as
+# the recipient with proper HOME, SHELL and LOGNAME environment settings.
+# Exception: delivery for root is done as $default_user.
+#
+# Other environment variables of interest: USER (recipient username),
+# EXTENSION (address extension), DOMAIN (domain part of address),
+# and LOCAL (the address localpart).
+#
+# Unlike other Postfix configuration parameters, the mailbox_command
+# parameter is not subjected to $parameter substitutions. This is to
+# make it easier to specify shell syntax (see example below).
+#
+# Avoid shell meta characters because they will force Postfix to run
+# an expensive shell process. Procmail alone is expensive enough.
+#
+# IF YOU USE THIS TO DELIVER MAIL SYSTEM-WIDE, YOU MUST SET UP AN
+# ALIAS THAT FORWARDS MAIL FOR ROOT TO A REAL USER.
+#
+#mailbox_command = /usr/bin/procmail
+#mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail -a "$EXTENSION"
+
+# The mailbox_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use after processing aliases and .forward files. This parameter
+# has precedence over the mailbox_command, fallback_transport and
+# luser_relay parameters.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+
+# If using the cyrus-imapd IMAP server deliver local mail to the IMAP
+# server using LMTP (Local Mail Transport Protocol), this is prefered
+# over the older cyrus deliver program by setting the
+# mailbox_transport as below:
+#
+# mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#
+# The efficiency of LMTP delivery for cyrus-imapd can be enhanced via
+# these settings.
+#
+# local_destination_recipient_limit = 300
+# local_destination_concurrency_limit = 5
+#
+# Of course you should adjust these settings as appropriate for the
+# capacity of the hardware you are using. The recipient limit setting
+# can be used to take advantage of the single instance message store
+# capability of Cyrus. The concurrency limit can be used to control
+# how many simultaneous LMTP sessions will be permitted to the Cyrus
+# message store.
+#
+# To use the old cyrus deliver program you have to set:
+#mailbox_transport = cyrus
+
+# The fallback_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use for recipients that are not found in the UNIX passwd database.
+# This parameter has precedence over the luser_relay parameter.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#fallback_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#fallback_transport =
+
+#transport_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/transport
+# The luser_relay parameter specifies an optional destination address
+# for unknown recipients. By default, mail for unknown@$mydestination,
+# unknown@[$inet_interfaces] or unknown@[$proxy_interfaces] is returned
+# as undeliverable.
+#
+# The following expansions are done on luser_relay: $user (recipient
+# username), $shell (recipient shell), $home (recipient home directory),
+# $recipient (full recipient address), $extension (recipient address
+# extension), $domain (recipient domain), $local (entire recipient
+# localpart), $recipient_delimiter. Specify ${name?value} or
+# ${name:value} to expand value only when $name does (does not) exist.
+#
+# luser_relay works only for the default Postfix local delivery agent.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must specify "local_recipient_maps =" (i.e. empty) in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#luser_relay = $user@other.host
+#luser_relay = $local@other.host
+#luser_relay = admin+$local
+
+# JUNK MAIL CONTROLS
+#
+# The controls listed here are only a very small subset. The file
+# SMTPD_ACCESS_README provides an overview.
+
+# The header_checks parameter specifies an optional table with patterns
+# that each logical message header is matched against, including
+# headers that span multiple physical lines.
+#
+# By default, these patterns also apply to MIME headers and to the
+# headers of attached messages. With older Postfix versions, MIME and
+# attached message headers were treated as body text.
+#
+# For details, see "man header_checks".
+#
+header_checks = regexp:/etc/postfix/header_checks
+
+# FAST ETRN SERVICE
+#
+# Postfix maintains per-destination logfiles with information about
+# deferred mail, so that mail can be flushed quickly with the SMTP
+# "ETRN domain.tld" command, or by executing "sendmail -qRdomain.tld".
+# See the ETRN_README document for a detailed description.
+#
+# The fast_flush_domains parameter controls what destinations are
+# eligible for this service. By default, they are all domains that
+# this server is willing to relay mail to.
+#
+#fast_flush_domains = $relay_domains
+
+# SHOW SOFTWARE VERSION OR NOT
+#
+# The smtpd_banner parameter specifies the text that follows the 220
+# code in the SMTP server's greeting banner. Some people like to see
+# the mail version advertised. By default, Postfix shows no version.
+#
+# You MUST specify $myhostname at the start of the text. That is an
+# RFC requirement. Postfix itself does not care.
+#
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name ($mail_version)
+
+# PARALLEL DELIVERY TO THE SAME DESTINATION
+#
+# How many parallel deliveries to the same user or domain? With local
+# delivery, it does not make sense to do massively parallel delivery
+# to the same user, because mailbox updates must happen sequentially,
+# and expensive pipelines in .forward files can cause disasters when
+# too many are run at the same time. With SMTP deliveries, 10
+# simultaneous connections to the same domain could be sufficient to
+# raise eyebrows.
+#
+# Each message delivery transport has its XXX_destination_concurrency_limit
+# parameter. The default is $default_destination_concurrency_limit for
+# most delivery transports. For the local delivery agent the default is 2.
+
+#local_destination_concurrency_limit = 2
+#default_destination_concurrency_limit = 20
+
+# DEBUGGING CONTROL
+#
+# The debug_peer_level parameter specifies the increment in verbose
+# logging level when an SMTP client or server host name or address
+# matches a pattern in the debug_peer_list parameter.
+#
+debug_peer_level = 2
+
+# The debug_peer_list parameter specifies an optional list of domain
+# or network patterns, /file/name patterns or type:name tables. When
+# an SMTP client or server host name or address matches a pattern,
+# increase the verbose logging level by the amount specified in the
+# debug_peer_level parameter.
+#
+#debug_peer_list = 127.0.0.1
+#debug_peer_list = some.domain
+
+# The debugger_command specifies the external command that is executed
+# when a Postfix daemon program is run with the -D option.
+#
+# Use "command .. & sleep 5" so that the debugger can attach before
+# the process marches on. If you use an X-based debugger, be sure to
+# set up your XAUTHORITY environment variable before starting Postfix.
+#
+debugger_command =
+ PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin:/usr/X11R6/bin
+ xxgdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id & sleep 5
+
+# If you can't use X, use this to capture the call stack when a
+# daemon crashes. The result is in a file in the configuration
+# directory, and is named after the process name and the process ID.
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin; export PATH; (echo cont;
+# echo where) | gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id 2>&1
+# >$config_directory/$process_name.$process_id.log & sleep 5
+#
+# Another possibility is to run gdb under a detached screen session.
+# To attach to the screen sesssion, su root and run "screen -r
+# <id_string>" where <id_string> uniquely matches one of the detached
+# sessions (from "screen -list").
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/sbin:/usr/sbin; export PATH; screen
+# -dmS $process_name gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name
+# $process_id & sleep 1
+
+# INSTALL-TIME CONFIGURATION INFORMATION
+#
+# The following parameters are used when installing a new Postfix version.
+#
+# sendmail_path: The full pathname of the Postfix sendmail command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible mail posting interface.
+#
+sendmail_path = /usr/sbin/sendmail.postfix
+
+# newaliases_path: The full pathname of the Postfix newaliases command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible command to build alias databases.
+#
+newaliases_path = /usr/bin/newaliases.postfix
+
+# mailq_path: The full pathname of the Postfix mailq command. This
+# is the Sendmail-compatible mail queue listing command.
+#
+mailq_path = /usr/bin/mailq.postfix
+
+# setgid_group: The group for mail submission and queue management
+# commands. This must be a group name with a numerical group ID that
+# is not shared with other accounts, not even with the Postfix account.
+#
+setgid_group = postdrop
+
+# html_directory: The location of the Postfix HTML documentation.
+#
+html_directory = no
+
+# manpage_directory: The location of the Postfix on-line manual pages.
+#
+manpage_directory = /usr/share/man
+
+# sample_directory: The location of the Postfix sample configuration files.
+# This parameter is obsolete as of Postfix 2.1.
+#
+sample_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/samples
+
+# readme_directory: The location of the Postfix README files.
+#
+readme_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/README_FILES
+
+# add this to new postfix to get it to add proper message-id and other
+# headers to outgoing emails via the gateway.
+
+
+message_size_limit = 20971520
+#inet_protocols = ipv4
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.kojibuilder b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.kojibuilder
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..9030d252b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.kojibuilder
@@ -0,0 +1,687 @@
+# "false"
+# Global Postfix configuration file. This file lists only a subset
+# of all parameters. For the syntax, and for a complete parameter
+# list, see the postconf(5) manual page (command: "man 5 postconf").
+#
+# For common configuration examples, see BASIC_CONFIGURATION_README
+# and STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README. To find these documents, use
+# the command "postconf html_directory readme_directory", or go to
+# http://www.postfix.org/.
+#
+# For best results, change no more than 2-3 parameters at a time,
+# and test if Postfix still works after every change.
+
+# SOFT BOUNCE
+#
+# The soft_bounce parameter provides a limited safety net for
+# testing. When soft_bounce is enabled, mail will remain queued that
+# would otherwise bounce. This parameter disables locally-generated
+# bounces, and prevents the SMTP server from rejecting mail permanently
+# (by changing 5xx replies into 4xx replies). However, soft_bounce
+# is no cure for address rewriting mistakes or mail routing mistakes.
+#
+#soft_bounce = no
+
+# LOCAL PATHNAME INFORMATION
+#
+# The queue_directory specifies the location of the Postfix queue.
+# This is also the root directory of Postfix daemons that run chrooted.
+# See the files in examples/chroot-setup for setting up Postfix chroot
+# environments on different UNIX systems.
+#
+queue_directory = /var/spool/postfix
+
+# The command_directory parameter specifies the location of all
+# postXXX commands.
+#
+command_directory = /usr/sbin
+
+# The daemon_directory parameter specifies the location of all Postfix
+# daemon programs (i.e. programs listed in the master.cf file). This
+# directory must be owned by root.
+#
+daemon_directory = /usr/libexec/postfix
+
+# QUEUE AND PROCESS OWNERSHIP
+#
+# The mail_owner parameter specifies the owner of the Postfix queue
+# and of most Postfix daemon processes. Specify the name of a user
+# account THAT DOES NOT SHARE ITS USER OR GROUP ID WITH OTHER ACCOUNTS
+# AND THAT OWNS NO OTHER FILES OR PROCESSES ON THE SYSTEM. In
+# particular, don't specify nobody or daemon. PLEASE USE A DEDICATED
+# USER.
+#
+mail_owner = postfix
+
+# The default_privs parameter specifies the default rights used by
+# the local delivery agent for delivery to external file or command.
+# These rights are used in the absence of a recipient user context.
+# DO NOT SPECIFY A PRIVILEGED USER OR THE POSTFIX OWNER.
+#
+#default_privs = nobody
+
+# INTERNET HOST AND DOMAIN NAMES
+#
+# The myhostname parameter specifies the internet hostname of this
+# mail system. The default is to use the fully-qualified domain name
+# from gethostname(). $myhostname is used as a default value for many
+# other configuration parameters.
+#
+#myhostname = host.domain.tld
+#myhostname = virtual.domain.tld
+
+# The mydomain parameter specifies the local internet domain name.
+# The default is to use $myhostname minus the first component.
+# $mydomain is used as a default value for many other configuration
+# parameters.
+#
+#mydomain = domain.tld
+
+# SENDING MAIL
+#
+# The myorigin parameter specifies the domain that locally-posted
+# mail appears to come from. The default is to append $myhostname,
+# which is fine for small sites. If you run a domain with multiple
+# machines, you should (1) change this to $mydomain and (2) set up
+# a domain-wide alias database that aliases each user to
+# user@that.users.mailhost.
+#
+# For the sake of consistency between sender and recipient addresses,
+# myorigin also specifies the default domain name that is appended
+# to recipient addresses that have no @domain part.
+#
+#myorigin = $myhostname
+#myorigin = $mydomain
+
+mydomain = fedoraproject.org
+myorigin = fedoraproject.org
+
+# RECEIVING MAIL
+
+# The inet_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on. By default,
+# the software claims all active interfaces on the machine. The
+# parameter also controls delivery of mail to user@[ip.address].
+#
+# See also the proxy_interfaces parameter, for network addresses that
+# are forwarded to us via a proxy or network address translator.
+#
+# Note: you need to stop/start Postfix when this parameter changes.
+#
+#inet_interfaces = all
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname, localhost
+inet_interfaces = all
+
+# The proxy_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on by way of a
+# proxy or network address translation unit. This setting extends
+# the address list specified with the inet_interfaces parameter.
+#
+# You must specify your proxy/NAT addresses when your system is a
+# backup MX host for other domains, otherwise mail delivery loops
+# will happen when the primary MX host is down.
+#
+#proxy_interfaces =
+#proxy_interfaces = 1.2.3.4
+
+# The mydestination parameter specifies the list of domains that this
+# machine considers itself the final destination for.
+#
+# These domains are routed to the delivery agent specified with the
+# local_transport parameter setting. By default, that is the UNIX
+# compatible delivery agent that lookups all recipients in /etc/passwd
+# and /etc/aliases or their equivalent.
+#
+# The default is $myhostname + localhost.$mydomain. On a mail domain
+# gateway, you should also include $mydomain.
+#
+# Do not specify the names of virtual domains - those domains are
+# specified elsewhere (see VIRTUAL_README).
+#
+# Do not specify the names of domains that this machine is backup MX
+# host for. Specify those names via the relay_domains settings for
+# the SMTP server, or use permit_mx_backup if you are lazy (see
+# STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README).
+#
+# The local machine is always the final destination for mail addressed
+# to user@[the.net.work.address] of an interface that the mail system
+# receives mail on (see the inet_interfaces parameter).
+#
+# Specify a list of host or domain names, /file/name or type:table
+# patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. A /file/name
+# pattern is replaced by its contents; a type:table is matched when
+# a name matches a lookup key (the right-hand side is ignored).
+# Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.
+#
+# See also below, section "REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS".
+#
+mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, fedora.redhat.com, localhost
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain,
+# mail.$mydomain, www.$mydomain, ftp.$mydomain
+
+# REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS
+#
+# The local_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all names or addresses of users that are local with respect
+# to $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown local users. This parameter is defined by default.
+#
+# To turn off local recipient checking in the SMTP server, specify
+# local_recipient_maps = (i.e. empty).
+#
+# The default setting assumes that you use the default Postfix local
+# delivery agent for local delivery. You need to update the
+# local_recipient_maps setting if:
+#
+# - You define $mydestination domain recipients in files other than
+# /etc/passwd, /etc/aliases, or the $virtual_alias_maps files.
+# For example, you define $mydestination domain recipients in
+# the $virtual_mailbox_maps files.
+#
+# - You redefine the local delivery agent in master.cf.
+#
+# - You redefine the "local_transport" setting in main.cf.
+#
+# - You use the "luser_relay", "mailbox_transport", or "fallback_transport"
+# feature of the Postfix local delivery agent (see local(8)).
+#
+# Details are described in the LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README file.
+#
+# Beware: if the Postfix SMTP server runs chrooted, you probably have
+# to access the passwd file via the proxymap service, in order to
+# overcome chroot restrictions. The alternative, having a copy of
+# the system passwd file in the chroot jail is just not practical.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify a bare username, an @domain.tld
+# wild-card, or specify a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#local_recipient_maps = unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps = proxy:unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps =
+
+# The unknown_local_recipient_reject_code specifies the SMTP server
+# response code when a recipient domain matches $mydestination or
+# ${proxy,inet}_interfaces, while $local_recipient_maps is non-empty
+# and the recipient address or address local-part is not found.
+#
+# The default setting is 550 (reject mail) but it is safer to start
+# with 450 (try again later) until you are certain that your
+# local_recipient_maps settings are OK.
+#
+unknown_local_recipient_reject_code = 550
+
+# TRUST AND RELAY CONTROL
+
+# The mynetworks parameter specifies the list of "trusted" SMTP
+# clients that have more privileges than "strangers".
+#
+# In particular, "trusted" SMTP clients are allowed to relay mail
+# through Postfix. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions parameter
+# in postconf(5).
+#
+# You can specify the list of "trusted" network addresses by hand
+# or you can let Postfix do it for you (which is the default).
+#
+# By default (mynetworks_style = subnet), Postfix "trusts" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP subnetworks as the local machine.
+# On Linux, this does works correctly only with interfaces specified
+# with the "ifconfig" command.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = class" when Postfix should "trust" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP class A/B/C networks as the local machine.
+# Don't do this with a dialup site - it would cause Postfix to "trust"
+# your entire provider's network. Instead, specify an explicit
+# mynetworks list by hand, as described below.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = host" when Postfix should "trust"
+# only the local machine.
+#
+#mynetworks_style = class
+#mynetworks_style = subnet
+#mynetworks_style = host
+
+# Alternatively, you can specify the mynetworks list by hand, in
+# which case Postfix ignores the mynetworks_style setting.
+#
+# Specify an explicit list of network/netmask patterns, where the
+# mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host
+# address.
+#
+# You can also specify the absolute pathname of a pattern file instead
+# of listing the patterns here. Specify type:table for table-based lookups
+# (the value on the table right-hand side is not used).
+#
+#mynetworks = 168.100.189.0/28, 127.0.0.0/8
+#mynetworks = $config_directory/mynetworks
+#mynetworks = hash:/etc/postfix/network_table
+
+
+# The relay_domains parameter restricts what destinations this system will
+# relay mail to. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions description in
+# postconf(5) for detailed information.
+#
+# By default, Postfix relays mail
+# - from "trusted" clients (IP address matches $mynetworks) to any destination,
+# - from "untrusted" clients to destinations that match $relay_domains or
+# subdomains thereof, except addresses with sender-specified routing.
+# The default relay_domains value is $mydestination.
+#
+# In addition to the above, the Postfix SMTP server by default accepts mail
+# that Postfix is final destination for:
+# - destinations that match $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces,
+# - destinations that match $mydestination
+# - destinations that match $virtual_alias_domains,
+# - destinations that match $virtual_mailbox_domains.
+# These destinations do not need to be listed in $relay_domains.
+#
+# Specify a list of hosts or domains, /file/name patterns or type:name
+# lookup tables, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue
+# long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. A file name
+# is replaced by its contents; a type:name table is matched when a
+# (parent) domain appears as lookup key.
+#
+# NOTE: Postfix will not automatically forward mail for domains that
+# list this system as their primary or backup MX host. See the
+# permit_mx_backup restriction description in postconf(5).
+#
+#relay_domains = $mydestination
+
+
+
+# INTERNET OR INTRANET
+
+# The relayhost parameter specifies the default host to send mail to
+# when no entry is matched in the optional transport(5) table. When
+# no relayhost is given, mail is routed directly to the destination.
+#
+# On an intranet, specify the organizational domain name. If your
+# internal DNS uses no MX records, specify the name of the intranet
+# gateway host instead.
+#
+# In the case of SMTP, specify a domain, host, host:port, [host]:port,
+# [address] or [address]:port; the form [host] turns off MX lookups.
+#
+# If you're connected via UUCP, see also the default_transport parameter.
+#
+#relayhost = $mydomain
+#relayhost = [gateway.my.domain]
+#relayhost = [mailserver.isp.tld]
+#relayhost = uucphost
+#relayhost = [an.ip.add.ress]
+relayhost = bastion.fedoraproject.org
+
+
+# REJECTING UNKNOWN RELAY USERS
+#
+# The relay_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all addresses in the domains that match $relay_domains.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown relay users. This feature is off by default.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify an @domain.tld wild-card, or specify
+# a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#relay_recipient_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_recipients
+
+# INPUT RATE CONTROL
+#
+# The in_flow_delay configuration parameter implements mail input
+# flow control. This feature is turned on by default, although it
+# still needs further development (it's disabled on SCO UNIX due
+# to an SCO bug).
+#
+# A Postfix process will pause for $in_flow_delay seconds before
+# accepting a new message, when the message arrival rate exceeds the
+# message delivery rate. With the default 100 SMTP server process
+# limit, this limits the mail inflow to 100 messages a second more
+# than the number of messages delivered per second.
+#
+# Specify 0 to disable the feature. Valid delays are 0..10.
+#
+#in_flow_delay = 1s
+
+# ADDRESS REWRITING
+#
+# The ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document gives information about
+# address masquerading or other forms of address rewriting including
+# username->Firstname.Lastname mapping.
+
+masquerade_domains = redhat.com
+masquerade_exceptions = root apache
+
+# ADDRESS REDIRECTION (VIRTUAL DOMAIN)
+#
+# The VIRTUAL_README document gives information about the many forms
+# of domain hosting that Postfix supports.
+
+# "USER HAS MOVED" BOUNCE MESSAGES
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# TRANSPORT MAP
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# ALIAS DATABASE
+#
+# The alias_maps parameter specifies the list of alias databases used
+# by the local delivery agent. The default list is system dependent.
+#
+# On systems with NIS, the default is to search the local alias
+# database, then the NIS alias database. See aliases(5) for syntax
+# details.
+#
+# If you change the alias database, run "postalias /etc/aliases" (or
+# wherever your system stores the mail alias file), or simply run
+# "newaliases" to build the necessary DBM or DB file.
+#
+# It will take a minute or so before changes become visible. Use
+# "postfix reload" to eliminate the delay.
+#
+#alias_maps = dbm:/etc/aliases
+alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, nis:mail.aliases
+#alias_maps = netinfo:/aliases
+
+# The alias_database parameter specifies the alias database(s) that
+# are built with "newaliases" or "sendmail -bi". This is a separate
+# configuration parameter, because alias_maps (see above) may specify
+# tables that are not necessarily all under control by Postfix.
+#
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/mail/aliases
+alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases, hash:/opt/majordomo/aliases
+
+# ADDRESS EXTENSIONS (e.g., user+foo)
+#
+# The recipient_delimiter parameter specifies the separator between
+# user names and address extensions (user+foo). See canonical(5),
+# local(8), relocated(5) and virtual(5) for the effects this has on
+# aliases, canonical, virtual, relocated and .forward file lookups.
+# Basically, the software tries user+foo and .forward+foo before
+# trying user and .forward.
+#
+recipient_delimiter = +
+
+# DELIVERY TO MAILBOX
+#
+# The home_mailbox parameter specifies the optional pathname of a
+# mailbox file relative to a user's home directory. The default
+# mailbox file is /var/spool/mail/user or /var/mail/user. Specify
+# "Maildir/" for qmail-style delivery (the / is required).
+#
+#home_mailbox = Mailbox
+#home_mailbox = Maildir/
+
+# The mail_spool_directory parameter specifies the directory where
+# UNIX-style mailboxes are kept. The default setting depends on the
+# system type.
+#
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/mail
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/spool/mail
+
+# The mailbox_command parameter specifies the optional external
+# command to use instead of mailbox delivery. The command is run as
+# the recipient with proper HOME, SHELL and LOGNAME environment settings.
+# Exception: delivery for root is done as $default_user.
+#
+# Other environment variables of interest: USER (recipient username),
+# EXTENSION (address extension), DOMAIN (domain part of address),
+# and LOCAL (the address localpart).
+#
+# Unlike other Postfix configuration parameters, the mailbox_command
+# parameter is not subjected to $parameter substitutions. This is to
+# make it easier to specify shell syntax (see example below).
+#
+# Avoid shell meta characters because they will force Postfix to run
+# an expensive shell process. Procmail alone is expensive enough.
+#
+# IF YOU USE THIS TO DELIVER MAIL SYSTEM-WIDE, YOU MUST SET UP AN
+# ALIAS THAT FORWARDS MAIL FOR ROOT TO A REAL USER.
+#
+#mailbox_command = /usr/bin/procmail
+#mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail -a "$EXTENSION"
+
+# The mailbox_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use after processing aliases and .forward files. This parameter
+# has precedence over the mailbox_command, fallback_transport and
+# luser_relay parameters.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+
+# If using the cyrus-imapd IMAP server deliver local mail to the IMAP
+# server using LMTP (Local Mail Transport Protocol), this is prefered
+# over the older cyrus deliver program by setting the
+# mailbox_transport as below:
+#
+# mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#
+# The efficiency of LMTP delivery for cyrus-imapd can be enhanced via
+# these settings.
+#
+# local_destination_recipient_limit = 300
+# local_destination_concurrency_limit = 5
+#
+# Of course you should adjust these settings as appropriate for the
+# capacity of the hardware you are using. The recipient limit setting
+# can be used to take advantage of the single instance message store
+# capability of Cyrus. The concurrency limit can be used to control
+# how many simultaneous LMTP sessions will be permitted to the Cyrus
+# message store.
+#
+# To use the old cyrus deliver program you have to set:
+#mailbox_transport = cyrus
+
+# The fallback_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use for recipients that are not found in the UNIX passwd database.
+# This parameter has precedence over the luser_relay parameter.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#fallback_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#fallback_transport =
+
+#transport_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/transport
+# The luser_relay parameter specifies an optional destination address
+# for unknown recipients. By default, mail for unknown@$mydestination,
+# unknown@[$inet_interfaces] or unknown@[$proxy_interfaces] is returned
+# as undeliverable.
+#
+# The following expansions are done on luser_relay: $user (recipient
+# username), $shell (recipient shell), $home (recipient home directory),
+# $recipient (full recipient address), $extension (recipient address
+# extension), $domain (recipient domain), $local (entire recipient
+# localpart), $recipient_delimiter. Specify ${name?value} or
+# ${name:value} to expand value only when $name does (does not) exist.
+#
+# luser_relay works only for the default Postfix local delivery agent.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must specify "local_recipient_maps =" (i.e. empty) in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#luser_relay = $user@other.host
+#luser_relay = $local@other.host
+#luser_relay = admin+$local
+
+# JUNK MAIL CONTROLS
+#
+# The controls listed here are only a very small subset. The file
+# SMTPD_ACCESS_README provides an overview.
+
+# The header_checks parameter specifies an optional table with patterns
+# that each logical message header is matched against, including
+# headers that span multiple physical lines.
+#
+# By default, these patterns also apply to MIME headers and to the
+# headers of attached messages. With older Postfix versions, MIME and
+# attached message headers were treated as body text.
+#
+# For details, see "man header_checks".
+#
+header_checks = regexp:/etc/postfix/header_checks
+
+# FAST ETRN SERVICE
+#
+# Postfix maintains per-destination logfiles with information about
+# deferred mail, so that mail can be flushed quickly with the SMTP
+# "ETRN domain.tld" command, or by executing "sendmail -qRdomain.tld".
+# See the ETRN_README document for a detailed description.
+#
+# The fast_flush_domains parameter controls what destinations are
+# eligible for this service. By default, they are all domains that
+# this server is willing to relay mail to.
+#
+#fast_flush_domains = $relay_domains
+
+# SHOW SOFTWARE VERSION OR NOT
+#
+# The smtpd_banner parameter specifies the text that follows the 220
+# code in the SMTP server's greeting banner. Some people like to see
+# the mail version advertised. By default, Postfix shows no version.
+#
+# You MUST specify $myhostname at the start of the text. That is an
+# RFC requirement. Postfix itself does not care.
+#
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name ($mail_version)
+
+# PARALLEL DELIVERY TO THE SAME DESTINATION
+#
+# How many parallel deliveries to the same user or domain? With local
+# delivery, it does not make sense to do massively parallel delivery
+# to the same user, because mailbox updates must happen sequentially,
+# and expensive pipelines in .forward files can cause disasters when
+# too many are run at the same time. With SMTP deliveries, 10
+# simultaneous connections to the same domain could be sufficient to
+# raise eyebrows.
+#
+# Each message delivery transport has its XXX_destination_concurrency_limit
+# parameter. The default is $default_destination_concurrency_limit for
+# most delivery transports. For the local delivery agent the default is 2.
+
+#local_destination_concurrency_limit = 2
+#default_destination_concurrency_limit = 20
+
+# DEBUGGING CONTROL
+#
+# The debug_peer_level parameter specifies the increment in verbose
+# logging level when an SMTP client or server host name or address
+# matches a pattern in the debug_peer_list parameter.
+#
+debug_peer_level = 2
+
+# The debug_peer_list parameter specifies an optional list of domain
+# or network patterns, /file/name patterns or type:name tables. When
+# an SMTP client or server host name or address matches a pattern,
+# increase the verbose logging level by the amount specified in the
+# debug_peer_level parameter.
+#
+#debug_peer_list = 127.0.0.1
+#debug_peer_list = some.domain
+
+# The debugger_command specifies the external command that is executed
+# when a Postfix daemon program is run with the -D option.
+#
+# Use "command .. & sleep 5" so that the debugger can attach before
+# the process marches on. If you use an X-based debugger, be sure to
+# set up your XAUTHORITY environment variable before starting Postfix.
+#
+debugger_command =
+ PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin:/usr/X11R6/bin
+ xxgdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id & sleep 5
+
+# If you can't use X, use this to capture the call stack when a
+# daemon crashes. The result is in a file in the configuration
+# directory, and is named after the process name and the process ID.
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin; export PATH; (echo cont;
+# echo where) | gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id 2>&1
+# >$config_directory/$process_name.$process_id.log & sleep 5
+#
+# Another possibility is to run gdb under a detached screen session.
+# To attach to the screen sesssion, su root and run "screen -r
+# <id_string>" where <id_string> uniquely matches one of the detached
+# sessions (from "screen -list").
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/sbin:/usr/sbin; export PATH; screen
+# -dmS $process_name gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name
+# $process_id & sleep 1
+
+# INSTALL-TIME CONFIGURATION INFORMATION
+#
+# The following parameters are used when installing a new Postfix version.
+#
+# sendmail_path: The full pathname of the Postfix sendmail command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible mail posting interface.
+#
+sendmail_path = /usr/sbin/sendmail.postfix
+
+# newaliases_path: The full pathname of the Postfix newaliases command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible command to build alias databases.
+#
+newaliases_path = /usr/bin/newaliases.postfix
+
+# mailq_path: The full pathname of the Postfix mailq command. This
+# is the Sendmail-compatible mail queue listing command.
+#
+mailq_path = /usr/bin/mailq.postfix
+
+# setgid_group: The group for mail submission and queue management
+# commands. This must be a group name with a numerical group ID that
+# is not shared with other accounts, not even with the Postfix account.
+#
+setgid_group = postdrop
+
+# html_directory: The location of the Postfix HTML documentation.
+#
+html_directory = no
+
+# manpage_directory: The location of the Postfix on-line manual pages.
+#
+manpage_directory = /usr/share/man
+
+# sample_directory: The location of the Postfix sample configuration files.
+# This parameter is obsolete as of Postfix 2.1.
+#
+sample_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/samples
+
+# readme_directory: The location of the Postfix README files.
+#
+readme_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/README_FILES
+
+# add this to new postfix to get it to add proper message-id and other
+# headers to outgoing emails via the gateway.
+
+
+message_size_limit = 20971520
+inet_protocols = ipv4
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.lists-dev.cloud.fedoraproject.org b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.lists-dev.cloud.fedoraproject.org
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..dd08f22be
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.lists-dev.cloud.fedoraproject.org
@@ -0,0 +1,694 @@
+# "false"
+# Global Postfix configuration file. This file lists only a subset
+# of all parameters. For the syntax, and for a complete parameter
+# list, see the postconf(5) manual page (command: "man 5 postconf").
+#
+# For common configuration examples, see BASIC_CONFIGURATION_README
+# and STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README. To find these documents, use
+# the command "postconf html_directory readme_directory", or go to
+# http://www.postfix.org/.
+#
+# For best results, change no more than 2-3 parameters at a time,
+# and test if Postfix still works after every change.
+
+# SOFT BOUNCE
+#
+# The soft_bounce parameter provides a limited safety net for
+# testing. When soft_bounce is enabled, mail will remain queued that
+# would otherwise bounce. This parameter disables locally-generated
+# bounces, and prevents the SMTP server from rejecting mail permanently
+# (by changing 5xx replies into 4xx replies). However, soft_bounce
+# is no cure for address rewriting mistakes or mail routing mistakes.
+#
+#soft_bounce = no
+
+# LOCAL PATHNAME INFORMATION
+#
+# The queue_directory specifies the location of the Postfix queue.
+# This is also the root directory of Postfix daemons that run chrooted.
+# See the files in examples/chroot-setup for setting up Postfix chroot
+# environments on different UNIX systems.
+#
+queue_directory = /var/spool/postfix
+
+# The command_directory parameter specifies the location of all
+# postXXX commands.
+#
+command_directory = /usr/sbin
+
+# The daemon_directory parameter specifies the location of all Postfix
+# daemon programs (i.e. programs listed in the master.cf file). This
+# directory must be owned by root.
+#
+daemon_directory = /usr/libexec/postfix
+
+# QUEUE AND PROCESS OWNERSHIP
+#
+# The mail_owner parameter specifies the owner of the Postfix queue
+# and of most Postfix daemon processes. Specify the name of a user
+# account THAT DOES NOT SHARE ITS USER OR GROUP ID WITH OTHER ACCOUNTS
+# AND THAT OWNS NO OTHER FILES OR PROCESSES ON THE SYSTEM. In
+# particular, don't specify nobody or daemon. PLEASE USE A DEDICATED
+# USER.
+#
+mail_owner = postfix
+
+# The default_privs parameter specifies the default rights used by
+# the local delivery agent for delivery to external file or command.
+# These rights are used in the absence of a recipient user context.
+# DO NOT SPECIFY A PRIVILEGED USER OR THE POSTFIX OWNER.
+#
+#default_privs = nobody
+
+# INTERNET HOST AND DOMAIN NAMES
+#
+# The myhostname parameter specifies the internet hostname of this
+# mail system. The default is to use the fully-qualified domain name
+# from gethostname(). $myhostname is used as a default value for many
+# other configuration parameters.
+#
+#myhostname = host.domain.tld
+#myhostname = virtual.domain.tld
+
+# The mydomain parameter specifies the local internet domain name.
+# The default is to use $myhostname minus the first component.
+# $mydomain is used as a default value for many other configuration
+# parameters.
+#
+#mydomain = domain.tld
+
+# SENDING MAIL
+#
+# The myorigin parameter specifies the domain that locally-posted
+# mail appears to come from. The default is to append $myhostname,
+# which is fine for small sites. If you run a domain with multiple
+# machines, you should (1) change this to $mydomain and (2) set up
+# a domain-wide alias database that aliases each user to
+# user@that.users.mailhost.
+#
+# For the sake of consistency between sender and recipient addresses,
+# myorigin also specifies the default domain name that is appended
+# to recipient addresses that have no @domain part.
+#
+#myorigin = $myhostname
+#myorigin = $mydomain
+
+mydomain = fedoraproject.org
+myorigin = fedoraproject.org
+
+# RECEIVING MAIL
+
+# The inet_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on. By default,
+# the software claims all active interfaces on the machine. The
+# parameter also controls delivery of mail to user@[ip.address].
+#
+# See also the proxy_interfaces parameter, for network addresses that
+# are forwarded to us via a proxy or network address translator.
+#
+# Note: you need to stop/start Postfix when this parameter changes.
+#
+#inet_interfaces = all
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname, localhost
+inet_interfaces = all
+
+# The proxy_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on by way of a
+# proxy or network address translation unit. This setting extends
+# the address list specified with the inet_interfaces parameter.
+#
+# You must specify your proxy/NAT addresses when your system is a
+# backup MX host for other domains, otherwise mail delivery loops
+# will happen when the primary MX host is down.
+#
+#proxy_interfaces =
+#proxy_interfaces = 1.2.3.4
+
+# The mydestination parameter specifies the list of domains that this
+# machine considers itself the final destination for.
+#
+# These domains are routed to the delivery agent specified with the
+# local_transport parameter setting. By default, that is the UNIX
+# compatible delivery agent that lookups all recipients in /etc/passwd
+# and /etc/aliases or their equivalent.
+#
+# The default is $myhostname + localhost.$mydomain. On a mail domain
+# gateway, you should also include $mydomain.
+#
+# Do not specify the names of virtual domains - those domains are
+# specified elsewhere (see VIRTUAL_README).
+#
+# Do not specify the names of domains that this machine is backup MX
+# host for. Specify those names via the relay_domains settings for
+# the SMTP server, or use permit_mx_backup if you are lazy (see
+# STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README).
+#
+# The local machine is always the final destination for mail addressed
+# to user@[the.net.work.address] of an interface that the mail system
+# receives mail on (see the inet_interfaces parameter).
+#
+# Specify a list of host or domain names, /file/name or type:table
+# patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. A /file/name
+# pattern is replaced by its contents; a type:table is matched when
+# a name matches a lookup key (the right-hand side is ignored).
+# Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.
+#
+# See also below, section "REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS".
+#
+mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, lists-dev.cloud.fedoraproject.org
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain,
+# mail.$mydomain, www.$mydomain, ftp.$mydomain
+
+# REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS
+#
+# The local_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all names or addresses of users that are local with respect
+# to $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown local users. This parameter is defined by default.
+#
+# To turn off local recipient checking in the SMTP server, specify
+# local_recipient_maps = (i.e. empty).
+#
+# The default setting assumes that you use the default Postfix local
+# delivery agent for local delivery. You need to update the
+# local_recipient_maps setting if:
+#
+# - You define $mydestination domain recipients in files other than
+# /etc/passwd, /etc/aliases, or the $virtual_alias_maps files.
+# For example, you define $mydestination domain recipients in
+# the $virtual_mailbox_maps files.
+#
+# - You redefine the local delivery agent in master.cf.
+#
+# - You redefine the "local_transport" setting in main.cf.
+#
+# - You use the "luser_relay", "mailbox_transport", or "fallback_transport"
+# feature of the Postfix local delivery agent (see local(8)).
+#
+# Details are described in the LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README file.
+#
+# Beware: if the Postfix SMTP server runs chrooted, you probably have
+# to access the passwd file via the proxymap service, in order to
+# overcome chroot restrictions. The alternative, having a copy of
+# the system passwd file in the chroot jail is just not practical.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify a bare username, an @domain.tld
+# wild-card, or specify a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#local_recipient_maps = unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps = proxy:unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps =
+
+# The unknown_local_recipient_reject_code specifies the SMTP server
+# response code when a recipient domain matches $mydestination or
+# ${proxy,inet}_interfaces, while $local_recipient_maps is non-empty
+# and the recipient address or address local-part is not found.
+#
+# The default setting is 550 (reject mail) but it is safer to start
+# with 450 (try again later) until you are certain that your
+# local_recipient_maps settings are OK.
+#
+unknown_local_recipient_reject_code = 550
+
+# TRUST AND RELAY CONTROL
+
+# The mynetworks parameter specifies the list of "trusted" SMTP
+# clients that have more privileges than "strangers".
+#
+# In particular, "trusted" SMTP clients are allowed to relay mail
+# through Postfix. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions parameter
+# in postconf(5).
+#
+# You can specify the list of "trusted" network addresses by hand
+# or you can let Postfix do it for you (which is the default).
+#
+# By default (mynetworks_style = subnet), Postfix "trusts" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP subnetworks as the local machine.
+# On Linux, this does works correctly only with interfaces specified
+# with the "ifconfig" command.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = class" when Postfix should "trust" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP class A/B/C networks as the local machine.
+# Don't do this with a dialup site - it would cause Postfix to "trust"
+# your entire provider's network. Instead, specify an explicit
+# mynetworks list by hand, as described below.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = host" when Postfix should "trust"
+# only the local machine.
+#
+#mynetworks_style = class
+#mynetworks_style = subnet
+#mynetworks_style = host
+
+# Alternatively, you can specify the mynetworks list by hand, in
+# which case Postfix ignores the mynetworks_style setting.
+#
+# Specify an explicit list of network/netmask patterns, where the
+# mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host
+# address.
+#
+# You can also specify the absolute pathname of a pattern file instead
+# of listing the patterns here. Specify type:table for table-based lookups
+# (the value on the table right-hand side is not used).
+#
+#mynetworks = 168.100.189.0/28, 127.0.0.0/8
+#mynetworks = $config_directory/mynetworks
+#mynetworks = hash:/etc/postfix/network_table
+
+
+# The relay_domains parameter restricts what destinations this system will
+# relay mail to. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions description in
+# postconf(5) for detailed information.
+#
+# By default, Postfix relays mail
+# - from "trusted" clients (IP address matches $mynetworks) to any destination,
+# - from "untrusted" clients to destinations that match $relay_domains or
+# subdomains thereof, except addresses with sender-specified routing.
+# The default relay_domains value is $mydestination.
+#
+# In addition to the above, the Postfix SMTP server by default accepts mail
+# that Postfix is final destination for:
+# - destinations that match $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces,
+# - destinations that match $mydestination
+# - destinations that match $virtual_alias_domains,
+# - destinations that match $virtual_mailbox_domains.
+# These destinations do not need to be listed in $relay_domains.
+#
+# Specify a list of hosts or domains, /file/name patterns or type:name
+# lookup tables, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue
+# long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. A file name
+# is replaced by its contents; a type:name table is matched when a
+# (parent) domain appears as lookup key.
+#
+# NOTE: Postfix will not automatically forward mail for domains that
+# list this system as their primary or backup MX host. See the
+# permit_mx_backup restriction description in postconf(5).
+#
+#relay_domains = $mydestination
+
+
+
+# INTERNET OR INTRANET
+
+# The relayhost parameter specifies the default host to send mail to
+# when no entry is matched in the optional transport(5) table. When
+# no relayhost is given, mail is routed directly to the destination.
+#
+# On an intranet, specify the organizational domain name. If your
+# internal DNS uses no MX records, specify the name of the intranet
+# gateway host instead.
+#
+# In the case of SMTP, specify a domain, host, host:port, [host]:port,
+# [address] or [address]:port; the form [host] turns off MX lookups.
+#
+# If you're connected via UUCP, see also the default_transport parameter.
+#
+#relayhost = $mydomain
+#relayhost = [gateway.my.domain]
+#relayhost = [mailserver.isp.tld]
+#relayhost = uucphost
+#relayhost = [an.ip.add.ress]
+
+
+# REJECTING UNKNOWN RELAY USERS
+#
+# The relay_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all addresses in the domains that match $relay_domains.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown relay users. This feature is off by default.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify an @domain.tld wild-card, or specify
+# a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#relay_recipient_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_recipients
+
+# INPUT RATE CONTROL
+#
+# The in_flow_delay configuration parameter implements mail input
+# flow control. This feature is turned on by default, although it
+# still needs further development (it's disabled on SCO UNIX due
+# to an SCO bug).
+#
+# A Postfix process will pause for $in_flow_delay seconds before
+# accepting a new message, when the message arrival rate exceeds the
+# message delivery rate. With the default 100 SMTP server process
+# limit, this limits the mail inflow to 100 messages a second more
+# than the number of messages delivered per second.
+#
+# Specify 0 to disable the feature. Valid delays are 0..10.
+#
+#in_flow_delay = 1s
+
+# ADDRESS REWRITING
+#
+# The ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document gives information about
+# address masquerading or other forms of address rewriting including
+# username->Firstname.Lastname mapping.
+
+masquerade_domains = redhat.com
+masquerade_exceptions = root apache
+
+# ADDRESS REDIRECTION (VIRTUAL DOMAIN)
+#
+# The VIRTUAL_README document gives information about the many forms
+# of domain hosting that Postfix supports.
+
+# "USER HAS MOVED" BOUNCE MESSAGES
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# TRANSPORT MAP
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# ALIAS DATABASE
+#
+# The alias_maps parameter specifies the list of alias databases used
+# by the local delivery agent. The default list is system dependent.
+#
+# On systems with NIS, the default is to search the local alias
+# database, then the NIS alias database. See aliases(5) for syntax
+# details.
+#
+# If you change the alias database, run "postalias /etc/aliases" (or
+# wherever your system stores the mail alias file), or simply run
+# "newaliases" to build the necessary DBM or DB file.
+#
+# It will take a minute or so before changes become visible. Use
+# "postfix reload" to eliminate the delay.
+#
+#alias_maps = dbm:/etc/aliases
+alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, nis:mail.aliases
+#alias_maps = netinfo:/aliases
+
+# The alias_database parameter specifies the alias database(s) that
+# are built with "newaliases" or "sendmail -bi". This is a separate
+# configuration parameter, because alias_maps (see above) may specify
+# tables that are not necessarily all under control by Postfix.
+#
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/mail/aliases
+alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases, hash:/opt/majordomo/aliases
+
+# ADDRESS EXTENSIONS (e.g., user+foo)
+#
+# The recipient_delimiter parameter specifies the separator between
+# user names and address extensions (user+foo). See canonical(5),
+# local(8), relocated(5) and virtual(5) for the effects this has on
+# aliases, canonical, virtual, relocated and .forward file lookups.
+# Basically, the software tries user+foo and .forward+foo before
+# trying user and .forward.
+#
+recipient_delimiter = +
+
+# DELIVERY TO MAILBOX
+#
+# The home_mailbox parameter specifies the optional pathname of a
+# mailbox file relative to a user's home directory. The default
+# mailbox file is /var/spool/mail/user or /var/mail/user. Specify
+# "Maildir/" for qmail-style delivery (the / is required).
+#
+#home_mailbox = Mailbox
+#home_mailbox = Maildir/
+
+# The mail_spool_directory parameter specifies the directory where
+# UNIX-style mailboxes are kept. The default setting depends on the
+# system type.
+#
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/mail
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/spool/mail
+
+# The mailbox_command parameter specifies the optional external
+# command to use instead of mailbox delivery. The command is run as
+# the recipient with proper HOME, SHELL and LOGNAME environment settings.
+# Exception: delivery for root is done as $default_user.
+#
+# Other environment variables of interest: USER (recipient username),
+# EXTENSION (address extension), DOMAIN (domain part of address),
+# and LOCAL (the address localpart).
+#
+# Unlike other Postfix configuration parameters, the mailbox_command
+# parameter is not subjected to $parameter substitutions. This is to
+# make it easier to specify shell syntax (see example below).
+#
+# Avoid shell meta characters because they will force Postfix to run
+# an expensive shell process. Procmail alone is expensive enough.
+#
+# IF YOU USE THIS TO DELIVER MAIL SYSTEM-WIDE, YOU MUST SET UP AN
+# ALIAS THAT FORWARDS MAIL FOR ROOT TO A REAL USER.
+#
+#mailbox_command = /usr/bin/procmail
+#mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail -a "$EXTENSION"
+
+# The mailbox_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use after processing aliases and .forward files. This parameter
+# has precedence over the mailbox_command, fallback_transport and
+# luser_relay parameters.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+
+# If using the cyrus-imapd IMAP server deliver local mail to the IMAP
+# server using LMTP (Local Mail Transport Protocol), this is prefered
+# over the older cyrus deliver program by setting the
+# mailbox_transport as below:
+#
+# mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#
+# The efficiency of LMTP delivery for cyrus-imapd can be enhanced via
+# these settings.
+#
+# local_destination_recipient_limit = 300
+# local_destination_concurrency_limit = 5
+#
+# Of course you should adjust these settings as appropriate for the
+# capacity of the hardware you are using. The recipient limit setting
+# can be used to take advantage of the single instance message store
+# capability of Cyrus. The concurrency limit can be used to control
+# how many simultaneous LMTP sessions will be permitted to the Cyrus
+# message store.
+#
+# To use the old cyrus deliver program you have to set:
+#mailbox_transport = cyrus
+
+# The fallback_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use for recipients that are not found in the UNIX passwd database.
+# This parameter has precedence over the luser_relay parameter.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#fallback_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#fallback_transport =
+
+#transport_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/transport
+# The luser_relay parameter specifies an optional destination address
+# for unknown recipients. By default, mail for unknown@$mydestination,
+# unknown@[$inet_interfaces] or unknown@[$proxy_interfaces] is returned
+# as undeliverable.
+#
+# The following expansions are done on luser_relay: $user (recipient
+# username), $shell (recipient shell), $home (recipient home directory),
+# $recipient (full recipient address), $extension (recipient address
+# extension), $domain (recipient domain), $local (entire recipient
+# localpart), $recipient_delimiter. Specify ${name?value} or
+# ${name:value} to expand value only when $name does (does not) exist.
+#
+# luser_relay works only for the default Postfix local delivery agent.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must specify "local_recipient_maps =" (i.e. empty) in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#luser_relay = $user@other.host
+#luser_relay = $local@other.host
+#luser_relay = admin+$local
+
+# JUNK MAIL CONTROLS
+#
+# The controls listed here are only a very small subset. The file
+# SMTPD_ACCESS_README provides an overview.
+
+# The header_checks parameter specifies an optional table with patterns
+# that each logical message header is matched against, including
+# headers that span multiple physical lines.
+#
+# By default, these patterns also apply to MIME headers and to the
+# headers of attached messages. With older Postfix versions, MIME and
+# attached message headers were treated as body text.
+#
+# For details, see "man header_checks".
+#
+header_checks = regexp:/etc/postfix/header_checks
+
+# FAST ETRN SERVICE
+#
+# Postfix maintains per-destination logfiles with information about
+# deferred mail, so that mail can be flushed quickly with the SMTP
+# "ETRN domain.tld" command, or by executing "sendmail -qRdomain.tld".
+# See the ETRN_README document for a detailed description.
+#
+# The fast_flush_domains parameter controls what destinations are
+# eligible for this service. By default, they are all domains that
+# this server is willing to relay mail to.
+#
+#fast_flush_domains = $relay_domains
+
+# SHOW SOFTWARE VERSION OR NOT
+#
+# The smtpd_banner parameter specifies the text that follows the 220
+# code in the SMTP server's greeting banner. Some people like to see
+# the mail version advertised. By default, Postfix shows no version.
+#
+# You MUST specify $myhostname at the start of the text. That is an
+# RFC requirement. Postfix itself does not care.
+#
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name ($mail_version)
+
+# PARALLEL DELIVERY TO THE SAME DESTINATION
+#
+# How many parallel deliveries to the same user or domain? With local
+# delivery, it does not make sense to do massively parallel delivery
+# to the same user, because mailbox updates must happen sequentially,
+# and expensive pipelines in .forward files can cause disasters when
+# too many are run at the same time. With SMTP deliveries, 10
+# simultaneous connections to the same domain could be sufficient to
+# raise eyebrows.
+#
+# Each message delivery transport has its XXX_destination_concurrency_limit
+# parameter. The default is $default_destination_concurrency_limit for
+# most delivery transports. For the local delivery agent the default is 2.
+
+#local_destination_concurrency_limit = 2
+#default_destination_concurrency_limit = 20
+
+# DEBUGGING CONTROL
+#
+# The debug_peer_level parameter specifies the increment in verbose
+# logging level when an SMTP client or server host name or address
+# matches a pattern in the debug_peer_list parameter.
+#
+debug_peer_level = 2
+
+# The debug_peer_list parameter specifies an optional list of domain
+# or network patterns, /file/name patterns or type:name tables. When
+# an SMTP client or server host name or address matches a pattern,
+# increase the verbose logging level by the amount specified in the
+# debug_peer_level parameter.
+#
+#debug_peer_list = 127.0.0.1
+#debug_peer_list = some.domain
+
+# The debugger_command specifies the external command that is executed
+# when a Postfix daemon program is run with the -D option.
+#
+# Use "command .. & sleep 5" so that the debugger can attach before
+# the process marches on. If you use an X-based debugger, be sure to
+# set up your XAUTHORITY environment variable before starting Postfix.
+#
+debugger_command =
+ PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin:/usr/X11R6/bin
+ xxgdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id & sleep 5
+
+# If you can't use X, use this to capture the call stack when a
+# daemon crashes. The result is in a file in the configuration
+# directory, and is named after the process name and the process ID.
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin; export PATH; (echo cont;
+# echo where) | gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id 2>&1
+# >$config_directory/$process_name.$process_id.log & sleep 5
+#
+# Another possibility is to run gdb under a detached screen session.
+# To attach to the screen sesssion, su root and run "screen -r
+# <id_string>" where <id_string> uniquely matches one of the detached
+# sessions (from "screen -list").
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/sbin:/usr/sbin; export PATH; screen
+# -dmS $process_name gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name
+# $process_id & sleep 1
+
+# INSTALL-TIME CONFIGURATION INFORMATION
+#
+# The following parameters are used when installing a new Postfix version.
+#
+# sendmail_path: The full pathname of the Postfix sendmail command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible mail posting interface.
+#
+sendmail_path = /usr/sbin/sendmail.postfix
+
+# newaliases_path: The full pathname of the Postfix newaliases command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible command to build alias databases.
+#
+newaliases_path = /usr/bin/newaliases.postfix
+
+# mailq_path: The full pathname of the Postfix mailq command. This
+# is the Sendmail-compatible mail queue listing command.
+#
+mailq_path = /usr/bin/mailq.postfix
+
+# setgid_group: The group for mail submission and queue management
+# commands. This must be a group name with a numerical group ID that
+# is not shared with other accounts, not even with the Postfix account.
+#
+setgid_group = postdrop
+
+# html_directory: The location of the Postfix HTML documentation.
+#
+html_directory = no
+
+# manpage_directory: The location of the Postfix on-line manual pages.
+#
+manpage_directory = /usr/share/man
+
+# sample_directory: The location of the Postfix sample configuration files.
+# This parameter is obsolete as of Postfix 2.1.
+#
+sample_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/samples
+
+# readme_directory: The location of the Postfix README files.
+#
+readme_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/README_FILES
+
+# add this to new postfix to get it to add proper message-id and other
+# headers to outgoing emails via the gateway.
+
+
+message_size_limit = 20971520
+#inet_protocols = ipv4
+
+
+# Mailman, see MTA.rst
+owner_request_special = no
+# Mailman is installed from source
+transport_maps = hash:/srv/webui/var/data/postfix_lmtp
+local_recipient_maps = hash:/srv/webui/var/data/postfix_lmtp
+relay_domains = hash:/srv/webui/var/data/postfix_domains
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.lists-dev.fedorainfracloud.org b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.lists-dev.fedorainfracloud.org
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..94a1bf8b0
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.lists-dev.fedorainfracloud.org
@@ -0,0 +1,693 @@
+# "false"
+# Global Postfix configuration file. This file lists only a subset
+# of all parameters. For the syntax, and for a complete parameter
+# list, see the postconf(5) manual page (command: "man 5 postconf").
+#
+# For common configuration examples, see BASIC_CONFIGURATION_README
+# and STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README. To find these documents, use
+# the command "postconf html_directory readme_directory", or go to
+# http://www.postfix.org/.
+#
+# For best results, change no more than 2-3 parameters at a time,
+# and test if Postfix still works after every change.
+
+# SOFT BOUNCE
+#
+# The soft_bounce parameter provides a limited safety net for
+# testing. When soft_bounce is enabled, mail will remain queued that
+# would otherwise bounce. This parameter disables locally-generated
+# bounces, and prevents the SMTP server from rejecting mail permanently
+# (by changing 5xx replies into 4xx replies). However, soft_bounce
+# is no cure for address rewriting mistakes or mail routing mistakes.
+#
+#soft_bounce = no
+
+# LOCAL PATHNAME INFORMATION
+#
+# The queue_directory specifies the location of the Postfix queue.
+# This is also the root directory of Postfix daemons that run chrooted.
+# See the files in examples/chroot-setup for setting up Postfix chroot
+# environments on different UNIX systems.
+#
+queue_directory = /var/spool/postfix
+
+# The command_directory parameter specifies the location of all
+# postXXX commands.
+#
+command_directory = /usr/sbin
+
+# The daemon_directory parameter specifies the location of all Postfix
+# daemon programs (i.e. programs listed in the master.cf file). This
+# directory must be owned by root.
+#
+daemon_directory = /usr/libexec/postfix
+
+# QUEUE AND PROCESS OWNERSHIP
+#
+# The mail_owner parameter specifies the owner of the Postfix queue
+# and of most Postfix daemon processes. Specify the name of a user
+# account THAT DOES NOT SHARE ITS USER OR GROUP ID WITH OTHER ACCOUNTS
+# AND THAT OWNS NO OTHER FILES OR PROCESSES ON THE SYSTEM. In
+# particular, don't specify nobody or daemon. PLEASE USE A DEDICATED
+# USER.
+#
+mail_owner = postfix
+
+# The default_privs parameter specifies the default rights used by
+# the local delivery agent for delivery to external file or command.
+# These rights are used in the absence of a recipient user context.
+# DO NOT SPECIFY A PRIVILEGED USER OR THE POSTFIX OWNER.
+#
+#default_privs = nobody
+
+# INTERNET HOST AND DOMAIN NAMES
+#
+# The myhostname parameter specifies the internet hostname of this
+# mail system. The default is to use the fully-qualified domain name
+# from gethostname(). $myhostname is used as a default value for many
+# other configuration parameters.
+#
+#myhostname = host.domain.tld
+#myhostname = virtual.domain.tld
+
+# The mydomain parameter specifies the local internet domain name.
+# The default is to use $myhostname minus the first component.
+# $mydomain is used as a default value for many other configuration
+# parameters.
+#
+#mydomain = domain.tld
+
+# SENDING MAIL
+#
+# The myorigin parameter specifies the domain that locally-posted
+# mail appears to come from. The default is to append $myhostname,
+# which is fine for small sites. If you run a domain with multiple
+# machines, you should (1) change this to $mydomain and (2) set up
+# a domain-wide alias database that aliases each user to
+# user@that.users.mailhost.
+#
+# For the sake of consistency between sender and recipient addresses,
+# myorigin also specifies the default domain name that is appended
+# to recipient addresses that have no @domain part.
+#
+#myorigin = $myhostname
+#myorigin = $mydomain
+
+mydomain = fedoraproject.org
+myorigin = fedoraproject.org
+
+# RECEIVING MAIL
+
+# The inet_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on. By default,
+# the software claims all active interfaces on the machine. The
+# parameter also controls delivery of mail to user@[ip.address].
+#
+# See also the proxy_interfaces parameter, for network addresses that
+# are forwarded to us via a proxy or network address translator.
+#
+# Note: you need to stop/start Postfix when this parameter changes.
+#
+#inet_interfaces = all
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname, localhost
+inet_interfaces = all
+
+# The proxy_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on by way of a
+# proxy or network address translation unit. This setting extends
+# the address list specified with the inet_interfaces parameter.
+#
+# You must specify your proxy/NAT addresses when your system is a
+# backup MX host for other domains, otherwise mail delivery loops
+# will happen when the primary MX host is down.
+#
+#proxy_interfaces =
+#proxy_interfaces = 1.2.3.4
+
+# The mydestination parameter specifies the list of domains that this
+# machine considers itself the final destination for.
+#
+# These domains are routed to the delivery agent specified with the
+# local_transport parameter setting. By default, that is the UNIX
+# compatible delivery agent that lookups all recipients in /etc/passwd
+# and /etc/aliases or their equivalent.
+#
+# The default is $myhostname + localhost.$mydomain. On a mail domain
+# gateway, you should also include $mydomain.
+#
+# Do not specify the names of virtual domains - those domains are
+# specified elsewhere (see VIRTUAL_README).
+#
+# Do not specify the names of domains that this machine is backup MX
+# host for. Specify those names via the relay_domains settings for
+# the SMTP server, or use permit_mx_backup if you are lazy (see
+# STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README).
+#
+# The local machine is always the final destination for mail addressed
+# to user@[the.net.work.address] of an interface that the mail system
+# receives mail on (see the inet_interfaces parameter).
+#
+# Specify a list of host or domain names, /file/name or type:table
+# patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. A /file/name
+# pattern is replaced by its contents; a type:table is matched when
+# a name matches a lookup key (the right-hand side is ignored).
+# Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.
+#
+# See also below, section "REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS".
+#
+mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain,
+# mail.$mydomain, www.$mydomain, ftp.$mydomain
+
+# REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS
+#
+# The local_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all names or addresses of users that are local with respect
+# to $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown local users. This parameter is defined by default.
+#
+# To turn off local recipient checking in the SMTP server, specify
+# local_recipient_maps = (i.e. empty).
+#
+# The default setting assumes that you use the default Postfix local
+# delivery agent for local delivery. You need to update the
+# local_recipient_maps setting if:
+#
+# - You define $mydestination domain recipients in files other than
+# /etc/passwd, /etc/aliases, or the $virtual_alias_maps files.
+# For example, you define $mydestination domain recipients in
+# the $virtual_mailbox_maps files.
+#
+# - You redefine the local delivery agent in master.cf.
+#
+# - You redefine the "local_transport" setting in main.cf.
+#
+# - You use the "luser_relay", "mailbox_transport", or "fallback_transport"
+# feature of the Postfix local delivery agent (see local(8)).
+#
+# Details are described in the LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README file.
+#
+# Beware: if the Postfix SMTP server runs chrooted, you probably have
+# to access the passwd file via the proxymap service, in order to
+# overcome chroot restrictions. The alternative, having a copy of
+# the system passwd file in the chroot jail is just not practical.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify a bare username, an @domain.tld
+# wild-card, or specify a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#local_recipient_maps = unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps = proxy:unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps =
+
+# The unknown_local_recipient_reject_code specifies the SMTP server
+# response code when a recipient domain matches $mydestination or
+# ${proxy,inet}_interfaces, while $local_recipient_maps is non-empty
+# and the recipient address or address local-part is not found.
+#
+# The default setting is 550 (reject mail) but it is safer to start
+# with 450 (try again later) until you are certain that your
+# local_recipient_maps settings are OK.
+#
+unknown_local_recipient_reject_code = 550
+
+# TRUST AND RELAY CONTROL
+
+# The mynetworks parameter specifies the list of "trusted" SMTP
+# clients that have more privileges than "strangers".
+#
+# In particular, "trusted" SMTP clients are allowed to relay mail
+# through Postfix. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions parameter
+# in postconf(5).
+#
+# You can specify the list of "trusted" network addresses by hand
+# or you can let Postfix do it for you (which is the default).
+#
+# By default (mynetworks_style = subnet), Postfix "trusts" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP subnetworks as the local machine.
+# On Linux, this does works correctly only with interfaces specified
+# with the "ifconfig" command.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = class" when Postfix should "trust" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP class A/B/C networks as the local machine.
+# Don't do this with a dialup site - it would cause Postfix to "trust"
+# your entire provider's network. Instead, specify an explicit
+# mynetworks list by hand, as described below.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = host" when Postfix should "trust"
+# only the local machine.
+#
+#mynetworks_style = class
+#mynetworks_style = subnet
+#mynetworks_style = host
+
+# Alternatively, you can specify the mynetworks list by hand, in
+# which case Postfix ignores the mynetworks_style setting.
+#
+# Specify an explicit list of network/netmask patterns, where the
+# mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host
+# address.
+#
+# You can also specify the absolute pathname of a pattern file instead
+# of listing the patterns here. Specify type:table for table-based lookups
+# (the value on the table right-hand side is not used).
+#
+#mynetworks = 168.100.189.0/28, 127.0.0.0/8
+#mynetworks = $config_directory/mynetworks
+#mynetworks = hash:/etc/postfix/network_table
+
+
+# The relay_domains parameter restricts what destinations this system will
+# relay mail to. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions description in
+# postconf(5) for detailed information.
+#
+# By default, Postfix relays mail
+# - from "trusted" clients (IP address matches $mynetworks) to any destination,
+# - from "untrusted" clients to destinations that match $relay_domains or
+# subdomains thereof, except addresses with sender-specified routing.
+# The default relay_domains value is $mydestination.
+#
+# In addition to the above, the Postfix SMTP server by default accepts mail
+# that Postfix is final destination for:
+# - destinations that match $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces,
+# - destinations that match $mydestination
+# - destinations that match $virtual_alias_domains,
+# - destinations that match $virtual_mailbox_domains.
+# These destinations do not need to be listed in $relay_domains.
+#
+# Specify a list of hosts or domains, /file/name patterns or type:name
+# lookup tables, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue
+# long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. A file name
+# is replaced by its contents; a type:name table is matched when a
+# (parent) domain appears as lookup key.
+#
+# NOTE: Postfix will not automatically forward mail for domains that
+# list this system as their primary or backup MX host. See the
+# permit_mx_backup restriction description in postconf(5).
+#
+#relay_domains = $mydestination
+
+
+
+# INTERNET OR INTRANET
+
+# The relayhost parameter specifies the default host to send mail to
+# when no entry is matched in the optional transport(5) table. When
+# no relayhost is given, mail is routed directly to the destination.
+#
+# On an intranet, specify the organizational domain name. If your
+# internal DNS uses no MX records, specify the name of the intranet
+# gateway host instead.
+#
+# In the case of SMTP, specify a domain, host, host:port, [host]:port,
+# [address] or [address]:port; the form [host] turns off MX lookups.
+#
+# If you're connected via UUCP, see also the default_transport parameter.
+#
+#relayhost = $mydomain
+#relayhost = [gateway.my.domain]
+#relayhost = [mailserver.isp.tld]
+#relayhost = uucphost
+#relayhost = [an.ip.add.ress]
+
+
+# REJECTING UNKNOWN RELAY USERS
+#
+# The relay_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all addresses in the domains that match $relay_domains.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown relay users. This feature is off by default.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify an @domain.tld wild-card, or specify
+# a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#relay_recipient_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_recipients
+
+# INPUT RATE CONTROL
+#
+# The in_flow_delay configuration parameter implements mail input
+# flow control. This feature is turned on by default, although it
+# still needs further development (it's disabled on SCO UNIX due
+# to an SCO bug).
+#
+# A Postfix process will pause for $in_flow_delay seconds before
+# accepting a new message, when the message arrival rate exceeds the
+# message delivery rate. With the default 100 SMTP server process
+# limit, this limits the mail inflow to 100 messages a second more
+# than the number of messages delivered per second.
+#
+# Specify 0 to disable the feature. Valid delays are 0..10.
+#
+#in_flow_delay = 1s
+
+# ADDRESS REWRITING
+#
+# The ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document gives information about
+# address masquerading or other forms of address rewriting including
+# username->Firstname.Lastname mapping.
+
+masquerade_domains = redhat.com
+masquerade_exceptions = root apache
+
+# ADDRESS REDIRECTION (VIRTUAL DOMAIN)
+#
+# The VIRTUAL_README document gives information about the many forms
+# of domain hosting that Postfix supports.
+
+# "USER HAS MOVED" BOUNCE MESSAGES
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# TRANSPORT MAP
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# ALIAS DATABASE
+#
+# The alias_maps parameter specifies the list of alias databases used
+# by the local delivery agent. The default list is system dependent.
+#
+# On systems with NIS, the default is to search the local alias
+# database, then the NIS alias database. See aliases(5) for syntax
+# details.
+#
+# If you change the alias database, run "postalias /etc/aliases" (or
+# wherever your system stores the mail alias file), or simply run
+# "newaliases" to build the necessary DBM or DB file.
+#
+# It will take a minute or so before changes become visible. Use
+# "postfix reload" to eliminate the delay.
+#
+#alias_maps = dbm:/etc/aliases
+alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, nis:mail.aliases
+#alias_maps = netinfo:/aliases
+
+# The alias_database parameter specifies the alias database(s) that
+# are built with "newaliases" or "sendmail -bi". This is a separate
+# configuration parameter, because alias_maps (see above) may specify
+# tables that are not necessarily all under control by Postfix.
+#
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/mail/aliases
+alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases, hash:/opt/majordomo/aliases
+
+# ADDRESS EXTENSIONS (e.g., user+foo)
+#
+# The recipient_delimiter parameter specifies the separator between
+# user names and address extensions (user+foo). See canonical(5),
+# local(8), relocated(5) and virtual(5) for the effects this has on
+# aliases, canonical, virtual, relocated and .forward file lookups.
+# Basically, the software tries user+foo and .forward+foo before
+# trying user and .forward.
+#
+recipient_delimiter = +
+
+# DELIVERY TO MAILBOX
+#
+# The home_mailbox parameter specifies the optional pathname of a
+# mailbox file relative to a user's home directory. The default
+# mailbox file is /var/spool/mail/user or /var/mail/user. Specify
+# "Maildir/" for qmail-style delivery (the / is required).
+#
+#home_mailbox = Mailbox
+#home_mailbox = Maildir/
+
+# The mail_spool_directory parameter specifies the directory where
+# UNIX-style mailboxes are kept. The default setting depends on the
+# system type.
+#
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/mail
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/spool/mail
+
+# The mailbox_command parameter specifies the optional external
+# command to use instead of mailbox delivery. The command is run as
+# the recipient with proper HOME, SHELL and LOGNAME environment settings.
+# Exception: delivery for root is done as $default_user.
+#
+# Other environment variables of interest: USER (recipient username),
+# EXTENSION (address extension), DOMAIN (domain part of address),
+# and LOCAL (the address localpart).
+#
+# Unlike other Postfix configuration parameters, the mailbox_command
+# parameter is not subjected to $parameter substitutions. This is to
+# make it easier to specify shell syntax (see example below).
+#
+# Avoid shell meta characters because they will force Postfix to run
+# an expensive shell process. Procmail alone is expensive enough.
+#
+# IF YOU USE THIS TO DELIVER MAIL SYSTEM-WIDE, YOU MUST SET UP AN
+# ALIAS THAT FORWARDS MAIL FOR ROOT TO A REAL USER.
+#
+#mailbox_command = /usr/bin/procmail
+#mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail -a "$EXTENSION"
+
+# The mailbox_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use after processing aliases and .forward files. This parameter
+# has precedence over the mailbox_command, fallback_transport and
+# luser_relay parameters.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+
+# If using the cyrus-imapd IMAP server deliver local mail to the IMAP
+# server using LMTP (Local Mail Transport Protocol), this is prefered
+# over the older cyrus deliver program by setting the
+# mailbox_transport as below:
+#
+# mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#
+# The efficiency of LMTP delivery for cyrus-imapd can be enhanced via
+# these settings.
+#
+# local_destination_recipient_limit = 300
+# local_destination_concurrency_limit = 5
+#
+# Of course you should adjust these settings as appropriate for the
+# capacity of the hardware you are using. The recipient limit setting
+# can be used to take advantage of the single instance message store
+# capability of Cyrus. The concurrency limit can be used to control
+# how many simultaneous LMTP sessions will be permitted to the Cyrus
+# message store.
+#
+# To use the old cyrus deliver program you have to set:
+#mailbox_transport = cyrus
+
+# The fallback_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use for recipients that are not found in the UNIX passwd database.
+# This parameter has precedence over the luser_relay parameter.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#fallback_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#fallback_transport =
+
+#transport_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/transport
+# The luser_relay parameter specifies an optional destination address
+# for unknown recipients. By default, mail for unknown@$mydestination,
+# unknown@[$inet_interfaces] or unknown@[$proxy_interfaces] is returned
+# as undeliverable.
+#
+# The following expansions are done on luser_relay: $user (recipient
+# username), $shell (recipient shell), $home (recipient home directory),
+# $recipient (full recipient address), $extension (recipient address
+# extension), $domain (recipient domain), $local (entire recipient
+# localpart), $recipient_delimiter. Specify ${name?value} or
+# ${name:value} to expand value only when $name does (does not) exist.
+#
+# luser_relay works only for the default Postfix local delivery agent.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must specify "local_recipient_maps =" (i.e. empty) in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#luser_relay = $user@other.host
+#luser_relay = $local@other.host
+#luser_relay = admin+$local
+
+# JUNK MAIL CONTROLS
+#
+# The controls listed here are only a very small subset. The file
+# SMTPD_ACCESS_README provides an overview.
+
+# The header_checks parameter specifies an optional table with patterns
+# that each logical message header is matched against, including
+# headers that span multiple physical lines.
+#
+# By default, these patterns also apply to MIME headers and to the
+# headers of attached messages. With older Postfix versions, MIME and
+# attached message headers were treated as body text.
+#
+# For details, see "man header_checks".
+#
+header_checks = regexp:/etc/postfix/header_checks
+
+# FAST ETRN SERVICE
+#
+# Postfix maintains per-destination logfiles with information about
+# deferred mail, so that mail can be flushed quickly with the SMTP
+# "ETRN domain.tld" command, or by executing "sendmail -qRdomain.tld".
+# See the ETRN_README document for a detailed description.
+#
+# The fast_flush_domains parameter controls what destinations are
+# eligible for this service. By default, they are all domains that
+# this server is willing to relay mail to.
+#
+#fast_flush_domains = $relay_domains
+
+# SHOW SOFTWARE VERSION OR NOT
+#
+# The smtpd_banner parameter specifies the text that follows the 220
+# code in the SMTP server's greeting banner. Some people like to see
+# the mail version advertised. By default, Postfix shows no version.
+#
+# You MUST specify $myhostname at the start of the text. That is an
+# RFC requirement. Postfix itself does not care.
+#
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name ($mail_version)
+
+# PARALLEL DELIVERY TO THE SAME DESTINATION
+#
+# How many parallel deliveries to the same user or domain? With local
+# delivery, it does not make sense to do massively parallel delivery
+# to the same user, because mailbox updates must happen sequentially,
+# and expensive pipelines in .forward files can cause disasters when
+# too many are run at the same time. With SMTP deliveries, 10
+# simultaneous connections to the same domain could be sufficient to
+# raise eyebrows.
+#
+# Each message delivery transport has its XXX_destination_concurrency_limit
+# parameter. The default is $default_destination_concurrency_limit for
+# most delivery transports. For the local delivery agent the default is 2.
+
+#local_destination_concurrency_limit = 2
+#default_destination_concurrency_limit = 20
+
+# DEBUGGING CONTROL
+#
+# The debug_peer_level parameter specifies the increment in verbose
+# logging level when an SMTP client or server host name or address
+# matches a pattern in the debug_peer_list parameter.
+#
+debug_peer_level = 2
+
+# The debug_peer_list parameter specifies an optional list of domain
+# or network patterns, /file/name patterns or type:name tables. When
+# an SMTP client or server host name or address matches a pattern,
+# increase the verbose logging level by the amount specified in the
+# debug_peer_level parameter.
+#
+#debug_peer_list = 127.0.0.1
+#debug_peer_list = some.domain
+
+# The debugger_command specifies the external command that is executed
+# when a Postfix daemon program is run with the -D option.
+#
+# Use "command .. & sleep 5" so that the debugger can attach before
+# the process marches on. If you use an X-based debugger, be sure to
+# set up your XAUTHORITY environment variable before starting Postfix.
+#
+debugger_command =
+ PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin:/usr/X11R6/bin
+ xxgdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id & sleep 5
+
+# If you can't use X, use this to capture the call stack when a
+# daemon crashes. The result is in a file in the configuration
+# directory, and is named after the process name and the process ID.
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin; export PATH; (echo cont;
+# echo where) | gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id 2>&1
+# >$config_directory/$process_name.$process_id.log & sleep 5
+#
+# Another possibility is to run gdb under a detached screen session.
+# To attach to the screen sesssion, su root and run "screen -r
+# <id_string>" where <id_string> uniquely matches one of the detached
+# sessions (from "screen -list").
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/sbin:/usr/sbin; export PATH; screen
+# -dmS $process_name gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name
+# $process_id & sleep 1
+
+# INSTALL-TIME CONFIGURATION INFORMATION
+#
+# The following parameters are used when installing a new Postfix version.
+#
+# sendmail_path: The full pathname of the Postfix sendmail command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible mail posting interface.
+#
+sendmail_path = /usr/sbin/sendmail.postfix
+
+# newaliases_path: The full pathname of the Postfix newaliases command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible command to build alias databases.
+#
+newaliases_path = /usr/bin/newaliases.postfix
+
+# mailq_path: The full pathname of the Postfix mailq command. This
+# is the Sendmail-compatible mail queue listing command.
+#
+mailq_path = /usr/bin/mailq.postfix
+
+# setgid_group: The group for mail submission and queue management
+# commands. This must be a group name with a numerical group ID that
+# is not shared with other accounts, not even with the Postfix account.
+#
+setgid_group = postdrop
+
+# html_directory: The location of the Postfix HTML documentation.
+#
+html_directory = no
+
+# manpage_directory: The location of the Postfix on-line manual pages.
+#
+manpage_directory = /usr/share/man
+
+# sample_directory: The location of the Postfix sample configuration files.
+# This parameter is obsolete as of Postfix 2.1.
+#
+sample_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/samples
+
+# readme_directory: The location of the Postfix README files.
+#
+readme_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/README_FILES
+
+# add this to new postfix to get it to add proper message-id and other
+# headers to outgoing emails via the gateway.
+
+
+message_size_limit = 20971520
+#inet_protocols = ipv4
+
+
+# Mailman, see MTA.rst
+owner_request_special = no
+transport_maps = hash:/var/lib/mailman3/data/postfix_lmtp
+local_recipient_maps = hash:/var/lib/mailman3/data/postfix_lmtp
+relay_domains = hash:/var/lib/mailman3/data/postfix_domains
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.mailman b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.mailman
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..11d1ad0a6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.mailman
@@ -0,0 +1,696 @@
+# "false"
+# Global Postfix configuration file. This file lists only a subset
+# of all parameters. For the syntax, and for a complete parameter
+# list, see the postconf(5) manual page (command: "man 5 postconf").
+#
+# For common configuration examples, see BASIC_CONFIGURATION_README
+# and STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README. To find these documents, use
+# the command "postconf html_directory readme_directory", or go to
+# http://www.postfix.org/.
+#
+# For best results, change no more than 2-3 parameters at a time,
+# and test if Postfix still works after every change.
+
+# SOFT BOUNCE
+#
+# The soft_bounce parameter provides a limited safety net for
+# testing. When soft_bounce is enabled, mail will remain queued that
+# would otherwise bounce. This parameter disables locally-generated
+# bounces, and prevents the SMTP server from rejecting mail permanently
+# (by changing 5xx replies into 4xx replies). However, soft_bounce
+# is no cure for address rewriting mistakes or mail routing mistakes.
+#
+#soft_bounce = no
+
+# LOCAL PATHNAME INFORMATION
+#
+# The queue_directory specifies the location of the Postfix queue.
+# This is also the root directory of Postfix daemons that run chrooted.
+# See the files in examples/chroot-setup for setting up Postfix chroot
+# environments on different UNIX systems.
+#
+queue_directory = /var/spool/postfix
+
+# The command_directory parameter specifies the location of all
+# postXXX commands.
+#
+command_directory = /usr/sbin
+
+# The daemon_directory parameter specifies the location of all Postfix
+# daemon programs (i.e. programs listed in the master.cf file). This
+# directory must be owned by root.
+#
+daemon_directory = /usr/libexec/postfix
+
+# QUEUE AND PROCESS OWNERSHIP
+#
+# The mail_owner parameter specifies the owner of the Postfix queue
+# and of most Postfix daemon processes. Specify the name of a user
+# account THAT DOES NOT SHARE ITS USER OR GROUP ID WITH OTHER ACCOUNTS
+# AND THAT OWNS NO OTHER FILES OR PROCESSES ON THE SYSTEM. In
+# particular, don't specify nobody or daemon. PLEASE USE A DEDICATED
+# USER.
+#
+mail_owner = postfix
+
+# The default_privs parameter specifies the default rights used by
+# the local delivery agent for delivery to external file or command.
+# These rights are used in the absence of a recipient user context.
+# DO NOT SPECIFY A PRIVILEGED USER OR THE POSTFIX OWNER.
+#
+#default_privs = nobody
+
+# INTERNET HOST AND DOMAIN NAMES
+#
+# The myhostname parameter specifies the internet hostname of this
+# mail system. The default is to use the fully-qualified domain name
+# from gethostname(). $myhostname is used as a default value for many
+# other configuration parameters.
+#
+#myhostname = host.domain.tld
+#myhostname = virtual.domain.tld
+
+# The mydomain parameter specifies the local internet domain name.
+# The default is to use $myhostname minus the first component.
+# $mydomain is used as a default value for many other configuration
+# parameters.
+#
+#mydomain = domain.tld
+
+# SENDING MAIL
+#
+# The myorigin parameter specifies the domain that locally-posted
+# mail appears to come from. The default is to append $myhostname,
+# which is fine for small sites. If you run a domain with multiple
+# machines, you should (1) change this to $mydomain and (2) set up
+# a domain-wide alias database that aliases each user to
+# user@that.users.mailhost.
+#
+# For the sake of consistency between sender and recipient addresses,
+# myorigin also specifies the default domain name that is appended
+# to recipient addresses that have no @domain part.
+#
+#myorigin = $myhostname
+#myorigin = $mydomain
+
+mydomain = fedoraproject.org
+myorigin = fedoraproject.org
+
+# RECEIVING MAIL
+
+# The inet_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on. By default,
+# the software claims all active interfaces on the machine. The
+# parameter also controls delivery of mail to user@[ip.address].
+#
+# See also the proxy_interfaces parameter, for network addresses that
+# are forwarded to us via a proxy or network address translator.
+#
+# Note: you need to stop/start Postfix when this parameter changes.
+#
+#inet_interfaces = all
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname, localhost
+inet_interfaces = all
+
+# The proxy_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on by way of a
+# proxy or network address translation unit. This setting extends
+# the address list specified with the inet_interfaces parameter.
+#
+# You must specify your proxy/NAT addresses when your system is a
+# backup MX host for other domains, otherwise mail delivery loops
+# will happen when the primary MX host is down.
+#
+#proxy_interfaces =
+#proxy_interfaces = 1.2.3.4
+
+# The mydestination parameter specifies the list of domains that this
+# machine considers itself the final destination for.
+#
+# These domains are routed to the delivery agent specified with the
+# local_transport parameter setting. By default, that is the UNIX
+# compatible delivery agent that lookups all recipients in /etc/passwd
+# and /etc/aliases or their equivalent.
+#
+# The default is $myhostname + localhost.$mydomain. On a mail domain
+# gateway, you should also include $mydomain.
+#
+# Do not specify the names of virtual domains - those domains are
+# specified elsewhere (see VIRTUAL_README).
+#
+# Do not specify the names of domains that this machine is backup MX
+# host for. Specify those names via the relay_domains settings for
+# the SMTP server, or use permit_mx_backup if you are lazy (see
+# STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README).
+#
+# The local machine is always the final destination for mail addressed
+# to user@[the.net.work.address] of an interface that the mail system
+# receives mail on (see the inet_interfaces parameter).
+#
+# Specify a list of host or domain names, /file/name or type:table
+# patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. A /file/name
+# pattern is replaced by its contents; a type:table is matched when
+# a name matches a lookup key (the right-hand side is ignored).
+# Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.
+#
+# See also below, section "REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS".
+#
+mydestination = $myhostname,
+ localhost.$mydomain, localhost,
+ lists.fedoraproject.org, lists.fedorahosted.org
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain,
+# mail.$mydomain, www.$mydomain, ftp.$mydomain
+
+# REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS
+#
+# The local_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all names or addresses of users that are local with respect
+# to $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown local users. This parameter is defined by default.
+#
+# To turn off local recipient checking in the SMTP server, specify
+# local_recipient_maps = (i.e. empty).
+#
+# The default setting assumes that you use the default Postfix local
+# delivery agent for local delivery. You need to update the
+# local_recipient_maps setting if:
+#
+# - You define $mydestination domain recipients in files other than
+# /etc/passwd, /etc/aliases, or the $virtual_alias_maps files.
+# For example, you define $mydestination domain recipients in
+# the $virtual_mailbox_maps files.
+#
+# - You redefine the local delivery agent in master.cf.
+#
+# - You redefine the "local_transport" setting in main.cf.
+#
+# - You use the "luser_relay", "mailbox_transport", or "fallback_transport"
+# feature of the Postfix local delivery agent (see local(8)).
+#
+# Details are described in the LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README file.
+#
+# Beware: if the Postfix SMTP server runs chrooted, you probably have
+# to access the passwd file via the proxymap service, in order to
+# overcome chroot restrictions. The alternative, having a copy of
+# the system passwd file in the chroot jail is just not practical.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify a bare username, an @domain.tld
+# wild-card, or specify a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#local_recipient_maps = unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps = proxy:unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps =
+
+# The unknown_local_recipient_reject_code specifies the SMTP server
+# response code when a recipient domain matches $mydestination or
+# ${proxy,inet}_interfaces, while $local_recipient_maps is non-empty
+# and the recipient address or address local-part is not found.
+#
+# The default setting is 550 (reject mail) but it is safer to start
+# with 450 (try again later) until you are certain that your
+# local_recipient_maps settings are OK.
+#
+unknown_local_recipient_reject_code = 550
+
+# TRUST AND RELAY CONTROL
+
+# The mynetworks parameter specifies the list of "trusted" SMTP
+# clients that have more privileges than "strangers".
+#
+# In particular, "trusted" SMTP clients are allowed to relay mail
+# through Postfix. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions parameter
+# in postconf(5).
+#
+# You can specify the list of "trusted" network addresses by hand
+# or you can let Postfix do it for you (which is the default).
+#
+# By default (mynetworks_style = subnet), Postfix "trusts" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP subnetworks as the local machine.
+# On Linux, this does works correctly only with interfaces specified
+# with the "ifconfig" command.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = class" when Postfix should "trust" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP class A/B/C networks as the local machine.
+# Don't do this with a dialup site - it would cause Postfix to "trust"
+# your entire provider's network. Instead, specify an explicit
+# mynetworks list by hand, as described below.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = host" when Postfix should "trust"
+# only the local machine.
+#
+#mynetworks_style = class
+#mynetworks_style = subnet
+#mynetworks_style = host
+
+# Alternatively, you can specify the mynetworks list by hand, in
+# which case Postfix ignores the mynetworks_style setting.
+#
+# Specify an explicit list of network/netmask patterns, where the
+# mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host
+# address.
+#
+# You can also specify the absolute pathname of a pattern file instead
+# of listing the patterns here. Specify type:table for table-based lookups
+# (the value on the table right-hand side is not used).
+#
+#mynetworks = 168.100.189.0/28, 127.0.0.0/8
+#mynetworks = $config_directory/mynetworks
+#mynetworks = hash:/etc/postfix/network_table
+
+
+# The relay_domains parameter restricts what destinations this system will
+# relay mail to. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions description in
+# postconf(5) for detailed information.
+#
+# By default, Postfix relays mail
+# - from "trusted" clients (IP address matches $mynetworks) to any destination,
+# - from "untrusted" clients to destinations that match $relay_domains or
+# subdomains thereof, except addresses with sender-specified routing.
+# The default relay_domains value is $mydestination.
+#
+# In addition to the above, the Postfix SMTP server by default accepts mail
+# that Postfix is final destination for:
+# - destinations that match $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces,
+# - destinations that match $mydestination
+# - destinations that match $virtual_alias_domains,
+# - destinations that match $virtual_mailbox_domains.
+# These destinations do not need to be listed in $relay_domains.
+#
+# Specify a list of hosts or domains, /file/name patterns or type:name
+# lookup tables, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue
+# long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. A file name
+# is replaced by its contents; a type:name table is matched when a
+# (parent) domain appears as lookup key.
+#
+# NOTE: Postfix will not automatically forward mail for domains that
+# list this system as their primary or backup MX host. See the
+# permit_mx_backup restriction description in postconf(5).
+#
+#relay_domains = $mydestination
+
+
+
+# INTERNET OR INTRANET
+
+# The relayhost parameter specifies the default host to send mail to
+# when no entry is matched in the optional transport(5) table. When
+# no relayhost is given, mail is routed directly to the destination.
+#
+# On an intranet, specify the organizational domain name. If your
+# internal DNS uses no MX records, specify the name of the intranet
+# gateway host instead.
+#
+# In the case of SMTP, specify a domain, host, host:port, [host]:port,
+# [address] or [address]:port; the form [host] turns off MX lookups.
+#
+# If you're connected via UUCP, see also the default_transport parameter.
+#
+#relayhost = $mydomain
+#relayhost = [gateway.my.domain]
+#relayhost = [mailserver.isp.tld]
+#relayhost = uucphost
+#relayhost = [an.ip.add.ress]
+relayhost = bastion.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+
+
+# REJECTING UNKNOWN RELAY USERS
+#
+# The relay_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all addresses in the domains that match $relay_domains.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown relay users. This feature is off by default.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify an @domain.tld wild-card, or specify
+# a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#relay_recipient_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_recipients
+
+# INPUT RATE CONTROL
+#
+# The in_flow_delay configuration parameter implements mail input
+# flow control. This feature is turned on by default, although it
+# still needs further development (it's disabled on SCO UNIX due
+# to an SCO bug).
+#
+# A Postfix process will pause for $in_flow_delay seconds before
+# accepting a new message, when the message arrival rate exceeds the
+# message delivery rate. With the default 100 SMTP server process
+# limit, this limits the mail inflow to 100 messages a second more
+# than the number of messages delivered per second.
+#
+# Specify 0 to disable the feature. Valid delays are 0..10.
+#
+#in_flow_delay = 1s
+
+# ADDRESS REWRITING
+#
+# The ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document gives information about
+# address masquerading or other forms of address rewriting including
+# username->Firstname.Lastname mapping.
+
+masquerade_domains = redhat.com
+masquerade_exceptions = root apache
+
+# ADDRESS REDIRECTION (VIRTUAL DOMAIN)
+#
+# The VIRTUAL_README document gives information about the many forms
+# of domain hosting that Postfix supports.
+
+# "USER HAS MOVED" BOUNCE MESSAGES
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# TRANSPORT MAP
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# ALIAS DATABASE
+#
+# The alias_maps parameter specifies the list of alias databases used
+# by the local delivery agent. The default list is system dependent.
+#
+# On systems with NIS, the default is to search the local alias
+# database, then the NIS alias database. See aliases(5) for syntax
+# details.
+#
+# If you change the alias database, run "postalias /etc/aliases" (or
+# wherever your system stores the mail alias file), or simply run
+# "newaliases" to build the necessary DBM or DB file.
+#
+# It will take a minute or so before changes become visible. Use
+# "postfix reload" to eliminate the delay.
+#
+#alias_maps = dbm:/etc/aliases
+alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, nis:mail.aliases
+#alias_maps = netinfo:/aliases
+
+# The alias_database parameter specifies the alias database(s) that
+# are built with "newaliases" or "sendmail -bi". This is a separate
+# configuration parameter, because alias_maps (see above) may specify
+# tables that are not necessarily all under control by Postfix.
+#
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/mail/aliases
+alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases, hash:/opt/majordomo/aliases
+
+# ADDRESS EXTENSIONS (e.g., user+foo)
+#
+# The recipient_delimiter parameter specifies the separator between
+# user names and address extensions (user+foo). See canonical(5),
+# local(8), relocated(5) and virtual(5) for the effects this has on
+# aliases, canonical, virtual, relocated and .forward file lookups.
+# Basically, the software tries user+foo and .forward+foo before
+# trying user and .forward.
+#
+recipient_delimiter = +
+
+# DELIVERY TO MAILBOX
+#
+# The home_mailbox parameter specifies the optional pathname of a
+# mailbox file relative to a user's home directory. The default
+# mailbox file is /var/spool/mail/user or /var/mail/user. Specify
+# "Maildir/" for qmail-style delivery (the / is required).
+#
+#home_mailbox = Mailbox
+#home_mailbox = Maildir/
+
+# The mail_spool_directory parameter specifies the directory where
+# UNIX-style mailboxes are kept. The default setting depends on the
+# system type.
+#
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/mail
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/spool/mail
+
+# The mailbox_command parameter specifies the optional external
+# command to use instead of mailbox delivery. The command is run as
+# the recipient with proper HOME, SHELL and LOGNAME environment settings.
+# Exception: delivery for root is done as $default_user.
+#
+# Other environment variables of interest: USER (recipient username),
+# EXTENSION (address extension), DOMAIN (domain part of address),
+# and LOCAL (the address localpart).
+#
+# Unlike other Postfix configuration parameters, the mailbox_command
+# parameter is not subjected to $parameter substitutions. This is to
+# make it easier to specify shell syntax (see example below).
+#
+# Avoid shell meta characters because they will force Postfix to run
+# an expensive shell process. Procmail alone is expensive enough.
+#
+# IF YOU USE THIS TO DELIVER MAIL SYSTEM-WIDE, YOU MUST SET UP AN
+# ALIAS THAT FORWARDS MAIL FOR ROOT TO A REAL USER.
+#
+#mailbox_command = /usr/bin/procmail
+#mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail -a "$EXTENSION"
+
+# The mailbox_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use after processing aliases and .forward files. This parameter
+# has precedence over the mailbox_command, fallback_transport and
+# luser_relay parameters.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+
+# If using the cyrus-imapd IMAP server deliver local mail to the IMAP
+# server using LMTP (Local Mail Transport Protocol), this is prefered
+# over the older cyrus deliver program by setting the
+# mailbox_transport as below:
+#
+# mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#
+# The efficiency of LMTP delivery for cyrus-imapd can be enhanced via
+# these settings.
+#
+# local_destination_recipient_limit = 300
+# local_destination_concurrency_limit = 5
+#
+# Of course you should adjust these settings as appropriate for the
+# capacity of the hardware you are using. The recipient limit setting
+# can be used to take advantage of the single instance message store
+# capability of Cyrus. The concurrency limit can be used to control
+# how many simultaneous LMTP sessions will be permitted to the Cyrus
+# message store.
+#
+# To use the old cyrus deliver program you have to set:
+#mailbox_transport = cyrus
+
+# The fallback_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use for recipients that are not found in the UNIX passwd database.
+# This parameter has precedence over the luser_relay parameter.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#fallback_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#fallback_transport =
+
+#transport_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/transport
+# The luser_relay parameter specifies an optional destination address
+# for unknown recipients. By default, mail for unknown@$mydestination,
+# unknown@[$inet_interfaces] or unknown@[$proxy_interfaces] is returned
+# as undeliverable.
+#
+# The following expansions are done on luser_relay: $user (recipient
+# username), $shell (recipient shell), $home (recipient home directory),
+# $recipient (full recipient address), $extension (recipient address
+# extension), $domain (recipient domain), $local (entire recipient
+# localpart), $recipient_delimiter. Specify ${name?value} or
+# ${name:value} to expand value only when $name does (does not) exist.
+#
+# luser_relay works only for the default Postfix local delivery agent.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must specify "local_recipient_maps =" (i.e. empty) in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#luser_relay = $user@other.host
+#luser_relay = $local@other.host
+#luser_relay = admin+$local
+
+# JUNK MAIL CONTROLS
+#
+# The controls listed here are only a very small subset. The file
+# SMTPD_ACCESS_README provides an overview.
+
+# The header_checks parameter specifies an optional table with patterns
+# that each logical message header is matched against, including
+# headers that span multiple physical lines.
+#
+# By default, these patterns also apply to MIME headers and to the
+# headers of attached messages. With older Postfix versions, MIME and
+# attached message headers were treated as body text.
+#
+# For details, see "man header_checks".
+#
+header_checks = regexp:/etc/postfix/header_checks
+
+# FAST ETRN SERVICE
+#
+# Postfix maintains per-destination logfiles with information about
+# deferred mail, so that mail can be flushed quickly with the SMTP
+# "ETRN domain.tld" command, or by executing "sendmail -qRdomain.tld".
+# See the ETRN_README document for a detailed description.
+#
+# The fast_flush_domains parameter controls what destinations are
+# eligible for this service. By default, they are all domains that
+# this server is willing to relay mail to.
+#
+#fast_flush_domains = $relay_domains
+
+# SHOW SOFTWARE VERSION OR NOT
+#
+# The smtpd_banner parameter specifies the text that follows the 220
+# code in the SMTP server's greeting banner. Some people like to see
+# the mail version advertised. By default, Postfix shows no version.
+#
+# You MUST specify $myhostname at the start of the text. That is an
+# RFC requirement. Postfix itself does not care.
+#
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name ($mail_version)
+
+# PARALLEL DELIVERY TO THE SAME DESTINATION
+#
+# How many parallel deliveries to the same user or domain? With local
+# delivery, it does not make sense to do massively parallel delivery
+# to the same user, because mailbox updates must happen sequentially,
+# and expensive pipelines in .forward files can cause disasters when
+# too many are run at the same time. With SMTP deliveries, 10
+# simultaneous connections to the same domain could be sufficient to
+# raise eyebrows.
+#
+# Each message delivery transport has its XXX_destination_concurrency_limit
+# parameter. The default is $default_destination_concurrency_limit for
+# most delivery transports. For the local delivery agent the default is 2.
+
+#local_destination_concurrency_limit = 2
+#default_destination_concurrency_limit = 20
+
+# DEBUGGING CONTROL
+#
+# The debug_peer_level parameter specifies the increment in verbose
+# logging level when an SMTP client or server host name or address
+# matches a pattern in the debug_peer_list parameter.
+#
+debug_peer_level = 2
+
+# The debug_peer_list parameter specifies an optional list of domain
+# or network patterns, /file/name patterns or type:name tables. When
+# an SMTP client or server host name or address matches a pattern,
+# increase the verbose logging level by the amount specified in the
+# debug_peer_level parameter.
+#
+#debug_peer_list = 127.0.0.1
+#debug_peer_list = some.domain
+
+# The debugger_command specifies the external command that is executed
+# when a Postfix daemon program is run with the -D option.
+#
+# Use "command .. & sleep 5" so that the debugger can attach before
+# the process marches on. If you use an X-based debugger, be sure to
+# set up your XAUTHORITY environment variable before starting Postfix.
+#
+debugger_command =
+ PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin:/usr/X11R6/bin
+ xxgdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id & sleep 5
+
+# If you can't use X, use this to capture the call stack when a
+# daemon crashes. The result is in a file in the configuration
+# directory, and is named after the process name and the process ID.
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin; export PATH; (echo cont;
+# echo where) | gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id 2>&1
+# >$config_directory/$process_name.$process_id.log & sleep 5
+#
+# Another possibility is to run gdb under a detached screen session.
+# To attach to the screen sesssion, su root and run "screen -r
+# <id_string>" where <id_string> uniquely matches one of the detached
+# sessions (from "screen -list").
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/sbin:/usr/sbin; export PATH; screen
+# -dmS $process_name gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name
+# $process_id & sleep 1
+
+# INSTALL-TIME CONFIGURATION INFORMATION
+#
+# The following parameters are used when installing a new Postfix version.
+#
+# sendmail_path: The full pathname of the Postfix sendmail command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible mail posting interface.
+#
+sendmail_path = /usr/sbin/sendmail.postfix
+
+# newaliases_path: The full pathname of the Postfix newaliases command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible command to build alias databases.
+#
+newaliases_path = /usr/bin/newaliases.postfix
+
+# mailq_path: The full pathname of the Postfix mailq command. This
+# is the Sendmail-compatible mail queue listing command.
+#
+mailq_path = /usr/bin/mailq.postfix
+
+# setgid_group: The group for mail submission and queue management
+# commands. This must be a group name with a numerical group ID that
+# is not shared with other accounts, not even with the Postfix account.
+#
+setgid_group = postdrop
+
+# html_directory: The location of the Postfix HTML documentation.
+#
+html_directory = no
+
+# manpage_directory: The location of the Postfix on-line manual pages.
+#
+manpage_directory = /usr/share/man
+
+# sample_directory: The location of the Postfix sample configuration files.
+# This parameter is obsolete as of Postfix 2.1.
+#
+sample_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/samples
+
+# readme_directory: The location of the Postfix README files.
+#
+readme_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/README_FILES
+
+# add this to new postfix to get it to add proper message-id and other
+# headers to outgoing emails via the gateway.
+
+
+message_size_limit = 20971520
+#inet_protocols = ipv4
+
+
+# Mailman, see MTA.rst
+owner_request_special = no
+transport_maps = hash:/var/lib/mailman3/data/postfix_lmtp
+local_recipient_maps = hash:/var/lib/mailman3/data/postfix_lmtp
+relay_domains = hash:/var/lib/mailman3/data/postfix_domains
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.mailman01.stg.phx2.fedoraproject.org b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.mailman01.stg.phx2.fedoraproject.org
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..97f4ecec2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.mailman01.stg.phx2.fedoraproject.org
@@ -0,0 +1,694 @@
+# "false"
+# Global Postfix configuration file. This file lists only a subset
+# of all parameters. For the syntax, and for a complete parameter
+# list, see the postconf(5) manual page (command: "man 5 postconf").
+#
+# For common configuration examples, see BASIC_CONFIGURATION_README
+# and STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README. To find these documents, use
+# the command "postconf html_directory readme_directory", or go to
+# http://www.postfix.org/.
+#
+# For best results, change no more than 2-3 parameters at a time,
+# and test if Postfix still works after every change.
+
+# SOFT BOUNCE
+#
+# The soft_bounce parameter provides a limited safety net for
+# testing. When soft_bounce is enabled, mail will remain queued that
+# would otherwise bounce. This parameter disables locally-generated
+# bounces, and prevents the SMTP server from rejecting mail permanently
+# (by changing 5xx replies into 4xx replies). However, soft_bounce
+# is no cure for address rewriting mistakes or mail routing mistakes.
+#
+#soft_bounce = no
+
+# LOCAL PATHNAME INFORMATION
+#
+# The queue_directory specifies the location of the Postfix queue.
+# This is also the root directory of Postfix daemons that run chrooted.
+# See the files in examples/chroot-setup for setting up Postfix chroot
+# environments on different UNIX systems.
+#
+queue_directory = /var/spool/postfix
+
+# The command_directory parameter specifies the location of all
+# postXXX commands.
+#
+command_directory = /usr/sbin
+
+# The daemon_directory parameter specifies the location of all Postfix
+# daemon programs (i.e. programs listed in the master.cf file). This
+# directory must be owned by root.
+#
+daemon_directory = /usr/libexec/postfix
+
+# QUEUE AND PROCESS OWNERSHIP
+#
+# The mail_owner parameter specifies the owner of the Postfix queue
+# and of most Postfix daemon processes. Specify the name of a user
+# account THAT DOES NOT SHARE ITS USER OR GROUP ID WITH OTHER ACCOUNTS
+# AND THAT OWNS NO OTHER FILES OR PROCESSES ON THE SYSTEM. In
+# particular, don't specify nobody or daemon. PLEASE USE A DEDICATED
+# USER.
+#
+mail_owner = postfix
+
+# The default_privs parameter specifies the default rights used by
+# the local delivery agent for delivery to external file or command.
+# These rights are used in the absence of a recipient user context.
+# DO NOT SPECIFY A PRIVILEGED USER OR THE POSTFIX OWNER.
+#
+#default_privs = nobody
+
+# INTERNET HOST AND DOMAIN NAMES
+#
+# The myhostname parameter specifies the internet hostname of this
+# mail system. The default is to use the fully-qualified domain name
+# from gethostname(). $myhostname is used as a default value for many
+# other configuration parameters.
+#
+#myhostname = host.domain.tld
+#myhostname = virtual.domain.tld
+
+# The mydomain parameter specifies the local internet domain name.
+# The default is to use $myhostname minus the first component.
+# $mydomain is used as a default value for many other configuration
+# parameters.
+#
+#mydomain = domain.tld
+
+# SENDING MAIL
+#
+# The myorigin parameter specifies the domain that locally-posted
+# mail appears to come from. The default is to append $myhostname,
+# which is fine for small sites. If you run a domain with multiple
+# machines, you should (1) change this to $mydomain and (2) set up
+# a domain-wide alias database that aliases each user to
+# user@that.users.mailhost.
+#
+# For the sake of consistency between sender and recipient addresses,
+# myorigin also specifies the default domain name that is appended
+# to recipient addresses that have no @domain part.
+#
+#myorigin = $myhostname
+#myorigin = $mydomain
+
+mydomain = stg.fedoraproject.org
+myorigin = stg.fedoraproject.org
+
+# RECEIVING MAIL
+
+# The inet_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on. By default,
+# the software claims all active interfaces on the machine. The
+# parameter also controls delivery of mail to user@[ip.address].
+#
+# See also the proxy_interfaces parameter, for network addresses that
+# are forwarded to us via a proxy or network address translator.
+#
+# Note: you need to stop/start Postfix when this parameter changes.
+#
+#inet_interfaces = all
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname, localhost
+inet_interfaces = all
+
+# The proxy_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on by way of a
+# proxy or network address translation unit. This setting extends
+# the address list specified with the inet_interfaces parameter.
+#
+# You must specify your proxy/NAT addresses when your system is a
+# backup MX host for other domains, otherwise mail delivery loops
+# will happen when the primary MX host is down.
+#
+#proxy_interfaces =
+#proxy_interfaces = 1.2.3.4
+
+# The mydestination parameter specifies the list of domains that this
+# machine considers itself the final destination for.
+#
+# These domains are routed to the delivery agent specified with the
+# local_transport parameter setting. By default, that is the UNIX
+# compatible delivery agent that lookups all recipients in /etc/passwd
+# and /etc/aliases or their equivalent.
+#
+# The default is $myhostname + localhost.$mydomain. On a mail domain
+# gateway, you should also include $mydomain.
+#
+# Do not specify the names of virtual domains - those domains are
+# specified elsewhere (see VIRTUAL_README).
+#
+# Do not specify the names of domains that this machine is backup MX
+# host for. Specify those names via the relay_domains settings for
+# the SMTP server, or use permit_mx_backup if you are lazy (see
+# STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README).
+#
+# The local machine is always the final destination for mail addressed
+# to user@[the.net.work.address] of an interface that the mail system
+# receives mail on (see the inet_interfaces parameter).
+#
+# Specify a list of host or domain names, /file/name or type:table
+# patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. A /file/name
+# pattern is replaced by its contents; a type:table is matched when
+# a name matches a lookup key (the right-hand side is ignored).
+# Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.
+#
+# See also below, section "REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS".
+#
+mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, fedora.redhat.com, localhost, lists.stg.fedoraproject.org,
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain,
+# mail.$mydomain, www.$mydomain, ftp.$mydomain
+
+# REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS
+#
+# The local_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all names or addresses of users that are local with respect
+# to $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown local users. This parameter is defined by default.
+#
+# To turn off local recipient checking in the SMTP server, specify
+# local_recipient_maps = (i.e. empty).
+#
+# The default setting assumes that you use the default Postfix local
+# delivery agent for local delivery. You need to update the
+# local_recipient_maps setting if:
+#
+# - You define $mydestination domain recipients in files other than
+# /etc/passwd, /etc/aliases, or the $virtual_alias_maps files.
+# For example, you define $mydestination domain recipients in
+# the $virtual_mailbox_maps files.
+#
+# - You redefine the local delivery agent in master.cf.
+#
+# - You redefine the "local_transport" setting in main.cf.
+#
+# - You use the "luser_relay", "mailbox_transport", or "fallback_transport"
+# feature of the Postfix local delivery agent (see local(8)).
+#
+# Details are described in the LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README file.
+#
+# Beware: if the Postfix SMTP server runs chrooted, you probably have
+# to access the passwd file via the proxymap service, in order to
+# overcome chroot restrictions. The alternative, having a copy of
+# the system passwd file in the chroot jail is just not practical.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify a bare username, an @domain.tld
+# wild-card, or specify a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#local_recipient_maps = unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps = proxy:unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps =
+
+# The unknown_local_recipient_reject_code specifies the SMTP server
+# response code when a recipient domain matches $mydestination or
+# ${proxy,inet}_interfaces, while $local_recipient_maps is non-empty
+# and the recipient address or address local-part is not found.
+#
+# The default setting is 550 (reject mail) but it is safer to start
+# with 450 (try again later) until you are certain that your
+# local_recipient_maps settings are OK.
+#
+unknown_local_recipient_reject_code = 550
+
+# TRUST AND RELAY CONTROL
+
+# The mynetworks parameter specifies the list of "trusted" SMTP
+# clients that have more privileges than "strangers".
+#
+# In particular, "trusted" SMTP clients are allowed to relay mail
+# through Postfix. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions parameter
+# in postconf(5).
+#
+# You can specify the list of "trusted" network addresses by hand
+# or you can let Postfix do it for you (which is the default).
+#
+# By default (mynetworks_style = subnet), Postfix "trusts" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP subnetworks as the local machine.
+# On Linux, this does works correctly only with interfaces specified
+# with the "ifconfig" command.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = class" when Postfix should "trust" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP class A/B/C networks as the local machine.
+# Don't do this with a dialup site - it would cause Postfix to "trust"
+# your entire provider's network. Instead, specify an explicit
+# mynetworks list by hand, as described below.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = host" when Postfix should "trust"
+# only the local machine.
+#
+#mynetworks_style = class
+#mynetworks_style = subnet
+#mynetworks_style = host
+
+# Alternatively, you can specify the mynetworks list by hand, in
+# which case Postfix ignores the mynetworks_style setting.
+#
+# Specify an explicit list of network/netmask patterns, where the
+# mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host
+# address.
+#
+# You can also specify the absolute pathname of a pattern file instead
+# of listing the patterns here. Specify type:table for table-based lookups
+# (the value on the table right-hand side is not used).
+#
+#mynetworks = 168.100.189.0/28, 127.0.0.0/8
+#mynetworks = $config_directory/mynetworks
+#mynetworks = hash:/etc/postfix/network_table
+
+
+# The relay_domains parameter restricts what destinations this system will
+# relay mail to. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions description in
+# postconf(5) for detailed information.
+#
+# By default, Postfix relays mail
+# - from "trusted" clients (IP address matches $mynetworks) to any destination,
+# - from "untrusted" clients to destinations that match $relay_domains or
+# subdomains thereof, except addresses with sender-specified routing.
+# The default relay_domains value is $mydestination.
+#
+# In addition to the above, the Postfix SMTP server by default accepts mail
+# that Postfix is final destination for:
+# - destinations that match $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces,
+# - destinations that match $mydestination
+# - destinations that match $virtual_alias_domains,
+# - destinations that match $virtual_mailbox_domains.
+# These destinations do not need to be listed in $relay_domains.
+#
+# Specify a list of hosts or domains, /file/name patterns or type:name
+# lookup tables, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue
+# long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. A file name
+# is replaced by its contents; a type:name table is matched when a
+# (parent) domain appears as lookup key.
+#
+# NOTE: Postfix will not automatically forward mail for domains that
+# list this system as their primary or backup MX host. See the
+# permit_mx_backup restriction description in postconf(5).
+#
+#relay_domains = $mydestination
+
+
+
+# INTERNET OR INTRANET
+
+# The relayhost parameter specifies the default host to send mail to
+# when no entry is matched in the optional transport(5) table. When
+# no relayhost is given, mail is routed directly to the destination.
+#
+# On an intranet, specify the organizational domain name. If your
+# internal DNS uses no MX records, specify the name of the intranet
+# gateway host instead.
+#
+# In the case of SMTP, specify a domain, host, host:port, [host]:port,
+# [address] or [address]:port; the form [host] turns off MX lookups.
+#
+# If you're connected via UUCP, see also the default_transport parameter.
+#
+#relayhost = $mydomain
+#relayhost = [gateway.my.domain]
+#relayhost = [mailserver.isp.tld]
+#relayhost = uucphost
+#relayhost = [an.ip.add.ress]
+relayhost = bastion.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+
+
+# REJECTING UNKNOWN RELAY USERS
+#
+# The relay_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all addresses in the domains that match $relay_domains.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown relay users. This feature is off by default.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify an @domain.tld wild-card, or specify
+# a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#relay_recipient_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_recipients
+
+# INPUT RATE CONTROL
+#
+# The in_flow_delay configuration parameter implements mail input
+# flow control. This feature is turned on by default, although it
+# still needs further development (it's disabled on SCO UNIX due
+# to an SCO bug).
+#
+# A Postfix process will pause for $in_flow_delay seconds before
+# accepting a new message, when the message arrival rate exceeds the
+# message delivery rate. With the default 100 SMTP server process
+# limit, this limits the mail inflow to 100 messages a second more
+# than the number of messages delivered per second.
+#
+# Specify 0 to disable the feature. Valid delays are 0..10.
+#
+#in_flow_delay = 1s
+
+# ADDRESS REWRITING
+#
+# The ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document gives information about
+# address masquerading or other forms of address rewriting including
+# username->Firstname.Lastname mapping.
+
+masquerade_domains = redhat.com
+masquerade_exceptions = root apache
+
+# ADDRESS REDIRECTION (VIRTUAL DOMAIN)
+#
+# The VIRTUAL_README document gives information about the many forms
+# of domain hosting that Postfix supports.
+
+# "USER HAS MOVED" BOUNCE MESSAGES
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# TRANSPORT MAP
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# ALIAS DATABASE
+#
+# The alias_maps parameter specifies the list of alias databases used
+# by the local delivery agent. The default list is system dependent.
+#
+# On systems with NIS, the default is to search the local alias
+# database, then the NIS alias database. See aliases(5) for syntax
+# details.
+#
+# If you change the alias database, run "postalias /etc/aliases" (or
+# wherever your system stores the mail alias file), or simply run
+# "newaliases" to build the necessary DBM or DB file.
+#
+# It will take a minute or so before changes become visible. Use
+# "postfix reload" to eliminate the delay.
+#
+#alias_maps = dbm:/etc/aliases
+alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, nis:mail.aliases
+#alias_maps = netinfo:/aliases
+
+# The alias_database parameter specifies the alias database(s) that
+# are built with "newaliases" or "sendmail -bi". This is a separate
+# configuration parameter, because alias_maps (see above) may specify
+# tables that are not necessarily all under control by Postfix.
+#
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/mail/aliases
+alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases, hash:/opt/majordomo/aliases
+
+# ADDRESS EXTENSIONS (e.g., user+foo)
+#
+# The recipient_delimiter parameter specifies the separator between
+# user names and address extensions (user+foo). See canonical(5),
+# local(8), relocated(5) and virtual(5) for the effects this has on
+# aliases, canonical, virtual, relocated and .forward file lookups.
+# Basically, the software tries user+foo and .forward+foo before
+# trying user and .forward.
+#
+recipient_delimiter = +
+
+# DELIVERY TO MAILBOX
+#
+# The home_mailbox parameter specifies the optional pathname of a
+# mailbox file relative to a user's home directory. The default
+# mailbox file is /var/spool/mail/user or /var/mail/user. Specify
+# "Maildir/" for qmail-style delivery (the / is required).
+#
+#home_mailbox = Mailbox
+#home_mailbox = Maildir/
+
+# The mail_spool_directory parameter specifies the directory where
+# UNIX-style mailboxes are kept. The default setting depends on the
+# system type.
+#
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/mail
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/spool/mail
+
+# The mailbox_command parameter specifies the optional external
+# command to use instead of mailbox delivery. The command is run as
+# the recipient with proper HOME, SHELL and LOGNAME environment settings.
+# Exception: delivery for root is done as $default_user.
+#
+# Other environment variables of interest: USER (recipient username),
+# EXTENSION (address extension), DOMAIN (domain part of address),
+# and LOCAL (the address localpart).
+#
+# Unlike other Postfix configuration parameters, the mailbox_command
+# parameter is not subjected to $parameter substitutions. This is to
+# make it easier to specify shell syntax (see example below).
+#
+# Avoid shell meta characters because they will force Postfix to run
+# an expensive shell process. Procmail alone is expensive enough.
+#
+# IF YOU USE THIS TO DELIVER MAIL SYSTEM-WIDE, YOU MUST SET UP AN
+# ALIAS THAT FORWARDS MAIL FOR ROOT TO A REAL USER.
+#
+#mailbox_command = /usr/bin/procmail
+#mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail -a "$EXTENSION"
+
+# The mailbox_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use after processing aliases and .forward files. This parameter
+# has precedence over the mailbox_command, fallback_transport and
+# luser_relay parameters.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+
+# If using the cyrus-imapd IMAP server deliver local mail to the IMAP
+# server using LMTP (Local Mail Transport Protocol), this is prefered
+# over the older cyrus deliver program by setting the
+# mailbox_transport as below:
+#
+# mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#
+# The efficiency of LMTP delivery for cyrus-imapd can be enhanced via
+# these settings.
+#
+# local_destination_recipient_limit = 300
+# local_destination_concurrency_limit = 5
+#
+# Of course you should adjust these settings as appropriate for the
+# capacity of the hardware you are using. The recipient limit setting
+# can be used to take advantage of the single instance message store
+# capability of Cyrus. The concurrency limit can be used to control
+# how many simultaneous LMTP sessions will be permitted to the Cyrus
+# message store.
+#
+# To use the old cyrus deliver program you have to set:
+#mailbox_transport = cyrus
+
+# The fallback_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use for recipients that are not found in the UNIX passwd database.
+# This parameter has precedence over the luser_relay parameter.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#fallback_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#fallback_transport =
+
+#transport_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/transport
+# The luser_relay parameter specifies an optional destination address
+# for unknown recipients. By default, mail for unknown@$mydestination,
+# unknown@[$inet_interfaces] or unknown@[$proxy_interfaces] is returned
+# as undeliverable.
+#
+# The following expansions are done on luser_relay: $user (recipient
+# username), $shell (recipient shell), $home (recipient home directory),
+# $recipient (full recipient address), $extension (recipient address
+# extension), $domain (recipient domain), $local (entire recipient
+# localpart), $recipient_delimiter. Specify ${name?value} or
+# ${name:value} to expand value only when $name does (does not) exist.
+#
+# luser_relay works only for the default Postfix local delivery agent.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must specify "local_recipient_maps =" (i.e. empty) in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#luser_relay = $user@other.host
+#luser_relay = $local@other.host
+#luser_relay = admin+$local
+
+# JUNK MAIL CONTROLS
+#
+# The controls listed here are only a very small subset. The file
+# SMTPD_ACCESS_README provides an overview.
+
+# The header_checks parameter specifies an optional table with patterns
+# that each logical message header is matched against, including
+# headers that span multiple physical lines.
+#
+# By default, these patterns also apply to MIME headers and to the
+# headers of attached messages. With older Postfix versions, MIME and
+# attached message headers were treated as body text.
+#
+# For details, see "man header_checks".
+#
+header_checks = regexp:/etc/postfix/header_checks
+
+# FAST ETRN SERVICE
+#
+# Postfix maintains per-destination logfiles with information about
+# deferred mail, so that mail can be flushed quickly with the SMTP
+# "ETRN domain.tld" command, or by executing "sendmail -qRdomain.tld".
+# See the ETRN_README document for a detailed description.
+#
+# The fast_flush_domains parameter controls what destinations are
+# eligible for this service. By default, they are all domains that
+# this server is willing to relay mail to.
+#
+#fast_flush_domains = $relay_domains
+
+# SHOW SOFTWARE VERSION OR NOT
+#
+# The smtpd_banner parameter specifies the text that follows the 220
+# code in the SMTP server's greeting banner. Some people like to see
+# the mail version advertised. By default, Postfix shows no version.
+#
+# You MUST specify $myhostname at the start of the text. That is an
+# RFC requirement. Postfix itself does not care.
+#
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name ($mail_version)
+
+# PARALLEL DELIVERY TO THE SAME DESTINATION
+#
+# How many parallel deliveries to the same user or domain? With local
+# delivery, it does not make sense to do massively parallel delivery
+# to the same user, because mailbox updates must happen sequentially,
+# and expensive pipelines in .forward files can cause disasters when
+# too many are run at the same time. With SMTP deliveries, 10
+# simultaneous connections to the same domain could be sufficient to
+# raise eyebrows.
+#
+# Each message delivery transport has its XXX_destination_concurrency_limit
+# parameter. The default is $default_destination_concurrency_limit for
+# most delivery transports. For the local delivery agent the default is 2.
+
+#local_destination_concurrency_limit = 2
+#default_destination_concurrency_limit = 20
+
+# DEBUGGING CONTROL
+#
+# The debug_peer_level parameter specifies the increment in verbose
+# logging level when an SMTP client or server host name or address
+# matches a pattern in the debug_peer_list parameter.
+#
+debug_peer_level = 2
+
+# The debug_peer_list parameter specifies an optional list of domain
+# or network patterns, /file/name patterns or type:name tables. When
+# an SMTP client or server host name or address matches a pattern,
+# increase the verbose logging level by the amount specified in the
+# debug_peer_level parameter.
+#
+#debug_peer_list = 127.0.0.1
+#debug_peer_list = some.domain
+
+# The debugger_command specifies the external command that is executed
+# when a Postfix daemon program is run with the -D option.
+#
+# Use "command .. & sleep 5" so that the debugger can attach before
+# the process marches on. If you use an X-based debugger, be sure to
+# set up your XAUTHORITY environment variable before starting Postfix.
+#
+debugger_command =
+ PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin:/usr/X11R6/bin
+ xxgdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id & sleep 5
+
+# If you can't use X, use this to capture the call stack when a
+# daemon crashes. The result is in a file in the configuration
+# directory, and is named after the process name and the process ID.
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin; export PATH; (echo cont;
+# echo where) | gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id 2>&1
+# >$config_directory/$process_name.$process_id.log & sleep 5
+#
+# Another possibility is to run gdb under a detached screen session.
+# To attach to the screen sesssion, su root and run "screen -r
+# <id_string>" where <id_string> uniquely matches one of the detached
+# sessions (from "screen -list").
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/sbin:/usr/sbin; export PATH; screen
+# -dmS $process_name gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name
+# $process_id & sleep 1
+
+# INSTALL-TIME CONFIGURATION INFORMATION
+#
+# The following parameters are used when installing a new Postfix version.
+#
+# sendmail_path: The full pathname of the Postfix sendmail command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible mail posting interface.
+#
+sendmail_path = /usr/sbin/sendmail.postfix
+
+# newaliases_path: The full pathname of the Postfix newaliases command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible command to build alias databases.
+#
+newaliases_path = /usr/bin/newaliases.postfix
+
+# mailq_path: The full pathname of the Postfix mailq command. This
+# is the Sendmail-compatible mail queue listing command.
+#
+mailq_path = /usr/bin/mailq.postfix
+
+# setgid_group: The group for mail submission and queue management
+# commands. This must be a group name with a numerical group ID that
+# is not shared with other accounts, not even with the Postfix account.
+#
+setgid_group = postdrop
+
+# html_directory: The location of the Postfix HTML documentation.
+#
+html_directory = no
+
+# manpage_directory: The location of the Postfix on-line manual pages.
+#
+manpage_directory = /usr/share/man
+
+# sample_directory: The location of the Postfix sample configuration files.
+# This parameter is obsolete as of Postfix 2.1.
+#
+sample_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/samples
+
+# readme_directory: The location of the Postfix README files.
+#
+readme_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/README_FILES
+
+smtp_host_lookup = native,dns
+
+# add this to new postfix to get it to add proper message-id and other
+# headers to outgoing emails via the gateway.
+
+message_size_limit = 20971520
+
+
+# Mailman, see MTA.rst
+owner_request_special = no
+transport_maps = hash:/var/lib/mailman3/data/postfix_lmtp
+local_recipient_maps = hash:/var/lib/mailman3/data/postfix_lmtp
+relay_domains = hash:/var/lib/mailman3/data/postfix_domains
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.noc02.fedoraproject.org b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.noc02.fedoraproject.org
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..a0680ed17
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.noc02.fedoraproject.org
@@ -0,0 +1,698 @@
+# Global Postfix configuration file. This file lists only a subset
+# of all parameters. For the syntax, and for a complete parameter
+# list, see the postconf(5) manual page (command: "man 5 postconf").
+#
+# For common configuration examples, see BASIC_CONFIGURATION_README
+# and STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README. To find these documents, use
+# the command "postconf html_directory readme_directory", or go to
+# http://www.postfix.org/.
+#
+# For best results, change no more than 2-3 parameters at a time,
+# and test if Postfix still works after every change.
+
+# Custom rules
+
+# SOFT BOUNCE
+#
+# The soft_bounce parameter provides a limited safety net for
+# testing. When soft_bounce is enabled, mail will remain queued that
+# would otherwise bounce. This parameter disables locally-generated
+# bounces, and prevents the SMTP server from rejecting mail permanently
+# (by changing 5xx replies into 4xx replies). However, soft_bounce
+# is no cure for address rewriting mistakes or mail routing mistakes.
+#
+#soft_bounce = no
+
+# LOCAL PATHNAME INFORMATION
+#
+# The queue_directory specifies the location of the Postfix queue.
+# This is also the root directory of Postfix daemons that run chrooted.
+# See the files in examples/chroot-setup for setting up Postfix chroot
+# environments on different UNIX systems.
+#
+queue_directory = /var/spool/postfix
+
+# The command_directory parameter specifies the location of all
+# postXXX commands.
+#
+command_directory = /usr/sbin
+
+# The daemon_directory parameter specifies the location of all Postfix
+# daemon programs (i.e. programs listed in the master.cf file). This
+# directory must be owned by root.
+#
+daemon_directory = /usr/libexec/postfix
+
+# The data_directory parameter specifies the location of Postfix-writable
+# data files (caches, random numbers). This directory must be owned
+# by the mail_owner account (see below).
+#
+data_directory = /var/lib/postfix
+
+# QUEUE AND PROCESS OWNERSHIP
+#
+# The mail_owner parameter specifies the owner of the Postfix queue
+# and of most Postfix daemon processes. Specify the name of a user
+# account THAT DOES NOT SHARE ITS USER OR GROUP ID WITH OTHER ACCOUNTS
+# AND THAT OWNS NO OTHER FILES OR PROCESSES ON THE SYSTEM. In
+# particular, don't specify nobody or daemon. PLEASE USE A DEDICATED
+# USER.
+#
+mail_owner = postfix
+
+# The default_privs parameter specifies the default rights used by
+# the local delivery agent for delivery to external file or command.
+# These rights are used in the absence of a recipient user context.
+# DO NOT SPECIFY A PRIVILEGED USER OR THE POSTFIX OWNER.
+#
+#default_privs = nobody
+
+# INTERNET HOST AND DOMAIN NAMES
+#
+# The myhostname parameter specifies the internet hostname of this
+# mail system. The default is to use the fully-qualified domain name
+# from gethostname(). $myhostname is used as a default value for many
+# other configuration parameters.
+#
+#myhostname = host.domain.tld
+#myhostname = virtual.domain.tld
+
+
+smtp_helo_name = noc02.fedoraproject.org
+
+# The mydomain parameter specifies the local internet domain name.
+# The default is to use $myhostname minus the first component.
+# $mydomain is used as a default value for many other configuration
+# parameters.
+#
+#mydomain = domain.tld
+
+mydomain = fedoraproject.org
+
+# SENDING MAIL
+#
+# The myorigin parameter specifies the domain that locally-posted
+# mail appears to come from. The default is to append $myhostname,
+# which is fine for small sites. If you run a domain with multiple
+# machines, you should (1) change this to $mydomain and (2) set up
+# a domain-wide alias database that aliases each user to
+# user@that.users.mailhost.
+#
+# For the sake of consistency between sender and recipient addresses,
+# myorigin also specifies the default domain name that is appended
+# to recipient addresses that have no @domain part.
+#
+#myorigin = $myhostname
+#myorigin = $mydomain
+
+myorigin = fedoraproject.org
+
+# RECEIVING MAIL
+
+# The inet_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on. By default,
+# the software claims all active interfaces on the machine. The
+# parameter also controls delivery of mail to user@[ip.address].
+#
+# See also the proxy_interfaces parameter, for network addresses that
+# are forwarded to us via a proxy or network address translator.
+#
+# Note: you need to stop/start Postfix when this parameter changes.
+#
+#inet_interfaces = all
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname, localhost
+
+inet_interfaces = all
+
+# The proxy_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on by way of a
+# proxy or network address translation unit. This setting extends
+# the address list specified with the inet_interfaces parameter.
+#
+# You must specify your proxy/NAT addresses when your system is a
+# backup MX host for other domains, otherwise mail delivery loops
+# will happen when the primary MX host is down.
+#
+#proxy_interfaces =
+#proxy_interfaces = 1.2.3.4
+
+# The mydestination parameter specifies the list of domains that this
+# machine considers itself the final destination for.
+#
+# These domains are routed to the delivery agent specified with the
+# local_transport parameter setting. By default, that is the UNIX
+# compatible delivery agent that lookups all recipients in /etc/passwd
+# and /etc/aliases or their equivalent.
+#
+# The default is $myhostname + localhost.$mydomain. On a mail domain
+# gateway, you should also include $mydomain.
+#
+# Do not specify the names of virtual domains - those domains are
+# specified elsewhere (see VIRTUAL_README).
+#
+# Do not specify the names of domains that this machine is backup MX
+# host for. Specify those names via the relay_domains settings for
+# the SMTP server, or use permit_mx_backup if you are lazy (see
+# STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README).
+#
+# The local machine is always the final destination for mail addressed
+# to user@[the.net.work.address] of an interface that the mail system
+# receives mail on (see the inet_interfaces parameter).
+#
+# Specify a list of host or domain names, /file/name or type:table
+# patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. A /file/name
+# pattern is replaced by its contents; a type:table is matched when
+# a name matches a lookup key (the right-hand side is ignored).
+# Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.
+#
+# See also below, section "REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS".
+#
+mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, fedora.redhat.com, localhost
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain,
+# mail.$mydomain, www.$mydomain, ftp.$mydomain
+
+# REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS
+#
+# The local_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all names or addresses of users that are local with respect
+# to $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown local users. This parameter is defined by default.
+#
+# To turn off local recipient checking in the SMTP server, specify
+# local_recipient_maps = (i.e. empty).
+#
+# The default setting assumes that you use the default Postfix local
+# delivery agent for local delivery. You need to update the
+# local_recipient_maps setting if:
+#
+# - You define $mydestination domain recipients in files other than
+# /etc/passwd, /etc/aliases, or the $virtual_alias_maps files.
+# For example, you define $mydestination domain recipients in
+# the $virtual_mailbox_maps files.
+#
+# - You redefine the local delivery agent in master.cf.
+#
+# - You redefine the "local_transport" setting in main.cf.
+#
+# - You use the "luser_relay", "mailbox_transport", or "fallback_transport"
+# feature of the Postfix local delivery agent (see local(8)).
+#
+# Details are described in the LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README file.
+#
+# Beware: if the Postfix SMTP server runs chrooted, you probably have
+# to access the passwd file via the proxymap service, in order to
+# overcome chroot restrictions. The alternative, having a copy of
+# the system passwd file in the chroot jail is just not practical.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify a bare username, an @domain.tld
+# wild-card, or specify a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#local_recipient_maps = unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps = proxy:unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps =
+
+# The unknown_local_recipient_reject_code specifies the SMTP server
+# response code when a recipient domain matches $mydestination or
+# ${proxy,inet}_interfaces, while $local_recipient_maps is non-empty
+# and the recipient address or address local-part is not found.
+#
+# The default setting is 550 (reject mail) but it is safer to start
+# with 450 (try again later) until you are certain that your
+# local_recipient_maps settings are OK.
+#
+unknown_local_recipient_reject_code = 550
+
+# TRUST AND RELAY CONTROL
+
+# The mynetworks parameter specifies the list of "trusted" SMTP
+# clients that have more privileges than "strangers".
+#
+# In particular, "trusted" SMTP clients are allowed to relay mail
+# through Postfix. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions parameter
+# in postconf(5).
+#
+# You can specify the list of "trusted" network addresses by hand
+# or you can let Postfix do it for you (which is the default).
+#
+# By default (mynetworks_style = subnet), Postfix "trusts" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP subnetworks as the local machine.
+# On Linux, this does works correctly only with interfaces specified
+# with the "ifconfig" command.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = class" when Postfix should "trust" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP class A/B/C networks as the local machine.
+# Don't do this with a dialup site - it would cause Postfix to "trust"
+# your entire provider's network. Instead, specify an explicit
+# mynetworks list by hand, as described below.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = host" when Postfix should "trust"
+# only the local machine.
+#
+#mynetworks_style = class
+#mynetworks_style = subnet
+#mynetworks_style = host
+
+# Alternatively, you can specify the mynetworks list by hand, in
+# which case Postfix ignores the mynetworks_style setting.
+#
+# Specify an explicit list of network/netmask patterns, where the
+# mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host
+# address.
+#
+# You can also specify the absolute pathname of a pattern file instead
+# of listing the patterns here. Specify type:table for table-based lookups
+# (the value on the table right-hand side is not used).
+#
+#mynetworks = 168.100.189.0/28, 127.0.0.0/8
+#mynetworks = $config_directory/mynetworks
+#mynetworks = hash:/etc/postfix/network_table
+
+
+# The relay_domains parameter restricts what destinations this system will
+# relay mail to. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions description in
+# postconf(5) for detailed information.
+#
+# By default, Postfix relays mail
+# - from "trusted" clients (IP address matches $mynetworks) to any destination,
+# - from "untrusted" clients to destinations that match $relay_domains or
+# subdomains thereof, except addresses with sender-specified routing.
+# The default relay_domains value is $mydestination.
+#
+# In addition to the above, the Postfix SMTP server by default accepts mail
+# that Postfix is final destination for:
+# - destinations that match $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces,
+# - destinations that match $mydestination
+# - destinations that match $virtual_alias_domains,
+# - destinations that match $virtual_mailbox_domains.
+# These destinations do not need to be listed in $relay_domains.
+#
+# Specify a list of hosts or domains, /file/name patterns or type:name
+# lookup tables, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue
+# long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. A file name
+# is replaced by its contents; a type:name table is matched when a
+# (parent) domain appears as lookup key.
+#
+# NOTE: Postfix will not automatically forward mail for domains that
+# list this system as their primary or backup MX host. See the
+# permit_mx_backup restriction description in postconf(5).
+#
+#relay_domains = $mydestination
+
+
+
+# INTERNET OR INTRANET
+
+# The relayhost parameter specifies the default host to send mail to
+# when no entry is matched in the optional transport(5) table. When
+# no relayhost is given, mail is routed directly to the destination.
+#
+# On an intranet, specify the organizational domain name. If your
+# internal DNS uses no MX records, specify the name of the intranet
+# gateway host instead.
+#
+# In the case of SMTP, specify a domain, host, host:port, [host]:port,
+# [address] or [address]:port; the form [host] turns off MX lookups.
+#
+# If you're connected via UUCP, see also the default_transport parameter.
+#
+#relayhost = $mydomain
+#relayhost = [gateway.my.domain]
+#relayhost = [mailserver.isp.tld]
+#relayhost = uucphost
+#relayhost = [an.ip.add.ress]
+#relayhost = bastion
+
+
+# REJECTING UNKNOWN RELAY USERS
+#
+# The relay_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all addresses in the domains that match $relay_domains.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown relay users. This feature is off by default.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify an @domain.tld wild-card, or specify
+# a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#relay_recipient_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_recipients
+
+# INPUT RATE CONTROL
+#
+# The in_flow_delay configuration parameter implements mail input
+# flow control. This feature is turned on by default, although it
+# still needs further development (it's disabled on SCO UNIX due
+# to an SCO bug).
+#
+# A Postfix process will pause for $in_flow_delay seconds before
+# accepting a new message, when the message arrival rate exceeds the
+# message delivery rate. With the default 100 SMTP server process
+# limit, this limits the mail inflow to 100 messages a second more
+# than the number of messages delivered per second.
+#
+# Specify 0 to disable the feature. Valid delays are 0..10.
+#
+#in_flow_delay = 1s
+
+# ADDRESS REWRITING
+#
+# The ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document gives information about
+# address masquerading or other forms of address rewriting including
+# username->Firstname.Lastname mapping.
+
+# ADDRESS REDIRECTION (VIRTUAL DOMAIN)
+#
+# The VIRTUAL_README document gives information about the many forms
+# of domain hosting that Postfix supports.
+
+# "USER HAS MOVED" BOUNCE MESSAGES
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# TRANSPORT MAP
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# ALIAS DATABASE
+#
+# The alias_maps parameter specifies the list of alias databases used
+# by the local delivery agent. The default list is system dependent.
+#
+# On systems with NIS, the default is to search the local alias
+# database, then the NIS alias database. See aliases(5) for syntax
+# details.
+#
+# If you change the alias database, run "postalias /etc/aliases" (or
+# wherever your system stores the mail alias file), or simply run
+# "newaliases" to build the necessary DBM or DB file.
+#
+# It will take a minute or so before changes become visible. Use
+# "postfix reload" to eliminate the delay.
+#
+#alias_maps = dbm:/etc/aliases
+alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, nis:mail.aliases
+#alias_maps = netinfo:/aliases
+
+# The alias_database parameter specifies the alias database(s) that
+# are built with "newaliases" or "sendmail -bi". This is a separate
+# configuration parameter, because alias_maps (see above) may specify
+# tables that are not necessarily all under control by Postfix.
+#
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/mail/aliases
+alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases, hash:/opt/majordomo/aliases
+
+# ADDRESS EXTENSIONS (e.g., user+foo)
+#
+# The recipient_delimiter parameter specifies the separator between
+# user names and address extensions (user+foo). See canonical(5),
+# local(8), relocated(5) and virtual(5) for the effects this has on
+# aliases, canonical, virtual, relocated and .forward file lookups.
+# Basically, the software tries user+foo and .forward+foo before
+# trying user and .forward.
+#
+recipient_delimiter = +
+
+# DELIVERY TO MAILBOX
+#
+# The home_mailbox parameter specifies the optional pathname of a
+# mailbox file relative to a user's home directory. The default
+# mailbox file is /var/spool/mail/user or /var/mail/user. Specify
+# "Maildir/" for qmail-style delivery (the / is required).
+#
+#home_mailbox = Mailbox
+#home_mailbox = Maildir/
+
+# The mail_spool_directory parameter specifies the directory where
+# UNIX-style mailboxes are kept. The default setting depends on the
+# system type.
+#
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/mail
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/spool/mail
+
+# The mailbox_command parameter specifies the optional external
+# command to use instead of mailbox delivery. The command is run as
+# the recipient with proper HOME, SHELL and LOGNAME environment settings.
+# Exception: delivery for root is done as $default_user.
+#
+# Other environment variables of interest: USER (recipient username),
+# EXTENSION (address extension), DOMAIN (domain part of address),
+# and LOCAL (the address localpart).
+#
+# Unlike other Postfix configuration parameters, the mailbox_command
+# parameter is not subjected to $parameter substitutions. This is to
+# make it easier to specify shell syntax (see example below).
+#
+# Avoid shell meta characters because they will force Postfix to run
+# an expensive shell process. Procmail alone is expensive enough.
+#
+# IF YOU USE THIS TO DELIVER MAIL SYSTEM-WIDE, YOU MUST SET UP AN
+# ALIAS THAT FORWARDS MAIL FOR ROOT TO A REAL USER.
+#
+#mailbox_command = /usr/bin/procmail
+#mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail -a "$EXTENSION"
+
+# The mailbox_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use after processing aliases and .forward files. This parameter
+# has precedence over the mailbox_command, fallback_transport and
+# luser_relay parameters.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+
+# If using the cyrus-imapd IMAP server deliver local mail to the IMAP
+# server using LMTP (Local Mail Transport Protocol), this is prefered
+# over the older cyrus deliver program by setting the
+# mailbox_transport as below:
+#
+# mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#
+# The efficiency of LMTP delivery for cyrus-imapd can be enhanced via
+# these settings.
+#
+# local_destination_recipient_limit = 300
+# local_destination_concurrency_limit = 5
+#
+# Of course you should adjust these settings as appropriate for the
+# capacity of the hardware you are using. The recipient limit setting
+# can be used to take advantage of the single instance message store
+# capability of Cyrus. The concurrency limit can be used to control
+# how many simultaneous LMTP sessions will be permitted to the Cyrus
+# message store.
+#
+# To use the old cyrus deliver program you have to set:
+#mailbox_transport = cyrus
+
+# The fallback_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use for recipients that are not found in the UNIX passwd database.
+# This parameter has precedence over the luser_relay parameter.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#fallback_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#fallback_transport =
+
+# The luser_relay parameter specifies an optional destination address
+# for unknown recipients. By default, mail for unknown@$mydestination,
+# unknown@[$inet_interfaces] or unknown@[$proxy_interfaces] is returned
+# as undeliverable.
+#
+# The following expansions are done on luser_relay: $user (recipient
+# username), $shell (recipient shell), $home (recipient home directory),
+# $recipient (full recipient address), $extension (recipient address
+# extension), $domain (recipient domain), $local (entire recipient
+# localpart), $recipient_delimiter. Specify ${name?value} or
+# ${name:value} to expand value only when $name does (does not) exist.
+#
+# luser_relay works only for the default Postfix local delivery agent.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must specify "local_recipient_maps =" (i.e. empty) in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#luser_relay = $user@other.host
+#luser_relay = $local@other.host
+#luser_relay = admin+$local
+
+# JUNK MAIL CONTROLS
+#
+# The controls listed here are only a very small subset. The file
+# SMTPD_ACCESS_README provides an overview.
+
+# The header_checks parameter specifies an optional table with patterns
+# that each logical message header is matched against, including
+# headers that span multiple physical lines.
+#
+# By default, these patterns also apply to MIME headers and to the
+# headers of attached messages. With older Postfix versions, MIME and
+# attached message headers were treated as body text.
+#
+# For details, see "man header_checks".
+#
+header_checks = regexp:/etc/postfix/header_checks
+
+# FAST ETRN SERVICE
+#
+# Postfix maintains per-destination logfiles with information about
+# deferred mail, so that mail can be flushed quickly with the SMTP
+# "ETRN domain.tld" command, or by executing "sendmail -qRdomain.tld".
+# See the ETRN_README document for a detailed description.
+#
+# The fast_flush_domains parameter controls what destinations are
+# eligible for this service. By default, they are all domains that
+# this server is willing to relay mail to.
+#
+#fast_flush_domains = $relay_domains
+
+# SHOW SOFTWARE VERSION OR NOT
+#
+# The smtpd_banner parameter specifies the text that follows the 220
+# code in the SMTP server's greeting banner. Some people like to see
+# the mail version advertised. By default, Postfix shows no version.
+#
+# You MUST specify $myhostname at the start of the text. That is an
+# RFC requirement. Postfix itself does not care.
+#
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name ($mail_version)
+
+# PARALLEL DELIVERY TO THE SAME DESTINATION
+#
+# How many parallel deliveries to the same user or domain? With local
+# delivery, it does not make sense to do massively parallel delivery
+# to the same user, because mailbox updates must happen sequentially,
+# and expensive pipelines in .forward files can cause disasters when
+# too many are run at the same time. With SMTP deliveries, 10
+# simultaneous connections to the same domain could be sufficient to
+# raise eyebrows.
+#
+# Each message delivery transport has its XXX_destination_concurrency_limit
+# parameter. The default is $default_destination_concurrency_limit for
+# most delivery transports. For the local delivery agent the default is 2.
+
+#local_destination_concurrency_limit = 2
+#default_destination_concurrency_limit = 20
+
+# DEBUGGING CONTROL
+#
+# The debug_peer_level parameter specifies the increment in verbose
+# logging level when an SMTP client or server host name or address
+# matches a pattern in the debug_peer_list parameter.
+#
+debug_peer_level = 2
+
+# The debug_peer_list parameter specifies an optional list of domain
+# or network patterns, /file/name patterns or type:name tables. When
+# an SMTP client or server host name or address matches a pattern,
+# increase the verbose logging level by the amount specified in the
+# debug_peer_level parameter.
+#
+#debug_peer_list = 127.0.0.1
+#debug_peer_list = some.domain
+
+# The debugger_command specifies the external command that is executed
+# when a Postfix daemon program is run with the -D option.
+#
+# Use "command .. & sleep 5" so that the debugger can attach before
+# the process marches on. If you use an X-based debugger, be sure to
+# set up your XAUTHORITY environment variable before starting Postfix.
+#
+debugger_command =
+ PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin:/usr/X11R6/bin
+ ddd $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id & sleep 5
+
+# If you can't use X, use this to capture the call stack when a
+# daemon crashes. The result is in a file in the configuration
+# directory, and is named after the process name and the process ID.
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin; export PATH; (echo cont;
+# echo where) | gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id 2>&1
+# >$config_directory/$process_name.$process_id.log & sleep 5
+#
+# Another possibility is to run gdb under a detached screen session.
+# To attach to the screen sesssion, su root and run "screen -r
+# <id_string>" where <id_string> uniquely matches one of the detached
+# sessions (from "screen -list").
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/sbin:/usr/sbin; export PATH; screen
+# -dmS $process_name gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name
+# $process_id & sleep 1
+
+# INSTALL-TIME CONFIGURATION INFORMATION
+#
+# The following parameters are used when installing a new Postfix version.
+#
+# sendmail_path: The full pathname of the Postfix sendmail command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible mail posting interface.
+#
+sendmail_path = /usr/sbin/sendmail.postfix
+
+# newaliases_path: The full pathname of the Postfix newaliases command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible command to build alias databases.
+#
+newaliases_path = /usr/bin/newaliases.postfix
+
+# mailq_path: The full pathname of the Postfix mailq command. This
+# is the Sendmail-compatible mail queue listing command.
+#
+mailq_path = /usr/bin/mailq.postfix
+
+# setgid_group: The group for mail submission and queue management
+# commands. This must be a group name with a numerical group ID that
+# is not shared with other accounts, not even with the Postfix account.
+#
+setgid_group = postdrop
+
+# html_directory: The location of the Postfix HTML documentation.
+#
+html_directory = no
+
+# manpage_directory: The location of the Postfix on-line manual pages.
+#
+manpage_directory = /usr/share/man
+
+# sample_directory: The location of the Postfix sample configuration files.
+# This parameter is obsolete as of Postfix 2.1.
+#
+sample_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.5.6/samples
+
+# readme_directory: The location of the Postfix README files.
+#
+readme_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.5.6/README_FILES
+# Enable IPv4, and IPv6 if supported
+inet_protocols = ipv4
+
+# mapping so we know where to go for .redhat.com mail
+
+transport_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/transport
+local_header_rewrite_clients = static:all
+
+
+message_size_limit = 20971520
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.norelay b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.norelay
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..85b694756
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.norelay
@@ -0,0 +1,686 @@
+# "false"
+# Global Postfix configuration file. This file lists only a subset
+# of all parameters. For the syntax, and for a complete parameter
+# list, see the postconf(5) manual page (command: "man 5 postconf").
+#
+# For common configuration examples, see BASIC_CONFIGURATION_README
+# and STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README. To find these documents, use
+# the command "postconf html_directory readme_directory", or go to
+# http://www.postfix.org/.
+#
+# For best results, change no more than 2-3 parameters at a time,
+# and test if Postfix still works after every change.
+
+# SOFT BOUNCE
+#
+# The soft_bounce parameter provides a limited safety net for
+# testing. When soft_bounce is enabled, mail will remain queued that
+# would otherwise bounce. This parameter disables locally-generated
+# bounces, and prevents the SMTP server from rejecting mail permanently
+# (by changing 5xx replies into 4xx replies). However, soft_bounce
+# is no cure for address rewriting mistakes or mail routing mistakes.
+#
+#soft_bounce = no
+
+# LOCAL PATHNAME INFORMATION
+#
+# The queue_directory specifies the location of the Postfix queue.
+# This is also the root directory of Postfix daemons that run chrooted.
+# See the files in examples/chroot-setup for setting up Postfix chroot
+# environments on different UNIX systems.
+#
+queue_directory = /var/spool/postfix
+
+# The command_directory parameter specifies the location of all
+# postXXX commands.
+#
+command_directory = /usr/sbin
+
+# The daemon_directory parameter specifies the location of all Postfix
+# daemon programs (i.e. programs listed in the master.cf file). This
+# directory must be owned by root.
+#
+daemon_directory = /usr/libexec/postfix
+
+# QUEUE AND PROCESS OWNERSHIP
+#
+# The mail_owner parameter specifies the owner of the Postfix queue
+# and of most Postfix daemon processes. Specify the name of a user
+# account THAT DOES NOT SHARE ITS USER OR GROUP ID WITH OTHER ACCOUNTS
+# AND THAT OWNS NO OTHER FILES OR PROCESSES ON THE SYSTEM. In
+# particular, don't specify nobody or daemon. PLEASE USE A DEDICATED
+# USER.
+#
+mail_owner = postfix
+
+# The default_privs parameter specifies the default rights used by
+# the local delivery agent for delivery to external file or command.
+# These rights are used in the absence of a recipient user context.
+# DO NOT SPECIFY A PRIVILEGED USER OR THE POSTFIX OWNER.
+#
+#default_privs = nobody
+
+# INTERNET HOST AND DOMAIN NAMES
+#
+# The myhostname parameter specifies the internet hostname of this
+# mail system. The default is to use the fully-qualified domain name
+# from gethostname(). $myhostname is used as a default value for many
+# other configuration parameters.
+#
+#myhostname = host.domain.tld
+#myhostname = virtual.domain.tld
+
+# The mydomain parameter specifies the local internet domain name.
+# The default is to use $myhostname minus the first component.
+# $mydomain is used as a default value for many other configuration
+# parameters.
+#
+#mydomain = domain.tld
+
+# SENDING MAIL
+#
+# The myorigin parameter specifies the domain that locally-posted
+# mail appears to come from. The default is to append $myhostname,
+# which is fine for small sites. If you run a domain with multiple
+# machines, you should (1) change this to $mydomain and (2) set up
+# a domain-wide alias database that aliases each user to
+# user@that.users.mailhost.
+#
+# For the sake of consistency between sender and recipient addresses,
+# myorigin also specifies the default domain name that is appended
+# to recipient addresses that have no @domain part.
+#
+#myorigin = $myhostname
+#myorigin = $mydomain
+
+mydomain = fedoraproject.org
+myorigin = fedoraproject.org
+
+# RECEIVING MAIL
+
+# The inet_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on. By default,
+# the software claims all active interfaces on the machine. The
+# parameter also controls delivery of mail to user@[ip.address].
+#
+# See also the proxy_interfaces parameter, for network addresses that
+# are forwarded to us via a proxy or network address translator.
+#
+# Note: you need to stop/start Postfix when this parameter changes.
+#
+#inet_interfaces = all
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname, localhost
+inet_interfaces = all
+
+# The proxy_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on by way of a
+# proxy or network address translation unit. This setting extends
+# the address list specified with the inet_interfaces parameter.
+#
+# You must specify your proxy/NAT addresses when your system is a
+# backup MX host for other domains, otherwise mail delivery loops
+# will happen when the primary MX host is down.
+#
+#proxy_interfaces =
+#proxy_interfaces = 1.2.3.4
+
+# The mydestination parameter specifies the list of domains that this
+# machine considers itself the final destination for.
+#
+# These domains are routed to the delivery agent specified with the
+# local_transport parameter setting. By default, that is the UNIX
+# compatible delivery agent that lookups all recipients in /etc/passwd
+# and /etc/aliases or their equivalent.
+#
+# The default is $myhostname + localhost.$mydomain. On a mail domain
+# gateway, you should also include $mydomain.
+#
+# Do not specify the names of virtual domains - those domains are
+# specified elsewhere (see VIRTUAL_README).
+#
+# Do not specify the names of domains that this machine is backup MX
+# host for. Specify those names via the relay_domains settings for
+# the SMTP server, or use permit_mx_backup if you are lazy (see
+# STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README).
+#
+# The local machine is always the final destination for mail addressed
+# to user@[the.net.work.address] of an interface that the mail system
+# receives mail on (see the inet_interfaces parameter).
+#
+# Specify a list of host or domain names, /file/name or type:table
+# patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. A /file/name
+# pattern is replaced by its contents; a type:table is matched when
+# a name matches a lookup key (the right-hand side is ignored).
+# Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.
+#
+# See also below, section "REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS".
+#
+mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, fedora.redhat.com, localhost
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain,
+# mail.$mydomain, www.$mydomain, ftp.$mydomain
+
+# REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS
+#
+# The local_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all names or addresses of users that are local with respect
+# to $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown local users. This parameter is defined by default.
+#
+# To turn off local recipient checking in the SMTP server, specify
+# local_recipient_maps = (i.e. empty).
+#
+# The default setting assumes that you use the default Postfix local
+# delivery agent for local delivery. You need to update the
+# local_recipient_maps setting if:
+#
+# - You define $mydestination domain recipients in files other than
+# /etc/passwd, /etc/aliases, or the $virtual_alias_maps files.
+# For example, you define $mydestination domain recipients in
+# the $virtual_mailbox_maps files.
+#
+# - You redefine the local delivery agent in master.cf.
+#
+# - You redefine the "local_transport" setting in main.cf.
+#
+# - You use the "luser_relay", "mailbox_transport", or "fallback_transport"
+# feature of the Postfix local delivery agent (see local(8)).
+#
+# Details are described in the LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README file.
+#
+# Beware: if the Postfix SMTP server runs chrooted, you probably have
+# to access the passwd file via the proxymap service, in order to
+# overcome chroot restrictions. The alternative, having a copy of
+# the system passwd file in the chroot jail is just not practical.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify a bare username, an @domain.tld
+# wild-card, or specify a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#local_recipient_maps = unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps = proxy:unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps =
+
+# The unknown_local_recipient_reject_code specifies the SMTP server
+# response code when a recipient domain matches $mydestination or
+# ${proxy,inet}_interfaces, while $local_recipient_maps is non-empty
+# and the recipient address or address local-part is not found.
+#
+# The default setting is 550 (reject mail) but it is safer to start
+# with 450 (try again later) until you are certain that your
+# local_recipient_maps settings are OK.
+#
+unknown_local_recipient_reject_code = 550
+
+# TRUST AND RELAY CONTROL
+
+# The mynetworks parameter specifies the list of "trusted" SMTP
+# clients that have more privileges than "strangers".
+#
+# In particular, "trusted" SMTP clients are allowed to relay mail
+# through Postfix. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions parameter
+# in postconf(5).
+#
+# You can specify the list of "trusted" network addresses by hand
+# or you can let Postfix do it for you (which is the default).
+#
+# By default (mynetworks_style = subnet), Postfix "trusts" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP subnetworks as the local machine.
+# On Linux, this does works correctly only with interfaces specified
+# with the "ifconfig" command.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = class" when Postfix should "trust" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP class A/B/C networks as the local machine.
+# Don't do this with a dialup site - it would cause Postfix to "trust"
+# your entire provider's network. Instead, specify an explicit
+# mynetworks list by hand, as described below.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = host" when Postfix should "trust"
+# only the local machine.
+#
+#mynetworks_style = class
+#mynetworks_style = subnet
+#mynetworks_style = host
+
+# Alternatively, you can specify the mynetworks list by hand, in
+# which case Postfix ignores the mynetworks_style setting.
+#
+# Specify an explicit list of network/netmask patterns, where the
+# mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host
+# address.
+#
+# You can also specify the absolute pathname of a pattern file instead
+# of listing the patterns here. Specify type:table for table-based lookups
+# (the value on the table right-hand side is not used).
+#
+#mynetworks = 168.100.189.0/28, 127.0.0.0/8
+#mynetworks = $config_directory/mynetworks
+#mynetworks = hash:/etc/postfix/network_table
+
+
+# The relay_domains parameter restricts what destinations this system will
+# relay mail to. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions description in
+# postconf(5) for detailed information.
+#
+# By default, Postfix relays mail
+# - from "trusted" clients (IP address matches $mynetworks) to any destination,
+# - from "untrusted" clients to destinations that match $relay_domains or
+# subdomains thereof, except addresses with sender-specified routing.
+# The default relay_domains value is $mydestination.
+#
+# In addition to the above, the Postfix SMTP server by default accepts mail
+# that Postfix is final destination for:
+# - destinations that match $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces,
+# - destinations that match $mydestination
+# - destinations that match $virtual_alias_domains,
+# - destinations that match $virtual_mailbox_domains.
+# These destinations do not need to be listed in $relay_domains.
+#
+# Specify a list of hosts or domains, /file/name patterns or type:name
+# lookup tables, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue
+# long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. A file name
+# is replaced by its contents; a type:name table is matched when a
+# (parent) domain appears as lookup key.
+#
+# NOTE: Postfix will not automatically forward mail for domains that
+# list this system as their primary or backup MX host. See the
+# permit_mx_backup restriction description in postconf(5).
+#
+#relay_domains = $mydestination
+
+
+
+# INTERNET OR INTRANET
+
+# The relayhost parameter specifies the default host to send mail to
+# when no entry is matched in the optional transport(5) table. When
+# no relayhost is given, mail is routed directly to the destination.
+#
+# On an intranet, specify the organizational domain name. If your
+# internal DNS uses no MX records, specify the name of the intranet
+# gateway host instead.
+#
+# In the case of SMTP, specify a domain, host, host:port, [host]:port,
+# [address] or [address]:port; the form [host] turns off MX lookups.
+#
+# If you're connected via UUCP, see also the default_transport parameter.
+#
+#relayhost = $mydomain
+#relayhost = [gateway.my.domain]
+#relayhost = [mailserver.isp.tld]
+#relayhost = uucphost
+#relayhost = [an.ip.add.ress]
+#relayhost = bastion
+
+
+# REJECTING UNKNOWN RELAY USERS
+#
+# The relay_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all addresses in the domains that match $relay_domains.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown relay users. This feature is off by default.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify an @domain.tld wild-card, or specify
+# a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#relay_recipient_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_recipients
+
+# INPUT RATE CONTROL
+#
+# The in_flow_delay configuration parameter implements mail input
+# flow control. This feature is turned on by default, although it
+# still needs further development (it's disabled on SCO UNIX due
+# to an SCO bug).
+#
+# A Postfix process will pause for $in_flow_delay seconds before
+# accepting a new message, when the message arrival rate exceeds the
+# message delivery rate. With the default 100 SMTP server process
+# limit, this limits the mail inflow to 100 messages a second more
+# than the number of messages delivered per second.
+#
+# Specify 0 to disable the feature. Valid delays are 0..10.
+#
+#in_flow_delay = 1s
+
+# ADDRESS REWRITING
+#
+# The ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document gives information about
+# address masquerading or other forms of address rewriting including
+# username->Firstname.Lastname mapping.
+
+masquerade_domains = redhat.com
+masquerade_exceptions = root apache
+
+# ADDRESS REDIRECTION (VIRTUAL DOMAIN)
+#
+# The VIRTUAL_README document gives information about the many forms
+# of domain hosting that Postfix supports.
+
+# "USER HAS MOVED" BOUNCE MESSAGES
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# TRANSPORT MAP
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# ALIAS DATABASE
+#
+# The alias_maps parameter specifies the list of alias databases used
+# by the local delivery agent. The default list is system dependent.
+#
+# On systems with NIS, the default is to search the local alias
+# database, then the NIS alias database. See aliases(5) for syntax
+# details.
+#
+# If you change the alias database, run "postalias /etc/aliases" (or
+# wherever your system stores the mail alias file), or simply run
+# "newaliases" to build the necessary DBM or DB file.
+#
+# It will take a minute or so before changes become visible. Use
+# "postfix reload" to eliminate the delay.
+#
+#alias_maps = dbm:/etc/aliases
+alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, nis:mail.aliases
+#alias_maps = netinfo:/aliases
+
+# The alias_database parameter specifies the alias database(s) that
+# are built with "newaliases" or "sendmail -bi". This is a separate
+# configuration parameter, because alias_maps (see above) may specify
+# tables that are not necessarily all under control by Postfix.
+#
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/mail/aliases
+alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases, hash:/opt/majordomo/aliases
+
+# ADDRESS EXTENSIONS (e.g., user+foo)
+#
+# The recipient_delimiter parameter specifies the separator between
+# user names and address extensions (user+foo). See canonical(5),
+# local(8), relocated(5) and virtual(5) for the effects this has on
+# aliases, canonical, virtual, relocated and .forward file lookups.
+# Basically, the software tries user+foo and .forward+foo before
+# trying user and .forward.
+#
+recipient_delimiter = +
+
+# DELIVERY TO MAILBOX
+#
+# The home_mailbox parameter specifies the optional pathname of a
+# mailbox file relative to a user's home directory. The default
+# mailbox file is /var/spool/mail/user or /var/mail/user. Specify
+# "Maildir/" for qmail-style delivery (the / is required).
+#
+#home_mailbox = Mailbox
+#home_mailbox = Maildir/
+
+# The mail_spool_directory parameter specifies the directory where
+# UNIX-style mailboxes are kept. The default setting depends on the
+# system type.
+#
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/mail
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/spool/mail
+
+# The mailbox_command parameter specifies the optional external
+# command to use instead of mailbox delivery. The command is run as
+# the recipient with proper HOME, SHELL and LOGNAME environment settings.
+# Exception: delivery for root is done as $default_user.
+#
+# Other environment variables of interest: USER (recipient username),
+# EXTENSION (address extension), DOMAIN (domain part of address),
+# and LOCAL (the address localpart).
+#
+# Unlike other Postfix configuration parameters, the mailbox_command
+# parameter is not subjected to $parameter substitutions. This is to
+# make it easier to specify shell syntax (see example below).
+#
+# Avoid shell meta characters because they will force Postfix to run
+# an expensive shell process. Procmail alone is expensive enough.
+#
+# IF YOU USE THIS TO DELIVER MAIL SYSTEM-WIDE, YOU MUST SET UP AN
+# ALIAS THAT FORWARDS MAIL FOR ROOT TO A REAL USER.
+#
+#mailbox_command = /usr/bin/procmail
+#mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail -a "$EXTENSION"
+
+# The mailbox_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use after processing aliases and .forward files. This parameter
+# has precedence over the mailbox_command, fallback_transport and
+# luser_relay parameters.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+
+# If using the cyrus-imapd IMAP server deliver local mail to the IMAP
+# server using LMTP (Local Mail Transport Protocol), this is prefered
+# over the older cyrus deliver program by setting the
+# mailbox_transport as below:
+#
+# mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#
+# The efficiency of LMTP delivery for cyrus-imapd can be enhanced via
+# these settings.
+#
+# local_destination_recipient_limit = 300
+# local_destination_concurrency_limit = 5
+#
+# Of course you should adjust these settings as appropriate for the
+# capacity of the hardware you are using. The recipient limit setting
+# can be used to take advantage of the single instance message store
+# capability of Cyrus. The concurrency limit can be used to control
+# how many simultaneous LMTP sessions will be permitted to the Cyrus
+# message store.
+#
+# To use the old cyrus deliver program you have to set:
+#mailbox_transport = cyrus
+
+# The fallback_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use for recipients that are not found in the UNIX passwd database.
+# This parameter has precedence over the luser_relay parameter.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#fallback_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#fallback_transport =
+
+#transport_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/transport
+# The luser_relay parameter specifies an optional destination address
+# for unknown recipients. By default, mail for unknown@$mydestination,
+# unknown@[$inet_interfaces] or unknown@[$proxy_interfaces] is returned
+# as undeliverable.
+#
+# The following expansions are done on luser_relay: $user (recipient
+# username), $shell (recipient shell), $home (recipient home directory),
+# $recipient (full recipient address), $extension (recipient address
+# extension), $domain (recipient domain), $local (entire recipient
+# localpart), $recipient_delimiter. Specify ${name?value} or
+# ${name:value} to expand value only when $name does (does not) exist.
+#
+# luser_relay works only for the default Postfix local delivery agent.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must specify "local_recipient_maps =" (i.e. empty) in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#luser_relay = $user@other.host
+#luser_relay = $local@other.host
+#luser_relay = admin+$local
+
+# JUNK MAIL CONTROLS
+#
+# The controls listed here are only a very small subset. The file
+# SMTPD_ACCESS_README provides an overview.
+
+# The header_checks parameter specifies an optional table with patterns
+# that each logical message header is matched against, including
+# headers that span multiple physical lines.
+#
+# By default, these patterns also apply to MIME headers and to the
+# headers of attached messages. With older Postfix versions, MIME and
+# attached message headers were treated as body text.
+#
+# For details, see "man header_checks".
+#
+header_checks = regexp:/etc/postfix/header_checks
+
+# FAST ETRN SERVICE
+#
+# Postfix maintains per-destination logfiles with information about
+# deferred mail, so that mail can be flushed quickly with the SMTP
+# "ETRN domain.tld" command, or by executing "sendmail -qRdomain.tld".
+# See the ETRN_README document for a detailed description.
+#
+# The fast_flush_domains parameter controls what destinations are
+# eligible for this service. By default, they are all domains that
+# this server is willing to relay mail to.
+#
+#fast_flush_domains = $relay_domains
+
+# SHOW SOFTWARE VERSION OR NOT
+#
+# The smtpd_banner parameter specifies the text that follows the 220
+# code in the SMTP server's greeting banner. Some people like to see
+# the mail version advertised. By default, Postfix shows no version.
+#
+# You MUST specify $myhostname at the start of the text. That is an
+# RFC requirement. Postfix itself does not care.
+#
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name ($mail_version)
+
+# PARALLEL DELIVERY TO THE SAME DESTINATION
+#
+# How many parallel deliveries to the same user or domain? With local
+# delivery, it does not make sense to do massively parallel delivery
+# to the same user, because mailbox updates must happen sequentially,
+# and expensive pipelines in .forward files can cause disasters when
+# too many are run at the same time. With SMTP deliveries, 10
+# simultaneous connections to the same domain could be sufficient to
+# raise eyebrows.
+#
+# Each message delivery transport has its XXX_destination_concurrency_limit
+# parameter. The default is $default_destination_concurrency_limit for
+# most delivery transports. For the local delivery agent the default is 2.
+
+#local_destination_concurrency_limit = 2
+#default_destination_concurrency_limit = 20
+
+# DEBUGGING CONTROL
+#
+# The debug_peer_level parameter specifies the increment in verbose
+# logging level when an SMTP client or server host name or address
+# matches a pattern in the debug_peer_list parameter.
+#
+debug_peer_level = 2
+
+# The debug_peer_list parameter specifies an optional list of domain
+# or network patterns, /file/name patterns or type:name tables. When
+# an SMTP client or server host name or address matches a pattern,
+# increase the verbose logging level by the amount specified in the
+# debug_peer_level parameter.
+#
+#debug_peer_list = 127.0.0.1
+#debug_peer_list = some.domain
+
+# The debugger_command specifies the external command that is executed
+# when a Postfix daemon program is run with the -D option.
+#
+# Use "command .. & sleep 5" so that the debugger can attach before
+# the process marches on. If you use an X-based debugger, be sure to
+# set up your XAUTHORITY environment variable before starting Postfix.
+#
+debugger_command =
+ PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin:/usr/X11R6/bin
+ xxgdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id & sleep 5
+
+# If you can't use X, use this to capture the call stack when a
+# daemon crashes. The result is in a file in the configuration
+# directory, and is named after the process name and the process ID.
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin; export PATH; (echo cont;
+# echo where) | gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id 2>&1
+# >$config_directory/$process_name.$process_id.log & sleep 5
+#
+# Another possibility is to run gdb under a detached screen session.
+# To attach to the screen sesssion, su root and run "screen -r
+# <id_string>" where <id_string> uniquely matches one of the detached
+# sessions (from "screen -list").
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/sbin:/usr/sbin; export PATH; screen
+# -dmS $process_name gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name
+# $process_id & sleep 1
+
+# INSTALL-TIME CONFIGURATION INFORMATION
+#
+# The following parameters are used when installing a new Postfix version.
+#
+# sendmail_path: The full pathname of the Postfix sendmail command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible mail posting interface.
+#
+sendmail_path = /usr/sbin/sendmail.postfix
+
+# newaliases_path: The full pathname of the Postfix newaliases command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible command to build alias databases.
+#
+newaliases_path = /usr/bin/newaliases.postfix
+
+# mailq_path: The full pathname of the Postfix mailq command. This
+# is the Sendmail-compatible mail queue listing command.
+#
+mailq_path = /usr/bin/mailq.postfix
+
+# setgid_group: The group for mail submission and queue management
+# commands. This must be a group name with a numerical group ID that
+# is not shared with other accounts, not even with the Postfix account.
+#
+setgid_group = postdrop
+
+# html_directory: The location of the Postfix HTML documentation.
+#
+html_directory = no
+
+# manpage_directory: The location of the Postfix on-line manual pages.
+#
+manpage_directory = /usr/share/man
+
+# sample_directory: The location of the Postfix sample configuration files.
+# This parameter is obsolete as of Postfix 2.1.
+#
+sample_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/samples
+
+# readme_directory: The location of the Postfix README files.
+#
+readme_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/README_FILES
+
+# add this to new postfix to get it to add proper message-id and other
+# headers to outgoing emails via the gateway.
+
+
+message_size_limit = 20971520
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.openstack-compute b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.openstack-compute
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..293c0c165
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.openstack-compute
@@ -0,0 +1,687 @@
+# "false"
+# Global Postfix configuration file. This file lists only a subset
+# of all parameters. For the syntax, and for a complete parameter
+# list, see the postconf(5) manual page (command: "man 5 postconf").
+#
+# For common configuration examples, see BASIC_CONFIGURATION_README
+# and STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README. To find these documents, use
+# the command "postconf html_directory readme_directory", or go to
+# http://www.postfix.org/.
+#
+# For best results, change no more than 2-3 parameters at a time,
+# and test if Postfix still works after every change.
+
+# SOFT BOUNCE
+#
+# The soft_bounce parameter provides a limited safety net for
+# testing. When soft_bounce is enabled, mail will remain queued that
+# would otherwise bounce. This parameter disables locally-generated
+# bounces, and prevents the SMTP server from rejecting mail permanently
+# (by changing 5xx replies into 4xx replies). However, soft_bounce
+# is no cure for address rewriting mistakes or mail routing mistakes.
+#
+#soft_bounce = no
+
+# LOCAL PATHNAME INFORMATION
+#
+# The queue_directory specifies the location of the Postfix queue.
+# This is also the root directory of Postfix daemons that run chrooted.
+# See the files in examples/chroot-setup for setting up Postfix chroot
+# environments on different UNIX systems.
+#
+queue_directory = /var/spool/postfix
+
+# The command_directory parameter specifies the location of all
+# postXXX commands.
+#
+command_directory = /usr/sbin
+
+# The daemon_directory parameter specifies the location of all Postfix
+# daemon programs (i.e. programs listed in the master.cf file). This
+# directory must be owned by root.
+#
+daemon_directory = /usr/libexec/postfix
+
+# QUEUE AND PROCESS OWNERSHIP
+#
+# The mail_owner parameter specifies the owner of the Postfix queue
+# and of most Postfix daemon processes. Specify the name of a user
+# account THAT DOES NOT SHARE ITS USER OR GROUP ID WITH OTHER ACCOUNTS
+# AND THAT OWNS NO OTHER FILES OR PROCESSES ON THE SYSTEM. In
+# particular, don't specify nobody or daemon. PLEASE USE A DEDICATED
+# USER.
+#
+mail_owner = postfix
+
+# The default_privs parameter specifies the default rights used by
+# the local delivery agent for delivery to external file or command.
+# These rights are used in the absence of a recipient user context.
+# DO NOT SPECIFY A PRIVILEGED USER OR THE POSTFIX OWNER.
+#
+#default_privs = nobody
+
+# INTERNET HOST AND DOMAIN NAMES
+#
+# The myhostname parameter specifies the internet hostname of this
+# mail system. The default is to use the fully-qualified domain name
+# from gethostname(). $myhostname is used as a default value for many
+# other configuration parameters.
+#
+#myhostname = host.domain.tld
+#myhostname = virtual.domain.tld
+
+# The mydomain parameter specifies the local internet domain name.
+# The default is to use $myhostname minus the first component.
+# $mydomain is used as a default value for many other configuration
+# parameters.
+#
+#mydomain = domain.tld
+
+# SENDING MAIL
+#
+# The myorigin parameter specifies the domain that locally-posted
+# mail appears to come from. The default is to append $myhostname,
+# which is fine for small sites. If you run a domain with multiple
+# machines, you should (1) change this to $mydomain and (2) set up
+# a domain-wide alias database that aliases each user to
+# user@that.users.mailhost.
+#
+# For the sake of consistency between sender and recipient addresses,
+# myorigin also specifies the default domain name that is appended
+# to recipient addresses that have no @domain part.
+#
+#myorigin = $myhostname
+#myorigin = $mydomain
+
+mydomain = fedoraproject.org
+myorigin = fedoraproject.org
+
+# RECEIVING MAIL
+
+# The inet_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on. By default,
+# the software claims all active interfaces on the machine. The
+# parameter also controls delivery of mail to user@[ip.address].
+#
+# See also the proxy_interfaces parameter, for network addresses that
+# are forwarded to us via a proxy or network address translator.
+#
+# Note: you need to stop/start Postfix when this parameter changes.
+#
+#inet_interfaces = all
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname, localhost
+inet_interfaces = all
+
+# The proxy_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on by way of a
+# proxy or network address translation unit. This setting extends
+# the address list specified with the inet_interfaces parameter.
+#
+# You must specify your proxy/NAT addresses when your system is a
+# backup MX host for other domains, otherwise mail delivery loops
+# will happen when the primary MX host is down.
+#
+#proxy_interfaces =
+#proxy_interfaces = 1.2.3.4
+
+# The mydestination parameter specifies the list of domains that this
+# machine considers itself the final destination for.
+#
+# These domains are routed to the delivery agent specified with the
+# local_transport parameter setting. By default, that is the UNIX
+# compatible delivery agent that lookups all recipients in /etc/passwd
+# and /etc/aliases or their equivalent.
+#
+# The default is $myhostname + localhost.$mydomain. On a mail domain
+# gateway, you should also include $mydomain.
+#
+# Do not specify the names of virtual domains - those domains are
+# specified elsewhere (see VIRTUAL_README).
+#
+# Do not specify the names of domains that this machine is backup MX
+# host for. Specify those names via the relay_domains settings for
+# the SMTP server, or use permit_mx_backup if you are lazy (see
+# STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README).
+#
+# The local machine is always the final destination for mail addressed
+# to user@[the.net.work.address] of an interface that the mail system
+# receives mail on (see the inet_interfaces parameter).
+#
+# Specify a list of host or domain names, /file/name or type:table
+# patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. A /file/name
+# pattern is replaced by its contents; a type:table is matched when
+# a name matches a lookup key (the right-hand side is ignored).
+# Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.
+#
+# See also below, section "REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS".
+#
+mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, fedora.redhat.com, localhost
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain,
+# mail.$mydomain, www.$mydomain, ftp.$mydomain
+
+# REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS
+#
+# The local_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all names or addresses of users that are local with respect
+# to $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown local users. This parameter is defined by default.
+#
+# To turn off local recipient checking in the SMTP server, specify
+# local_recipient_maps = (i.e. empty).
+#
+# The default setting assumes that you use the default Postfix local
+# delivery agent for local delivery. You need to update the
+# local_recipient_maps setting if:
+#
+# - You define $mydestination domain recipients in files other than
+# /etc/passwd, /etc/aliases, or the $virtual_alias_maps files.
+# For example, you define $mydestination domain recipients in
+# the $virtual_mailbox_maps files.
+#
+# - You redefine the local delivery agent in master.cf.
+#
+# - You redefine the "local_transport" setting in main.cf.
+#
+# - You use the "luser_relay", "mailbox_transport", or "fallback_transport"
+# feature of the Postfix local delivery agent (see local(8)).
+#
+# Details are described in the LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README file.
+#
+# Beware: if the Postfix SMTP server runs chrooted, you probably have
+# to access the passwd file via the proxymap service, in order to
+# overcome chroot restrictions. The alternative, having a copy of
+# the system passwd file in the chroot jail is just not practical.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify a bare username, an @domain.tld
+# wild-card, or specify a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#local_recipient_maps = unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps = proxy:unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps =
+
+# The unknown_local_recipient_reject_code specifies the SMTP server
+# response code when a recipient domain matches $mydestination or
+# ${proxy,inet}_interfaces, while $local_recipient_maps is non-empty
+# and the recipient address or address local-part is not found.
+#
+# The default setting is 550 (reject mail) but it is safer to start
+# with 450 (try again later) until you are certain that your
+# local_recipient_maps settings are OK.
+#
+unknown_local_recipient_reject_code = 550
+
+# TRUST AND RELAY CONTROL
+
+# The mynetworks parameter specifies the list of "trusted" SMTP
+# clients that have more privileges than "strangers".
+#
+# In particular, "trusted" SMTP clients are allowed to relay mail
+# through Postfix. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions parameter
+# in postconf(5).
+#
+# You can specify the list of "trusted" network addresses by hand
+# or you can let Postfix do it for you (which is the default).
+#
+# By default (mynetworks_style = subnet), Postfix "trusts" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP subnetworks as the local machine.
+# On Linux, this does works correctly only with interfaces specified
+# with the "ifconfig" command.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = class" when Postfix should "trust" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP class A/B/C networks as the local machine.
+# Don't do this with a dialup site - it would cause Postfix to "trust"
+# your entire provider's network. Instead, specify an explicit
+# mynetworks list by hand, as described below.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = host" when Postfix should "trust"
+# only the local machine.
+#
+#mynetworks_style = class
+#mynetworks_style = subnet
+#mynetworks_style = host
+
+# Alternatively, you can specify the mynetworks list by hand, in
+# which case Postfix ignores the mynetworks_style setting.
+#
+# Specify an explicit list of network/netmask patterns, where the
+# mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host
+# address.
+#
+# You can also specify the absolute pathname of a pattern file instead
+# of listing the patterns here. Specify type:table for table-based lookups
+# (the value on the table right-hand side is not used).
+#
+#mynetworks = 168.100.189.0/28, 127.0.0.0/8
+#mynetworks = $config_directory/mynetworks
+#mynetworks = hash:/etc/postfix/network_table
+
+
+# The relay_domains parameter restricts what destinations this system will
+# relay mail to. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions description in
+# postconf(5) for detailed information.
+#
+# By default, Postfix relays mail
+# - from "trusted" clients (IP address matches $mynetworks) to any destination,
+# - from "untrusted" clients to destinations that match $relay_domains or
+# subdomains thereof, except addresses with sender-specified routing.
+# The default relay_domains value is $mydestination.
+#
+# In addition to the above, the Postfix SMTP server by default accepts mail
+# that Postfix is final destination for:
+# - destinations that match $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces,
+# - destinations that match $mydestination
+# - destinations that match $virtual_alias_domains,
+# - destinations that match $virtual_mailbox_domains.
+# These destinations do not need to be listed in $relay_domains.
+#
+# Specify a list of hosts or domains, /file/name patterns or type:name
+# lookup tables, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue
+# long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. A file name
+# is replaced by its contents; a type:name table is matched when a
+# (parent) domain appears as lookup key.
+#
+# NOTE: Postfix will not automatically forward mail for domains that
+# list this system as their primary or backup MX host. See the
+# permit_mx_backup restriction description in postconf(5).
+#
+#relay_domains = $mydestination
+
+
+
+# INTERNET OR INTRANET
+
+# The relayhost parameter specifies the default host to send mail to
+# when no entry is matched in the optional transport(5) table. When
+# no relayhost is given, mail is routed directly to the destination.
+#
+# On an intranet, specify the organizational domain name. If your
+# internal DNS uses no MX records, specify the name of the intranet
+# gateway host instead.
+#
+# In the case of SMTP, specify a domain, host, host:port, [host]:port,
+# [address] or [address]:port; the form [host] turns off MX lookups.
+#
+# If you're connected via UUCP, see also the default_transport parameter.
+#
+#relayhost = $mydomain
+#relayhost = [gateway.my.domain]
+#relayhost = [mailserver.isp.tld]
+#relayhost = uucphost
+#relayhost = [an.ip.add.ress]
+#relayhost = bastion
+
+
+# REJECTING UNKNOWN RELAY USERS
+#
+# The relay_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all addresses in the domains that match $relay_domains.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown relay users. This feature is off by default.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify an @domain.tld wild-card, or specify
+# a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#relay_recipient_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_recipients
+
+# INPUT RATE CONTROL
+#
+# The in_flow_delay configuration parameter implements mail input
+# flow control. This feature is turned on by default, although it
+# still needs further development (it's disabled on SCO UNIX due
+# to an SCO bug).
+#
+# A Postfix process will pause for $in_flow_delay seconds before
+# accepting a new message, when the message arrival rate exceeds the
+# message delivery rate. With the default 100 SMTP server process
+# limit, this limits the mail inflow to 100 messages a second more
+# than the number of messages delivered per second.
+#
+# Specify 0 to disable the feature. Valid delays are 0..10.
+#
+#in_flow_delay = 1s
+
+# ADDRESS REWRITING
+#
+# The ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document gives information about
+# address masquerading or other forms of address rewriting including
+# username->Firstname.Lastname mapping.
+
+masquerade_domains = redhat.com
+masquerade_exceptions = root apache
+
+# ADDRESS REDIRECTION (VIRTUAL DOMAIN)
+#
+# The VIRTUAL_README document gives information about the many forms
+# of domain hosting that Postfix supports.
+
+# "USER HAS MOVED" BOUNCE MESSAGES
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# TRANSPORT MAP
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# ALIAS DATABASE
+#
+# The alias_maps parameter specifies the list of alias databases used
+# by the local delivery agent. The default list is system dependent.
+#
+# On systems with NIS, the default is to search the local alias
+# database, then the NIS alias database. See aliases(5) for syntax
+# details.
+#
+# If you change the alias database, run "postalias /etc/aliases" (or
+# wherever your system stores the mail alias file), or simply run
+# "newaliases" to build the necessary DBM or DB file.
+#
+# It will take a minute or so before changes become visible. Use
+# "postfix reload" to eliminate the delay.
+#
+#alias_maps = dbm:/etc/aliases
+alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, nis:mail.aliases
+#alias_maps = netinfo:/aliases
+
+# The alias_database parameter specifies the alias database(s) that
+# are built with "newaliases" or "sendmail -bi". This is a separate
+# configuration parameter, because alias_maps (see above) may specify
+# tables that are not necessarily all under control by Postfix.
+#
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/mail/aliases
+alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases, hash:/opt/majordomo/aliases
+
+# ADDRESS EXTENSIONS (e.g., user+foo)
+#
+# The recipient_delimiter parameter specifies the separator between
+# user names and address extensions (user+foo). See canonical(5),
+# local(8), relocated(5) and virtual(5) for the effects this has on
+# aliases, canonical, virtual, relocated and .forward file lookups.
+# Basically, the software tries user+foo and .forward+foo before
+# trying user and .forward.
+#
+recipient_delimiter = +
+
+# DELIVERY TO MAILBOX
+#
+# The home_mailbox parameter specifies the optional pathname of a
+# mailbox file relative to a user's home directory. The default
+# mailbox file is /var/spool/mail/user or /var/mail/user. Specify
+# "Maildir/" for qmail-style delivery (the / is required).
+#
+#home_mailbox = Mailbox
+#home_mailbox = Maildir/
+
+# The mail_spool_directory parameter specifies the directory where
+# UNIX-style mailboxes are kept. The default setting depends on the
+# system type.
+#
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/mail
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/spool/mail
+
+# The mailbox_command parameter specifies the optional external
+# command to use instead of mailbox delivery. The command is run as
+# the recipient with proper HOME, SHELL and LOGNAME environment settings.
+# Exception: delivery for root is done as $default_user.
+#
+# Other environment variables of interest: USER (recipient username),
+# EXTENSION (address extension), DOMAIN (domain part of address),
+# and LOCAL (the address localpart).
+#
+# Unlike other Postfix configuration parameters, the mailbox_command
+# parameter is not subjected to $parameter substitutions. This is to
+# make it easier to specify shell syntax (see example below).
+#
+# Avoid shell meta characters because they will force Postfix to run
+# an expensive shell process. Procmail alone is expensive enough.
+#
+# IF YOU USE THIS TO DELIVER MAIL SYSTEM-WIDE, YOU MUST SET UP AN
+# ALIAS THAT FORWARDS MAIL FOR ROOT TO A REAL USER.
+#
+#mailbox_command = /usr/bin/procmail
+#mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail -a "$EXTENSION"
+
+# The mailbox_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use after processing aliases and .forward files. This parameter
+# has precedence over the mailbox_command, fallback_transport and
+# luser_relay parameters.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+
+# If using the cyrus-imapd IMAP server deliver local mail to the IMAP
+# server using LMTP (Local Mail Transport Protocol), this is prefered
+# over the older cyrus deliver program by setting the
+# mailbox_transport as below:
+#
+# mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#
+# The efficiency of LMTP delivery for cyrus-imapd can be enhanced via
+# these settings.
+#
+# local_destination_recipient_limit = 300
+# local_destination_concurrency_limit = 5
+#
+# Of course you should adjust these settings as appropriate for the
+# capacity of the hardware you are using. The recipient limit setting
+# can be used to take advantage of the single instance message store
+# capability of Cyrus. The concurrency limit can be used to control
+# how many simultaneous LMTP sessions will be permitted to the Cyrus
+# message store.
+#
+# To use the old cyrus deliver program you have to set:
+#mailbox_transport = cyrus
+
+# The fallback_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use for recipients that are not found in the UNIX passwd database.
+# This parameter has precedence over the luser_relay parameter.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#fallback_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#fallback_transport =
+
+#transport_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/transport
+# The luser_relay parameter specifies an optional destination address
+# for unknown recipients. By default, mail for unknown@$mydestination,
+# unknown@[$inet_interfaces] or unknown@[$proxy_interfaces] is returned
+# as undeliverable.
+#
+# The following expansions are done on luser_relay: $user (recipient
+# username), $shell (recipient shell), $home (recipient home directory),
+# $recipient (full recipient address), $extension (recipient address
+# extension), $domain (recipient domain), $local (entire recipient
+# localpart), $recipient_delimiter. Specify ${name?value} or
+# ${name:value} to expand value only when $name does (does not) exist.
+#
+# luser_relay works only for the default Postfix local delivery agent.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must specify "local_recipient_maps =" (i.e. empty) in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#luser_relay = $user@other.host
+#luser_relay = $local@other.host
+#luser_relay = admin+$local
+
+# JUNK MAIL CONTROLS
+#
+# The controls listed here are only a very small subset. The file
+# SMTPD_ACCESS_README provides an overview.
+
+# The header_checks parameter specifies an optional table with patterns
+# that each logical message header is matched against, including
+# headers that span multiple physical lines.
+#
+# By default, these patterns also apply to MIME headers and to the
+# headers of attached messages. With older Postfix versions, MIME and
+# attached message headers were treated as body text.
+#
+# For details, see "man header_checks".
+#
+header_checks = regexp:/etc/postfix/header_checks
+
+# FAST ETRN SERVICE
+#
+# Postfix maintains per-destination logfiles with information about
+# deferred mail, so that mail can be flushed quickly with the SMTP
+# "ETRN domain.tld" command, or by executing "sendmail -qRdomain.tld".
+# See the ETRN_README document for a detailed description.
+#
+# The fast_flush_domains parameter controls what destinations are
+# eligible for this service. By default, they are all domains that
+# this server is willing to relay mail to.
+#
+#fast_flush_domains = $relay_domains
+
+# SHOW SOFTWARE VERSION OR NOT
+#
+# The smtpd_banner parameter specifies the text that follows the 220
+# code in the SMTP server's greeting banner. Some people like to see
+# the mail version advertised. By default, Postfix shows no version.
+#
+# You MUST specify $myhostname at the start of the text. That is an
+# RFC requirement. Postfix itself does not care.
+#
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name ($mail_version)
+
+# PARALLEL DELIVERY TO THE SAME DESTINATION
+#
+# How many parallel deliveries to the same user or domain? With local
+# delivery, it does not make sense to do massively parallel delivery
+# to the same user, because mailbox updates must happen sequentially,
+# and expensive pipelines in .forward files can cause disasters when
+# too many are run at the same time. With SMTP deliveries, 10
+# simultaneous connections to the same domain could be sufficient to
+# raise eyebrows.
+#
+# Each message delivery transport has its XXX_destination_concurrency_limit
+# parameter. The default is $default_destination_concurrency_limit for
+# most delivery transports. For the local delivery agent the default is 2.
+
+#local_destination_concurrency_limit = 2
+#default_destination_concurrency_limit = 20
+
+# DEBUGGING CONTROL
+#
+# The debug_peer_level parameter specifies the increment in verbose
+# logging level when an SMTP client or server host name or address
+# matches a pattern in the debug_peer_list parameter.
+#
+debug_peer_level = 2
+
+# The debug_peer_list parameter specifies an optional list of domain
+# or network patterns, /file/name patterns or type:name tables. When
+# an SMTP client or server host name or address matches a pattern,
+# increase the verbose logging level by the amount specified in the
+# debug_peer_level parameter.
+#
+#debug_peer_list = 127.0.0.1
+#debug_peer_list = some.domain
+
+# The debugger_command specifies the external command that is executed
+# when a Postfix daemon program is run with the -D option.
+#
+# Use "command .. & sleep 5" so that the debugger can attach before
+# the process marches on. If you use an X-based debugger, be sure to
+# set up your XAUTHORITY environment variable before starting Postfix.
+#
+debugger_command =
+ PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin:/usr/X11R6/bin
+ xxgdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id & sleep 5
+
+# If you can't use X, use this to capture the call stack when a
+# daemon crashes. The result is in a file in the configuration
+# directory, and is named after the process name and the process ID.
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin; export PATH; (echo cont;
+# echo where) | gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id 2>&1
+# >$config_directory/$process_name.$process_id.log & sleep 5
+#
+# Another possibility is to run gdb under a detached screen session.
+# To attach to the screen sesssion, su root and run "screen -r
+# <id_string>" where <id_string> uniquely matches one of the detached
+# sessions (from "screen -list").
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/sbin:/usr/sbin; export PATH; screen
+# -dmS $process_name gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name
+# $process_id & sleep 1
+
+# INSTALL-TIME CONFIGURATION INFORMATION
+#
+# The following parameters are used when installing a new Postfix version.
+#
+# sendmail_path: The full pathname of the Postfix sendmail command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible mail posting interface.
+#
+sendmail_path = /usr/sbin/sendmail.postfix
+
+# newaliases_path: The full pathname of the Postfix newaliases command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible command to build alias databases.
+#
+newaliases_path = /usr/bin/newaliases.postfix
+
+# mailq_path: The full pathname of the Postfix mailq command. This
+# is the Sendmail-compatible mail queue listing command.
+#
+mailq_path = /usr/bin/mailq.postfix
+
+# setgid_group: The group for mail submission and queue management
+# commands. This must be a group name with a numerical group ID that
+# is not shared with other accounts, not even with the Postfix account.
+#
+setgid_group = postdrop
+
+# html_directory: The location of the Postfix HTML documentation.
+#
+html_directory = no
+
+# manpage_directory: The location of the Postfix on-line manual pages.
+#
+manpage_directory = /usr/share/man
+
+# sample_directory: The location of the Postfix sample configuration files.
+# This parameter is obsolete as of Postfix 2.1.
+#
+sample_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/samples
+
+# readme_directory: The location of the Postfix README files.
+#
+readme_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/README_FILES
+
+# add this to new postfix to get it to add proper message-id and other
+# headers to outgoing emails via the gateway.
+
+
+message_size_limit = 20971520
+#inet_protocols = ipv4
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.phx b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.phx
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..5db2061fb
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.phx
@@ -0,0 +1,687 @@
+# "false"
+# Global Postfix configuration file. This file lists only a subset
+# of all parameters. For the syntax, and for a complete parameter
+# list, see the postconf(5) manual page (command: "man 5 postconf").
+#
+# For common configuration examples, see BASIC_CONFIGURATION_README
+# and STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README. To find these documents, use
+# the command "postconf html_directory readme_directory", or go to
+# http://www.postfix.org/.
+#
+# For best results, change no more than 2-3 parameters at a time,
+# and test if Postfix still works after every change.
+
+# SOFT BOUNCE
+#
+# The soft_bounce parameter provides a limited safety net for
+# testing. When soft_bounce is enabled, mail will remain queued that
+# would otherwise bounce. This parameter disables locally-generated
+# bounces, and prevents the SMTP server from rejecting mail permanently
+# (by changing 5xx replies into 4xx replies). However, soft_bounce
+# is no cure for address rewriting mistakes or mail routing mistakes.
+#
+#soft_bounce = no
+
+# LOCAL PATHNAME INFORMATION
+#
+# The queue_directory specifies the location of the Postfix queue.
+# This is also the root directory of Postfix daemons that run chrooted.
+# See the files in examples/chroot-setup for setting up Postfix chroot
+# environments on different UNIX systems.
+#
+queue_directory = /var/spool/postfix
+
+# The command_directory parameter specifies the location of all
+# postXXX commands.
+#
+command_directory = /usr/sbin
+
+# The daemon_directory parameter specifies the location of all Postfix
+# daemon programs (i.e. programs listed in the master.cf file). This
+# directory must be owned by root.
+#
+daemon_directory = /usr/libexec/postfix
+
+# QUEUE AND PROCESS OWNERSHIP
+#
+# The mail_owner parameter specifies the owner of the Postfix queue
+# and of most Postfix daemon processes. Specify the name of a user
+# account THAT DOES NOT SHARE ITS USER OR GROUP ID WITH OTHER ACCOUNTS
+# AND THAT OWNS NO OTHER FILES OR PROCESSES ON THE SYSTEM. In
+# particular, don't specify nobody or daemon. PLEASE USE A DEDICATED
+# USER.
+#
+mail_owner = postfix
+
+# The default_privs parameter specifies the default rights used by
+# the local delivery agent for delivery to external file or command.
+# These rights are used in the absence of a recipient user context.
+# DO NOT SPECIFY A PRIVILEGED USER OR THE POSTFIX OWNER.
+#
+#default_privs = nobody
+
+# INTERNET HOST AND DOMAIN NAMES
+#
+# The myhostname parameter specifies the internet hostname of this
+# mail system. The default is to use the fully-qualified domain name
+# from gethostname(). $myhostname is used as a default value for many
+# other configuration parameters.
+#
+#myhostname = host.domain.tld
+#myhostname = virtual.domain.tld
+
+# The mydomain parameter specifies the local internet domain name.
+# The default is to use $myhostname minus the first component.
+# $mydomain is used as a default value for many other configuration
+# parameters.
+#
+#mydomain = domain.tld
+
+# SENDING MAIL
+#
+# The myorigin parameter specifies the domain that locally-posted
+# mail appears to come from. The default is to append $myhostname,
+# which is fine for small sites. If you run a domain with multiple
+# machines, you should (1) change this to $mydomain and (2) set up
+# a domain-wide alias database that aliases each user to
+# user@that.users.mailhost.
+#
+# For the sake of consistency between sender and recipient addresses,
+# myorigin also specifies the default domain name that is appended
+# to recipient addresses that have no @domain part.
+#
+#myorigin = $myhostname
+#myorigin = $mydomain
+
+mydomain = fedoraproject.org
+myorigin = fedoraproject.org
+
+# RECEIVING MAIL
+
+# The inet_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on. By default,
+# the software claims all active interfaces on the machine. The
+# parameter also controls delivery of mail to user@[ip.address].
+#
+# See also the proxy_interfaces parameter, for network addresses that
+# are forwarded to us via a proxy or network address translator.
+#
+# Note: you need to stop/start Postfix when this parameter changes.
+#
+#inet_interfaces = all
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname, localhost
+inet_interfaces = all
+
+# The proxy_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on by way of a
+# proxy or network address translation unit. This setting extends
+# the address list specified with the inet_interfaces parameter.
+#
+# You must specify your proxy/NAT addresses when your system is a
+# backup MX host for other domains, otherwise mail delivery loops
+# will happen when the primary MX host is down.
+#
+#proxy_interfaces =
+#proxy_interfaces = 1.2.3.4
+
+# The mydestination parameter specifies the list of domains that this
+# machine considers itself the final destination for.
+#
+# These domains are routed to the delivery agent specified with the
+# local_transport parameter setting. By default, that is the UNIX
+# compatible delivery agent that lookups all recipients in /etc/passwd
+# and /etc/aliases or their equivalent.
+#
+# The default is $myhostname + localhost.$mydomain. On a mail domain
+# gateway, you should also include $mydomain.
+#
+# Do not specify the names of virtual domains - those domains are
+# specified elsewhere (see VIRTUAL_README).
+#
+# Do not specify the names of domains that this machine is backup MX
+# host for. Specify those names via the relay_domains settings for
+# the SMTP server, or use permit_mx_backup if you are lazy (see
+# STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README).
+#
+# The local machine is always the final destination for mail addressed
+# to user@[the.net.work.address] of an interface that the mail system
+# receives mail on (see the inet_interfaces parameter).
+#
+# Specify a list of host or domain names, /file/name or type:table
+# patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. A /file/name
+# pattern is replaced by its contents; a type:table is matched when
+# a name matches a lookup key (the right-hand side is ignored).
+# Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.
+#
+# See also below, section "REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS".
+#
+mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, fedora.redhat.com, localhost
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain,
+# mail.$mydomain, www.$mydomain, ftp.$mydomain
+
+# REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS
+#
+# The local_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all names or addresses of users that are local with respect
+# to $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown local users. This parameter is defined by default.
+#
+# To turn off local recipient checking in the SMTP server, specify
+# local_recipient_maps = (i.e. empty).
+#
+# The default setting assumes that you use the default Postfix local
+# delivery agent for local delivery. You need to update the
+# local_recipient_maps setting if:
+#
+# - You define $mydestination domain recipients in files other than
+# /etc/passwd, /etc/aliases, or the $virtual_alias_maps files.
+# For example, you define $mydestination domain recipients in
+# the $virtual_mailbox_maps files.
+#
+# - You redefine the local delivery agent in master.cf.
+#
+# - You redefine the "local_transport" setting in main.cf.
+#
+# - You use the "luser_relay", "mailbox_transport", or "fallback_transport"
+# feature of the Postfix local delivery agent (see local(8)).
+#
+# Details are described in the LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README file.
+#
+# Beware: if the Postfix SMTP server runs chrooted, you probably have
+# to access the passwd file via the proxymap service, in order to
+# overcome chroot restrictions. The alternative, having a copy of
+# the system passwd file in the chroot jail is just not practical.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify a bare username, an @domain.tld
+# wild-card, or specify a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#local_recipient_maps = unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps = proxy:unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps =
+
+# The unknown_local_recipient_reject_code specifies the SMTP server
+# response code when a recipient domain matches $mydestination or
+# ${proxy,inet}_interfaces, while $local_recipient_maps is non-empty
+# and the recipient address or address local-part is not found.
+#
+# The default setting is 550 (reject mail) but it is safer to start
+# with 450 (try again later) until you are certain that your
+# local_recipient_maps settings are OK.
+#
+unknown_local_recipient_reject_code = 550
+
+# TRUST AND RELAY CONTROL
+
+# The mynetworks parameter specifies the list of "trusted" SMTP
+# clients that have more privileges than "strangers".
+#
+# In particular, "trusted" SMTP clients are allowed to relay mail
+# through Postfix. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions parameter
+# in postconf(5).
+#
+# You can specify the list of "trusted" network addresses by hand
+# or you can let Postfix do it for you (which is the default).
+#
+# By default (mynetworks_style = subnet), Postfix "trusts" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP subnetworks as the local machine.
+# On Linux, this does works correctly only with interfaces specified
+# with the "ifconfig" command.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = class" when Postfix should "trust" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP class A/B/C networks as the local machine.
+# Don't do this with a dialup site - it would cause Postfix to "trust"
+# your entire provider's network. Instead, specify an explicit
+# mynetworks list by hand, as described below.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = host" when Postfix should "trust"
+# only the local machine.
+#
+#mynetworks_style = class
+#mynetworks_style = subnet
+#mynetworks_style = host
+
+# Alternatively, you can specify the mynetworks list by hand, in
+# which case Postfix ignores the mynetworks_style setting.
+#
+# Specify an explicit list of network/netmask patterns, where the
+# mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host
+# address.
+#
+# You can also specify the absolute pathname of a pattern file instead
+# of listing the patterns here. Specify type:table for table-based lookups
+# (the value on the table right-hand side is not used).
+#
+#mynetworks = 168.100.189.0/28, 127.0.0.0/8
+#mynetworks = $config_directory/mynetworks
+#mynetworks = hash:/etc/postfix/network_table
+
+
+# The relay_domains parameter restricts what destinations this system will
+# relay mail to. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions description in
+# postconf(5) for detailed information.
+#
+# By default, Postfix relays mail
+# - from "trusted" clients (IP address matches $mynetworks) to any destination,
+# - from "untrusted" clients to destinations that match $relay_domains or
+# subdomains thereof, except addresses with sender-specified routing.
+# The default relay_domains value is $mydestination.
+#
+# In addition to the above, the Postfix SMTP server by default accepts mail
+# that Postfix is final destination for:
+# - destinations that match $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces,
+# - destinations that match $mydestination
+# - destinations that match $virtual_alias_domains,
+# - destinations that match $virtual_mailbox_domains.
+# These destinations do not need to be listed in $relay_domains.
+#
+# Specify a list of hosts or domains, /file/name patterns or type:name
+# lookup tables, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue
+# long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. A file name
+# is replaced by its contents; a type:name table is matched when a
+# (parent) domain appears as lookup key.
+#
+# NOTE: Postfix will not automatically forward mail for domains that
+# list this system as their primary or backup MX host. See the
+# permit_mx_backup restriction description in postconf(5).
+#
+#relay_domains = $mydestination
+
+
+
+# INTERNET OR INTRANET
+
+# The relayhost parameter specifies the default host to send mail to
+# when no entry is matched in the optional transport(5) table. When
+# no relayhost is given, mail is routed directly to the destination.
+#
+# On an intranet, specify the organizational domain name. If your
+# internal DNS uses no MX records, specify the name of the intranet
+# gateway host instead.
+#
+# In the case of SMTP, specify a domain, host, host:port, [host]:port,
+# [address] or [address]:port; the form [host] turns off MX lookups.
+#
+# If you're connected via UUCP, see also the default_transport parameter.
+#
+#relayhost = $mydomain
+#relayhost = [gateway.my.domain]
+#relayhost = [mailserver.isp.tld]
+#relayhost = uucphost
+#relayhost = [an.ip.add.ress]
+relayhost = bastion
+
+
+# REJECTING UNKNOWN RELAY USERS
+#
+# The relay_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all addresses in the domains that match $relay_domains.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown relay users. This feature is off by default.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify an @domain.tld wild-card, or specify
+# a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#relay_recipient_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_recipients
+
+# INPUT RATE CONTROL
+#
+# The in_flow_delay configuration parameter implements mail input
+# flow control. This feature is turned on by default, although it
+# still needs further development (it's disabled on SCO UNIX due
+# to an SCO bug).
+#
+# A Postfix process will pause for $in_flow_delay seconds before
+# accepting a new message, when the message arrival rate exceeds the
+# message delivery rate. With the default 100 SMTP server process
+# limit, this limits the mail inflow to 100 messages a second more
+# than the number of messages delivered per second.
+#
+# Specify 0 to disable the feature. Valid delays are 0..10.
+#
+#in_flow_delay = 1s
+
+# ADDRESS REWRITING
+#
+# The ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document gives information about
+# address masquerading or other forms of address rewriting including
+# username->Firstname.Lastname mapping.
+
+masquerade_domains = redhat.com
+masquerade_exceptions = root apache
+
+# ADDRESS REDIRECTION (VIRTUAL DOMAIN)
+#
+# The VIRTUAL_README document gives information about the many forms
+# of domain hosting that Postfix supports.
+
+# "USER HAS MOVED" BOUNCE MESSAGES
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# TRANSPORT MAP
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# ALIAS DATABASE
+#
+# The alias_maps parameter specifies the list of alias databases used
+# by the local delivery agent. The default list is system dependent.
+#
+# On systems with NIS, the default is to search the local alias
+# database, then the NIS alias database. See aliases(5) for syntax
+# details.
+#
+# If you change the alias database, run "postalias /etc/aliases" (or
+# wherever your system stores the mail alias file), or simply run
+# "newaliases" to build the necessary DBM or DB file.
+#
+# It will take a minute or so before changes become visible. Use
+# "postfix reload" to eliminate the delay.
+#
+#alias_maps = dbm:/etc/aliases
+alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, nis:mail.aliases
+#alias_maps = netinfo:/aliases
+
+# The alias_database parameter specifies the alias database(s) that
+# are built with "newaliases" or "sendmail -bi". This is a separate
+# configuration parameter, because alias_maps (see above) may specify
+# tables that are not necessarily all under control by Postfix.
+#
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/mail/aliases
+alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases, hash:/opt/majordomo/aliases
+
+# ADDRESS EXTENSIONS (e.g., user+foo)
+#
+# The recipient_delimiter parameter specifies the separator between
+# user names and address extensions (user+foo). See canonical(5),
+# local(8), relocated(5) and virtual(5) for the effects this has on
+# aliases, canonical, virtual, relocated and .forward file lookups.
+# Basically, the software tries user+foo and .forward+foo before
+# trying user and .forward.
+#
+recipient_delimiter = +
+
+# DELIVERY TO MAILBOX
+#
+# The home_mailbox parameter specifies the optional pathname of a
+# mailbox file relative to a user's home directory. The default
+# mailbox file is /var/spool/mail/user or /var/mail/user. Specify
+# "Maildir/" for qmail-style delivery (the / is required).
+#
+#home_mailbox = Mailbox
+#home_mailbox = Maildir/
+
+# The mail_spool_directory parameter specifies the directory where
+# UNIX-style mailboxes are kept. The default setting depends on the
+# system type.
+#
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/mail
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/spool/mail
+
+# The mailbox_command parameter specifies the optional external
+# command to use instead of mailbox delivery. The command is run as
+# the recipient with proper HOME, SHELL and LOGNAME environment settings.
+# Exception: delivery for root is done as $default_user.
+#
+# Other environment variables of interest: USER (recipient username),
+# EXTENSION (address extension), DOMAIN (domain part of address),
+# and LOCAL (the address localpart).
+#
+# Unlike other Postfix configuration parameters, the mailbox_command
+# parameter is not subjected to $parameter substitutions. This is to
+# make it easier to specify shell syntax (see example below).
+#
+# Avoid shell meta characters because they will force Postfix to run
+# an expensive shell process. Procmail alone is expensive enough.
+#
+# IF YOU USE THIS TO DELIVER MAIL SYSTEM-WIDE, YOU MUST SET UP AN
+# ALIAS THAT FORWARDS MAIL FOR ROOT TO A REAL USER.
+#
+#mailbox_command = /usr/bin/procmail
+#mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail -a "$EXTENSION"
+
+# The mailbox_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use after processing aliases and .forward files. This parameter
+# has precedence over the mailbox_command, fallback_transport and
+# luser_relay parameters.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+
+# If using the cyrus-imapd IMAP server deliver local mail to the IMAP
+# server using LMTP (Local Mail Transport Protocol), this is prefered
+# over the older cyrus deliver program by setting the
+# mailbox_transport as below:
+#
+# mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#
+# The efficiency of LMTP delivery for cyrus-imapd can be enhanced via
+# these settings.
+#
+# local_destination_recipient_limit = 300
+# local_destination_concurrency_limit = 5
+#
+# Of course you should adjust these settings as appropriate for the
+# capacity of the hardware you are using. The recipient limit setting
+# can be used to take advantage of the single instance message store
+# capability of Cyrus. The concurrency limit can be used to control
+# how many simultaneous LMTP sessions will be permitted to the Cyrus
+# message store.
+#
+# To use the old cyrus deliver program you have to set:
+#mailbox_transport = cyrus
+
+# The fallback_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use for recipients that are not found in the UNIX passwd database.
+# This parameter has precedence over the luser_relay parameter.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#fallback_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#fallback_transport =
+
+#transport_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/transport
+# The luser_relay parameter specifies an optional destination address
+# for unknown recipients. By default, mail for unknown@$mydestination,
+# unknown@[$inet_interfaces] or unknown@[$proxy_interfaces] is returned
+# as undeliverable.
+#
+# The following expansions are done on luser_relay: $user (recipient
+# username), $shell (recipient shell), $home (recipient home directory),
+# $recipient (full recipient address), $extension (recipient address
+# extension), $domain (recipient domain), $local (entire recipient
+# localpart), $recipient_delimiter. Specify ${name?value} or
+# ${name:value} to expand value only when $name does (does not) exist.
+#
+# luser_relay works only for the default Postfix local delivery agent.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must specify "local_recipient_maps =" (i.e. empty) in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#luser_relay = $user@other.host
+#luser_relay = $local@other.host
+#luser_relay = admin+$local
+
+# JUNK MAIL CONTROLS
+#
+# The controls listed here are only a very small subset. The file
+# SMTPD_ACCESS_README provides an overview.
+
+# The header_checks parameter specifies an optional table with patterns
+# that each logical message header is matched against, including
+# headers that span multiple physical lines.
+#
+# By default, these patterns also apply to MIME headers and to the
+# headers of attached messages. With older Postfix versions, MIME and
+# attached message headers were treated as body text.
+#
+# For details, see "man header_checks".
+#
+header_checks = regexp:/etc/postfix/header_checks
+
+# FAST ETRN SERVICE
+#
+# Postfix maintains per-destination logfiles with information about
+# deferred mail, so that mail can be flushed quickly with the SMTP
+# "ETRN domain.tld" command, or by executing "sendmail -qRdomain.tld".
+# See the ETRN_README document for a detailed description.
+#
+# The fast_flush_domains parameter controls what destinations are
+# eligible for this service. By default, they are all domains that
+# this server is willing to relay mail to.
+#
+#fast_flush_domains = $relay_domains
+
+# SHOW SOFTWARE VERSION OR NOT
+#
+# The smtpd_banner parameter specifies the text that follows the 220
+# code in the SMTP server's greeting banner. Some people like to see
+# the mail version advertised. By default, Postfix shows no version.
+#
+# You MUST specify $myhostname at the start of the text. That is an
+# RFC requirement. Postfix itself does not care.
+#
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name ($mail_version)
+
+# PARALLEL DELIVERY TO THE SAME DESTINATION
+#
+# How many parallel deliveries to the same user or domain? With local
+# delivery, it does not make sense to do massively parallel delivery
+# to the same user, because mailbox updates must happen sequentially,
+# and expensive pipelines in .forward files can cause disasters when
+# too many are run at the same time. With SMTP deliveries, 10
+# simultaneous connections to the same domain could be sufficient to
+# raise eyebrows.
+#
+# Each message delivery transport has its XXX_destination_concurrency_limit
+# parameter. The default is $default_destination_concurrency_limit for
+# most delivery transports. For the local delivery agent the default is 2.
+
+#local_destination_concurrency_limit = 2
+#default_destination_concurrency_limit = 20
+
+# DEBUGGING CONTROL
+#
+# The debug_peer_level parameter specifies the increment in verbose
+# logging level when an SMTP client or server host name or address
+# matches a pattern in the debug_peer_list parameter.
+#
+debug_peer_level = 2
+
+# The debug_peer_list parameter specifies an optional list of domain
+# or network patterns, /file/name patterns or type:name tables. When
+# an SMTP client or server host name or address matches a pattern,
+# increase the verbose logging level by the amount specified in the
+# debug_peer_level parameter.
+#
+#debug_peer_list = 127.0.0.1
+#debug_peer_list = some.domain
+
+# The debugger_command specifies the external command that is executed
+# when a Postfix daemon program is run with the -D option.
+#
+# Use "command .. & sleep 5" so that the debugger can attach before
+# the process marches on. If you use an X-based debugger, be sure to
+# set up your XAUTHORITY environment variable before starting Postfix.
+#
+debugger_command =
+ PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin:/usr/X11R6/bin
+ xxgdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id & sleep 5
+
+# If you can't use X, use this to capture the call stack when a
+# daemon crashes. The result is in a file in the configuration
+# directory, and is named after the process name and the process ID.
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin; export PATH; (echo cont;
+# echo where) | gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id 2>&1
+# >$config_directory/$process_name.$process_id.log & sleep 5
+#
+# Another possibility is to run gdb under a detached screen session.
+# To attach to the screen sesssion, su root and run "screen -r
+# <id_string>" where <id_string> uniquely matches one of the detached
+# sessions (from "screen -list").
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/sbin:/usr/sbin; export PATH; screen
+# -dmS $process_name gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name
+# $process_id & sleep 1
+
+# INSTALL-TIME CONFIGURATION INFORMATION
+#
+# The following parameters are used when installing a new Postfix version.
+#
+# sendmail_path: The full pathname of the Postfix sendmail command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible mail posting interface.
+#
+sendmail_path = /usr/sbin/sendmail.postfix
+
+# newaliases_path: The full pathname of the Postfix newaliases command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible command to build alias databases.
+#
+newaliases_path = /usr/bin/newaliases.postfix
+
+# mailq_path: The full pathname of the Postfix mailq command. This
+# is the Sendmail-compatible mail queue listing command.
+#
+mailq_path = /usr/bin/mailq.postfix
+
+# setgid_group: The group for mail submission and queue management
+# commands. This must be a group name with a numerical group ID that
+# is not shared with other accounts, not even with the Postfix account.
+#
+setgid_group = postdrop
+
+# html_directory: The location of the Postfix HTML documentation.
+#
+html_directory = no
+
+# manpage_directory: The location of the Postfix on-line manual pages.
+#
+manpage_directory = /usr/share/man
+
+# sample_directory: The location of the Postfix sample configuration files.
+# This parameter is obsolete as of Postfix 2.1.
+#
+sample_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/samples
+
+# readme_directory: The location of the Postfix README files.
+#
+readme_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/README_FILES
+
+# add this to new postfix to get it to add proper message-id and other
+# headers to outgoing emails via the gateway.
+
+
+message_size_limit = 20971520
+#inet_protocols = ipv4
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.phx2 b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.phx2
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..3d792fd2b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.phx2
@@ -0,0 +1,687 @@
+# "false"
+# Global Postfix configuration file. This file lists only a subset
+# of all parameters. For the syntax, and for a complete parameter
+# list, see the postconf(5) manual page (command: "man 5 postconf").
+#
+# For common configuration examples, see BASIC_CONFIGURATION_README
+# and STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README. To find these documents, use
+# the command "postconf html_directory readme_directory", or go to
+# http://www.postfix.org/.
+#
+# For best results, change no more than 2-3 parameters at a time,
+# and test if Postfix still works after every change.
+
+# SOFT BOUNCE
+#
+# The soft_bounce parameter provides a limited safety net for
+# testing. When soft_bounce is enabled, mail will remain queued that
+# would otherwise bounce. This parameter disables locally-generated
+# bounces, and prevents the SMTP server from rejecting mail permanently
+# (by changing 5xx replies into 4xx replies). However, soft_bounce
+# is no cure for address rewriting mistakes or mail routing mistakes.
+#
+#soft_bounce = no
+
+# LOCAL PATHNAME INFORMATION
+#
+# The queue_directory specifies the location of the Postfix queue.
+# This is also the root directory of Postfix daemons that run chrooted.
+# See the files in examples/chroot-setup for setting up Postfix chroot
+# environments on different UNIX systems.
+#
+queue_directory = /var/spool/postfix
+
+# The command_directory parameter specifies the location of all
+# postXXX commands.
+#
+command_directory = /usr/sbin
+
+# The daemon_directory parameter specifies the location of all Postfix
+# daemon programs (i.e. programs listed in the master.cf file). This
+# directory must be owned by root.
+#
+daemon_directory = /usr/libexec/postfix
+
+# QUEUE AND PROCESS OWNERSHIP
+#
+# The mail_owner parameter specifies the owner of the Postfix queue
+# and of most Postfix daemon processes. Specify the name of a user
+# account THAT DOES NOT SHARE ITS USER OR GROUP ID WITH OTHER ACCOUNTS
+# AND THAT OWNS NO OTHER FILES OR PROCESSES ON THE SYSTEM. In
+# particular, don't specify nobody or daemon. PLEASE USE A DEDICATED
+# USER.
+#
+mail_owner = postfix
+
+# The default_privs parameter specifies the default rights used by
+# the local delivery agent for delivery to external file or command.
+# These rights are used in the absence of a recipient user context.
+# DO NOT SPECIFY A PRIVILEGED USER OR THE POSTFIX OWNER.
+#
+#default_privs = nobody
+
+# INTERNET HOST AND DOMAIN NAMES
+#
+# The myhostname parameter specifies the internet hostname of this
+# mail system. The default is to use the fully-qualified domain name
+# from gethostname(). $myhostname is used as a default value for many
+# other configuration parameters.
+#
+#myhostname = host.domain.tld
+#myhostname = virtual.domain.tld
+
+# The mydomain parameter specifies the local internet domain name.
+# The default is to use $myhostname minus the first component.
+# $mydomain is used as a default value for many other configuration
+# parameters.
+#
+#mydomain = domain.tld
+
+# SENDING MAIL
+#
+# The myorigin parameter specifies the domain that locally-posted
+# mail appears to come from. The default is to append $myhostname,
+# which is fine for small sites. If you run a domain with multiple
+# machines, you should (1) change this to $mydomain and (2) set up
+# a domain-wide alias database that aliases each user to
+# user@that.users.mailhost.
+#
+# For the sake of consistency between sender and recipient addresses,
+# myorigin also specifies the default domain name that is appended
+# to recipient addresses that have no @domain part.
+#
+#myorigin = $myhostname
+#myorigin = $mydomain
+
+mydomain = fedoraproject.org
+myorigin = fedoraproject.org
+
+# RECEIVING MAIL
+
+# The inet_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on. By default,
+# the software claims all active interfaces on the machine. The
+# parameter also controls delivery of mail to user@[ip.address].
+#
+# See also the proxy_interfaces parameter, for network addresses that
+# are forwarded to us via a proxy or network address translator.
+#
+# Note: you need to stop/start Postfix when this parameter changes.
+#
+#inet_interfaces = all
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname, localhost
+inet_interfaces = all
+
+# The proxy_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on by way of a
+# proxy or network address translation unit. This setting extends
+# the address list specified with the inet_interfaces parameter.
+#
+# You must specify your proxy/NAT addresses when your system is a
+# backup MX host for other domains, otherwise mail delivery loops
+# will happen when the primary MX host is down.
+#
+#proxy_interfaces =
+#proxy_interfaces = 1.2.3.4
+
+# The mydestination parameter specifies the list of domains that this
+# machine considers itself the final destination for.
+#
+# These domains are routed to the delivery agent specified with the
+# local_transport parameter setting. By default, that is the UNIX
+# compatible delivery agent that lookups all recipients in /etc/passwd
+# and /etc/aliases or their equivalent.
+#
+# The default is $myhostname + localhost.$mydomain. On a mail domain
+# gateway, you should also include $mydomain.
+#
+# Do not specify the names of virtual domains - those domains are
+# specified elsewhere (see VIRTUAL_README).
+#
+# Do not specify the names of domains that this machine is backup MX
+# host for. Specify those names via the relay_domains settings for
+# the SMTP server, or use permit_mx_backup if you are lazy (see
+# STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README).
+#
+# The local machine is always the final destination for mail addressed
+# to user@[the.net.work.address] of an interface that the mail system
+# receives mail on (see the inet_interfaces parameter).
+#
+# Specify a list of host or domain names, /file/name or type:table
+# patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. A /file/name
+# pattern is replaced by its contents; a type:table is matched when
+# a name matches a lookup key (the right-hand side is ignored).
+# Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.
+#
+# See also below, section "REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS".
+#
+mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, fedora.redhat.com, localhost
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain,
+# mail.$mydomain, www.$mydomain, ftp.$mydomain
+
+# REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS
+#
+# The local_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all names or addresses of users that are local with respect
+# to $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown local users. This parameter is defined by default.
+#
+# To turn off local recipient checking in the SMTP server, specify
+# local_recipient_maps = (i.e. empty).
+#
+# The default setting assumes that you use the default Postfix local
+# delivery agent for local delivery. You need to update the
+# local_recipient_maps setting if:
+#
+# - You define $mydestination domain recipients in files other than
+# /etc/passwd, /etc/aliases, or the $virtual_alias_maps files.
+# For example, you define $mydestination domain recipients in
+# the $virtual_mailbox_maps files.
+#
+# - You redefine the local delivery agent in master.cf.
+#
+# - You redefine the "local_transport" setting in main.cf.
+#
+# - You use the "luser_relay", "mailbox_transport", or "fallback_transport"
+# feature of the Postfix local delivery agent (see local(8)).
+#
+# Details are described in the LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README file.
+#
+# Beware: if the Postfix SMTP server runs chrooted, you probably have
+# to access the passwd file via the proxymap service, in order to
+# overcome chroot restrictions. The alternative, having a copy of
+# the system passwd file in the chroot jail is just not practical.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify a bare username, an @domain.tld
+# wild-card, or specify a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#local_recipient_maps = unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps = proxy:unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps =
+
+# The unknown_local_recipient_reject_code specifies the SMTP server
+# response code when a recipient domain matches $mydestination or
+# ${proxy,inet}_interfaces, while $local_recipient_maps is non-empty
+# and the recipient address or address local-part is not found.
+#
+# The default setting is 550 (reject mail) but it is safer to start
+# with 450 (try again later) until you are certain that your
+# local_recipient_maps settings are OK.
+#
+unknown_local_recipient_reject_code = 550
+
+# TRUST AND RELAY CONTROL
+
+# The mynetworks parameter specifies the list of "trusted" SMTP
+# clients that have more privileges than "strangers".
+#
+# In particular, "trusted" SMTP clients are allowed to relay mail
+# through Postfix. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions parameter
+# in postconf(5).
+#
+# You can specify the list of "trusted" network addresses by hand
+# or you can let Postfix do it for you (which is the default).
+#
+# By default (mynetworks_style = subnet), Postfix "trusts" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP subnetworks as the local machine.
+# On Linux, this does works correctly only with interfaces specified
+# with the "ifconfig" command.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = class" when Postfix should "trust" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP class A/B/C networks as the local machine.
+# Don't do this with a dialup site - it would cause Postfix to "trust"
+# your entire provider's network. Instead, specify an explicit
+# mynetworks list by hand, as described below.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = host" when Postfix should "trust"
+# only the local machine.
+#
+#mynetworks_style = class
+#mynetworks_style = subnet
+#mynetworks_style = host
+
+# Alternatively, you can specify the mynetworks list by hand, in
+# which case Postfix ignores the mynetworks_style setting.
+#
+# Specify an explicit list of network/netmask patterns, where the
+# mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host
+# address.
+#
+# You can also specify the absolute pathname of a pattern file instead
+# of listing the patterns here. Specify type:table for table-based lookups
+# (the value on the table right-hand side is not used).
+#
+#mynetworks = 168.100.189.0/28, 127.0.0.0/8
+#mynetworks = $config_directory/mynetworks
+#mynetworks = hash:/etc/postfix/network_table
+
+
+# The relay_domains parameter restricts what destinations this system will
+# relay mail to. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions description in
+# postconf(5) for detailed information.
+#
+# By default, Postfix relays mail
+# - from "trusted" clients (IP address matches $mynetworks) to any destination,
+# - from "untrusted" clients to destinations that match $relay_domains or
+# subdomains thereof, except addresses with sender-specified routing.
+# The default relay_domains value is $mydestination.
+#
+# In addition to the above, the Postfix SMTP server by default accepts mail
+# that Postfix is final destination for:
+# - destinations that match $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces,
+# - destinations that match $mydestination
+# - destinations that match $virtual_alias_domains,
+# - destinations that match $virtual_mailbox_domains.
+# These destinations do not need to be listed in $relay_domains.
+#
+# Specify a list of hosts or domains, /file/name patterns or type:name
+# lookup tables, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue
+# long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. A file name
+# is replaced by its contents; a type:name table is matched when a
+# (parent) domain appears as lookup key.
+#
+# NOTE: Postfix will not automatically forward mail for domains that
+# list this system as their primary or backup MX host. See the
+# permit_mx_backup restriction description in postconf(5).
+#
+#relay_domains = $mydestination
+
+
+
+# INTERNET OR INTRANET
+
+# The relayhost parameter specifies the default host to send mail to
+# when no entry is matched in the optional transport(5) table. When
+# no relayhost is given, mail is routed directly to the destination.
+#
+# On an intranet, specify the organizational domain name. If your
+# internal DNS uses no MX records, specify the name of the intranet
+# gateway host instead.
+#
+# In the case of SMTP, specify a domain, host, host:port, [host]:port,
+# [address] or [address]:port; the form [host] turns off MX lookups.
+#
+# If you're connected via UUCP, see also the default_transport parameter.
+#
+#relayhost = $mydomain
+#relayhost = [gateway.my.domain]
+#relayhost = [mailserver.isp.tld]
+#relayhost = uucphost
+#relayhost = [an.ip.add.ress]
+relayhost = bastion.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+
+
+# REJECTING UNKNOWN RELAY USERS
+#
+# The relay_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all addresses in the domains that match $relay_domains.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown relay users. This feature is off by default.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify an @domain.tld wild-card, or specify
+# a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#relay_recipient_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_recipients
+
+# INPUT RATE CONTROL
+#
+# The in_flow_delay configuration parameter implements mail input
+# flow control. This feature is turned on by default, although it
+# still needs further development (it's disabled on SCO UNIX due
+# to an SCO bug).
+#
+# A Postfix process will pause for $in_flow_delay seconds before
+# accepting a new message, when the message arrival rate exceeds the
+# message delivery rate. With the default 100 SMTP server process
+# limit, this limits the mail inflow to 100 messages a second more
+# than the number of messages delivered per second.
+#
+# Specify 0 to disable the feature. Valid delays are 0..10.
+#
+#in_flow_delay = 1s
+
+# ADDRESS REWRITING
+#
+# The ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document gives information about
+# address masquerading or other forms of address rewriting including
+# username->Firstname.Lastname mapping.
+
+masquerade_domains = redhat.com
+masquerade_exceptions = root apache
+
+# ADDRESS REDIRECTION (VIRTUAL DOMAIN)
+#
+# The VIRTUAL_README document gives information about the many forms
+# of domain hosting that Postfix supports.
+
+# "USER HAS MOVED" BOUNCE MESSAGES
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# TRANSPORT MAP
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# ALIAS DATABASE
+#
+# The alias_maps parameter specifies the list of alias databases used
+# by the local delivery agent. The default list is system dependent.
+#
+# On systems with NIS, the default is to search the local alias
+# database, then the NIS alias database. See aliases(5) for syntax
+# details.
+#
+# If you change the alias database, run "postalias /etc/aliases" (or
+# wherever your system stores the mail alias file), or simply run
+# "newaliases" to build the necessary DBM or DB file.
+#
+# It will take a minute or so before changes become visible. Use
+# "postfix reload" to eliminate the delay.
+#
+#alias_maps = dbm:/etc/aliases
+alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, nis:mail.aliases
+#alias_maps = netinfo:/aliases
+
+# The alias_database parameter specifies the alias database(s) that
+# are built with "newaliases" or "sendmail -bi". This is a separate
+# configuration parameter, because alias_maps (see above) may specify
+# tables that are not necessarily all under control by Postfix.
+#
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/mail/aliases
+alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases, hash:/opt/majordomo/aliases
+
+# ADDRESS EXTENSIONS (e.g., user+foo)
+#
+# The recipient_delimiter parameter specifies the separator between
+# user names and address extensions (user+foo). See canonical(5),
+# local(8), relocated(5) and virtual(5) for the effects this has on
+# aliases, canonical, virtual, relocated and .forward file lookups.
+# Basically, the software tries user+foo and .forward+foo before
+# trying user and .forward.
+#
+recipient_delimiter = +
+
+# DELIVERY TO MAILBOX
+#
+# The home_mailbox parameter specifies the optional pathname of a
+# mailbox file relative to a user's home directory. The default
+# mailbox file is /var/spool/mail/user or /var/mail/user. Specify
+# "Maildir/" for qmail-style delivery (the / is required).
+#
+#home_mailbox = Mailbox
+#home_mailbox = Maildir/
+
+# The mail_spool_directory parameter specifies the directory where
+# UNIX-style mailboxes are kept. The default setting depends on the
+# system type.
+#
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/mail
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/spool/mail
+
+# The mailbox_command parameter specifies the optional external
+# command to use instead of mailbox delivery. The command is run as
+# the recipient with proper HOME, SHELL and LOGNAME environment settings.
+# Exception: delivery for root is done as $default_user.
+#
+# Other environment variables of interest: USER (recipient username),
+# EXTENSION (address extension), DOMAIN (domain part of address),
+# and LOCAL (the address localpart).
+#
+# Unlike other Postfix configuration parameters, the mailbox_command
+# parameter is not subjected to $parameter substitutions. This is to
+# make it easier to specify shell syntax (see example below).
+#
+# Avoid shell meta characters because they will force Postfix to run
+# an expensive shell process. Procmail alone is expensive enough.
+#
+# IF YOU USE THIS TO DELIVER MAIL SYSTEM-WIDE, YOU MUST SET UP AN
+# ALIAS THAT FORWARDS MAIL FOR ROOT TO A REAL USER.
+#
+#mailbox_command = /usr/bin/procmail
+#mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail -a "$EXTENSION"
+
+# The mailbox_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use after processing aliases and .forward files. This parameter
+# has precedence over the mailbox_command, fallback_transport and
+# luser_relay parameters.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+
+# If using the cyrus-imapd IMAP server deliver local mail to the IMAP
+# server using LMTP (Local Mail Transport Protocol), this is prefered
+# over the older cyrus deliver program by setting the
+# mailbox_transport as below:
+#
+# mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#
+# The efficiency of LMTP delivery for cyrus-imapd can be enhanced via
+# these settings.
+#
+# local_destination_recipient_limit = 300
+# local_destination_concurrency_limit = 5
+#
+# Of course you should adjust these settings as appropriate for the
+# capacity of the hardware you are using. The recipient limit setting
+# can be used to take advantage of the single instance message store
+# capability of Cyrus. The concurrency limit can be used to control
+# how many simultaneous LMTP sessions will be permitted to the Cyrus
+# message store.
+#
+# To use the old cyrus deliver program you have to set:
+#mailbox_transport = cyrus
+
+# The fallback_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use for recipients that are not found in the UNIX passwd database.
+# This parameter has precedence over the luser_relay parameter.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#fallback_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#fallback_transport =
+
+#transport_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/transport
+# The luser_relay parameter specifies an optional destination address
+# for unknown recipients. By default, mail for unknown@$mydestination,
+# unknown@[$inet_interfaces] or unknown@[$proxy_interfaces] is returned
+# as undeliverable.
+#
+# The following expansions are done on luser_relay: $user (recipient
+# username), $shell (recipient shell), $home (recipient home directory),
+# $recipient (full recipient address), $extension (recipient address
+# extension), $domain (recipient domain), $local (entire recipient
+# localpart), $recipient_delimiter. Specify ${name?value} or
+# ${name:value} to expand value only when $name does (does not) exist.
+#
+# luser_relay works only for the default Postfix local delivery agent.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must specify "local_recipient_maps =" (i.e. empty) in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#luser_relay = $user@other.host
+#luser_relay = $local@other.host
+#luser_relay = admin+$local
+
+# JUNK MAIL CONTROLS
+#
+# The controls listed here are only a very small subset. The file
+# SMTPD_ACCESS_README provides an overview.
+
+# The header_checks parameter specifies an optional table with patterns
+# that each logical message header is matched against, including
+# headers that span multiple physical lines.
+#
+# By default, these patterns also apply to MIME headers and to the
+# headers of attached messages. With older Postfix versions, MIME and
+# attached message headers were treated as body text.
+#
+# For details, see "man header_checks".
+#
+header_checks = regexp:/etc/postfix/header_checks
+
+# FAST ETRN SERVICE
+#
+# Postfix maintains per-destination logfiles with information about
+# deferred mail, so that mail can be flushed quickly with the SMTP
+# "ETRN domain.tld" command, or by executing "sendmail -qRdomain.tld".
+# See the ETRN_README document for a detailed description.
+#
+# The fast_flush_domains parameter controls what destinations are
+# eligible for this service. By default, they are all domains that
+# this server is willing to relay mail to.
+#
+#fast_flush_domains = $relay_domains
+
+# SHOW SOFTWARE VERSION OR NOT
+#
+# The smtpd_banner parameter specifies the text that follows the 220
+# code in the SMTP server's greeting banner. Some people like to see
+# the mail version advertised. By default, Postfix shows no version.
+#
+# You MUST specify $myhostname at the start of the text. That is an
+# RFC requirement. Postfix itself does not care.
+#
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name ($mail_version)
+
+# PARALLEL DELIVERY TO THE SAME DESTINATION
+#
+# How many parallel deliveries to the same user or domain? With local
+# delivery, it does not make sense to do massively parallel delivery
+# to the same user, because mailbox updates must happen sequentially,
+# and expensive pipelines in .forward files can cause disasters when
+# too many are run at the same time. With SMTP deliveries, 10
+# simultaneous connections to the same domain could be sufficient to
+# raise eyebrows.
+#
+# Each message delivery transport has its XXX_destination_concurrency_limit
+# parameter. The default is $default_destination_concurrency_limit for
+# most delivery transports. For the local delivery agent the default is 2.
+
+#local_destination_concurrency_limit = 2
+#default_destination_concurrency_limit = 20
+
+# DEBUGGING CONTROL
+#
+# The debug_peer_level parameter specifies the increment in verbose
+# logging level when an SMTP client or server host name or address
+# matches a pattern in the debug_peer_list parameter.
+#
+debug_peer_level = 2
+
+# The debug_peer_list parameter specifies an optional list of domain
+# or network patterns, /file/name patterns or type:name tables. When
+# an SMTP client or server host name or address matches a pattern,
+# increase the verbose logging level by the amount specified in the
+# debug_peer_level parameter.
+#
+#debug_peer_list = 127.0.0.1
+#debug_peer_list = some.domain
+
+# The debugger_command specifies the external command that is executed
+# when a Postfix daemon program is run with the -D option.
+#
+# Use "command .. & sleep 5" so that the debugger can attach before
+# the process marches on. If you use an X-based debugger, be sure to
+# set up your XAUTHORITY environment variable before starting Postfix.
+#
+debugger_command =
+ PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin:/usr/X11R6/bin
+ xxgdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id & sleep 5
+
+# If you can't use X, use this to capture the call stack when a
+# daemon crashes. The result is in a file in the configuration
+# directory, and is named after the process name and the process ID.
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin; export PATH; (echo cont;
+# echo where) | gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id 2>&1
+# >$config_directory/$process_name.$process_id.log & sleep 5
+#
+# Another possibility is to run gdb under a detached screen session.
+# To attach to the screen sesssion, su root and run "screen -r
+# <id_string>" where <id_string> uniquely matches one of the detached
+# sessions (from "screen -list").
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/sbin:/usr/sbin; export PATH; screen
+# -dmS $process_name gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name
+# $process_id & sleep 1
+
+# INSTALL-TIME CONFIGURATION INFORMATION
+#
+# The following parameters are used when installing a new Postfix version.
+#
+# sendmail_path: The full pathname of the Postfix sendmail command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible mail posting interface.
+#
+sendmail_path = /usr/sbin/sendmail.postfix
+
+# newaliases_path: The full pathname of the Postfix newaliases command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible command to build alias databases.
+#
+newaliases_path = /usr/bin/newaliases.postfix
+
+# mailq_path: The full pathname of the Postfix mailq command. This
+# is the Sendmail-compatible mail queue listing command.
+#
+mailq_path = /usr/bin/mailq.postfix
+
+# setgid_group: The group for mail submission and queue management
+# commands. This must be a group name with a numerical group ID that
+# is not shared with other accounts, not even with the Postfix account.
+#
+setgid_group = postdrop
+
+# html_directory: The location of the Postfix HTML documentation.
+#
+html_directory = no
+
+# manpage_directory: The location of the Postfix on-line manual pages.
+#
+manpage_directory = /usr/share/man
+
+# sample_directory: The location of the Postfix sample configuration files.
+# This parameter is obsolete as of Postfix 2.1.
+#
+sample_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/samples
+
+# readme_directory: The location of the Postfix README files.
+#
+readme_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/README_FILES
+
+# add this to new postfix to get it to add proper message-id and other
+# headers to outgoing emails via the gateway.
+
+
+message_size_limit = 20971520
+#inet_protocols = ipv4
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.rdu b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.rdu
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..f3c260f73
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.rdu
@@ -0,0 +1,686 @@
+# "false"
+# Global Postfix configuration file. This file lists only a subset
+# of all parameters. For the syntax, and for a complete parameter
+# list, see the postconf(5) manual page (command: "man 5 postconf").
+#
+# For common configuration examples, see BASIC_CONFIGURATION_README
+# and STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README. To find these documents, use
+# the command "postconf html_directory readme_directory", or go to
+# http://www.postfix.org/.
+#
+# For best results, change no more than 2-3 parameters at a time,
+# and test if Postfix still works after every change.
+
+# SOFT BOUNCE
+#
+# The soft_bounce parameter provides a limited safety net for
+# testing. When soft_bounce is enabled, mail will remain queued that
+# would otherwise bounce. This parameter disables locally-generated
+# bounces, and prevents the SMTP server from rejecting mail permanently
+# (by changing 5xx replies into 4xx replies). However, soft_bounce
+# is no cure for address rewriting mistakes or mail routing mistakes.
+#
+#soft_bounce = no
+
+# LOCAL PATHNAME INFORMATION
+#
+# The queue_directory specifies the location of the Postfix queue.
+# This is also the root directory of Postfix daemons that run chrooted.
+# See the files in examples/chroot-setup for setting up Postfix chroot
+# environments on different UNIX systems.
+#
+queue_directory = /var/spool/postfix
+
+# The command_directory parameter specifies the location of all
+# postXXX commands.
+#
+command_directory = /usr/sbin
+
+# The daemon_directory parameter specifies the location of all Postfix
+# daemon programs (i.e. programs listed in the master.cf file). This
+# directory must be owned by root.
+#
+daemon_directory = /usr/libexec/postfix
+
+# QUEUE AND PROCESS OWNERSHIP
+#
+# The mail_owner parameter specifies the owner of the Postfix queue
+# and of most Postfix daemon processes. Specify the name of a user
+# account THAT DOES NOT SHARE ITS USER OR GROUP ID WITH OTHER ACCOUNTS
+# AND THAT OWNS NO OTHER FILES OR PROCESSES ON THE SYSTEM. In
+# particular, don't specify nobody or daemon. PLEASE USE A DEDICATED
+# USER.
+#
+mail_owner = postfix
+
+# The default_privs parameter specifies the default rights used by
+# the local delivery agent for delivery to external file or command.
+# These rights are used in the absence of a recipient user context.
+# DO NOT SPECIFY A PRIVILEGED USER OR THE POSTFIX OWNER.
+#
+#default_privs = nobody
+
+# INTERNET HOST AND DOMAIN NAMES
+#
+# The myhostname parameter specifies the internet hostname of this
+# mail system. The default is to use the fully-qualified domain name
+# from gethostname(). $myhostname is used as a default value for many
+# other configuration parameters.
+#
+#myhostname = host.domain.tld
+#myhostname = virtual.domain.tld
+
+# The mydomain parameter specifies the local internet domain name.
+# The default is to use $myhostname minus the first component.
+# $mydomain is used as a default value for many other configuration
+# parameters.
+#
+#mydomain = domain.tld
+
+# SENDING MAIL
+#
+# The myorigin parameter specifies the domain that locally-posted
+# mail appears to come from. The default is to append $myhostname,
+# which is fine for small sites. If you run a domain with multiple
+# machines, you should (1) change this to $mydomain and (2) set up
+# a domain-wide alias database that aliases each user to
+# user@that.users.mailhost.
+#
+# For the sake of consistency between sender and recipient addresses,
+# myorigin also specifies the default domain name that is appended
+# to recipient addresses that have no @domain part.
+#
+#myorigin = $myhostname
+#myorigin = $mydomain
+
+mydomain = fedoraproject.org
+myorigin = fedoraproject.org
+
+# RECEIVING MAIL
+
+# The inet_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on. By default,
+# the software claims all active interfaces on the machine. The
+# parameter also controls delivery of mail to user@[ip.address].
+#
+# See also the proxy_interfaces parameter, for network addresses that
+# are forwarded to us via a proxy or network address translator.
+#
+# Note: you need to stop/start Postfix when this parameter changes.
+#
+#inet_interfaces = all
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname, localhost
+inet_interfaces = all
+
+# The proxy_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on by way of a
+# proxy or network address translation unit. This setting extends
+# the address list specified with the inet_interfaces parameter.
+#
+# You must specify your proxy/NAT addresses when your system is a
+# backup MX host for other domains, otherwise mail delivery loops
+# will happen when the primary MX host is down.
+#
+#proxy_interfaces =
+#proxy_interfaces = 1.2.3.4
+
+# The mydestination parameter specifies the list of domains that this
+# machine considers itself the final destination for.
+#
+# These domains are routed to the delivery agent specified with the
+# local_transport parameter setting. By default, that is the UNIX
+# compatible delivery agent that lookups all recipients in /etc/passwd
+# and /etc/aliases or their equivalent.
+#
+# The default is $myhostname + localhost.$mydomain. On a mail domain
+# gateway, you should also include $mydomain.
+#
+# Do not specify the names of virtual domains - those domains are
+# specified elsewhere (see VIRTUAL_README).
+#
+# Do not specify the names of domains that this machine is backup MX
+# host for. Specify those names via the relay_domains settings for
+# the SMTP server, or use permit_mx_backup if you are lazy (see
+# STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README).
+#
+# The local machine is always the final destination for mail addressed
+# to user@[the.net.work.address] of an interface that the mail system
+# receives mail on (see the inet_interfaces parameter).
+#
+# Specify a list of host or domain names, /file/name or type:table
+# patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. A /file/name
+# pattern is replaced by its contents; a type:table is matched when
+# a name matches a lookup key (the right-hand side is ignored).
+# Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.
+#
+# See also below, section "REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS".
+#
+mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, fedora.redhat.com, localhost
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain,
+# mail.$mydomain, www.$mydomain, ftp.$mydomain
+
+# REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS
+#
+# The local_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all names or addresses of users that are local with respect
+# to $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown local users. This parameter is defined by default.
+#
+# To turn off local recipient checking in the SMTP server, specify
+# local_recipient_maps = (i.e. empty).
+#
+# The default setting assumes that you use the default Postfix local
+# delivery agent for local delivery. You need to update the
+# local_recipient_maps setting if:
+#
+# - You define $mydestination domain recipients in files other than
+# /etc/passwd, /etc/aliases, or the $virtual_alias_maps files.
+# For example, you define $mydestination domain recipients in
+# the $virtual_mailbox_maps files.
+#
+# - You redefine the local delivery agent in master.cf.
+#
+# - You redefine the "local_transport" setting in main.cf.
+#
+# - You use the "luser_relay", "mailbox_transport", or "fallback_transport"
+# feature of the Postfix local delivery agent (see local(8)).
+#
+# Details are described in the LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README file.
+#
+# Beware: if the Postfix SMTP server runs chrooted, you probably have
+# to access the passwd file via the proxymap service, in order to
+# overcome chroot restrictions. The alternative, having a copy of
+# the system passwd file in the chroot jail is just not practical.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify a bare username, an @domain.tld
+# wild-card, or specify a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#local_recipient_maps = unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps = proxy:unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps =
+
+# The unknown_local_recipient_reject_code specifies the SMTP server
+# response code when a recipient domain matches $mydestination or
+# ${proxy,inet}_interfaces, while $local_recipient_maps is non-empty
+# and the recipient address or address local-part is not found.
+#
+# The default setting is 550 (reject mail) but it is safer to start
+# with 450 (try again later) until you are certain that your
+# local_recipient_maps settings are OK.
+#
+unknown_local_recipient_reject_code = 550
+
+# TRUST AND RELAY CONTROL
+
+# The mynetworks parameter specifies the list of "trusted" SMTP
+# clients that have more privileges than "strangers".
+#
+# In particular, "trusted" SMTP clients are allowed to relay mail
+# through Postfix. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions parameter
+# in postconf(5).
+#
+# You can specify the list of "trusted" network addresses by hand
+# or you can let Postfix do it for you (which is the default).
+#
+# By default (mynetworks_style = subnet), Postfix "trusts" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP subnetworks as the local machine.
+# On Linux, this does works correctly only with interfaces specified
+# with the "ifconfig" command.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = class" when Postfix should "trust" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP class A/B/C networks as the local machine.
+# Don't do this with a dialup site - it would cause Postfix to "trust"
+# your entire provider's network. Instead, specify an explicit
+# mynetworks list by hand, as described below.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = host" when Postfix should "trust"
+# only the local machine.
+#
+#mynetworks_style = class
+#mynetworks_style = subnet
+#mynetworks_style = host
+
+# Alternatively, you can specify the mynetworks list by hand, in
+# which case Postfix ignores the mynetworks_style setting.
+#
+# Specify an explicit list of network/netmask patterns, where the
+# mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host
+# address.
+#
+# You can also specify the absolute pathname of a pattern file instead
+# of listing the patterns here. Specify type:table for table-based lookups
+# (the value on the table right-hand side is not used).
+#
+#mynetworks = 168.100.189.0/28, 127.0.0.0/8
+#mynetworks = $config_directory/mynetworks
+#mynetworks = hash:/etc/postfix/network_table
+
+
+# The relay_domains parameter restricts what destinations this system will
+# relay mail to. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions description in
+# postconf(5) for detailed information.
+#
+# By default, Postfix relays mail
+# - from "trusted" clients (IP address matches $mynetworks) to any destination,
+# - from "untrusted" clients to destinations that match $relay_domains or
+# subdomains thereof, except addresses with sender-specified routing.
+# The default relay_domains value is $mydestination.
+#
+# In addition to the above, the Postfix SMTP server by default accepts mail
+# that Postfix is final destination for:
+# - destinations that match $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces,
+# - destinations that match $mydestination
+# - destinations that match $virtual_alias_domains,
+# - destinations that match $virtual_mailbox_domains.
+# These destinations do not need to be listed in $relay_domains.
+#
+# Specify a list of hosts or domains, /file/name patterns or type:name
+# lookup tables, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue
+# long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. A file name
+# is replaced by its contents; a type:name table is matched when a
+# (parent) domain appears as lookup key.
+#
+# NOTE: Postfix will not automatically forward mail for domains that
+# list this system as their primary or backup MX host. See the
+# permit_mx_backup restriction description in postconf(5).
+#
+#relay_domains = $mydestination
+
+
+
+# INTERNET OR INTRANET
+
+# The relayhost parameter specifies the default host to send mail to
+# when no entry is matched in the optional transport(5) table. When
+# no relayhost is given, mail is routed directly to the destination.
+#
+# On an intranet, specify the organizational domain name. If your
+# internal DNS uses no MX records, specify the name of the intranet
+# gateway host instead.
+#
+# In the case of SMTP, specify a domain, host, host:port, [host]:port,
+# [address] or [address]:port; the form [host] turns off MX lookups.
+#
+# If you're connected via UUCP, see also the default_transport parameter.
+#
+#relayhost = $mydomain
+#relayhost = [gateway.my.domain]
+#relayhost = [mailserver.isp.tld]
+#relayhost = uucphost
+#relayhost = [an.ip.add.ress]
+relayhost = bastion
+
+
+# REJECTING UNKNOWN RELAY USERS
+#
+# The relay_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all addresses in the domains that match $relay_domains.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown relay users. This feature is off by default.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify an @domain.tld wild-card, or specify
+# a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#relay_recipient_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_recipients
+
+# INPUT RATE CONTROL
+#
+# The in_flow_delay configuration parameter implements mail input
+# flow control. This feature is turned on by default, although it
+# still needs further development (it's disabled on SCO UNIX due
+# to an SCO bug).
+#
+# A Postfix process will pause for $in_flow_delay seconds before
+# accepting a new message, when the message arrival rate exceeds the
+# message delivery rate. With the default 100 SMTP server process
+# limit, this limits the mail inflow to 100 messages a second more
+# than the number of messages delivered per second.
+#
+# Specify 0 to disable the feature. Valid delays are 0..10.
+#
+#in_flow_delay = 1s
+
+# ADDRESS REWRITING
+#
+# The ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document gives information about
+# address masquerading or other forms of address rewriting including
+# username->Firstname.Lastname mapping.
+
+masquerade_domains = redhat.com
+masquerade_exceptions = root apache
+
+# ADDRESS REDIRECTION (VIRTUAL DOMAIN)
+#
+# The VIRTUAL_README document gives information about the many forms
+# of domain hosting that Postfix supports.
+
+# "USER HAS MOVED" BOUNCE MESSAGES
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# TRANSPORT MAP
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# ALIAS DATABASE
+#
+# The alias_maps parameter specifies the list of alias databases used
+# by the local delivery agent. The default list is system dependent.
+#
+# On systems with NIS, the default is to search the local alias
+# database, then the NIS alias database. See aliases(5) for syntax
+# details.
+#
+# If you change the alias database, run "postalias /etc/aliases" (or
+# wherever your system stores the mail alias file), or simply run
+# "newaliases" to build the necessary DBM or DB file.
+#
+# It will take a minute or so before changes become visible. Use
+# "postfix reload" to eliminate the delay.
+#
+#alias_maps = dbm:/etc/aliases
+alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, nis:mail.aliases
+#alias_maps = netinfo:/aliases
+
+# The alias_database parameter specifies the alias database(s) that
+# are built with "newaliases" or "sendmail -bi". This is a separate
+# configuration parameter, because alias_maps (see above) may specify
+# tables that are not necessarily all under control by Postfix.
+#
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/mail/aliases
+alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases, hash:/opt/majordomo/aliases
+
+# ADDRESS EXTENSIONS (e.g., user+foo)
+#
+# The recipient_delimiter parameter specifies the separator between
+# user names and address extensions (user+foo). See canonical(5),
+# local(8), relocated(5) and virtual(5) for the effects this has on
+# aliases, canonical, virtual, relocated and .forward file lookups.
+# Basically, the software tries user+foo and .forward+foo before
+# trying user and .forward.
+#
+recipient_delimiter = +
+
+# DELIVERY TO MAILBOX
+#
+# The home_mailbox parameter specifies the optional pathname of a
+# mailbox file relative to a user's home directory. The default
+# mailbox file is /var/spool/mail/user or /var/mail/user. Specify
+# "Maildir/" for qmail-style delivery (the / is required).
+#
+#home_mailbox = Mailbox
+#home_mailbox = Maildir/
+
+# The mail_spool_directory parameter specifies the directory where
+# UNIX-style mailboxes are kept. The default setting depends on the
+# system type.
+#
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/mail
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/spool/mail
+
+# The mailbox_command parameter specifies the optional external
+# command to use instead of mailbox delivery. The command is run as
+# the recipient with proper HOME, SHELL and LOGNAME environment settings.
+# Exception: delivery for root is done as $default_user.
+#
+# Other environment variables of interest: USER (recipient username),
+# EXTENSION (address extension), DOMAIN (domain part of address),
+# and LOCAL (the address localpart).
+#
+# Unlike other Postfix configuration parameters, the mailbox_command
+# parameter is not subjected to $parameter substitutions. This is to
+# make it easier to specify shell syntax (see example below).
+#
+# Avoid shell meta characters because they will force Postfix to run
+# an expensive shell process. Procmail alone is expensive enough.
+#
+# IF YOU USE THIS TO DELIVER MAIL SYSTEM-WIDE, YOU MUST SET UP AN
+# ALIAS THAT FORWARDS MAIL FOR ROOT TO A REAL USER.
+#
+#mailbox_command = /usr/bin/procmail
+#mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail -a "$EXTENSION"
+
+# The mailbox_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use after processing aliases and .forward files. This parameter
+# has precedence over the mailbox_command, fallback_transport and
+# luser_relay parameters.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+
+# If using the cyrus-imapd IMAP server deliver local mail to the IMAP
+# server using LMTP (Local Mail Transport Protocol), this is prefered
+# over the older cyrus deliver program by setting the
+# mailbox_transport as below:
+#
+# mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#
+# The efficiency of LMTP delivery for cyrus-imapd can be enhanced via
+# these settings.
+#
+# local_destination_recipient_limit = 300
+# local_destination_concurrency_limit = 5
+#
+# Of course you should adjust these settings as appropriate for the
+# capacity of the hardware you are using. The recipient limit setting
+# can be used to take advantage of the single instance message store
+# capability of Cyrus. The concurrency limit can be used to control
+# how many simultaneous LMTP sessions will be permitted to the Cyrus
+# message store.
+#
+# To use the old cyrus deliver program you have to set:
+#mailbox_transport = cyrus
+
+# The fallback_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use for recipients that are not found in the UNIX passwd database.
+# This parameter has precedence over the luser_relay parameter.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#fallback_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#fallback_transport =
+
+#transport_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/transport
+# The luser_relay parameter specifies an optional destination address
+# for unknown recipients. By default, mail for unknown@$mydestination,
+# unknown@[$inet_interfaces] or unknown@[$proxy_interfaces] is returned
+# as undeliverable.
+#
+# The following expansions are done on luser_relay: $user (recipient
+# username), $shell (recipient shell), $home (recipient home directory),
+# $recipient (full recipient address), $extension (recipient address
+# extension), $domain (recipient domain), $local (entire recipient
+# localpart), $recipient_delimiter. Specify ${name?value} or
+# ${name:value} to expand value only when $name does (does not) exist.
+#
+# luser_relay works only for the default Postfix local delivery agent.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must specify "local_recipient_maps =" (i.e. empty) in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#luser_relay = $user@other.host
+#luser_relay = $local@other.host
+#luser_relay = admin+$local
+
+# JUNK MAIL CONTROLS
+#
+# The controls listed here are only a very small subset. The file
+# SMTPD_ACCESS_README provides an overview.
+
+# The header_checks parameter specifies an optional table with patterns
+# that each logical message header is matched against, including
+# headers that span multiple physical lines.
+#
+# By default, these patterns also apply to MIME headers and to the
+# headers of attached messages. With older Postfix versions, MIME and
+# attached message headers were treated as body text.
+#
+# For details, see "man header_checks".
+#
+header_checks = regexp:/etc/postfix/header_checks
+
+# FAST ETRN SERVICE
+#
+# Postfix maintains per-destination logfiles with information about
+# deferred mail, so that mail can be flushed quickly with the SMTP
+# "ETRN domain.tld" command, or by executing "sendmail -qRdomain.tld".
+# See the ETRN_README document for a detailed description.
+#
+# The fast_flush_domains parameter controls what destinations are
+# eligible for this service. By default, they are all domains that
+# this server is willing to relay mail to.
+#
+#fast_flush_domains = $relay_domains
+
+# SHOW SOFTWARE VERSION OR NOT
+#
+# The smtpd_banner parameter specifies the text that follows the 220
+# code in the SMTP server's greeting banner. Some people like to see
+# the mail version advertised. By default, Postfix shows no version.
+#
+# You MUST specify $myhostname at the start of the text. That is an
+# RFC requirement. Postfix itself does not care.
+#
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name ($mail_version)
+
+# PARALLEL DELIVERY TO THE SAME DESTINATION
+#
+# How many parallel deliveries to the same user or domain? With local
+# delivery, it does not make sense to do massively parallel delivery
+# to the same user, because mailbox updates must happen sequentially,
+# and expensive pipelines in .forward files can cause disasters when
+# too many are run at the same time. With SMTP deliveries, 10
+# simultaneous connections to the same domain could be sufficient to
+# raise eyebrows.
+#
+# Each message delivery transport has its XXX_destination_concurrency_limit
+# parameter. The default is $default_destination_concurrency_limit for
+# most delivery transports. For the local delivery agent the default is 2.
+
+#local_destination_concurrency_limit = 2
+#default_destination_concurrency_limit = 20
+
+# DEBUGGING CONTROL
+#
+# The debug_peer_level parameter specifies the increment in verbose
+# logging level when an SMTP client or server host name or address
+# matches a pattern in the debug_peer_list parameter.
+#
+debug_peer_level = 2
+
+# The debug_peer_list parameter specifies an optional list of domain
+# or network patterns, /file/name patterns or type:name tables. When
+# an SMTP client or server host name or address matches a pattern,
+# increase the verbose logging level by the amount specified in the
+# debug_peer_level parameter.
+#
+#debug_peer_list = 127.0.0.1
+#debug_peer_list = some.domain
+
+# The debugger_command specifies the external command that is executed
+# when a Postfix daemon program is run with the -D option.
+#
+# Use "command .. & sleep 5" so that the debugger can attach before
+# the process marches on. If you use an X-based debugger, be sure to
+# set up your XAUTHORITY environment variable before starting Postfix.
+#
+debugger_command =
+ PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin:/usr/X11R6/bin
+ xxgdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id & sleep 5
+
+# If you can't use X, use this to capture the call stack when a
+# daemon crashes. The result is in a file in the configuration
+# directory, and is named after the process name and the process ID.
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin; export PATH; (echo cont;
+# echo where) | gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id 2>&1
+# >$config_directory/$process_name.$process_id.log & sleep 5
+#
+# Another possibility is to run gdb under a detached screen session.
+# To attach to the screen sesssion, su root and run "screen -r
+# <id_string>" where <id_string> uniquely matches one of the detached
+# sessions (from "screen -list").
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/sbin:/usr/sbin; export PATH; screen
+# -dmS $process_name gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name
+# $process_id & sleep 1
+
+# INSTALL-TIME CONFIGURATION INFORMATION
+#
+# The following parameters are used when installing a new Postfix version.
+#
+# sendmail_path: The full pathname of the Postfix sendmail command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible mail posting interface.
+#
+sendmail_path = /usr/sbin/sendmail.postfix
+
+# newaliases_path: The full pathname of the Postfix newaliases command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible command to build alias databases.
+#
+newaliases_path = /usr/bin/newaliases.postfix
+
+# mailq_path: The full pathname of the Postfix mailq command. This
+# is the Sendmail-compatible mail queue listing command.
+#
+mailq_path = /usr/bin/mailq.postfix
+
+# setgid_group: The group for mail submission and queue management
+# commands. This must be a group name with a numerical group ID that
+# is not shared with other accounts, not even with the Postfix account.
+#
+setgid_group = postdrop
+
+# html_directory: The location of the Postfix HTML documentation.
+#
+html_directory = no
+
+# manpage_directory: The location of the Postfix on-line manual pages.
+#
+manpage_directory = /usr/share/man
+
+# sample_directory: The location of the Postfix sample configuration files.
+# This parameter is obsolete as of Postfix 2.1.
+#
+sample_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/samples
+
+# readme_directory: The location of the Postfix README files.
+#
+readme_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/README_FILES
+
+# add this to new postfix to get it to add proper message-id and other
+# headers to outgoing emails via the gateway.
+
+
+message_size_limit = 20971520
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.releng b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.releng
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..dffe3b913
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.releng
@@ -0,0 +1,686 @@
+# "false"
+# Global Postfix configuration file. This file lists only a subset
+# of all parameters. For the syntax, and for a complete parameter
+# list, see the postconf(5) manual page (command: "man 5 postconf").
+#
+# For common configuration examples, see BASIC_CONFIGURATION_README
+# and STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README. To find these documents, use
+# the command "postconf html_directory readme_directory", or go to
+# http://www.postfix.org/.
+#
+# For best results, change no more than 2-3 parameters at a time,
+# and test if Postfix still works after every change.
+
+# SOFT BOUNCE
+#
+# The soft_bounce parameter provides a limited safety net for
+# testing. When soft_bounce is enabled, mail will remain queued that
+# would otherwise bounce. This parameter disables locally-generated
+# bounces, and prevents the SMTP server from rejecting mail permanently
+# (by changing 5xx replies into 4xx replies). However, soft_bounce
+# is no cure for address rewriting mistakes or mail routing mistakes.
+#
+#soft_bounce = no
+
+# LOCAL PATHNAME INFORMATION
+#
+# The queue_directory specifies the location of the Postfix queue.
+# This is also the root directory of Postfix daemons that run chrooted.
+# See the files in examples/chroot-setup for setting up Postfix chroot
+# environments on different UNIX systems.
+#
+queue_directory = /var/spool/postfix
+
+# The command_directory parameter specifies the location of all
+# postXXX commands.
+#
+command_directory = /usr/sbin
+
+# The daemon_directory parameter specifies the location of all Postfix
+# daemon programs (i.e. programs listed in the master.cf file). This
+# directory must be owned by root.
+#
+daemon_directory = /usr/libexec/postfix
+
+# QUEUE AND PROCESS OWNERSHIP
+#
+# The mail_owner parameter specifies the owner of the Postfix queue
+# and of most Postfix daemon processes. Specify the name of a user
+# account THAT DOES NOT SHARE ITS USER OR GROUP ID WITH OTHER ACCOUNTS
+# AND THAT OWNS NO OTHER FILES OR PROCESSES ON THE SYSTEM. In
+# particular, don't specify nobody or daemon. PLEASE USE A DEDICATED
+# USER.
+#
+mail_owner = postfix
+
+# The default_privs parameter specifies the default rights used by
+# the local delivery agent for delivery to external file or command.
+# These rights are used in the absence of a recipient user context.
+# DO NOT SPECIFY A PRIVILEGED USER OR THE POSTFIX OWNER.
+#
+#default_privs = nobody
+
+# INTERNET HOST AND DOMAIN NAMES
+#
+# The myhostname parameter specifies the internet hostname of this
+# mail system. The default is to use the fully-qualified domain name
+# from gethostname(). $myhostname is used as a default value for many
+# other configuration parameters.
+#
+#myhostname = host.domain.tld
+#myhostname = virtual.domain.tld
+
+# The mydomain parameter specifies the local internet domain name.
+# The default is to use $myhostname minus the first component.
+# $mydomain is used as a default value for many other configuration
+# parameters.
+#
+#mydomain = domain.tld
+
+# SENDING MAIL
+#
+# The myorigin parameter specifies the domain that locally-posted
+# mail appears to come from. The default is to append $myhostname,
+# which is fine for small sites. If you run a domain with multiple
+# machines, you should (1) change this to $mydomain and (2) set up
+# a domain-wide alias database that aliases each user to
+# user@that.users.mailhost.
+#
+# For the sake of consistency between sender and recipient addresses,
+# myorigin also specifies the default domain name that is appended
+# to recipient addresses that have no @domain part.
+#
+#myorigin = $myhostname
+#myorigin = $mydomain
+
+mydomain = fedoraproject.org
+myorigin = fedoraproject.org
+
+# RECEIVING MAIL
+
+# The inet_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on. By default,
+# the software claims all active interfaces on the machine. The
+# parameter also controls delivery of mail to user@[ip.address].
+#
+# See also the proxy_interfaces parameter, for network addresses that
+# are forwarded to us via a proxy or network address translator.
+#
+# Note: you need to stop/start Postfix when this parameter changes.
+#
+#inet_interfaces = all
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname, localhost
+inet_interfaces = 127.0.0.1
+
+# The proxy_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on by way of a
+# proxy or network address translation unit. This setting extends
+# the address list specified with the inet_interfaces parameter.
+#
+# You must specify your proxy/NAT addresses when your system is a
+# backup MX host for other domains, otherwise mail delivery loops
+# will happen when the primary MX host is down.
+#
+#proxy_interfaces =
+#proxy_interfaces = 1.2.3.4
+
+# The mydestination parameter specifies the list of domains that this
+# machine considers itself the final destination for.
+#
+# These domains are routed to the delivery agent specified with the
+# local_transport parameter setting. By default, that is the UNIX
+# compatible delivery agent that lookups all recipients in /etc/passwd
+# and /etc/aliases or their equivalent.
+#
+# The default is $myhostname + localhost.$mydomain. On a mail domain
+# gateway, you should also include $mydomain.
+#
+# Do not specify the names of virtual domains - those domains are
+# specified elsewhere (see VIRTUAL_README).
+#
+# Do not specify the names of domains that this machine is backup MX
+# host for. Specify those names via the relay_domains settings for
+# the SMTP server, or use permit_mx_backup if you are lazy (see
+# STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README).
+#
+# The local machine is always the final destination for mail addressed
+# to user@[the.net.work.address] of an interface that the mail system
+# receives mail on (see the inet_interfaces parameter).
+#
+# Specify a list of host or domain names, /file/name or type:table
+# patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. A /file/name
+# pattern is replaced by its contents; a type:table is matched when
+# a name matches a lookup key (the right-hand side is ignored).
+# Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.
+#
+# See also below, section "REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS".
+#
+mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, fedora.redhat.com, localhost
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain,
+# mail.$mydomain, www.$mydomain, ftp.$mydomain
+
+# REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS
+#
+# The local_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all names or addresses of users that are local with respect
+# to $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown local users. This parameter is defined by default.
+#
+# To turn off local recipient checking in the SMTP server, specify
+# local_recipient_maps = (i.e. empty).
+#
+# The default setting assumes that you use the default Postfix local
+# delivery agent for local delivery. You need to update the
+# local_recipient_maps setting if:
+#
+# - You define $mydestination domain recipients in files other than
+# /etc/passwd, /etc/aliases, or the $virtual_alias_maps files.
+# For example, you define $mydestination domain recipients in
+# the $virtual_mailbox_maps files.
+#
+# - You redefine the local delivery agent in master.cf.
+#
+# - You redefine the "local_transport" setting in main.cf.
+#
+# - You use the "luser_relay", "mailbox_transport", or "fallback_transport"
+# feature of the Postfix local delivery agent (see local(8)).
+#
+# Details are described in the LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README file.
+#
+# Beware: if the Postfix SMTP server runs chrooted, you probably have
+# to access the passwd file via the proxymap service, in order to
+# overcome chroot restrictions. The alternative, having a copy of
+# the system passwd file in the chroot jail is just not practical.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify a bare username, an @domain.tld
+# wild-card, or specify a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#local_recipient_maps = unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps = proxy:unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps =
+
+# The unknown_local_recipient_reject_code specifies the SMTP server
+# response code when a recipient domain matches $mydestination or
+# ${proxy,inet}_interfaces, while $local_recipient_maps is non-empty
+# and the recipient address or address local-part is not found.
+#
+# The default setting is 550 (reject mail) but it is safer to start
+# with 450 (try again later) until you are certain that your
+# local_recipient_maps settings are OK.
+#
+unknown_local_recipient_reject_code = 550
+
+# TRUST AND RELAY CONTROL
+
+# The mynetworks parameter specifies the list of "trusted" SMTP
+# clients that have more privileges than "strangers".
+#
+# In particular, "trusted" SMTP clients are allowed to relay mail
+# through Postfix. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions parameter
+# in postconf(5).
+#
+# You can specify the list of "trusted" network addresses by hand
+# or you can let Postfix do it for you (which is the default).
+#
+# By default (mynetworks_style = subnet), Postfix "trusts" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP subnetworks as the local machine.
+# On Linux, this does works correctly only with interfaces specified
+# with the "ifconfig" command.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = class" when Postfix should "trust" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP class A/B/C networks as the local machine.
+# Don't do this with a dialup site - it would cause Postfix to "trust"
+# your entire provider's network. Instead, specify an explicit
+# mynetworks list by hand, as described below.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = host" when Postfix should "trust"
+# only the local machine.
+#
+#mynetworks_style = class
+#mynetworks_style = subnet
+#mynetworks_style = host
+
+# Alternatively, you can specify the mynetworks list by hand, in
+# which case Postfix ignores the mynetworks_style setting.
+#
+# Specify an explicit list of network/netmask patterns, where the
+# mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host
+# address.
+#
+# You can also specify the absolute pathname of a pattern file instead
+# of listing the patterns here. Specify type:table for table-based lookups
+# (the value on the table right-hand side is not used).
+#
+#mynetworks = 168.100.189.0/28, 127.0.0.0/8
+#mynetworks = $config_directory/mynetworks
+#mynetworks = hash:/etc/postfix/network_table
+
+
+# The relay_domains parameter restricts what destinations this system will
+# relay mail to. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions description in
+# postconf(5) for detailed information.
+#
+# By default, Postfix relays mail
+# - from "trusted" clients (IP address matches $mynetworks) to any destination,
+# - from "untrusted" clients to destinations that match $relay_domains or
+# subdomains thereof, except addresses with sender-specified routing.
+# The default relay_domains value is $mydestination.
+#
+# In addition to the above, the Postfix SMTP server by default accepts mail
+# that Postfix is final destination for:
+# - destinations that match $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces,
+# - destinations that match $mydestination
+# - destinations that match $virtual_alias_domains,
+# - destinations that match $virtual_mailbox_domains.
+# These destinations do not need to be listed in $relay_domains.
+#
+# Specify a list of hosts or domains, /file/name patterns or type:name
+# lookup tables, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue
+# long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. A file name
+# is replaced by its contents; a type:name table is matched when a
+# (parent) domain appears as lookup key.
+#
+# NOTE: Postfix will not automatically forward mail for domains that
+# list this system as their primary or backup MX host. See the
+# permit_mx_backup restriction description in postconf(5).
+#
+#relay_domains = $mydestination
+
+
+
+# INTERNET OR INTRANET
+
+# The relayhost parameter specifies the default host to send mail to
+# when no entry is matched in the optional transport(5) table. When
+# no relayhost is given, mail is routed directly to the destination.
+#
+# On an intranet, specify the organizational domain name. If your
+# internal DNS uses no MX records, specify the name of the intranet
+# gateway host instead.
+#
+# In the case of SMTP, specify a domain, host, host:port, [host]:port,
+# [address] or [address]:port; the form [host] turns off MX lookups.
+#
+# If you're connected via UUCP, see also the default_transport parameter.
+#
+#relayhost = $mydomain
+#relayhost = [gateway.my.domain]
+#relayhost = [mailserver.isp.tld]
+#relayhost = uucphost
+#relayhost = [an.ip.add.ress]
+relayhost = bastion.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+
+
+# REJECTING UNKNOWN RELAY USERS
+#
+# The relay_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all addresses in the domains that match $relay_domains.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown relay users. This feature is off by default.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify an @domain.tld wild-card, or specify
+# a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#relay_recipient_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_recipients
+
+# INPUT RATE CONTROL
+#
+# The in_flow_delay configuration parameter implements mail input
+# flow control. This feature is turned on by default, although it
+# still needs further development (it's disabled on SCO UNIX due
+# to an SCO bug).
+#
+# A Postfix process will pause for $in_flow_delay seconds before
+# accepting a new message, when the message arrival rate exceeds the
+# message delivery rate. With the default 100 SMTP server process
+# limit, this limits the mail inflow to 100 messages a second more
+# than the number of messages delivered per second.
+#
+# Specify 0 to disable the feature. Valid delays are 0..10.
+#
+#in_flow_delay = 1s
+
+# ADDRESS REWRITING
+#
+# The ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document gives information about
+# address masquerading or other forms of address rewriting including
+# username->Firstname.Lastname mapping.
+
+masquerade_domains = redhat.com
+masquerade_exceptions = root apache
+
+# ADDRESS REDIRECTION (VIRTUAL DOMAIN)
+#
+# The VIRTUAL_README document gives information about the many forms
+# of domain hosting that Postfix supports.
+
+# "USER HAS MOVED" BOUNCE MESSAGES
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# TRANSPORT MAP
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# ALIAS DATABASE
+#
+# The alias_maps parameter specifies the list of alias databases used
+# by the local delivery agent. The default list is system dependent.
+#
+# On systems with NIS, the default is to search the local alias
+# database, then the NIS alias database. See aliases(5) for syntax
+# details.
+#
+# If you change the alias database, run "postalias /etc/aliases" (or
+# wherever your system stores the mail alias file), or simply run
+# "newaliases" to build the necessary DBM or DB file.
+#
+# It will take a minute or so before changes become visible. Use
+# "postfix reload" to eliminate the delay.
+#
+#alias_maps = dbm:/etc/aliases
+alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, nis:mail.aliases
+#alias_maps = netinfo:/aliases
+
+# The alias_database parameter specifies the alias database(s) that
+# are built with "newaliases" or "sendmail -bi". This is a separate
+# configuration parameter, because alias_maps (see above) may specify
+# tables that are not necessarily all under control by Postfix.
+#
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/mail/aliases
+alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases, hash:/opt/majordomo/aliases
+
+# ADDRESS EXTENSIONS (e.g., user+foo)
+#
+# The recipient_delimiter parameter specifies the separator between
+# user names and address extensions (user+foo). See canonical(5),
+# local(8), relocated(5) and virtual(5) for the effects this has on
+# aliases, canonical, virtual, relocated and .forward file lookups.
+# Basically, the software tries user+foo and .forward+foo before
+# trying user and .forward.
+#
+recipient_delimiter = +
+
+# DELIVERY TO MAILBOX
+#
+# The home_mailbox parameter specifies the optional pathname of a
+# mailbox file relative to a user's home directory. The default
+# mailbox file is /var/spool/mail/user or /var/mail/user. Specify
+# "Maildir/" for qmail-style delivery (the / is required).
+#
+#home_mailbox = Mailbox
+#home_mailbox = Maildir/
+
+# The mail_spool_directory parameter specifies the directory where
+# UNIX-style mailboxes are kept. The default setting depends on the
+# system type.
+#
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/mail
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/spool/mail
+
+# The mailbox_command parameter specifies the optional external
+# command to use instead of mailbox delivery. The command is run as
+# the recipient with proper HOME, SHELL and LOGNAME environment settings.
+# Exception: delivery for root is done as $default_user.
+#
+# Other environment variables of interest: USER (recipient username),
+# EXTENSION (address extension), DOMAIN (domain part of address),
+# and LOCAL (the address localpart).
+#
+# Unlike other Postfix configuration parameters, the mailbox_command
+# parameter is not subjected to $parameter substitutions. This is to
+# make it easier to specify shell syntax (see example below).
+#
+# Avoid shell meta characters because they will force Postfix to run
+# an expensive shell process. Procmail alone is expensive enough.
+#
+# IF YOU USE THIS TO DELIVER MAIL SYSTEM-WIDE, YOU MUST SET UP AN
+# ALIAS THAT FORWARDS MAIL FOR ROOT TO A REAL USER.
+#
+#mailbox_command = /usr/bin/procmail
+#mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail -a "$EXTENSION"
+
+# The mailbox_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use after processing aliases and .forward files. This parameter
+# has precedence over the mailbox_command, fallback_transport and
+# luser_relay parameters.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+
+# If using the cyrus-imapd IMAP server deliver local mail to the IMAP
+# server using LMTP (Local Mail Transport Protocol), this is prefered
+# over the older cyrus deliver program by setting the
+# mailbox_transport as below:
+#
+# mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#
+# The efficiency of LMTP delivery for cyrus-imapd can be enhanced via
+# these settings.
+#
+# local_destination_recipient_limit = 300
+# local_destination_concurrency_limit = 5
+#
+# Of course you should adjust these settings as appropriate for the
+# capacity of the hardware you are using. The recipient limit setting
+# can be used to take advantage of the single instance message store
+# capability of Cyrus. The concurrency limit can be used to control
+# how many simultaneous LMTP sessions will be permitted to the Cyrus
+# message store.
+#
+# To use the old cyrus deliver program you have to set:
+#mailbox_transport = cyrus
+
+# The fallback_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use for recipients that are not found in the UNIX passwd database.
+# This parameter has precedence over the luser_relay parameter.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#fallback_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#fallback_transport =
+
+#transport_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/transport
+# The luser_relay parameter specifies an optional destination address
+# for unknown recipients. By default, mail for unknown@$mydestination,
+# unknown@[$inet_interfaces] or unknown@[$proxy_interfaces] is returned
+# as undeliverable.
+#
+# The following expansions are done on luser_relay: $user (recipient
+# username), $shell (recipient shell), $home (recipient home directory),
+# $recipient (full recipient address), $extension (recipient address
+# extension), $domain (recipient domain), $local (entire recipient
+# localpart), $recipient_delimiter. Specify ${name?value} or
+# ${name:value} to expand value only when $name does (does not) exist.
+#
+# luser_relay works only for the default Postfix local delivery agent.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must specify "local_recipient_maps =" (i.e. empty) in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#luser_relay = $user@other.host
+#luser_relay = $local@other.host
+#luser_relay = admin+$local
+
+# JUNK MAIL CONTROLS
+#
+# The controls listed here are only a very small subset. The file
+# SMTPD_ACCESS_README provides an overview.
+
+# The header_checks parameter specifies an optional table with patterns
+# that each logical message header is matched against, including
+# headers that span multiple physical lines.
+#
+# By default, these patterns also apply to MIME headers and to the
+# headers of attached messages. With older Postfix versions, MIME and
+# attached message headers were treated as body text.
+#
+# For details, see "man header_checks".
+#
+header_checks = regexp:/etc/postfix/header_checks
+
+# FAST ETRN SERVICE
+#
+# Postfix maintains per-destination logfiles with information about
+# deferred mail, so that mail can be flushed quickly with the SMTP
+# "ETRN domain.tld" command, or by executing "sendmail -qRdomain.tld".
+# See the ETRN_README document for a detailed description.
+#
+# The fast_flush_domains parameter controls what destinations are
+# eligible for this service. By default, they are all domains that
+# this server is willing to relay mail to.
+#
+#fast_flush_domains = $relay_domains
+
+# SHOW SOFTWARE VERSION OR NOT
+#
+# The smtpd_banner parameter specifies the text that follows the 220
+# code in the SMTP server's greeting banner. Some people like to see
+# the mail version advertised. By default, Postfix shows no version.
+#
+# You MUST specify $myhostname at the start of the text. That is an
+# RFC requirement. Postfix itself does not care.
+#
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name ($mail_version)
+
+# PARALLEL DELIVERY TO THE SAME DESTINATION
+#
+# How many parallel deliveries to the same user or domain? With local
+# delivery, it does not make sense to do massively parallel delivery
+# to the same user, because mailbox updates must happen sequentially,
+# and expensive pipelines in .forward files can cause disasters when
+# too many are run at the same time. With SMTP deliveries, 10
+# simultaneous connections to the same domain could be sufficient to
+# raise eyebrows.
+#
+# Each message delivery transport has its XXX_destination_concurrency_limit
+# parameter. The default is $default_destination_concurrency_limit for
+# most delivery transports. For the local delivery agent the default is 2.
+
+#local_destination_concurrency_limit = 2
+#default_destination_concurrency_limit = 20
+
+# DEBUGGING CONTROL
+#
+# The debug_peer_level parameter specifies the increment in verbose
+# logging level when an SMTP client or server host name or address
+# matches a pattern in the debug_peer_list parameter.
+#
+debug_peer_level = 2
+
+# The debug_peer_list parameter specifies an optional list of domain
+# or network patterns, /file/name patterns or type:name tables. When
+# an SMTP client or server host name or address matches a pattern,
+# increase the verbose logging level by the amount specified in the
+# debug_peer_level parameter.
+#
+#debug_peer_list = 127.0.0.1
+#debug_peer_list = some.domain
+
+# The debugger_command specifies the external command that is executed
+# when a Postfix daemon program is run with the -D option.
+#
+# Use "command .. & sleep 5" so that the debugger can attach before
+# the process marches on. If you use an X-based debugger, be sure to
+# set up your XAUTHORITY environment variable before starting Postfix.
+#
+debugger_command =
+ PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin:/usr/X11R6/bin
+ xxgdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id & sleep 5
+
+# If you can't use X, use this to capture the call stack when a
+# daemon crashes. The result is in a file in the configuration
+# directory, and is named after the process name and the process ID.
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin; export PATH; (echo cont;
+# echo where) | gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id 2>&1
+# >$config_directory/$process_name.$process_id.log & sleep 5
+#
+# Another possibility is to run gdb under a detached screen session.
+# To attach to the screen sesssion, su root and run "screen -r
+# <id_string>" where <id_string> uniquely matches one of the detached
+# sessions (from "screen -list").
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/sbin:/usr/sbin; export PATH; screen
+# -dmS $process_name gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name
+# $process_id & sleep 1
+
+# INSTALL-TIME CONFIGURATION INFORMATION
+#
+# The following parameters are used when installing a new Postfix version.
+#
+# sendmail_path: The full pathname of the Postfix sendmail command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible mail posting interface.
+#
+sendmail_path = /usr/sbin/sendmail.postfix
+
+# newaliases_path: The full pathname of the Postfix newaliases command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible command to build alias databases.
+#
+newaliases_path = /usr/bin/newaliases.postfix
+
+# mailq_path: The full pathname of the Postfix mailq command. This
+# is the Sendmail-compatible mail queue listing command.
+#
+mailq_path = /usr/bin/mailq.postfix
+
+# setgid_group: The group for mail submission and queue management
+# commands. This must be a group name with a numerical group ID that
+# is not shared with other accounts, not even with the Postfix account.
+#
+setgid_group = postdrop
+
+# html_directory: The location of the Postfix HTML documentation.
+#
+html_directory = no
+
+# manpage_directory: The location of the Postfix on-line manual pages.
+#
+manpage_directory = /usr/share/man
+
+# sample_directory: The location of the Postfix sample configuration files.
+# This parameter is obsolete as of Postfix 2.1.
+#
+sample_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/samples
+
+# readme_directory: The location of the Postfix README files.
+#
+readme_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/README_FILES
+
+# add this to new postfix to get it to add proper message-id and other
+# headers to outgoing emails via the gateway.
+
+
+message_size_limit = 20971520
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.sign b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.sign
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..f3c260f73
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.sign
@@ -0,0 +1,686 @@
+# "false"
+# Global Postfix configuration file. This file lists only a subset
+# of all parameters. For the syntax, and for a complete parameter
+# list, see the postconf(5) manual page (command: "man 5 postconf").
+#
+# For common configuration examples, see BASIC_CONFIGURATION_README
+# and STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README. To find these documents, use
+# the command "postconf html_directory readme_directory", or go to
+# http://www.postfix.org/.
+#
+# For best results, change no more than 2-3 parameters at a time,
+# and test if Postfix still works after every change.
+
+# SOFT BOUNCE
+#
+# The soft_bounce parameter provides a limited safety net for
+# testing. When soft_bounce is enabled, mail will remain queued that
+# would otherwise bounce. This parameter disables locally-generated
+# bounces, and prevents the SMTP server from rejecting mail permanently
+# (by changing 5xx replies into 4xx replies). However, soft_bounce
+# is no cure for address rewriting mistakes or mail routing mistakes.
+#
+#soft_bounce = no
+
+# LOCAL PATHNAME INFORMATION
+#
+# The queue_directory specifies the location of the Postfix queue.
+# This is also the root directory of Postfix daemons that run chrooted.
+# See the files in examples/chroot-setup for setting up Postfix chroot
+# environments on different UNIX systems.
+#
+queue_directory = /var/spool/postfix
+
+# The command_directory parameter specifies the location of all
+# postXXX commands.
+#
+command_directory = /usr/sbin
+
+# The daemon_directory parameter specifies the location of all Postfix
+# daemon programs (i.e. programs listed in the master.cf file). This
+# directory must be owned by root.
+#
+daemon_directory = /usr/libexec/postfix
+
+# QUEUE AND PROCESS OWNERSHIP
+#
+# The mail_owner parameter specifies the owner of the Postfix queue
+# and of most Postfix daemon processes. Specify the name of a user
+# account THAT DOES NOT SHARE ITS USER OR GROUP ID WITH OTHER ACCOUNTS
+# AND THAT OWNS NO OTHER FILES OR PROCESSES ON THE SYSTEM. In
+# particular, don't specify nobody or daemon. PLEASE USE A DEDICATED
+# USER.
+#
+mail_owner = postfix
+
+# The default_privs parameter specifies the default rights used by
+# the local delivery agent for delivery to external file or command.
+# These rights are used in the absence of a recipient user context.
+# DO NOT SPECIFY A PRIVILEGED USER OR THE POSTFIX OWNER.
+#
+#default_privs = nobody
+
+# INTERNET HOST AND DOMAIN NAMES
+#
+# The myhostname parameter specifies the internet hostname of this
+# mail system. The default is to use the fully-qualified domain name
+# from gethostname(). $myhostname is used as a default value for many
+# other configuration parameters.
+#
+#myhostname = host.domain.tld
+#myhostname = virtual.domain.tld
+
+# The mydomain parameter specifies the local internet domain name.
+# The default is to use $myhostname minus the first component.
+# $mydomain is used as a default value for many other configuration
+# parameters.
+#
+#mydomain = domain.tld
+
+# SENDING MAIL
+#
+# The myorigin parameter specifies the domain that locally-posted
+# mail appears to come from. The default is to append $myhostname,
+# which is fine for small sites. If you run a domain with multiple
+# machines, you should (1) change this to $mydomain and (2) set up
+# a domain-wide alias database that aliases each user to
+# user@that.users.mailhost.
+#
+# For the sake of consistency between sender and recipient addresses,
+# myorigin also specifies the default domain name that is appended
+# to recipient addresses that have no @domain part.
+#
+#myorigin = $myhostname
+#myorigin = $mydomain
+
+mydomain = fedoraproject.org
+myorigin = fedoraproject.org
+
+# RECEIVING MAIL
+
+# The inet_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on. By default,
+# the software claims all active interfaces on the machine. The
+# parameter also controls delivery of mail to user@[ip.address].
+#
+# See also the proxy_interfaces parameter, for network addresses that
+# are forwarded to us via a proxy or network address translator.
+#
+# Note: you need to stop/start Postfix when this parameter changes.
+#
+#inet_interfaces = all
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname, localhost
+inet_interfaces = all
+
+# The proxy_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on by way of a
+# proxy or network address translation unit. This setting extends
+# the address list specified with the inet_interfaces parameter.
+#
+# You must specify your proxy/NAT addresses when your system is a
+# backup MX host for other domains, otherwise mail delivery loops
+# will happen when the primary MX host is down.
+#
+#proxy_interfaces =
+#proxy_interfaces = 1.2.3.4
+
+# The mydestination parameter specifies the list of domains that this
+# machine considers itself the final destination for.
+#
+# These domains are routed to the delivery agent specified with the
+# local_transport parameter setting. By default, that is the UNIX
+# compatible delivery agent that lookups all recipients in /etc/passwd
+# and /etc/aliases or their equivalent.
+#
+# The default is $myhostname + localhost.$mydomain. On a mail domain
+# gateway, you should also include $mydomain.
+#
+# Do not specify the names of virtual domains - those domains are
+# specified elsewhere (see VIRTUAL_README).
+#
+# Do not specify the names of domains that this machine is backup MX
+# host for. Specify those names via the relay_domains settings for
+# the SMTP server, or use permit_mx_backup if you are lazy (see
+# STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README).
+#
+# The local machine is always the final destination for mail addressed
+# to user@[the.net.work.address] of an interface that the mail system
+# receives mail on (see the inet_interfaces parameter).
+#
+# Specify a list of host or domain names, /file/name or type:table
+# patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. A /file/name
+# pattern is replaced by its contents; a type:table is matched when
+# a name matches a lookup key (the right-hand side is ignored).
+# Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.
+#
+# See also below, section "REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS".
+#
+mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, fedora.redhat.com, localhost
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain,
+# mail.$mydomain, www.$mydomain, ftp.$mydomain
+
+# REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS
+#
+# The local_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all names or addresses of users that are local with respect
+# to $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown local users. This parameter is defined by default.
+#
+# To turn off local recipient checking in the SMTP server, specify
+# local_recipient_maps = (i.e. empty).
+#
+# The default setting assumes that you use the default Postfix local
+# delivery agent for local delivery. You need to update the
+# local_recipient_maps setting if:
+#
+# - You define $mydestination domain recipients in files other than
+# /etc/passwd, /etc/aliases, or the $virtual_alias_maps files.
+# For example, you define $mydestination domain recipients in
+# the $virtual_mailbox_maps files.
+#
+# - You redefine the local delivery agent in master.cf.
+#
+# - You redefine the "local_transport" setting in main.cf.
+#
+# - You use the "luser_relay", "mailbox_transport", or "fallback_transport"
+# feature of the Postfix local delivery agent (see local(8)).
+#
+# Details are described in the LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README file.
+#
+# Beware: if the Postfix SMTP server runs chrooted, you probably have
+# to access the passwd file via the proxymap service, in order to
+# overcome chroot restrictions. The alternative, having a copy of
+# the system passwd file in the chroot jail is just not practical.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify a bare username, an @domain.tld
+# wild-card, or specify a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#local_recipient_maps = unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps = proxy:unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps =
+
+# The unknown_local_recipient_reject_code specifies the SMTP server
+# response code when a recipient domain matches $mydestination or
+# ${proxy,inet}_interfaces, while $local_recipient_maps is non-empty
+# and the recipient address or address local-part is not found.
+#
+# The default setting is 550 (reject mail) but it is safer to start
+# with 450 (try again later) until you are certain that your
+# local_recipient_maps settings are OK.
+#
+unknown_local_recipient_reject_code = 550
+
+# TRUST AND RELAY CONTROL
+
+# The mynetworks parameter specifies the list of "trusted" SMTP
+# clients that have more privileges than "strangers".
+#
+# In particular, "trusted" SMTP clients are allowed to relay mail
+# through Postfix. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions parameter
+# in postconf(5).
+#
+# You can specify the list of "trusted" network addresses by hand
+# or you can let Postfix do it for you (which is the default).
+#
+# By default (mynetworks_style = subnet), Postfix "trusts" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP subnetworks as the local machine.
+# On Linux, this does works correctly only with interfaces specified
+# with the "ifconfig" command.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = class" when Postfix should "trust" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP class A/B/C networks as the local machine.
+# Don't do this with a dialup site - it would cause Postfix to "trust"
+# your entire provider's network. Instead, specify an explicit
+# mynetworks list by hand, as described below.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = host" when Postfix should "trust"
+# only the local machine.
+#
+#mynetworks_style = class
+#mynetworks_style = subnet
+#mynetworks_style = host
+
+# Alternatively, you can specify the mynetworks list by hand, in
+# which case Postfix ignores the mynetworks_style setting.
+#
+# Specify an explicit list of network/netmask patterns, where the
+# mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host
+# address.
+#
+# You can also specify the absolute pathname of a pattern file instead
+# of listing the patterns here. Specify type:table for table-based lookups
+# (the value on the table right-hand side is not used).
+#
+#mynetworks = 168.100.189.0/28, 127.0.0.0/8
+#mynetworks = $config_directory/mynetworks
+#mynetworks = hash:/etc/postfix/network_table
+
+
+# The relay_domains parameter restricts what destinations this system will
+# relay mail to. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions description in
+# postconf(5) for detailed information.
+#
+# By default, Postfix relays mail
+# - from "trusted" clients (IP address matches $mynetworks) to any destination,
+# - from "untrusted" clients to destinations that match $relay_domains or
+# subdomains thereof, except addresses with sender-specified routing.
+# The default relay_domains value is $mydestination.
+#
+# In addition to the above, the Postfix SMTP server by default accepts mail
+# that Postfix is final destination for:
+# - destinations that match $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces,
+# - destinations that match $mydestination
+# - destinations that match $virtual_alias_domains,
+# - destinations that match $virtual_mailbox_domains.
+# These destinations do not need to be listed in $relay_domains.
+#
+# Specify a list of hosts or domains, /file/name patterns or type:name
+# lookup tables, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue
+# long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. A file name
+# is replaced by its contents; a type:name table is matched when a
+# (parent) domain appears as lookup key.
+#
+# NOTE: Postfix will not automatically forward mail for domains that
+# list this system as their primary or backup MX host. See the
+# permit_mx_backup restriction description in postconf(5).
+#
+#relay_domains = $mydestination
+
+
+
+# INTERNET OR INTRANET
+
+# The relayhost parameter specifies the default host to send mail to
+# when no entry is matched in the optional transport(5) table. When
+# no relayhost is given, mail is routed directly to the destination.
+#
+# On an intranet, specify the organizational domain name. If your
+# internal DNS uses no MX records, specify the name of the intranet
+# gateway host instead.
+#
+# In the case of SMTP, specify a domain, host, host:port, [host]:port,
+# [address] or [address]:port; the form [host] turns off MX lookups.
+#
+# If you're connected via UUCP, see also the default_transport parameter.
+#
+#relayhost = $mydomain
+#relayhost = [gateway.my.domain]
+#relayhost = [mailserver.isp.tld]
+#relayhost = uucphost
+#relayhost = [an.ip.add.ress]
+relayhost = bastion
+
+
+# REJECTING UNKNOWN RELAY USERS
+#
+# The relay_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all addresses in the domains that match $relay_domains.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown relay users. This feature is off by default.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify an @domain.tld wild-card, or specify
+# a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#relay_recipient_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_recipients
+
+# INPUT RATE CONTROL
+#
+# The in_flow_delay configuration parameter implements mail input
+# flow control. This feature is turned on by default, although it
+# still needs further development (it's disabled on SCO UNIX due
+# to an SCO bug).
+#
+# A Postfix process will pause for $in_flow_delay seconds before
+# accepting a new message, when the message arrival rate exceeds the
+# message delivery rate. With the default 100 SMTP server process
+# limit, this limits the mail inflow to 100 messages a second more
+# than the number of messages delivered per second.
+#
+# Specify 0 to disable the feature. Valid delays are 0..10.
+#
+#in_flow_delay = 1s
+
+# ADDRESS REWRITING
+#
+# The ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document gives information about
+# address masquerading or other forms of address rewriting including
+# username->Firstname.Lastname mapping.
+
+masquerade_domains = redhat.com
+masquerade_exceptions = root apache
+
+# ADDRESS REDIRECTION (VIRTUAL DOMAIN)
+#
+# The VIRTUAL_README document gives information about the many forms
+# of domain hosting that Postfix supports.
+
+# "USER HAS MOVED" BOUNCE MESSAGES
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# TRANSPORT MAP
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# ALIAS DATABASE
+#
+# The alias_maps parameter specifies the list of alias databases used
+# by the local delivery agent. The default list is system dependent.
+#
+# On systems with NIS, the default is to search the local alias
+# database, then the NIS alias database. See aliases(5) for syntax
+# details.
+#
+# If you change the alias database, run "postalias /etc/aliases" (or
+# wherever your system stores the mail alias file), or simply run
+# "newaliases" to build the necessary DBM or DB file.
+#
+# It will take a minute or so before changes become visible. Use
+# "postfix reload" to eliminate the delay.
+#
+#alias_maps = dbm:/etc/aliases
+alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, nis:mail.aliases
+#alias_maps = netinfo:/aliases
+
+# The alias_database parameter specifies the alias database(s) that
+# are built with "newaliases" or "sendmail -bi". This is a separate
+# configuration parameter, because alias_maps (see above) may specify
+# tables that are not necessarily all under control by Postfix.
+#
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/mail/aliases
+alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases, hash:/opt/majordomo/aliases
+
+# ADDRESS EXTENSIONS (e.g., user+foo)
+#
+# The recipient_delimiter parameter specifies the separator between
+# user names and address extensions (user+foo). See canonical(5),
+# local(8), relocated(5) and virtual(5) for the effects this has on
+# aliases, canonical, virtual, relocated and .forward file lookups.
+# Basically, the software tries user+foo and .forward+foo before
+# trying user and .forward.
+#
+recipient_delimiter = +
+
+# DELIVERY TO MAILBOX
+#
+# The home_mailbox parameter specifies the optional pathname of a
+# mailbox file relative to a user's home directory. The default
+# mailbox file is /var/spool/mail/user or /var/mail/user. Specify
+# "Maildir/" for qmail-style delivery (the / is required).
+#
+#home_mailbox = Mailbox
+#home_mailbox = Maildir/
+
+# The mail_spool_directory parameter specifies the directory where
+# UNIX-style mailboxes are kept. The default setting depends on the
+# system type.
+#
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/mail
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/spool/mail
+
+# The mailbox_command parameter specifies the optional external
+# command to use instead of mailbox delivery. The command is run as
+# the recipient with proper HOME, SHELL and LOGNAME environment settings.
+# Exception: delivery for root is done as $default_user.
+#
+# Other environment variables of interest: USER (recipient username),
+# EXTENSION (address extension), DOMAIN (domain part of address),
+# and LOCAL (the address localpart).
+#
+# Unlike other Postfix configuration parameters, the mailbox_command
+# parameter is not subjected to $parameter substitutions. This is to
+# make it easier to specify shell syntax (see example below).
+#
+# Avoid shell meta characters because they will force Postfix to run
+# an expensive shell process. Procmail alone is expensive enough.
+#
+# IF YOU USE THIS TO DELIVER MAIL SYSTEM-WIDE, YOU MUST SET UP AN
+# ALIAS THAT FORWARDS MAIL FOR ROOT TO A REAL USER.
+#
+#mailbox_command = /usr/bin/procmail
+#mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail -a "$EXTENSION"
+
+# The mailbox_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use after processing aliases and .forward files. This parameter
+# has precedence over the mailbox_command, fallback_transport and
+# luser_relay parameters.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+
+# If using the cyrus-imapd IMAP server deliver local mail to the IMAP
+# server using LMTP (Local Mail Transport Protocol), this is prefered
+# over the older cyrus deliver program by setting the
+# mailbox_transport as below:
+#
+# mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#
+# The efficiency of LMTP delivery for cyrus-imapd can be enhanced via
+# these settings.
+#
+# local_destination_recipient_limit = 300
+# local_destination_concurrency_limit = 5
+#
+# Of course you should adjust these settings as appropriate for the
+# capacity of the hardware you are using. The recipient limit setting
+# can be used to take advantage of the single instance message store
+# capability of Cyrus. The concurrency limit can be used to control
+# how many simultaneous LMTP sessions will be permitted to the Cyrus
+# message store.
+#
+# To use the old cyrus deliver program you have to set:
+#mailbox_transport = cyrus
+
+# The fallback_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use for recipients that are not found in the UNIX passwd database.
+# This parameter has precedence over the luser_relay parameter.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#fallback_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#fallback_transport =
+
+#transport_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/transport
+# The luser_relay parameter specifies an optional destination address
+# for unknown recipients. By default, mail for unknown@$mydestination,
+# unknown@[$inet_interfaces] or unknown@[$proxy_interfaces] is returned
+# as undeliverable.
+#
+# The following expansions are done on luser_relay: $user (recipient
+# username), $shell (recipient shell), $home (recipient home directory),
+# $recipient (full recipient address), $extension (recipient address
+# extension), $domain (recipient domain), $local (entire recipient
+# localpart), $recipient_delimiter. Specify ${name?value} or
+# ${name:value} to expand value only when $name does (does not) exist.
+#
+# luser_relay works only for the default Postfix local delivery agent.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must specify "local_recipient_maps =" (i.e. empty) in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#luser_relay = $user@other.host
+#luser_relay = $local@other.host
+#luser_relay = admin+$local
+
+# JUNK MAIL CONTROLS
+#
+# The controls listed here are only a very small subset. The file
+# SMTPD_ACCESS_README provides an overview.
+
+# The header_checks parameter specifies an optional table with patterns
+# that each logical message header is matched against, including
+# headers that span multiple physical lines.
+#
+# By default, these patterns also apply to MIME headers and to the
+# headers of attached messages. With older Postfix versions, MIME and
+# attached message headers were treated as body text.
+#
+# For details, see "man header_checks".
+#
+header_checks = regexp:/etc/postfix/header_checks
+
+# FAST ETRN SERVICE
+#
+# Postfix maintains per-destination logfiles with information about
+# deferred mail, so that mail can be flushed quickly with the SMTP
+# "ETRN domain.tld" command, or by executing "sendmail -qRdomain.tld".
+# See the ETRN_README document for a detailed description.
+#
+# The fast_flush_domains parameter controls what destinations are
+# eligible for this service. By default, they are all domains that
+# this server is willing to relay mail to.
+#
+#fast_flush_domains = $relay_domains
+
+# SHOW SOFTWARE VERSION OR NOT
+#
+# The smtpd_banner parameter specifies the text that follows the 220
+# code in the SMTP server's greeting banner. Some people like to see
+# the mail version advertised. By default, Postfix shows no version.
+#
+# You MUST specify $myhostname at the start of the text. That is an
+# RFC requirement. Postfix itself does not care.
+#
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name ($mail_version)
+
+# PARALLEL DELIVERY TO THE SAME DESTINATION
+#
+# How many parallel deliveries to the same user or domain? With local
+# delivery, it does not make sense to do massively parallel delivery
+# to the same user, because mailbox updates must happen sequentially,
+# and expensive pipelines in .forward files can cause disasters when
+# too many are run at the same time. With SMTP deliveries, 10
+# simultaneous connections to the same domain could be sufficient to
+# raise eyebrows.
+#
+# Each message delivery transport has its XXX_destination_concurrency_limit
+# parameter. The default is $default_destination_concurrency_limit for
+# most delivery transports. For the local delivery agent the default is 2.
+
+#local_destination_concurrency_limit = 2
+#default_destination_concurrency_limit = 20
+
+# DEBUGGING CONTROL
+#
+# The debug_peer_level parameter specifies the increment in verbose
+# logging level when an SMTP client or server host name or address
+# matches a pattern in the debug_peer_list parameter.
+#
+debug_peer_level = 2
+
+# The debug_peer_list parameter specifies an optional list of domain
+# or network patterns, /file/name patterns or type:name tables. When
+# an SMTP client or server host name or address matches a pattern,
+# increase the verbose logging level by the amount specified in the
+# debug_peer_level parameter.
+#
+#debug_peer_list = 127.0.0.1
+#debug_peer_list = some.domain
+
+# The debugger_command specifies the external command that is executed
+# when a Postfix daemon program is run with the -D option.
+#
+# Use "command .. & sleep 5" so that the debugger can attach before
+# the process marches on. If you use an X-based debugger, be sure to
+# set up your XAUTHORITY environment variable before starting Postfix.
+#
+debugger_command =
+ PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin:/usr/X11R6/bin
+ xxgdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id & sleep 5
+
+# If you can't use X, use this to capture the call stack when a
+# daemon crashes. The result is in a file in the configuration
+# directory, and is named after the process name and the process ID.
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin; export PATH; (echo cont;
+# echo where) | gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id 2>&1
+# >$config_directory/$process_name.$process_id.log & sleep 5
+#
+# Another possibility is to run gdb under a detached screen session.
+# To attach to the screen sesssion, su root and run "screen -r
+# <id_string>" where <id_string> uniquely matches one of the detached
+# sessions (from "screen -list").
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/sbin:/usr/sbin; export PATH; screen
+# -dmS $process_name gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name
+# $process_id & sleep 1
+
+# INSTALL-TIME CONFIGURATION INFORMATION
+#
+# The following parameters are used when installing a new Postfix version.
+#
+# sendmail_path: The full pathname of the Postfix sendmail command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible mail posting interface.
+#
+sendmail_path = /usr/sbin/sendmail.postfix
+
+# newaliases_path: The full pathname of the Postfix newaliases command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible command to build alias databases.
+#
+newaliases_path = /usr/bin/newaliases.postfix
+
+# mailq_path: The full pathname of the Postfix mailq command. This
+# is the Sendmail-compatible mail queue listing command.
+#
+mailq_path = /usr/bin/mailq.postfix
+
+# setgid_group: The group for mail submission and queue management
+# commands. This must be a group name with a numerical group ID that
+# is not shared with other accounts, not even with the Postfix account.
+#
+setgid_group = postdrop
+
+# html_directory: The location of the Postfix HTML documentation.
+#
+html_directory = no
+
+# manpage_directory: The location of the Postfix on-line manual pages.
+#
+manpage_directory = /usr/share/man
+
+# sample_directory: The location of the Postfix sample configuration files.
+# This parameter is obsolete as of Postfix 2.1.
+#
+sample_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/samples
+
+# readme_directory: The location of the Postfix README files.
+#
+readme_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/README_FILES
+
+# add this to new postfix to get it to add proper message-id and other
+# headers to outgoing emails via the gateway.
+
+
+message_size_limit = 20971520
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.smtp-mm b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.smtp-mm
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..ab4668bc5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.smtp-mm
@@ -0,0 +1,741 @@
+# Global Postfix configuration file. This file lists only a subset
+# of all parameters. For the syntax, and for a complete parameter
+# list, see the postconf(5) manual page (command: "man 5 postconf").
+#
+# For common configuration examples, see BASIC_CONFIGURATION_README
+# and STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README. To find these documents, use
+# the command "postconf html_directory readme_directory", or go to
+# http://www.postfix.org/.
+#
+# For best results, change no more than 2-3 parameters at a time,
+# and test if Postfix still works after every change.
+
+# Custom rules
+
+# SOFT BOUNCE
+#
+# The soft_bounce parameter provides a limited safety net for
+# testing. When soft_bounce is enabled, mail will remain queued that
+# would otherwise bounce. This parameter disables locally-generated
+# bounces, and prevents the SMTP server from rejecting mail permanently
+# (by changing 5xx replies into 4xx replies). However, soft_bounce
+# is no cure for address rewriting mistakes or mail routing mistakes.
+#
+#soft_bounce = no
+
+# LOCAL PATHNAME INFORMATION
+#
+# The queue_directory specifies the location of the Postfix queue.
+# This is also the root directory of Postfix daemons that run chrooted.
+# See the files in examples/chroot-setup for setting up Postfix chroot
+# environments on different UNIX systems.
+#
+queue_directory = /var/spool/postfix
+
+# The command_directory parameter specifies the location of all
+# postXXX commands.
+#
+command_directory = /usr/sbin
+
+# The daemon_directory parameter specifies the location of all Postfix
+# daemon programs (i.e. programs listed in the master.cf file). This
+# directory must be owned by root.
+#
+daemon_directory = /usr/libexec/postfix
+
+# The data_directory parameter specifies the location of Postfix-writable
+# data files (caches, random numbers). This directory must be owned
+# by the mail_owner account (see below).
+#
+data_directory = /var/lib/postfix
+
+# QUEUE AND PROCESS OWNERSHIP
+#
+# The mail_owner parameter specifies the owner of the Postfix queue
+# and of most Postfix daemon processes. Specify the name of a user
+# account THAT DOES NOT SHARE ITS USER OR GROUP ID WITH OTHER ACCOUNTS
+# AND THAT OWNS NO OTHER FILES OR PROCESSES ON THE SYSTEM. In
+# particular, don't specify nobody or daemon. PLEASE USE A DEDICATED
+# USER.
+#
+mail_owner = postfix
+
+# The default_privs parameter specifies the default rights used by
+# the local delivery agent for delivery to external file or command.
+# These rights are used in the absence of a recipient user context.
+# DO NOT SPECIFY A PRIVILEGED USER OR THE POSTFIX OWNER.
+#
+#default_privs = nobody
+
+# INTERNET HOST AND DOMAIN NAMES
+#
+# The myhostname parameter specifies the internet hostname of this
+# mail system. The default is to use the fully-qualified domain name
+# from gethostname(). $myhostname is used as a default value for many
+# other configuration parameters.
+#
+#myhostname = host.domain.tld
+#myhostname = virtual.domain.tld
+
+
+smtp_helo_name = $myhostname
+
+# The mydomain parameter specifies the local internet domain name.
+# The default is to use $myhostname minus the first component.
+# $mydomain is used as a default value for many other configuration
+# parameters.
+#
+#mydomain = domain.tld
+
+mydomain = fedoraproject.org
+
+# SENDING MAIL
+#
+# The myorigin parameter specifies the domain that locally-posted
+# mail appears to come from. The default is to append $myhostname,
+# which is fine for small sites. If you run a domain with multiple
+# machines, you should (1) change this to $mydomain and (2) set up
+# a domain-wide alias database that aliases each user to
+# user@that.users.mailhost.
+#
+# For the sake of consistency between sender and recipient addresses,
+# myorigin also specifies the default domain name that is appended
+# to recipient addresses that have no @domain part.
+#
+#myorigin = $myhostname
+#myorigin = $mydomain
+
+myorigin = fedoraproject.org
+
+# RECEIVING MAIL
+
+# The inet_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on. By default,
+# the software claims all active interfaces on the machine. The
+# parameter also controls delivery of mail to user@[ip.address].
+#
+# See also the proxy_interfaces parameter, for network addresses that
+# are forwarded to us via a proxy or network address translator.
+#
+# Note: you need to stop/start Postfix when this parameter changes.
+#
+#inet_interfaces = all
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname, localhost
+
+inet_interfaces = all
+
+# The proxy_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on by way of a
+# proxy or network address translation unit. This setting extends
+# the address list specified with the inet_interfaces parameter.
+#
+# You must specify your proxy/NAT addresses when your system is a
+# backup MX host for other domains, otherwise mail delivery loops
+# will happen when the primary MX host is down.
+#
+#proxy_interfaces =
+#proxy_interfaces = 1.2.3.4
+
+# The mydestination parameter specifies the list of domains that this
+# machine considers itself the final destination for.
+#
+# These domains are routed to the delivery agent specified with the
+# local_transport parameter setting. By default, that is the UNIX
+# compatible delivery agent that lookups all recipients in /etc/passwd
+# and /etc/aliases or their equivalent.
+#
+# The default is $myhostname + localhost.$mydomain. On a mail domain
+# gateway, you should also include $mydomain.
+#
+# Do not specify the names of virtual domains - those domains are
+# specified elsewhere (see VIRTUAL_README).
+#
+# Do not specify the names of domains that this machine is backup MX
+# host for. Specify those names via the relay_domains settings for
+# the SMTP server, or use permit_mx_backup if you are lazy (see
+# STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README).
+#
+# The local machine is always the final destination for mail addressed
+# to user@[the.net.work.address] of an interface that the mail system
+# receives mail on (see the inet_interfaces parameter).
+#
+# Specify a list of host or domain names, /file/name or type:table
+# patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. A /file/name
+# pattern is replaced by its contents; a type:table is matched when
+# a name matches a lookup key (the right-hand side is ignored).
+# Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.
+#
+# See also below, section "REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS".
+#
+
+mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain,
+# mail.$mydomain, www.$mydomain, ftp.$mydomain
+
+# REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS
+#
+# The local_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all names or addresses of users that are local with respect
+# to $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown local users. This parameter is defined by default.
+#
+# To turn off local recipient checking in the SMTP server, specify
+# local_recipient_maps = (i.e. empty).
+#
+# The default setting assumes that you use the default Postfix local
+# delivery agent for local delivery. You need to update the
+# local_recipient_maps setting if:
+#
+# - You define $mydestination domain recipients in files other than
+# /etc/passwd, /etc/aliases, or the $virtual_alias_maps files.
+# For example, you define $mydestination domain recipients in
+# the $virtual_mailbox_maps files.
+#
+# - You redefine the local delivery agent in master.cf.
+#
+# - You redefine the "local_transport" setting in main.cf.
+#
+# - You use the "luser_relay", "mailbox_transport", or "fallback_transport"
+# feature of the Postfix local delivery agent (see local(8)).
+#
+# Details are described in the LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README file.
+#
+# Beware: if the Postfix SMTP server runs chrooted, you probably have
+# to access the passwd file via the proxymap service, in order to
+# overcome chroot restrictions. The alternative, having a copy of
+# the system passwd file in the chroot jail is just not practical.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify a bare username, an @domain.tld
+# wild-card, or specify a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#local_recipient_maps = unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps = proxy:unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps =
+
+# The unknown_local_recipient_reject_code specifies the SMTP server
+# response code when a recipient domain matches $mydestination or
+# ${proxy,inet}_interfaces, while $local_recipient_maps is non-empty
+# and the recipient address or address local-part is not found.
+#
+# The default setting is 550 (reject mail) but it is safer to start
+# with 450 (try again later) until you are certain that your
+# local_recipient_maps settings are OK.
+#
+unknown_local_recipient_reject_code = 550
+
+# TRUST AND RELAY CONTROL
+
+# The mynetworks parameter specifies the list of "trusted" SMTP
+# clients that have more privileges than "strangers".
+#
+# In particular, "trusted" SMTP clients are allowed to relay mail
+# through Postfix. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions parameter
+# in postconf(5).
+#
+# You can specify the list of "trusted" network addresses by hand
+# or you can let Postfix do it for you (which is the default).
+#
+# By default (mynetworks_style = subnet), Postfix "trusts" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP subnetworks as the local machine.
+# On Linux, this does works correctly only with interfaces specified
+# with the "ifconfig" command.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = class" when Postfix should "trust" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP class A/B/C networks as the local machine.
+# Don't do this with a dialup site - it would cause Postfix to "trust"
+# your entire provider's network. Instead, specify an explicit
+# mynetworks list by hand, as described below.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = host" when Postfix should "trust"
+# only the local machine.
+#
+#mynetworks_style = class
+#mynetworks_style = subnet
+#mynetworks_style = host
+
+
+# Alternatively, you can specify the mynetworks list by hand, in
+# which case Postfix ignores the mynetworks_style setting.
+#
+# Specify an explicit list of network/netmask patterns, where the
+# mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host
+# address.
+#
+# You can also specify the absolute pathname of a pattern file instead
+# of listing the patterns here. Specify type:table for table-based lookups
+# (the value on the table right-hand side is not used).
+#
+#mynetworks = 168.100.189.0/28, 127.0.0.0/8
+#mynetworks = $config_directory/mynetworks
+#mynetworks = hash:/etc/postfix/network_table
+
+
+# The relay_domains parameter restricts what destinations this system will
+# relay mail to. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions description in
+# postconf(5) for detailed information.
+#
+# By default, Postfix relays mail
+# - from "trusted" clients (IP address matches $mynetworks) to any destination,
+# - from "untrusted" clients to destinations that match $relay_domains or
+# subdomains thereof, except addresses with sender-specified routing.
+# The default relay_domains value is $mydestination.
+#
+# In addition to the above, the Postfix SMTP server by default accepts mail
+# that Postfix is final destination for:
+# - destinations that match $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces,
+# - destinations that match $mydestination
+# - destinations that match $virtual_alias_domains,
+# - destinations that match $virtual_mailbox_domains.
+# These destinations do not need to be listed in $relay_domains.
+#
+# Specify a list of hosts or domains, /file/name patterns or type:name
+# lookup tables, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue
+# long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. A file name
+# is replaced by its contents; a type:name table is matched when a
+# (parent) domain appears as lookup key.
+#
+# NOTE: Postfix will not automatically forward mail for domains that
+# list this system as their primary or backup MX host. See the
+# permit_mx_backup restriction description in postconf(5).
+#
+#relay_domains = $mydestination
+
+relay_domains = $mydestination lists.fedoraproject.org lists.fedorahosted.org fedorahosted.org
+
+# INTERNET OR INTRANET
+
+# The relayhost parameter specifies the default host to send mail to
+# when no entry is matched in the optional transport(5) table. When
+# no relayhost is given, mail is routed directly to the destination.
+#
+# On an intranet, specify the organizational domain name. If your
+# internal DNS uses no MX records, specify the name of the intranet
+# gateway host instead.
+#
+# In the case of SMTP, specify a domain, host, host:port, [host]:port,
+# [address] or [address]:port; the form [host] turns off MX lookups.
+#
+# If you're connected via UUCP, see also the default_transport parameter.
+#
+#relayhost = $mydomain
+#relayhost = [gateway.my.domain]
+#relayhost = [mailserver.isp.tld]
+#relayhost = uucphost
+#relayhost = [an.ip.add.ress]
+
+relayhost =
+
+# REJECTING UNKNOWN RELAY USERS
+#
+# The relay_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all addresses in the domains that match $relay_domains.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown relay users. This feature is off by default.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify an @domain.tld wild-card, or specify
+# a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#relay_recipient_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_recipients
+
+# INPUT RATE CONTROL
+#
+# The in_flow_delay configuration parameter implements mail input
+# flow control. This feature is turned on by default, although it
+# still needs further development (it's disabled on SCO UNIX due
+# to an SCO bug).
+#
+# A Postfix process will pause for $in_flow_delay seconds before
+# accepting a new message, when the message arrival rate exceeds the
+# message delivery rate. With the default 100 SMTP server process
+# limit, this limits the mail inflow to 100 messages a second more
+# than the number of messages delivered per second.
+#
+# Specify 0 to disable the feature. Valid delays are 0..10.
+#
+#in_flow_delay = 1s
+
+# ADDRESS REWRITING
+#
+# The ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document gives information about
+# address masquerading or other forms of address rewriting including
+# username->Firstname.Lastname mapping.
+
+# ADDRESS REDIRECTION (VIRTUAL DOMAIN)
+#
+# The VIRTUAL_README document gives information about the many forms
+# of domain hosting that Postfix supports.
+
+# "USER HAS MOVED" BOUNCE MESSAGES
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# TRANSPORT MAP
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# ALIAS DATABASE
+#
+# The alias_maps parameter specifies the list of alias databases used
+# by the local delivery agent. The default list is system dependent.
+#
+# On systems with NIS, the default is to search the local alias
+# database, then the NIS alias database. See aliases(5) for syntax
+# details.
+#
+# If you change the alias database, run "postalias /etc/aliases" (or
+# wherever your system stores the mail alias file), or simply run
+# "newaliases" to build the necessary DBM or DB file.
+#
+# It will take a minute or so before changes become visible. Use
+# "postfix reload" to eliminate the delay.
+#
+#alias_maps = dbm:/etc/aliases
+alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases
+alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, nis:mail.aliases
+#alias_maps = netinfo:/aliases
+
+# The alias_database parameter specifies the alias database(s) that
+# are built with "newaliases" or "sendmail -bi". This is a separate
+# configuration parameter, because alias_maps (see above) may specify
+# tables that are not necessarily all under control by Postfix.
+#
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/mail/aliases
+alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases, hash:/opt/majordomo/aliases
+
+# ADDRESS EXTENSIONS (e.g., user+foo)
+#
+# The recipient_delimiter parameter specifies the separator between
+# user names and address extensions (user+foo). See canonical(5),
+# local(8), relocated(5) and virtual(5) for the effects this has on
+# aliases, canonical, virtual, relocated and .forward file lookups.
+# Basically, the software tries user+foo and .forward+foo before
+# trying user and .forward.
+#
+recipient_delimiter = +
+
+# DELIVERY TO MAILBOX
+#
+# The home_mailbox parameter specifies the optional pathname of a
+# mailbox file relative to a user's home directory. The default
+# mailbox file is /var/spool/mail/user or /var/mail/user. Specify
+# "Maildir/" for qmail-style delivery (the / is required).
+#
+#home_mailbox = Mailbox
+#home_mailbox = Maildir/
+
+# The mail_spool_directory parameter specifies the directory where
+# UNIX-style mailboxes are kept. The default setting depends on the
+# system type.
+#
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/mail
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/spool/mail
+
+# The mailbox_command parameter specifies the optional external
+# command to use instead of mailbox delivery. The command is run as
+# the recipient with proper HOME, SHELL and LOGNAME environment settings.
+# Exception: delivery for root is done as $default_user.
+#
+# Other environment variables of interest: USER (recipient username),
+# EXTENSION (address extension), DOMAIN (domain part of address),
+# and LOCAL (the address localpart).
+#
+# Unlike other Postfix configuration parameters, the mailbox_command
+# parameter is not subjected to $parameter substitutions. This is to
+# make it easier to specify shell syntax (see example below).
+#
+# Avoid shell meta characters because they will force Postfix to run
+# an expensive shell process. Procmail alone is expensive enough.
+#
+# IF YOU USE THIS TO DELIVER MAIL SYSTEM-WIDE, YOU MUST SET UP AN
+# ALIAS THAT FORWARDS MAIL FOR ROOT TO A REAL USER.
+#
+#mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail
+#mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail -a "$EXTENSION"
+
+# The mailbox_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use after processing aliases and .forward files. This parameter
+# has precedence over the mailbox_command, fallback_transport and
+# luser_relay parameters.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+
+# If using the cyrus-imapd IMAP server deliver local mail to the IMAP
+# server using LMTP (Local Mail Transport Protocol), this is prefered
+# over the older cyrus deliver program by setting the
+# mailbox_transport as below:
+#
+# mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#
+# The efficiency of LMTP delivery for cyrus-imapd can be enhanced via
+# these settings.
+#
+# local_destination_recipient_limit = 300
+# local_destination_concurrency_limit = 5
+#
+# Of course you should adjust these settings as appropriate for the
+# capacity of the hardware you are using. The recipient limit setting
+# can be used to take advantage of the single instance message store
+# capability of Cyrus. The concurrency limit can be used to control
+# how many simultaneous LMTP sessions will be permitted to the Cyrus
+# message store.
+#
+# To use the old cyrus deliver program you have to set:
+#mailbox_transport = cyrus
+
+
+
+# The fallback_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use for recipients that are not found in the UNIX passwd database.
+# This parameter has precedence over the luser_relay parameter.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#fallback_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#fallback_transport =
+
+# The luser_relay parameter specifies an optional destination address
+# for unknown recipients. By default, mail for unknown@$mydestination,
+# unknown@[$inet_interfaces] or unknown@[$proxy_interfaces] is returned
+# as undeliverable.
+#
+# The following expansions are done on luser_relay: $user (recipient
+# username), $shell (recipient shell), $home (recipient home directory),
+# $recipient (full recipient address), $extension (recipient address
+# extension), $domain (recipient domain), $local (entire recipient
+# localpart), $recipient_delimiter. Specify ${name?value} or
+# ${name:value} to expand value only when $name does (does not) exist.
+#
+# luser_relay works only for the default Postfix local delivery agent.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must specify "local_recipient_maps =" (i.e. empty) in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#luser_relay = $user@other.host
+#luser_relay = $local@other.host
+#luser_relay = admin+$local
+
+# JUNK MAIL CONTROLS
+#
+# The controls listed here are only a very small subset. The file
+# SMTPD_ACCESS_README provides an overview.
+
+# The header_checks parameter specifies an optional table with patterns
+# that each logical message header is matched against, including
+# headers that span multiple physical lines.
+#
+# By default, these patterns also apply to MIME headers and to the
+# headers of attached messages. With older Postfix versions, MIME and
+# attached message headers were treated as body text.
+#
+# For details, see "man header_checks".
+#
+#header_checks = regexp:/etc/postfix/header_checks
+
+# FAST ETRN SERVICE
+#
+# Postfix maintains per-destination logfiles with information about
+# deferred mail, so that mail can be flushed quickly with the SMTP
+# "ETRN domain.tld" command, or by executing "sendmail -qRdomain.tld".
+# See the ETRN_README document for a detailed description.
+#
+# The fast_flush_domains parameter controls what destinations are
+# eligible for this service. By default, they are all domains that
+# this server is willing to relay mail to.
+#
+#fast_flush_domains = $relay_domains
+
+# SHOW SOFTWARE VERSION OR NOT
+#
+# The smtpd_banner parameter specifies the text that follows the 220
+# code in the SMTP server's greeting banner. Some people like to see
+# the mail version advertised. By default, Postfix shows no version.
+#
+# You MUST specify $myhostname at the start of the text. That is an
+# RFC requirement. Postfix itself does not care.
+#
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name ($mail_version)
+
+# PARALLEL DELIVERY TO THE SAME DESTINATION
+#
+# How many parallel deliveries to the same user or domain? With local
+# delivery, it does not make sense to do massively parallel delivery
+# to the same user, because mailbox updates must happen sequentially,
+# and expensive pipelines in .forward files can cause disasters when
+# too many are run at the same time. With SMTP deliveries, 10
+# simultaneous connections to the same domain could be sufficient to
+# raise eyebrows.
+#
+# Each message delivery transport has its XXX_destination_concurrency_limit
+# parameter. The default is $default_destination_concurrency_limit for
+# most delivery transports. For the local delivery agent the default is 2.
+
+#local_destination_concurrency_limit = 2
+#default_destination_concurrency_limit = 20
+
+# DEBUGGING CONTROL
+#
+# The debug_peer_level parameter specifies the increment in verbose
+# logging level when an SMTP client or server host name or address
+# matches a pattern in the debug_peer_list parameter.
+#
+debug_peer_level = 2
+
+# The debug_peer_list parameter specifies an optional list of domain
+# or network patterns, /file/name patterns or type:name tables. When
+# an SMTP client or server host name or address matches a pattern,
+# increase the verbose logging level by the amount specified in the
+# debug_peer_level parameter.
+#
+#debug_peer_list = 127.0.0.1
+#debug_peer_list = some.domain
+
+# The debugger_command specifies the external command that is executed
+# when a Postfix daemon program is run with the -D option.
+#
+# Use "command .. & sleep 5" so that the debugger can attach before
+# the process marches on. If you use an X-based debugger, be sure to
+# set up your XAUTHORITY environment variable before starting Postfix.
+#
+debugger_command =
+ PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin:/usr/X11R6/bin
+ ddd $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id & sleep 5
+
+# If you can't use X, use this to capture the call stack when a
+# daemon crashes. The result is in a file in the configuration
+# directory, and is named after the process name and the process ID.
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin; export PATH; (echo cont;
+# echo where) | gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id 2>&1
+# >$config_directory/$process_name.$process_id.log & sleep 5
+#
+# Another possibility is to run gdb under a detached screen session.
+# To attach to the screen sesssion, su root and run "screen -r
+# <id_string>" where <id_string> uniquely matches one of the detached
+# sessions (from "screen -list").
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/sbin:/usr/sbin; export PATH; screen
+# -dmS $process_name gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name
+# $process_id & sleep 1
+
+# INSTALL-TIME CONFIGURATION INFORMATION
+#
+# The following parameters are used when installing a new Postfix version.
+#
+# sendmail_path: The full pathname of the Postfix sendmail command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible mail posting interface.
+#
+sendmail_path = /usr/sbin/sendmail.postfix
+
+# newaliases_path: The full pathname of the Postfix newaliases command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible command to build alias databases.
+#
+newaliases_path = /usr/bin/newaliases.postfix
+
+# mailq_path: The full pathname of the Postfix mailq command. This
+# is the Sendmail-compatible mail queue listing command.
+#
+mailq_path = /usr/bin/mailq.postfix
+
+# setgid_group: The group for mail submission and queue management
+# commands. This must be a group name with a numerical group ID that
+# is not shared with other accounts, not even with the Postfix account.
+#
+setgid_group = postdrop
+
+# html_directory: The location of the Postfix HTML documentation.
+#
+html_directory = no
+
+# manpage_directory: The location of the Postfix on-line manual pages.
+#
+manpage_directory = /usr/share/man
+
+# sample_directory: The location of the Postfix sample configuration files.
+# This parameter is obsolete as of Postfix 2.1.
+#
+sample_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.5.6/samples
+
+# readme_directory: The location of the Postfix README files.
+#
+readme_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.5.6/README_FILES
+# Enable IPv4, and IPv6 if supported
+inet_protocols = all
+
+# mapping so we know where to go for .redhat.com mail
+
+transport_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/transport
+
+message_size_limit = 20971520
+
+## TLS
+# enable opportunistic TLS support in the SMTP server
+smtpd_use_tls = yes
+smtpd_tls_security_level = may
+smtpd_tls_auth_only = yes
+smtpd_tls_mandatory_protocols = !SSLv2, !SSLv3
+smtpd_tls_mandatory_ciphers = high
+smtpd_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers = aNULL, MD5, RC4
+#tls_ssl_options = no_ticket, no_compression
+
+smtpd_tls_loglevel = 1
+smtpd_tls_cert_file = /etc/pki/tls/certs/gateway.crt
+smtpd_tls_key_file = /etc/pki/tls/private/gateway.key
+smtpd_tls_CAfile = /etc/pki/tls/certs/ca-bundle.crt
+smtpd_tls_session_cache_timeout = 3600s
+smtpd_tls_session_cache_database = btree:${queue_directory}/smtpd_scache
+smtpd_tls_received_header = yes
+smtpd_tls_ask_ccert = yes
+smtpd_tls_received_header = yes
+tls_random_source = dev:/dev/urandom
+smtpd_tls_eecdh_grade = ultra
+tls_eecdh_strong_curve = prime256v1
+tls_eecdh_ultra_curve = secp384r1
+# TLS end
+#TLS Client
+smtp_tls_fingerprint_digest=sha1
+smtp_tls_note_starttls_offer = yes
+smtp_tls_policy_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/tls_policy
+smtp_tls_security_level = may
+smtp_tls_mandatory_protocols = !SSLv2,!SSLv3
+smtp_tls_mandatory_ciphers = high
+smtp_tls_mandatory_exclude_ciphers= aNULL, MD5, RC4
+smtp_tls_loglevel = 1
+smtp_tls_cert_file = /etc/pki/tls/certs/gateway.crt
+smtp_tls_key_file = /etc/pki/tls/private/gateway.key
+smtp_tls_CAfile = /etc/pki/tls/certs/ca-bundle.crt
+
+# Deny email from some domains
+smtpd_sender_restrictions = hash:/etc/postfix/sender_access
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.staging b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.staging
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..96a7cb6ef
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.staging
@@ -0,0 +1,687 @@
+# "false"
+# Global Postfix configuration file. This file lists only a subset
+# of all parameters. For the syntax, and for a complete parameter
+# list, see the postconf(5) manual page (command: "man 5 postconf").
+#
+# For common configuration examples, see BASIC_CONFIGURATION_README
+# and STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README. To find these documents, use
+# the command "postconf html_directory readme_directory", or go to
+# http://www.postfix.org/.
+#
+# For best results, change no more than 2-3 parameters at a time,
+# and test if Postfix still works after every change.
+
+# SOFT BOUNCE
+#
+# The soft_bounce parameter provides a limited safety net for
+# testing. When soft_bounce is enabled, mail will remain queued that
+# would otherwise bounce. This parameter disables locally-generated
+# bounces, and prevents the SMTP server from rejecting mail permanently
+# (by changing 5xx replies into 4xx replies). However, soft_bounce
+# is no cure for address rewriting mistakes or mail routing mistakes.
+#
+#soft_bounce = no
+
+# LOCAL PATHNAME INFORMATION
+#
+# The queue_directory specifies the location of the Postfix queue.
+# This is also the root directory of Postfix daemons that run chrooted.
+# See the files in examples/chroot-setup for setting up Postfix chroot
+# environments on different UNIX systems.
+#
+queue_directory = /var/spool/postfix
+
+# The command_directory parameter specifies the location of all
+# postXXX commands.
+#
+command_directory = /usr/sbin
+
+# The daemon_directory parameter specifies the location of all Postfix
+# daemon programs (i.e. programs listed in the master.cf file). This
+# directory must be owned by root.
+#
+daemon_directory = /usr/libexec/postfix
+
+# QUEUE AND PROCESS OWNERSHIP
+#
+# The mail_owner parameter specifies the owner of the Postfix queue
+# and of most Postfix daemon processes. Specify the name of a user
+# account THAT DOES NOT SHARE ITS USER OR GROUP ID WITH OTHER ACCOUNTS
+# AND THAT OWNS NO OTHER FILES OR PROCESSES ON THE SYSTEM. In
+# particular, don't specify nobody or daemon. PLEASE USE A DEDICATED
+# USER.
+#
+mail_owner = postfix
+
+# The default_privs parameter specifies the default rights used by
+# the local delivery agent for delivery to external file or command.
+# These rights are used in the absence of a recipient user context.
+# DO NOT SPECIFY A PRIVILEGED USER OR THE POSTFIX OWNER.
+#
+#default_privs = nobody
+
+# INTERNET HOST AND DOMAIN NAMES
+#
+# The myhostname parameter specifies the internet hostname of this
+# mail system. The default is to use the fully-qualified domain name
+# from gethostname(). $myhostname is used as a default value for many
+# other configuration parameters.
+#
+#myhostname = host.domain.tld
+#myhostname = virtual.domain.tld
+
+# The mydomain parameter specifies the local internet domain name.
+# The default is to use $myhostname minus the first component.
+# $mydomain is used as a default value for many other configuration
+# parameters.
+#
+#mydomain = domain.tld
+
+# SENDING MAIL
+#
+# The myorigin parameter specifies the domain that locally-posted
+# mail appears to come from. The default is to append $myhostname,
+# which is fine for small sites. If you run a domain with multiple
+# machines, you should (1) change this to $mydomain and (2) set up
+# a domain-wide alias database that aliases each user to
+# user@that.users.mailhost.
+#
+# For the sake of consistency between sender and recipient addresses,
+# myorigin also specifies the default domain name that is appended
+# to recipient addresses that have no @domain part.
+#
+#myorigin = $myhostname
+#myorigin = $mydomain
+
+mydomain = stg.fedoraproject.org
+myorigin = stg.fedoraproject.org
+
+# RECEIVING MAIL
+
+# The inet_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on. By default,
+# the software claims all active interfaces on the machine. The
+# parameter also controls delivery of mail to user@[ip.address].
+#
+# See also the proxy_interfaces parameter, for network addresses that
+# are forwarded to us via a proxy or network address translator.
+#
+# Note: you need to stop/start Postfix when this parameter changes.
+#
+#inet_interfaces = all
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname, localhost
+inet_interfaces = all
+
+# The proxy_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on by way of a
+# proxy or network address translation unit. This setting extends
+# the address list specified with the inet_interfaces parameter.
+#
+# You must specify your proxy/NAT addresses when your system is a
+# backup MX host for other domains, otherwise mail delivery loops
+# will happen when the primary MX host is down.
+#
+#proxy_interfaces =
+#proxy_interfaces = 1.2.3.4
+
+# The mydestination parameter specifies the list of domains that this
+# machine considers itself the final destination for.
+#
+# These domains are routed to the delivery agent specified with the
+# local_transport parameter setting. By default, that is the UNIX
+# compatible delivery agent that lookups all recipients in /etc/passwd
+# and /etc/aliases or their equivalent.
+#
+# The default is $myhostname + localhost.$mydomain. On a mail domain
+# gateway, you should also include $mydomain.
+#
+# Do not specify the names of virtual domains - those domains are
+# specified elsewhere (see VIRTUAL_README).
+#
+# Do not specify the names of domains that this machine is backup MX
+# host for. Specify those names via the relay_domains settings for
+# the SMTP server, or use permit_mx_backup if you are lazy (see
+# STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README).
+#
+# The local machine is always the final destination for mail addressed
+# to user@[the.net.work.address] of an interface that the mail system
+# receives mail on (see the inet_interfaces parameter).
+#
+# Specify a list of host or domain names, /file/name or type:table
+# patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. A /file/name
+# pattern is replaced by its contents; a type:table is matched when
+# a name matches a lookup key (the right-hand side is ignored).
+# Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.
+#
+# See also below, section "REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS".
+#
+mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, fedora.redhat.com, localhost
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain,
+# mail.$mydomain, www.$mydomain, ftp.$mydomain
+
+# REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS
+#
+# The local_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all names or addresses of users that are local with respect
+# to $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown local users. This parameter is defined by default.
+#
+# To turn off local recipient checking in the SMTP server, specify
+# local_recipient_maps = (i.e. empty).
+#
+# The default setting assumes that you use the default Postfix local
+# delivery agent for local delivery. You need to update the
+# local_recipient_maps setting if:
+#
+# - You define $mydestination domain recipients in files other than
+# /etc/passwd, /etc/aliases, or the $virtual_alias_maps files.
+# For example, you define $mydestination domain recipients in
+# the $virtual_mailbox_maps files.
+#
+# - You redefine the local delivery agent in master.cf.
+#
+# - You redefine the "local_transport" setting in main.cf.
+#
+# - You use the "luser_relay", "mailbox_transport", or "fallback_transport"
+# feature of the Postfix local delivery agent (see local(8)).
+#
+# Details are described in the LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README file.
+#
+# Beware: if the Postfix SMTP server runs chrooted, you probably have
+# to access the passwd file via the proxymap service, in order to
+# overcome chroot restrictions. The alternative, having a copy of
+# the system passwd file in the chroot jail is just not practical.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify a bare username, an @domain.tld
+# wild-card, or specify a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#local_recipient_maps = unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps = proxy:unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps =
+
+# The unknown_local_recipient_reject_code specifies the SMTP server
+# response code when a recipient domain matches $mydestination or
+# ${proxy,inet}_interfaces, while $local_recipient_maps is non-empty
+# and the recipient address or address local-part is not found.
+#
+# The default setting is 550 (reject mail) but it is safer to start
+# with 450 (try again later) until you are certain that your
+# local_recipient_maps settings are OK.
+#
+unknown_local_recipient_reject_code = 550
+
+# TRUST AND RELAY CONTROL
+
+# The mynetworks parameter specifies the list of "trusted" SMTP
+# clients that have more privileges than "strangers".
+#
+# In particular, "trusted" SMTP clients are allowed to relay mail
+# through Postfix. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions parameter
+# in postconf(5).
+#
+# You can specify the list of "trusted" network addresses by hand
+# or you can let Postfix do it for you (which is the default).
+#
+# By default (mynetworks_style = subnet), Postfix "trusts" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP subnetworks as the local machine.
+# On Linux, this does works correctly only with interfaces specified
+# with the "ifconfig" command.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = class" when Postfix should "trust" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP class A/B/C networks as the local machine.
+# Don't do this with a dialup site - it would cause Postfix to "trust"
+# your entire provider's network. Instead, specify an explicit
+# mynetworks list by hand, as described below.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = host" when Postfix should "trust"
+# only the local machine.
+#
+#mynetworks_style = class
+#mynetworks_style = subnet
+#mynetworks_style = host
+
+# Alternatively, you can specify the mynetworks list by hand, in
+# which case Postfix ignores the mynetworks_style setting.
+#
+# Specify an explicit list of network/netmask patterns, where the
+# mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host
+# address.
+#
+# You can also specify the absolute pathname of a pattern file instead
+# of listing the patterns here. Specify type:table for table-based lookups
+# (the value on the table right-hand side is not used).
+#
+#mynetworks = 168.100.189.0/28, 127.0.0.0/8
+#mynetworks = $config_directory/mynetworks
+#mynetworks = hash:/etc/postfix/network_table
+
+
+# The relay_domains parameter restricts what destinations this system will
+# relay mail to. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions description in
+# postconf(5) for detailed information.
+#
+# By default, Postfix relays mail
+# - from "trusted" clients (IP address matches $mynetworks) to any destination,
+# - from "untrusted" clients to destinations that match $relay_domains or
+# subdomains thereof, except addresses with sender-specified routing.
+# The default relay_domains value is $mydestination.
+#
+# In addition to the above, the Postfix SMTP server by default accepts mail
+# that Postfix is final destination for:
+# - destinations that match $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces,
+# - destinations that match $mydestination
+# - destinations that match $virtual_alias_domains,
+# - destinations that match $virtual_mailbox_domains.
+# These destinations do not need to be listed in $relay_domains.
+#
+# Specify a list of hosts or domains, /file/name patterns or type:name
+# lookup tables, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue
+# long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. A file name
+# is replaced by its contents; a type:name table is matched when a
+# (parent) domain appears as lookup key.
+#
+# NOTE: Postfix will not automatically forward mail for domains that
+# list this system as their primary or backup MX host. See the
+# permit_mx_backup restriction description in postconf(5).
+#
+#relay_domains = $mydestination
+
+
+
+# INTERNET OR INTRANET
+
+# The relayhost parameter specifies the default host to send mail to
+# when no entry is matched in the optional transport(5) table. When
+# no relayhost is given, mail is routed directly to the destination.
+#
+# On an intranet, specify the organizational domain name. If your
+# internal DNS uses no MX records, specify the name of the intranet
+# gateway host instead.
+#
+# In the case of SMTP, specify a domain, host, host:port, [host]:port,
+# [address] or [address]:port; the form [host] turns off MX lookups.
+#
+# If you're connected via UUCP, see also the default_transport parameter.
+#
+#relayhost = $mydomain
+#relayhost = [gateway.my.domain]
+#relayhost = [mailserver.isp.tld]
+#relayhost = uucphost
+#relayhost = [an.ip.add.ress]
+relayhost = bastion.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+
+
+# REJECTING UNKNOWN RELAY USERS
+#
+# The relay_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all addresses in the domains that match $relay_domains.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown relay users. This feature is off by default.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify an @domain.tld wild-card, or specify
+# a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#relay_recipient_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_recipients
+
+# INPUT RATE CONTROL
+#
+# The in_flow_delay configuration parameter implements mail input
+# flow control. This feature is turned on by default, although it
+# still needs further development (it's disabled on SCO UNIX due
+# to an SCO bug).
+#
+# A Postfix process will pause for $in_flow_delay seconds before
+# accepting a new message, when the message arrival rate exceeds the
+# message delivery rate. With the default 100 SMTP server process
+# limit, this limits the mail inflow to 100 messages a second more
+# than the number of messages delivered per second.
+#
+# Specify 0 to disable the feature. Valid delays are 0..10.
+#
+#in_flow_delay = 1s
+
+# ADDRESS REWRITING
+#
+# The ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document gives information about
+# address masquerading or other forms of address rewriting including
+# username->Firstname.Lastname mapping.
+
+masquerade_domains = redhat.com
+masquerade_exceptions = root apache
+
+# ADDRESS REDIRECTION (VIRTUAL DOMAIN)
+#
+# The VIRTUAL_README document gives information about the many forms
+# of domain hosting that Postfix supports.
+
+# "USER HAS MOVED" BOUNCE MESSAGES
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# TRANSPORT MAP
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# ALIAS DATABASE
+#
+# The alias_maps parameter specifies the list of alias databases used
+# by the local delivery agent. The default list is system dependent.
+#
+# On systems with NIS, the default is to search the local alias
+# database, then the NIS alias database. See aliases(5) for syntax
+# details.
+#
+# If you change the alias database, run "postalias /etc/aliases" (or
+# wherever your system stores the mail alias file), or simply run
+# "newaliases" to build the necessary DBM or DB file.
+#
+# It will take a minute or so before changes become visible. Use
+# "postfix reload" to eliminate the delay.
+#
+#alias_maps = dbm:/etc/aliases
+alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, nis:mail.aliases
+#alias_maps = netinfo:/aliases
+
+# The alias_database parameter specifies the alias database(s) that
+# are built with "newaliases" or "sendmail -bi". This is a separate
+# configuration parameter, because alias_maps (see above) may specify
+# tables that are not necessarily all under control by Postfix.
+#
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/mail/aliases
+alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases, hash:/opt/majordomo/aliases
+
+# ADDRESS EXTENSIONS (e.g., user+foo)
+#
+# The recipient_delimiter parameter specifies the separator between
+# user names and address extensions (user+foo). See canonical(5),
+# local(8), relocated(5) and virtual(5) for the effects this has on
+# aliases, canonical, virtual, relocated and .forward file lookups.
+# Basically, the software tries user+foo and .forward+foo before
+# trying user and .forward.
+#
+recipient_delimiter = +
+
+# DELIVERY TO MAILBOX
+#
+# The home_mailbox parameter specifies the optional pathname of a
+# mailbox file relative to a user's home directory. The default
+# mailbox file is /var/spool/mail/user or /var/mail/user. Specify
+# "Maildir/" for qmail-style delivery (the / is required).
+#
+#home_mailbox = Mailbox
+#home_mailbox = Maildir/
+
+# The mail_spool_directory parameter specifies the directory where
+# UNIX-style mailboxes are kept. The default setting depends on the
+# system type.
+#
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/mail
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/spool/mail
+
+# The mailbox_command parameter specifies the optional external
+# command to use instead of mailbox delivery. The command is run as
+# the recipient with proper HOME, SHELL and LOGNAME environment settings.
+# Exception: delivery for root is done as $default_user.
+#
+# Other environment variables of interest: USER (recipient username),
+# EXTENSION (address extension), DOMAIN (domain part of address),
+# and LOCAL (the address localpart).
+#
+# Unlike other Postfix configuration parameters, the mailbox_command
+# parameter is not subjected to $parameter substitutions. This is to
+# make it easier to specify shell syntax (see example below).
+#
+# Avoid shell meta characters because they will force Postfix to run
+# an expensive shell process. Procmail alone is expensive enough.
+#
+# IF YOU USE THIS TO DELIVER MAIL SYSTEM-WIDE, YOU MUST SET UP AN
+# ALIAS THAT FORWARDS MAIL FOR ROOT TO A REAL USER.
+#
+#mailbox_command = /usr/bin/procmail
+#mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail -a "$EXTENSION"
+
+# The mailbox_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use after processing aliases and .forward files. This parameter
+# has precedence over the mailbox_command, fallback_transport and
+# luser_relay parameters.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+
+# If using the cyrus-imapd IMAP server deliver local mail to the IMAP
+# server using LMTP (Local Mail Transport Protocol), this is prefered
+# over the older cyrus deliver program by setting the
+# mailbox_transport as below:
+#
+# mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#
+# The efficiency of LMTP delivery for cyrus-imapd can be enhanced via
+# these settings.
+#
+# local_destination_recipient_limit = 300
+# local_destination_concurrency_limit = 5
+#
+# Of course you should adjust these settings as appropriate for the
+# capacity of the hardware you are using. The recipient limit setting
+# can be used to take advantage of the single instance message store
+# capability of Cyrus. The concurrency limit can be used to control
+# how many simultaneous LMTP sessions will be permitted to the Cyrus
+# message store.
+#
+# To use the old cyrus deliver program you have to set:
+#mailbox_transport = cyrus
+
+# The fallback_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use for recipients that are not found in the UNIX passwd database.
+# This parameter has precedence over the luser_relay parameter.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#fallback_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#fallback_transport =
+
+#transport_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/transport
+# The luser_relay parameter specifies an optional destination address
+# for unknown recipients. By default, mail for unknown@$mydestination,
+# unknown@[$inet_interfaces] or unknown@[$proxy_interfaces] is returned
+# as undeliverable.
+#
+# The following expansions are done on luser_relay: $user (recipient
+# username), $shell (recipient shell), $home (recipient home directory),
+# $recipient (full recipient address), $extension (recipient address
+# extension), $domain (recipient domain), $local (entire recipient
+# localpart), $recipient_delimiter. Specify ${name?value} or
+# ${name:value} to expand value only when $name does (does not) exist.
+#
+# luser_relay works only for the default Postfix local delivery agent.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must specify "local_recipient_maps =" (i.e. empty) in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#luser_relay = $user@other.host
+#luser_relay = $local@other.host
+#luser_relay = admin+$local
+
+# JUNK MAIL CONTROLS
+#
+# The controls listed here are only a very small subset. The file
+# SMTPD_ACCESS_README provides an overview.
+
+# The header_checks parameter specifies an optional table with patterns
+# that each logical message header is matched against, including
+# headers that span multiple physical lines.
+#
+# By default, these patterns also apply to MIME headers and to the
+# headers of attached messages. With older Postfix versions, MIME and
+# attached message headers were treated as body text.
+#
+# For details, see "man header_checks".
+#
+header_checks = regexp:/etc/postfix/header_checks
+
+# FAST ETRN SERVICE
+#
+# Postfix maintains per-destination logfiles with information about
+# deferred mail, so that mail can be flushed quickly with the SMTP
+# "ETRN domain.tld" command, or by executing "sendmail -qRdomain.tld".
+# See the ETRN_README document for a detailed description.
+#
+# The fast_flush_domains parameter controls what destinations are
+# eligible for this service. By default, they are all domains that
+# this server is willing to relay mail to.
+#
+#fast_flush_domains = $relay_domains
+
+# SHOW SOFTWARE VERSION OR NOT
+#
+# The smtpd_banner parameter specifies the text that follows the 220
+# code in the SMTP server's greeting banner. Some people like to see
+# the mail version advertised. By default, Postfix shows no version.
+#
+# You MUST specify $myhostname at the start of the text. That is an
+# RFC requirement. Postfix itself does not care.
+#
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name ($mail_version)
+
+# PARALLEL DELIVERY TO THE SAME DESTINATION
+#
+# How many parallel deliveries to the same user or domain? With local
+# delivery, it does not make sense to do massively parallel delivery
+# to the same user, because mailbox updates must happen sequentially,
+# and expensive pipelines in .forward files can cause disasters when
+# too many are run at the same time. With SMTP deliveries, 10
+# simultaneous connections to the same domain could be sufficient to
+# raise eyebrows.
+#
+# Each message delivery transport has its XXX_destination_concurrency_limit
+# parameter. The default is $default_destination_concurrency_limit for
+# most delivery transports. For the local delivery agent the default is 2.
+
+#local_destination_concurrency_limit = 2
+#default_destination_concurrency_limit = 20
+
+# DEBUGGING CONTROL
+#
+# The debug_peer_level parameter specifies the increment in verbose
+# logging level when an SMTP client or server host name or address
+# matches a pattern in the debug_peer_list parameter.
+#
+debug_peer_level = 2
+
+# The debug_peer_list parameter specifies an optional list of domain
+# or network patterns, /file/name patterns or type:name tables. When
+# an SMTP client or server host name or address matches a pattern,
+# increase the verbose logging level by the amount specified in the
+# debug_peer_level parameter.
+#
+#debug_peer_list = 127.0.0.1
+#debug_peer_list = some.domain
+
+# The debugger_command specifies the external command that is executed
+# when a Postfix daemon program is run with the -D option.
+#
+# Use "command .. & sleep 5" so that the debugger can attach before
+# the process marches on. If you use an X-based debugger, be sure to
+# set up your XAUTHORITY environment variable before starting Postfix.
+#
+debugger_command =
+ PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin:/usr/X11R6/bin
+ xxgdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id & sleep 5
+
+# If you can't use X, use this to capture the call stack when a
+# daemon crashes. The result is in a file in the configuration
+# directory, and is named after the process name and the process ID.
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin; export PATH; (echo cont;
+# echo where) | gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id 2>&1
+# >$config_directory/$process_name.$process_id.log & sleep 5
+#
+# Another possibility is to run gdb under a detached screen session.
+# To attach to the screen sesssion, su root and run "screen -r
+# <id_string>" where <id_string> uniquely matches one of the detached
+# sessions (from "screen -list").
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/sbin:/usr/sbin; export PATH; screen
+# -dmS $process_name gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name
+# $process_id & sleep 1
+
+# INSTALL-TIME CONFIGURATION INFORMATION
+#
+# The following parameters are used when installing a new Postfix version.
+#
+# sendmail_path: The full pathname of the Postfix sendmail command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible mail posting interface.
+#
+sendmail_path = /usr/sbin/sendmail.postfix
+
+# newaliases_path: The full pathname of the Postfix newaliases command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible command to build alias databases.
+#
+newaliases_path = /usr/bin/newaliases.postfix
+
+# mailq_path: The full pathname of the Postfix mailq command. This
+# is the Sendmail-compatible mail queue listing command.
+#
+mailq_path = /usr/bin/mailq.postfix
+
+# setgid_group: The group for mail submission and queue management
+# commands. This must be a group name with a numerical group ID that
+# is not shared with other accounts, not even with the Postfix account.
+#
+setgid_group = postdrop
+
+# html_directory: The location of the Postfix HTML documentation.
+#
+html_directory = no
+
+# manpage_directory: The location of the Postfix on-line manual pages.
+#
+manpage_directory = /usr/share/man
+
+# sample_directory: The location of the Postfix sample configuration files.
+# This parameter is obsolete as of Postfix 2.1.
+#
+sample_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/samples
+
+# readme_directory: The location of the Postfix README files.
+#
+readme_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/README_FILES
+
+smtp_host_lookup = native,dns
+
+# add this to new postfix to get it to add proper message-id and other
+# headers to outgoing emails via the gateway.
+
+message_size_limit = 20971520
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.upstreamfirst.fedorainfracloud.org b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.upstreamfirst.fedorainfracloud.org
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..293c0c165
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.upstreamfirst.fedorainfracloud.org
@@ -0,0 +1,687 @@
+# "false"
+# Global Postfix configuration file. This file lists only a subset
+# of all parameters. For the syntax, and for a complete parameter
+# list, see the postconf(5) manual page (command: "man 5 postconf").
+#
+# For common configuration examples, see BASIC_CONFIGURATION_README
+# and STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README. To find these documents, use
+# the command "postconf html_directory readme_directory", or go to
+# http://www.postfix.org/.
+#
+# For best results, change no more than 2-3 parameters at a time,
+# and test if Postfix still works after every change.
+
+# SOFT BOUNCE
+#
+# The soft_bounce parameter provides a limited safety net for
+# testing. When soft_bounce is enabled, mail will remain queued that
+# would otherwise bounce. This parameter disables locally-generated
+# bounces, and prevents the SMTP server from rejecting mail permanently
+# (by changing 5xx replies into 4xx replies). However, soft_bounce
+# is no cure for address rewriting mistakes or mail routing mistakes.
+#
+#soft_bounce = no
+
+# LOCAL PATHNAME INFORMATION
+#
+# The queue_directory specifies the location of the Postfix queue.
+# This is also the root directory of Postfix daemons that run chrooted.
+# See the files in examples/chroot-setup for setting up Postfix chroot
+# environments on different UNIX systems.
+#
+queue_directory = /var/spool/postfix
+
+# The command_directory parameter specifies the location of all
+# postXXX commands.
+#
+command_directory = /usr/sbin
+
+# The daemon_directory parameter specifies the location of all Postfix
+# daemon programs (i.e. programs listed in the master.cf file). This
+# directory must be owned by root.
+#
+daemon_directory = /usr/libexec/postfix
+
+# QUEUE AND PROCESS OWNERSHIP
+#
+# The mail_owner parameter specifies the owner of the Postfix queue
+# and of most Postfix daemon processes. Specify the name of a user
+# account THAT DOES NOT SHARE ITS USER OR GROUP ID WITH OTHER ACCOUNTS
+# AND THAT OWNS NO OTHER FILES OR PROCESSES ON THE SYSTEM. In
+# particular, don't specify nobody or daemon. PLEASE USE A DEDICATED
+# USER.
+#
+mail_owner = postfix
+
+# The default_privs parameter specifies the default rights used by
+# the local delivery agent for delivery to external file or command.
+# These rights are used in the absence of a recipient user context.
+# DO NOT SPECIFY A PRIVILEGED USER OR THE POSTFIX OWNER.
+#
+#default_privs = nobody
+
+# INTERNET HOST AND DOMAIN NAMES
+#
+# The myhostname parameter specifies the internet hostname of this
+# mail system. The default is to use the fully-qualified domain name
+# from gethostname(). $myhostname is used as a default value for many
+# other configuration parameters.
+#
+#myhostname = host.domain.tld
+#myhostname = virtual.domain.tld
+
+# The mydomain parameter specifies the local internet domain name.
+# The default is to use $myhostname minus the first component.
+# $mydomain is used as a default value for many other configuration
+# parameters.
+#
+#mydomain = domain.tld
+
+# SENDING MAIL
+#
+# The myorigin parameter specifies the domain that locally-posted
+# mail appears to come from. The default is to append $myhostname,
+# which is fine for small sites. If you run a domain with multiple
+# machines, you should (1) change this to $mydomain and (2) set up
+# a domain-wide alias database that aliases each user to
+# user@that.users.mailhost.
+#
+# For the sake of consistency between sender and recipient addresses,
+# myorigin also specifies the default domain name that is appended
+# to recipient addresses that have no @domain part.
+#
+#myorigin = $myhostname
+#myorigin = $mydomain
+
+mydomain = fedoraproject.org
+myorigin = fedoraproject.org
+
+# RECEIVING MAIL
+
+# The inet_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on. By default,
+# the software claims all active interfaces on the machine. The
+# parameter also controls delivery of mail to user@[ip.address].
+#
+# See also the proxy_interfaces parameter, for network addresses that
+# are forwarded to us via a proxy or network address translator.
+#
+# Note: you need to stop/start Postfix when this parameter changes.
+#
+#inet_interfaces = all
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname, localhost
+inet_interfaces = all
+
+# The proxy_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on by way of a
+# proxy or network address translation unit. This setting extends
+# the address list specified with the inet_interfaces parameter.
+#
+# You must specify your proxy/NAT addresses when your system is a
+# backup MX host for other domains, otherwise mail delivery loops
+# will happen when the primary MX host is down.
+#
+#proxy_interfaces =
+#proxy_interfaces = 1.2.3.4
+
+# The mydestination parameter specifies the list of domains that this
+# machine considers itself the final destination for.
+#
+# These domains are routed to the delivery agent specified with the
+# local_transport parameter setting. By default, that is the UNIX
+# compatible delivery agent that lookups all recipients in /etc/passwd
+# and /etc/aliases or their equivalent.
+#
+# The default is $myhostname + localhost.$mydomain. On a mail domain
+# gateway, you should also include $mydomain.
+#
+# Do not specify the names of virtual domains - those domains are
+# specified elsewhere (see VIRTUAL_README).
+#
+# Do not specify the names of domains that this machine is backup MX
+# host for. Specify those names via the relay_domains settings for
+# the SMTP server, or use permit_mx_backup if you are lazy (see
+# STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README).
+#
+# The local machine is always the final destination for mail addressed
+# to user@[the.net.work.address] of an interface that the mail system
+# receives mail on (see the inet_interfaces parameter).
+#
+# Specify a list of host or domain names, /file/name or type:table
+# patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. A /file/name
+# pattern is replaced by its contents; a type:table is matched when
+# a name matches a lookup key (the right-hand side is ignored).
+# Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.
+#
+# See also below, section "REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS".
+#
+mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, fedora.redhat.com, localhost
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain,
+# mail.$mydomain, www.$mydomain, ftp.$mydomain
+
+# REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS
+#
+# The local_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all names or addresses of users that are local with respect
+# to $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown local users. This parameter is defined by default.
+#
+# To turn off local recipient checking in the SMTP server, specify
+# local_recipient_maps = (i.e. empty).
+#
+# The default setting assumes that you use the default Postfix local
+# delivery agent for local delivery. You need to update the
+# local_recipient_maps setting if:
+#
+# - You define $mydestination domain recipients in files other than
+# /etc/passwd, /etc/aliases, or the $virtual_alias_maps files.
+# For example, you define $mydestination domain recipients in
+# the $virtual_mailbox_maps files.
+#
+# - You redefine the local delivery agent in master.cf.
+#
+# - You redefine the "local_transport" setting in main.cf.
+#
+# - You use the "luser_relay", "mailbox_transport", or "fallback_transport"
+# feature of the Postfix local delivery agent (see local(8)).
+#
+# Details are described in the LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README file.
+#
+# Beware: if the Postfix SMTP server runs chrooted, you probably have
+# to access the passwd file via the proxymap service, in order to
+# overcome chroot restrictions. The alternative, having a copy of
+# the system passwd file in the chroot jail is just not practical.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify a bare username, an @domain.tld
+# wild-card, or specify a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#local_recipient_maps = unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps = proxy:unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps =
+
+# The unknown_local_recipient_reject_code specifies the SMTP server
+# response code when a recipient domain matches $mydestination or
+# ${proxy,inet}_interfaces, while $local_recipient_maps is non-empty
+# and the recipient address or address local-part is not found.
+#
+# The default setting is 550 (reject mail) but it is safer to start
+# with 450 (try again later) until you are certain that your
+# local_recipient_maps settings are OK.
+#
+unknown_local_recipient_reject_code = 550
+
+# TRUST AND RELAY CONTROL
+
+# The mynetworks parameter specifies the list of "trusted" SMTP
+# clients that have more privileges than "strangers".
+#
+# In particular, "trusted" SMTP clients are allowed to relay mail
+# through Postfix. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions parameter
+# in postconf(5).
+#
+# You can specify the list of "trusted" network addresses by hand
+# or you can let Postfix do it for you (which is the default).
+#
+# By default (mynetworks_style = subnet), Postfix "trusts" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP subnetworks as the local machine.
+# On Linux, this does works correctly only with interfaces specified
+# with the "ifconfig" command.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = class" when Postfix should "trust" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP class A/B/C networks as the local machine.
+# Don't do this with a dialup site - it would cause Postfix to "trust"
+# your entire provider's network. Instead, specify an explicit
+# mynetworks list by hand, as described below.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = host" when Postfix should "trust"
+# only the local machine.
+#
+#mynetworks_style = class
+#mynetworks_style = subnet
+#mynetworks_style = host
+
+# Alternatively, you can specify the mynetworks list by hand, in
+# which case Postfix ignores the mynetworks_style setting.
+#
+# Specify an explicit list of network/netmask patterns, where the
+# mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host
+# address.
+#
+# You can also specify the absolute pathname of a pattern file instead
+# of listing the patterns here. Specify type:table for table-based lookups
+# (the value on the table right-hand side is not used).
+#
+#mynetworks = 168.100.189.0/28, 127.0.0.0/8
+#mynetworks = $config_directory/mynetworks
+#mynetworks = hash:/etc/postfix/network_table
+
+
+# The relay_domains parameter restricts what destinations this system will
+# relay mail to. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions description in
+# postconf(5) for detailed information.
+#
+# By default, Postfix relays mail
+# - from "trusted" clients (IP address matches $mynetworks) to any destination,
+# - from "untrusted" clients to destinations that match $relay_domains or
+# subdomains thereof, except addresses with sender-specified routing.
+# The default relay_domains value is $mydestination.
+#
+# In addition to the above, the Postfix SMTP server by default accepts mail
+# that Postfix is final destination for:
+# - destinations that match $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces,
+# - destinations that match $mydestination
+# - destinations that match $virtual_alias_domains,
+# - destinations that match $virtual_mailbox_domains.
+# These destinations do not need to be listed in $relay_domains.
+#
+# Specify a list of hosts or domains, /file/name patterns or type:name
+# lookup tables, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue
+# long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. A file name
+# is replaced by its contents; a type:name table is matched when a
+# (parent) domain appears as lookup key.
+#
+# NOTE: Postfix will not automatically forward mail for domains that
+# list this system as their primary or backup MX host. See the
+# permit_mx_backup restriction description in postconf(5).
+#
+#relay_domains = $mydestination
+
+
+
+# INTERNET OR INTRANET
+
+# The relayhost parameter specifies the default host to send mail to
+# when no entry is matched in the optional transport(5) table. When
+# no relayhost is given, mail is routed directly to the destination.
+#
+# On an intranet, specify the organizational domain name. If your
+# internal DNS uses no MX records, specify the name of the intranet
+# gateway host instead.
+#
+# In the case of SMTP, specify a domain, host, host:port, [host]:port,
+# [address] or [address]:port; the form [host] turns off MX lookups.
+#
+# If you're connected via UUCP, see also the default_transport parameter.
+#
+#relayhost = $mydomain
+#relayhost = [gateway.my.domain]
+#relayhost = [mailserver.isp.tld]
+#relayhost = uucphost
+#relayhost = [an.ip.add.ress]
+#relayhost = bastion
+
+
+# REJECTING UNKNOWN RELAY USERS
+#
+# The relay_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all addresses in the domains that match $relay_domains.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown relay users. This feature is off by default.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify an @domain.tld wild-card, or specify
+# a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#relay_recipient_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_recipients
+
+# INPUT RATE CONTROL
+#
+# The in_flow_delay configuration parameter implements mail input
+# flow control. This feature is turned on by default, although it
+# still needs further development (it's disabled on SCO UNIX due
+# to an SCO bug).
+#
+# A Postfix process will pause for $in_flow_delay seconds before
+# accepting a new message, when the message arrival rate exceeds the
+# message delivery rate. With the default 100 SMTP server process
+# limit, this limits the mail inflow to 100 messages a second more
+# than the number of messages delivered per second.
+#
+# Specify 0 to disable the feature. Valid delays are 0..10.
+#
+#in_flow_delay = 1s
+
+# ADDRESS REWRITING
+#
+# The ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document gives information about
+# address masquerading or other forms of address rewriting including
+# username->Firstname.Lastname mapping.
+
+masquerade_domains = redhat.com
+masquerade_exceptions = root apache
+
+# ADDRESS REDIRECTION (VIRTUAL DOMAIN)
+#
+# The VIRTUAL_README document gives information about the many forms
+# of domain hosting that Postfix supports.
+
+# "USER HAS MOVED" BOUNCE MESSAGES
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# TRANSPORT MAP
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# ALIAS DATABASE
+#
+# The alias_maps parameter specifies the list of alias databases used
+# by the local delivery agent. The default list is system dependent.
+#
+# On systems with NIS, the default is to search the local alias
+# database, then the NIS alias database. See aliases(5) for syntax
+# details.
+#
+# If you change the alias database, run "postalias /etc/aliases" (or
+# wherever your system stores the mail alias file), or simply run
+# "newaliases" to build the necessary DBM or DB file.
+#
+# It will take a minute or so before changes become visible. Use
+# "postfix reload" to eliminate the delay.
+#
+#alias_maps = dbm:/etc/aliases
+alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, nis:mail.aliases
+#alias_maps = netinfo:/aliases
+
+# The alias_database parameter specifies the alias database(s) that
+# are built with "newaliases" or "sendmail -bi". This is a separate
+# configuration parameter, because alias_maps (see above) may specify
+# tables that are not necessarily all under control by Postfix.
+#
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/mail/aliases
+alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases, hash:/opt/majordomo/aliases
+
+# ADDRESS EXTENSIONS (e.g., user+foo)
+#
+# The recipient_delimiter parameter specifies the separator between
+# user names and address extensions (user+foo). See canonical(5),
+# local(8), relocated(5) and virtual(5) for the effects this has on
+# aliases, canonical, virtual, relocated and .forward file lookups.
+# Basically, the software tries user+foo and .forward+foo before
+# trying user and .forward.
+#
+recipient_delimiter = +
+
+# DELIVERY TO MAILBOX
+#
+# The home_mailbox parameter specifies the optional pathname of a
+# mailbox file relative to a user's home directory. The default
+# mailbox file is /var/spool/mail/user or /var/mail/user. Specify
+# "Maildir/" for qmail-style delivery (the / is required).
+#
+#home_mailbox = Mailbox
+#home_mailbox = Maildir/
+
+# The mail_spool_directory parameter specifies the directory where
+# UNIX-style mailboxes are kept. The default setting depends on the
+# system type.
+#
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/mail
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/spool/mail
+
+# The mailbox_command parameter specifies the optional external
+# command to use instead of mailbox delivery. The command is run as
+# the recipient with proper HOME, SHELL and LOGNAME environment settings.
+# Exception: delivery for root is done as $default_user.
+#
+# Other environment variables of interest: USER (recipient username),
+# EXTENSION (address extension), DOMAIN (domain part of address),
+# and LOCAL (the address localpart).
+#
+# Unlike other Postfix configuration parameters, the mailbox_command
+# parameter is not subjected to $parameter substitutions. This is to
+# make it easier to specify shell syntax (see example below).
+#
+# Avoid shell meta characters because they will force Postfix to run
+# an expensive shell process. Procmail alone is expensive enough.
+#
+# IF YOU USE THIS TO DELIVER MAIL SYSTEM-WIDE, YOU MUST SET UP AN
+# ALIAS THAT FORWARDS MAIL FOR ROOT TO A REAL USER.
+#
+#mailbox_command = /usr/bin/procmail
+#mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail -a "$EXTENSION"
+
+# The mailbox_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use after processing aliases and .forward files. This parameter
+# has precedence over the mailbox_command, fallback_transport and
+# luser_relay parameters.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+
+# If using the cyrus-imapd IMAP server deliver local mail to the IMAP
+# server using LMTP (Local Mail Transport Protocol), this is prefered
+# over the older cyrus deliver program by setting the
+# mailbox_transport as below:
+#
+# mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#
+# The efficiency of LMTP delivery for cyrus-imapd can be enhanced via
+# these settings.
+#
+# local_destination_recipient_limit = 300
+# local_destination_concurrency_limit = 5
+#
+# Of course you should adjust these settings as appropriate for the
+# capacity of the hardware you are using. The recipient limit setting
+# can be used to take advantage of the single instance message store
+# capability of Cyrus. The concurrency limit can be used to control
+# how many simultaneous LMTP sessions will be permitted to the Cyrus
+# message store.
+#
+# To use the old cyrus deliver program you have to set:
+#mailbox_transport = cyrus
+
+# The fallback_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use for recipients that are not found in the UNIX passwd database.
+# This parameter has precedence over the luser_relay parameter.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#fallback_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#fallback_transport =
+
+#transport_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/transport
+# The luser_relay parameter specifies an optional destination address
+# for unknown recipients. By default, mail for unknown@$mydestination,
+# unknown@[$inet_interfaces] or unknown@[$proxy_interfaces] is returned
+# as undeliverable.
+#
+# The following expansions are done on luser_relay: $user (recipient
+# username), $shell (recipient shell), $home (recipient home directory),
+# $recipient (full recipient address), $extension (recipient address
+# extension), $domain (recipient domain), $local (entire recipient
+# localpart), $recipient_delimiter. Specify ${name?value} or
+# ${name:value} to expand value only when $name does (does not) exist.
+#
+# luser_relay works only for the default Postfix local delivery agent.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must specify "local_recipient_maps =" (i.e. empty) in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#luser_relay = $user@other.host
+#luser_relay = $local@other.host
+#luser_relay = admin+$local
+
+# JUNK MAIL CONTROLS
+#
+# The controls listed here are only a very small subset. The file
+# SMTPD_ACCESS_README provides an overview.
+
+# The header_checks parameter specifies an optional table with patterns
+# that each logical message header is matched against, including
+# headers that span multiple physical lines.
+#
+# By default, these patterns also apply to MIME headers and to the
+# headers of attached messages. With older Postfix versions, MIME and
+# attached message headers were treated as body text.
+#
+# For details, see "man header_checks".
+#
+header_checks = regexp:/etc/postfix/header_checks
+
+# FAST ETRN SERVICE
+#
+# Postfix maintains per-destination logfiles with information about
+# deferred mail, so that mail can be flushed quickly with the SMTP
+# "ETRN domain.tld" command, or by executing "sendmail -qRdomain.tld".
+# See the ETRN_README document for a detailed description.
+#
+# The fast_flush_domains parameter controls what destinations are
+# eligible for this service. By default, they are all domains that
+# this server is willing to relay mail to.
+#
+#fast_flush_domains = $relay_domains
+
+# SHOW SOFTWARE VERSION OR NOT
+#
+# The smtpd_banner parameter specifies the text that follows the 220
+# code in the SMTP server's greeting banner. Some people like to see
+# the mail version advertised. By default, Postfix shows no version.
+#
+# You MUST specify $myhostname at the start of the text. That is an
+# RFC requirement. Postfix itself does not care.
+#
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name ($mail_version)
+
+# PARALLEL DELIVERY TO THE SAME DESTINATION
+#
+# How many parallel deliveries to the same user or domain? With local
+# delivery, it does not make sense to do massively parallel delivery
+# to the same user, because mailbox updates must happen sequentially,
+# and expensive pipelines in .forward files can cause disasters when
+# too many are run at the same time. With SMTP deliveries, 10
+# simultaneous connections to the same domain could be sufficient to
+# raise eyebrows.
+#
+# Each message delivery transport has its XXX_destination_concurrency_limit
+# parameter. The default is $default_destination_concurrency_limit for
+# most delivery transports. For the local delivery agent the default is 2.
+
+#local_destination_concurrency_limit = 2
+#default_destination_concurrency_limit = 20
+
+# DEBUGGING CONTROL
+#
+# The debug_peer_level parameter specifies the increment in verbose
+# logging level when an SMTP client or server host name or address
+# matches a pattern in the debug_peer_list parameter.
+#
+debug_peer_level = 2
+
+# The debug_peer_list parameter specifies an optional list of domain
+# or network patterns, /file/name patterns or type:name tables. When
+# an SMTP client or server host name or address matches a pattern,
+# increase the verbose logging level by the amount specified in the
+# debug_peer_level parameter.
+#
+#debug_peer_list = 127.0.0.1
+#debug_peer_list = some.domain
+
+# The debugger_command specifies the external command that is executed
+# when a Postfix daemon program is run with the -D option.
+#
+# Use "command .. & sleep 5" so that the debugger can attach before
+# the process marches on. If you use an X-based debugger, be sure to
+# set up your XAUTHORITY environment variable before starting Postfix.
+#
+debugger_command =
+ PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin:/usr/X11R6/bin
+ xxgdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id & sleep 5
+
+# If you can't use X, use this to capture the call stack when a
+# daemon crashes. The result is in a file in the configuration
+# directory, and is named after the process name and the process ID.
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin; export PATH; (echo cont;
+# echo where) | gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id 2>&1
+# >$config_directory/$process_name.$process_id.log & sleep 5
+#
+# Another possibility is to run gdb under a detached screen session.
+# To attach to the screen sesssion, su root and run "screen -r
+# <id_string>" where <id_string> uniquely matches one of the detached
+# sessions (from "screen -list").
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/sbin:/usr/sbin; export PATH; screen
+# -dmS $process_name gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name
+# $process_id & sleep 1
+
+# INSTALL-TIME CONFIGURATION INFORMATION
+#
+# The following parameters are used when installing a new Postfix version.
+#
+# sendmail_path: The full pathname of the Postfix sendmail command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible mail posting interface.
+#
+sendmail_path = /usr/sbin/sendmail.postfix
+
+# newaliases_path: The full pathname of the Postfix newaliases command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible command to build alias databases.
+#
+newaliases_path = /usr/bin/newaliases.postfix
+
+# mailq_path: The full pathname of the Postfix mailq command. This
+# is the Sendmail-compatible mail queue listing command.
+#
+mailq_path = /usr/bin/mailq.postfix
+
+# setgid_group: The group for mail submission and queue management
+# commands. This must be a group name with a numerical group ID that
+# is not shared with other accounts, not even with the Postfix account.
+#
+setgid_group = postdrop
+
+# html_directory: The location of the Postfix HTML documentation.
+#
+html_directory = no
+
+# manpage_directory: The location of the Postfix on-line manual pages.
+#
+manpage_directory = /usr/share/man
+
+# sample_directory: The location of the Postfix sample configuration files.
+# This parameter is obsolete as of Postfix 2.1.
+#
+sample_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/samples
+
+# readme_directory: The location of the Postfix README files.
+#
+readme_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/README_FILES
+
+# add this to new postfix to get it to add proper message-id and other
+# headers to outgoing emails via the gateway.
+
+
+message_size_limit = 20971520
+#inet_protocols = ipv4
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.vpn b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.vpn
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..109879598
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.vpn
@@ -0,0 +1,687 @@
+# "false"
+# Global Postfix configuration file. This file lists only a subset
+# of all parameters. For the syntax, and for a complete parameter
+# list, see the postconf(5) manual page (command: "man 5 postconf").
+#
+# For common configuration examples, see BASIC_CONFIGURATION_README
+# and STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README. To find these documents, use
+# the command "postconf html_directory readme_directory", or go to
+# http://www.postfix.org/.
+#
+# For best results, change no more than 2-3 parameters at a time,
+# and test if Postfix still works after every change.
+
+# SOFT BOUNCE
+#
+# The soft_bounce parameter provides a limited safety net for
+# testing. When soft_bounce is enabled, mail will remain queued that
+# would otherwise bounce. This parameter disables locally-generated
+# bounces, and prevents the SMTP server from rejecting mail permanently
+# (by changing 5xx replies into 4xx replies). However, soft_bounce
+# is no cure for address rewriting mistakes or mail routing mistakes.
+#
+#soft_bounce = no
+
+# LOCAL PATHNAME INFORMATION
+#
+# The queue_directory specifies the location of the Postfix queue.
+# This is also the root directory of Postfix daemons that run chrooted.
+# See the files in examples/chroot-setup for setting up Postfix chroot
+# environments on different UNIX systems.
+#
+queue_directory = /var/spool/postfix
+
+# The command_directory parameter specifies the location of all
+# postXXX commands.
+#
+command_directory = /usr/sbin
+
+# The daemon_directory parameter specifies the location of all Postfix
+# daemon programs (i.e. programs listed in the master.cf file). This
+# directory must be owned by root.
+#
+daemon_directory = /usr/libexec/postfix
+
+# QUEUE AND PROCESS OWNERSHIP
+#
+# The mail_owner parameter specifies the owner of the Postfix queue
+# and of most Postfix daemon processes. Specify the name of a user
+# account THAT DOES NOT SHARE ITS USER OR GROUP ID WITH OTHER ACCOUNTS
+# AND THAT OWNS NO OTHER FILES OR PROCESSES ON THE SYSTEM. In
+# particular, don't specify nobody or daemon. PLEASE USE A DEDICATED
+# USER.
+#
+mail_owner = postfix
+
+# The default_privs parameter specifies the default rights used by
+# the local delivery agent for delivery to external file or command.
+# These rights are used in the absence of a recipient user context.
+# DO NOT SPECIFY A PRIVILEGED USER OR THE POSTFIX OWNER.
+#
+#default_privs = nobody
+
+# INTERNET HOST AND DOMAIN NAMES
+#
+# The myhostname parameter specifies the internet hostname of this
+# mail system. The default is to use the fully-qualified domain name
+# from gethostname(). $myhostname is used as a default value for many
+# other configuration parameters.
+#
+#myhostname = host.domain.tld
+#myhostname = virtual.domain.tld
+
+# The mydomain parameter specifies the local internet domain name.
+# The default is to use $myhostname minus the first component.
+# $mydomain is used as a default value for many other configuration
+# parameters.
+#
+#mydomain = domain.tld
+
+# SENDING MAIL
+#
+# The myorigin parameter specifies the domain that locally-posted
+# mail appears to come from. The default is to append $myhostname,
+# which is fine for small sites. If you run a domain with multiple
+# machines, you should (1) change this to $mydomain and (2) set up
+# a domain-wide alias database that aliases each user to
+# user@that.users.mailhost.
+#
+# For the sake of consistency between sender and recipient addresses,
+# myorigin also specifies the default domain name that is appended
+# to recipient addresses that have no @domain part.
+#
+#myorigin = $myhostname
+#myorigin = $mydomain
+
+mydomain = fedoraproject.org
+myorigin = fedoraproject.org
+
+# RECEIVING MAIL
+
+# The inet_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on. By default,
+# the software claims all active interfaces on the machine. The
+# parameter also controls delivery of mail to user@[ip.address].
+#
+# See also the proxy_interfaces parameter, for network addresses that
+# are forwarded to us via a proxy or network address translator.
+#
+# Note: you need to stop/start Postfix when this parameter changes.
+#
+#inet_interfaces = all
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname, localhost
+inet_interfaces = all
+
+# The proxy_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on by way of a
+# proxy or network address translation unit. This setting extends
+# the address list specified with the inet_interfaces parameter.
+#
+# You must specify your proxy/NAT addresses when your system is a
+# backup MX host for other domains, otherwise mail delivery loops
+# will happen when the primary MX host is down.
+#
+#proxy_interfaces =
+#proxy_interfaces = 1.2.3.4
+
+# The mydestination parameter specifies the list of domains that this
+# machine considers itself the final destination for.
+#
+# These domains are routed to the delivery agent specified with the
+# local_transport parameter setting. By default, that is the UNIX
+# compatible delivery agent that lookups all recipients in /etc/passwd
+# and /etc/aliases or their equivalent.
+#
+# The default is $myhostname + localhost.$mydomain. On a mail domain
+# gateway, you should also include $mydomain.
+#
+# Do not specify the names of virtual domains - those domains are
+# specified elsewhere (see VIRTUAL_README).
+#
+# Do not specify the names of domains that this machine is backup MX
+# host for. Specify those names via the relay_domains settings for
+# the SMTP server, or use permit_mx_backup if you are lazy (see
+# STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README).
+#
+# The local machine is always the final destination for mail addressed
+# to user@[the.net.work.address] of an interface that the mail system
+# receives mail on (see the inet_interfaces parameter).
+#
+# Specify a list of host or domain names, /file/name or type:table
+# patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. A /file/name
+# pattern is replaced by its contents; a type:table is matched when
+# a name matches a lookup key (the right-hand side is ignored).
+# Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.
+#
+# See also below, section "REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS".
+#
+mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, fedora.redhat.com, localhost
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain,
+# mail.$mydomain, www.$mydomain, ftp.$mydomain
+
+# REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS
+#
+# The local_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all names or addresses of users that are local with respect
+# to $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown local users. This parameter is defined by default.
+#
+# To turn off local recipient checking in the SMTP server, specify
+# local_recipient_maps = (i.e. empty).
+#
+# The default setting assumes that you use the default Postfix local
+# delivery agent for local delivery. You need to update the
+# local_recipient_maps setting if:
+#
+# - You define $mydestination domain recipients in files other than
+# /etc/passwd, /etc/aliases, or the $virtual_alias_maps files.
+# For example, you define $mydestination domain recipients in
+# the $virtual_mailbox_maps files.
+#
+# - You redefine the local delivery agent in master.cf.
+#
+# - You redefine the "local_transport" setting in main.cf.
+#
+# - You use the "luser_relay", "mailbox_transport", or "fallback_transport"
+# feature of the Postfix local delivery agent (see local(8)).
+#
+# Details are described in the LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README file.
+#
+# Beware: if the Postfix SMTP server runs chrooted, you probably have
+# to access the passwd file via the proxymap service, in order to
+# overcome chroot restrictions. The alternative, having a copy of
+# the system passwd file in the chroot jail is just not practical.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify a bare username, an @domain.tld
+# wild-card, or specify a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#local_recipient_maps = unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps = proxy:unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps =
+
+# The unknown_local_recipient_reject_code specifies the SMTP server
+# response code when a recipient domain matches $mydestination or
+# ${proxy,inet}_interfaces, while $local_recipient_maps is non-empty
+# and the recipient address or address local-part is not found.
+#
+# The default setting is 550 (reject mail) but it is safer to start
+# with 450 (try again later) until you are certain that your
+# local_recipient_maps settings are OK.
+#
+unknown_local_recipient_reject_code = 550
+
+# TRUST AND RELAY CONTROL
+
+# The mynetworks parameter specifies the list of "trusted" SMTP
+# clients that have more privileges than "strangers".
+#
+# In particular, "trusted" SMTP clients are allowed to relay mail
+# through Postfix. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions parameter
+# in postconf(5).
+#
+# You can specify the list of "trusted" network addresses by hand
+# or you can let Postfix do it for you (which is the default).
+#
+# By default (mynetworks_style = subnet), Postfix "trusts" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP subnetworks as the local machine.
+# On Linux, this does works correctly only with interfaces specified
+# with the "ifconfig" command.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = class" when Postfix should "trust" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP class A/B/C networks as the local machine.
+# Don't do this with a dialup site - it would cause Postfix to "trust"
+# your entire provider's network. Instead, specify an explicit
+# mynetworks list by hand, as described below.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = host" when Postfix should "trust"
+# only the local machine.
+#
+#mynetworks_style = class
+#mynetworks_style = subnet
+#mynetworks_style = host
+
+# Alternatively, you can specify the mynetworks list by hand, in
+# which case Postfix ignores the mynetworks_style setting.
+#
+# Specify an explicit list of network/netmask patterns, where the
+# mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host
+# address.
+#
+# You can also specify the absolute pathname of a pattern file instead
+# of listing the patterns here. Specify type:table for table-based lookups
+# (the value on the table right-hand side is not used).
+#
+#mynetworks = 168.100.189.0/28, 127.0.0.0/8
+#mynetworks = $config_directory/mynetworks
+#mynetworks = hash:/etc/postfix/network_table
+
+
+# The relay_domains parameter restricts what destinations this system will
+# relay mail to. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions description in
+# postconf(5) for detailed information.
+#
+# By default, Postfix relays mail
+# - from "trusted" clients (IP address matches $mynetworks) to any destination,
+# - from "untrusted" clients to destinations that match $relay_domains or
+# subdomains thereof, except addresses with sender-specified routing.
+# The default relay_domains value is $mydestination.
+#
+# In addition to the above, the Postfix SMTP server by default accepts mail
+# that Postfix is final destination for:
+# - destinations that match $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces,
+# - destinations that match $mydestination
+# - destinations that match $virtual_alias_domains,
+# - destinations that match $virtual_mailbox_domains.
+# These destinations do not need to be listed in $relay_domains.
+#
+# Specify a list of hosts or domains, /file/name patterns or type:name
+# lookup tables, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue
+# long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. A file name
+# is replaced by its contents; a type:name table is matched when a
+# (parent) domain appears as lookup key.
+#
+# NOTE: Postfix will not automatically forward mail for domains that
+# list this system as their primary or backup MX host. See the
+# permit_mx_backup restriction description in postconf(5).
+#
+#relay_domains = $mydestination
+
+
+
+# INTERNET OR INTRANET
+
+# The relayhost parameter specifies the default host to send mail to
+# when no entry is matched in the optional transport(5) table. When
+# no relayhost is given, mail is routed directly to the destination.
+#
+# On an intranet, specify the organizational domain name. If your
+# internal DNS uses no MX records, specify the name of the intranet
+# gateway host instead.
+#
+# In the case of SMTP, specify a domain, host, host:port, [host]:port,
+# [address] or [address]:port; the form [host] turns off MX lookups.
+#
+# If you're connected via UUCP, see also the default_transport parameter.
+#
+#relayhost = $mydomain
+#relayhost = [gateway.my.domain]
+#relayhost = [mailserver.isp.tld]
+#relayhost = uucphost
+#relayhost = [an.ip.add.ress]
+relayhost = bastion.vpn.fedoraproject.org
+
+
+# REJECTING UNKNOWN RELAY USERS
+#
+# The relay_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all addresses in the domains that match $relay_domains.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown relay users. This feature is off by default.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify an @domain.tld wild-card, or specify
+# a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#relay_recipient_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_recipients
+
+# INPUT RATE CONTROL
+#
+# The in_flow_delay configuration parameter implements mail input
+# flow control. This feature is turned on by default, although it
+# still needs further development (it's disabled on SCO UNIX due
+# to an SCO bug).
+#
+# A Postfix process will pause for $in_flow_delay seconds before
+# accepting a new message, when the message arrival rate exceeds the
+# message delivery rate. With the default 100 SMTP server process
+# limit, this limits the mail inflow to 100 messages a second more
+# than the number of messages delivered per second.
+#
+# Specify 0 to disable the feature. Valid delays are 0..10.
+#
+#in_flow_delay = 1s
+
+# ADDRESS REWRITING
+#
+# The ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document gives information about
+# address masquerading or other forms of address rewriting including
+# username->Firstname.Lastname mapping.
+
+masquerade_domains = redhat.com
+masquerade_exceptions = root apache
+
+# ADDRESS REDIRECTION (VIRTUAL DOMAIN)
+#
+# The VIRTUAL_README document gives information about the many forms
+# of domain hosting that Postfix supports.
+
+# "USER HAS MOVED" BOUNCE MESSAGES
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# TRANSPORT MAP
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# ALIAS DATABASE
+#
+# The alias_maps parameter specifies the list of alias databases used
+# by the local delivery agent. The default list is system dependent.
+#
+# On systems with NIS, the default is to search the local alias
+# database, then the NIS alias database. See aliases(5) for syntax
+# details.
+#
+# If you change the alias database, run "postalias /etc/aliases" (or
+# wherever your system stores the mail alias file), or simply run
+# "newaliases" to build the necessary DBM or DB file.
+#
+# It will take a minute or so before changes become visible. Use
+# "postfix reload" to eliminate the delay.
+#
+#alias_maps = dbm:/etc/aliases
+alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, nis:mail.aliases
+#alias_maps = netinfo:/aliases
+
+# The alias_database parameter specifies the alias database(s) that
+# are built with "newaliases" or "sendmail -bi". This is a separate
+# configuration parameter, because alias_maps (see above) may specify
+# tables that are not necessarily all under control by Postfix.
+#
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/mail/aliases
+alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases, hash:/opt/majordomo/aliases
+
+# ADDRESS EXTENSIONS (e.g., user+foo)
+#
+# The recipient_delimiter parameter specifies the separator between
+# user names and address extensions (user+foo). See canonical(5),
+# local(8), relocated(5) and virtual(5) for the effects this has on
+# aliases, canonical, virtual, relocated and .forward file lookups.
+# Basically, the software tries user+foo and .forward+foo before
+# trying user and .forward.
+#
+recipient_delimiter = +
+
+# DELIVERY TO MAILBOX
+#
+# The home_mailbox parameter specifies the optional pathname of a
+# mailbox file relative to a user's home directory. The default
+# mailbox file is /var/spool/mail/user or /var/mail/user. Specify
+# "Maildir/" for qmail-style delivery (the / is required).
+#
+#home_mailbox = Mailbox
+#home_mailbox = Maildir/
+
+# The mail_spool_directory parameter specifies the directory where
+# UNIX-style mailboxes are kept. The default setting depends on the
+# system type.
+#
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/mail
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/spool/mail
+
+# The mailbox_command parameter specifies the optional external
+# command to use instead of mailbox delivery. The command is run as
+# the recipient with proper HOME, SHELL and LOGNAME environment settings.
+# Exception: delivery for root is done as $default_user.
+#
+# Other environment variables of interest: USER (recipient username),
+# EXTENSION (address extension), DOMAIN (domain part of address),
+# and LOCAL (the address localpart).
+#
+# Unlike other Postfix configuration parameters, the mailbox_command
+# parameter is not subjected to $parameter substitutions. This is to
+# make it easier to specify shell syntax (see example below).
+#
+# Avoid shell meta characters because they will force Postfix to run
+# an expensive shell process. Procmail alone is expensive enough.
+#
+# IF YOU USE THIS TO DELIVER MAIL SYSTEM-WIDE, YOU MUST SET UP AN
+# ALIAS THAT FORWARDS MAIL FOR ROOT TO A REAL USER.
+#
+#mailbox_command = /usr/bin/procmail
+#mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail -a "$EXTENSION"
+
+# The mailbox_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use after processing aliases and .forward files. This parameter
+# has precedence over the mailbox_command, fallback_transport and
+# luser_relay parameters.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+
+# If using the cyrus-imapd IMAP server deliver local mail to the IMAP
+# server using LMTP (Local Mail Transport Protocol), this is prefered
+# over the older cyrus deliver program by setting the
+# mailbox_transport as below:
+#
+# mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#
+# The efficiency of LMTP delivery for cyrus-imapd can be enhanced via
+# these settings.
+#
+# local_destination_recipient_limit = 300
+# local_destination_concurrency_limit = 5
+#
+# Of course you should adjust these settings as appropriate for the
+# capacity of the hardware you are using. The recipient limit setting
+# can be used to take advantage of the single instance message store
+# capability of Cyrus. The concurrency limit can be used to control
+# how many simultaneous LMTP sessions will be permitted to the Cyrus
+# message store.
+#
+# To use the old cyrus deliver program you have to set:
+#mailbox_transport = cyrus
+
+# The fallback_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use for recipients that are not found in the UNIX passwd database.
+# This parameter has precedence over the luser_relay parameter.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#fallback_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#fallback_transport =
+
+#transport_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/transport
+# The luser_relay parameter specifies an optional destination address
+# for unknown recipients. By default, mail for unknown@$mydestination,
+# unknown@[$inet_interfaces] or unknown@[$proxy_interfaces] is returned
+# as undeliverable.
+#
+# The following expansions are done on luser_relay: $user (recipient
+# username), $shell (recipient shell), $home (recipient home directory),
+# $recipient (full recipient address), $extension (recipient address
+# extension), $domain (recipient domain), $local (entire recipient
+# localpart), $recipient_delimiter. Specify ${name?value} or
+# ${name:value} to expand value only when $name does (does not) exist.
+#
+# luser_relay works only for the default Postfix local delivery agent.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must specify "local_recipient_maps =" (i.e. empty) in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#luser_relay = $user@other.host
+#luser_relay = $local@other.host
+#luser_relay = admin+$local
+
+# JUNK MAIL CONTROLS
+#
+# The controls listed here are only a very small subset. The file
+# SMTPD_ACCESS_README provides an overview.
+
+# The header_checks parameter specifies an optional table with patterns
+# that each logical message header is matched against, including
+# headers that span multiple physical lines.
+#
+# By default, these patterns also apply to MIME headers and to the
+# headers of attached messages. With older Postfix versions, MIME and
+# attached message headers were treated as body text.
+#
+# For details, see "man header_checks".
+#
+header_checks = regexp:/etc/postfix/header_checks
+
+# FAST ETRN SERVICE
+#
+# Postfix maintains per-destination logfiles with information about
+# deferred mail, so that mail can be flushed quickly with the SMTP
+# "ETRN domain.tld" command, or by executing "sendmail -qRdomain.tld".
+# See the ETRN_README document for a detailed description.
+#
+# The fast_flush_domains parameter controls what destinations are
+# eligible for this service. By default, they are all domains that
+# this server is willing to relay mail to.
+#
+#fast_flush_domains = $relay_domains
+
+# SHOW SOFTWARE VERSION OR NOT
+#
+# The smtpd_banner parameter specifies the text that follows the 220
+# code in the SMTP server's greeting banner. Some people like to see
+# the mail version advertised. By default, Postfix shows no version.
+#
+# You MUST specify $myhostname at the start of the text. That is an
+# RFC requirement. Postfix itself does not care.
+#
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name ($mail_version)
+
+# PARALLEL DELIVERY TO THE SAME DESTINATION
+#
+# How many parallel deliveries to the same user or domain? With local
+# delivery, it does not make sense to do massively parallel delivery
+# to the same user, because mailbox updates must happen sequentially,
+# and expensive pipelines in .forward files can cause disasters when
+# too many are run at the same time. With SMTP deliveries, 10
+# simultaneous connections to the same domain could be sufficient to
+# raise eyebrows.
+#
+# Each message delivery transport has its XXX_destination_concurrency_limit
+# parameter. The default is $default_destination_concurrency_limit for
+# most delivery transports. For the local delivery agent the default is 2.
+
+#local_destination_concurrency_limit = 2
+#default_destination_concurrency_limit = 20
+
+# DEBUGGING CONTROL
+#
+# The debug_peer_level parameter specifies the increment in verbose
+# logging level when an SMTP client or server host name or address
+# matches a pattern in the debug_peer_list parameter.
+#
+debug_peer_level = 2
+
+# The debug_peer_list parameter specifies an optional list of domain
+# or network patterns, /file/name patterns or type:name tables. When
+# an SMTP client or server host name or address matches a pattern,
+# increase the verbose logging level by the amount specified in the
+# debug_peer_level parameter.
+#
+#debug_peer_list = 127.0.0.1
+#debug_peer_list = some.domain
+
+# The debugger_command specifies the external command that is executed
+# when a Postfix daemon program is run with the -D option.
+#
+# Use "command .. & sleep 5" so that the debugger can attach before
+# the process marches on. If you use an X-based debugger, be sure to
+# set up your XAUTHORITY environment variable before starting Postfix.
+#
+debugger_command =
+ PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin:/usr/X11R6/bin
+ xxgdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id & sleep 5
+
+# If you can't use X, use this to capture the call stack when a
+# daemon crashes. The result is in a file in the configuration
+# directory, and is named after the process name and the process ID.
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin; export PATH; (echo cont;
+# echo where) | gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id 2>&1
+# >$config_directory/$process_name.$process_id.log & sleep 5
+#
+# Another possibility is to run gdb under a detached screen session.
+# To attach to the screen sesssion, su root and run "screen -r
+# <id_string>" where <id_string> uniquely matches one of the detached
+# sessions (from "screen -list").
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/sbin:/usr/sbin; export PATH; screen
+# -dmS $process_name gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name
+# $process_id & sleep 1
+
+# INSTALL-TIME CONFIGURATION INFORMATION
+#
+# The following parameters are used when installing a new Postfix version.
+#
+# sendmail_path: The full pathname of the Postfix sendmail command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible mail posting interface.
+#
+sendmail_path = /usr/sbin/sendmail.postfix
+
+# newaliases_path: The full pathname of the Postfix newaliases command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible command to build alias databases.
+#
+newaliases_path = /usr/bin/newaliases.postfix
+
+# mailq_path: The full pathname of the Postfix mailq command. This
+# is the Sendmail-compatible mail queue listing command.
+#
+mailq_path = /usr/bin/mailq.postfix
+
+# setgid_group: The group for mail submission and queue management
+# commands. This must be a group name with a numerical group ID that
+# is not shared with other accounts, not even with the Postfix account.
+#
+setgid_group = postdrop
+
+# html_directory: The location of the Postfix HTML documentation.
+#
+html_directory = no
+
+# manpage_directory: The location of the Postfix on-line manual pages.
+#
+manpage_directory = /usr/share/man
+
+# sample_directory: The location of the Postfix sample configuration files.
+# This parameter is obsolete as of Postfix 2.1.
+#
+sample_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/samples
+
+# readme_directory: The location of the Postfix README files.
+#
+readme_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/README_FILES
+
+# add this to new postfix to get it to add proper message-id and other
+# headers to outgoing emails via the gateway.
+
+
+message_size_limit = 20971520
+#inet_protocols = ipv4
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.vpn.pagure b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.vpn.pagure
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..0b09a0203
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.vpn.pagure
@@ -0,0 +1,690 @@
+# "false"
+# Global Postfix configuration file. This file lists only a subset
+# of all parameters. For the syntax, and for a complete parameter
+# list, see the postconf(5) manual page (command: "man 5 postconf").
+#
+# For common configuration examples, see BASIC_CONFIGURATION_README
+# and STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README. To find these documents, use
+# the command "postconf html_directory readme_directory", or go to
+# http://www.postfix.org/.
+#
+# For best results, change no more than 2-3 parameters at a time,
+# and test if Postfix still works after every change.
+
+# SOFT BOUNCE
+#
+# The soft_bounce parameter provides a limited safety net for
+# testing. When soft_bounce is enabled, mail will remain queued that
+# would otherwise bounce. This parameter disables locally-generated
+# bounces, and prevents the SMTP server from rejecting mail permanently
+# (by changing 5xx replies into 4xx replies). However, soft_bounce
+# is no cure for address rewriting mistakes or mail routing mistakes.
+#
+#soft_bounce = no
+
+# LOCAL PATHNAME INFORMATION
+#
+# The queue_directory specifies the location of the Postfix queue.
+# This is also the root directory of Postfix daemons that run chrooted.
+# See the files in examples/chroot-setup for setting up Postfix chroot
+# environments on different UNIX systems.
+#
+queue_directory = /var/spool/postfix
+
+# The command_directory parameter specifies the location of all
+# postXXX commands.
+#
+command_directory = /usr/sbin
+
+# The daemon_directory parameter specifies the location of all Postfix
+# daemon programs (i.e. programs listed in the master.cf file). This
+# directory must be owned by root.
+#
+daemon_directory = /usr/libexec/postfix
+
+# QUEUE AND PROCESS OWNERSHIP
+#
+# The mail_owner parameter specifies the owner of the Postfix queue
+# and of most Postfix daemon processes. Specify the name of a user
+# account THAT DOES NOT SHARE ITS USER OR GROUP ID WITH OTHER ACCOUNTS
+# AND THAT OWNS NO OTHER FILES OR PROCESSES ON THE SYSTEM. In
+# particular, don't specify nobody or daemon. PLEASE USE A DEDICATED
+# USER.
+#
+mail_owner = postfix
+
+# The default_privs parameter specifies the default rights used by
+# the local delivery agent for delivery to external file or command.
+# These rights are used in the absence of a recipient user context.
+# DO NOT SPECIFY A PRIVILEGED USER OR THE POSTFIX OWNER.
+#
+#default_privs = nobody
+
+# INTERNET HOST AND DOMAIN NAMES
+#
+# The myhostname parameter specifies the internet hostname of this
+# mail system. The default is to use the fully-qualified domain name
+# from gethostname(). $myhostname is used as a default value for many
+# other configuration parameters.
+#
+#myhostname = host.domain.tld
+#myhostname = virtual.domain.tld
+
+# The mydomain parameter specifies the local internet domain name.
+# The default is to use $myhostname minus the first component.
+# $mydomain is used as a default value for many other configuration
+# parameters.
+#
+#mydomain = domain.tld
+
+# SENDING MAIL
+#
+# The myorigin parameter specifies the domain that locally-posted
+# mail appears to come from. The default is to append $myhostname,
+# which is fine for small sites. If you run a domain with multiple
+# machines, you should (1) change this to $mydomain and (2) set up
+# a domain-wide alias database that aliases each user to
+# user@that.users.mailhost.
+#
+# For the sake of consistency between sender and recipient addresses,
+# myorigin also specifies the default domain name that is appended
+# to recipient addresses that have no @domain part.
+#
+#myorigin = $myhostname
+#myorigin = $mydomain
+
+mydomain = pagure.io
+myorigin = pagure.io
+
+# RECEIVING MAIL
+
+# The inet_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on. By default,
+# the software claims all active interfaces on the machine. The
+# parameter also controls delivery of mail to user@[ip.address].
+#
+# See also the proxy_interfaces parameter, for network addresses that
+# are forwarded to us via a proxy or network address translator.
+#
+# Note: you need to stop/start Postfix when this parameter changes.
+#
+#inet_interfaces = all
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname, localhost
+inet_interfaces = all
+
+# The proxy_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on by way of a
+# proxy or network address translation unit. This setting extends
+# the address list specified with the inet_interfaces parameter.
+#
+# You must specify your proxy/NAT addresses when your system is a
+# backup MX host for other domains, otherwise mail delivery loops
+# will happen when the primary MX host is down.
+#
+#proxy_interfaces =
+#proxy_interfaces = 1.2.3.4
+
+# The mydestination parameter specifies the list of domains that this
+# machine considers itself the final destination for.
+#
+# These domains are routed to the delivery agent specified with the
+# local_transport parameter setting. By default, that is the UNIX
+# compatible delivery agent that lookups all recipients in /etc/passwd
+# and /etc/aliases or their equivalent.
+#
+# The default is $myhostname + localhost.$mydomain. On a mail domain
+# gateway, you should also include $mydomain.
+#
+# Do not specify the names of virtual domains - those domains are
+# specified elsewhere (see VIRTUAL_README).
+#
+# Do not specify the names of domains that this machine is backup MX
+# host for. Specify those names via the relay_domains settings for
+# the SMTP server, or use permit_mx_backup if you are lazy (see
+# STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README).
+#
+# The local machine is always the final destination for mail addressed
+# to user@[the.net.work.address] of an interface that the mail system
+# receives mail on (see the inet_interfaces parameter).
+#
+# Specify a list of host or domain names, /file/name or type:table
+# patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. A /file/name
+# pattern is replaced by its contents; a type:table is matched when
+# a name matches a lookup key (the right-hand side is ignored).
+# Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.
+#
+# See also below, section "REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS".
+#
+mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, fedora.redhat.com, localhost, $mydomain
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain,
+# mail.$mydomain, www.$mydomain, ftp.$mydomain
+
+# REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS
+#
+# The local_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all names or addresses of users that are local with respect
+# to $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown local users. This parameter is defined by default.
+#
+# To turn off local recipient checking in the SMTP server, specify
+# local_recipient_maps = (i.e. empty).
+#
+# The default setting assumes that you use the default Postfix local
+# delivery agent for local delivery. You need to update the
+# local_recipient_maps setting if:
+#
+# - You define $mydestination domain recipients in files other than
+# /etc/passwd, /etc/aliases, or the $virtual_alias_maps files.
+# For example, you define $mydestination domain recipients in
+# the $virtual_mailbox_maps files.
+#
+# - You redefine the local delivery agent in master.cf.
+#
+# - You redefine the "local_transport" setting in main.cf.
+#
+# - You use the "luser_relay", "mailbox_transport", or "fallback_transport"
+# feature of the Postfix local delivery agent (see local(8)).
+#
+# Details are described in the LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README file.
+#
+# Beware: if the Postfix SMTP server runs chrooted, you probably have
+# to access the passwd file via the proxymap service, in order to
+# overcome chroot restrictions. The alternative, having a copy of
+# the system passwd file in the chroot jail is just not practical.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify a bare username, an @domain.tld
+# wild-card, or specify a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#local_recipient_maps = unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps = proxy:unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps =
+
+# The unknown_local_recipient_reject_code specifies the SMTP server
+# response code when a recipient domain matches $mydestination or
+# ${proxy,inet}_interfaces, while $local_recipient_maps is non-empty
+# and the recipient address or address local-part is not found.
+#
+# The default setting is 550 (reject mail) but it is safer to start
+# with 450 (try again later) until you are certain that your
+# local_recipient_maps settings are OK.
+#
+unknown_local_recipient_reject_code = 550
+
+# TRUST AND RELAY CONTROL
+
+# The mynetworks parameter specifies the list of "trusted" SMTP
+# clients that have more privileges than "strangers".
+#
+# In particular, "trusted" SMTP clients are allowed to relay mail
+# through Postfix. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions parameter
+# in postconf(5).
+#
+# You can specify the list of "trusted" network addresses by hand
+# or you can let Postfix do it for you (which is the default).
+#
+# By default (mynetworks_style = subnet), Postfix "trusts" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP subnetworks as the local machine.
+# On Linux, this does works correctly only with interfaces specified
+# with the "ifconfig" command.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = class" when Postfix should "trust" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP class A/B/C networks as the local machine.
+# Don't do this with a dialup site - it would cause Postfix to "trust"
+# your entire provider's network. Instead, specify an explicit
+# mynetworks list by hand, as described below.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = host" when Postfix should "trust"
+# only the local machine.
+#
+#mynetworks_style = class
+#mynetworks_style = subnet
+#mynetworks_style = host
+
+# Alternatively, you can specify the mynetworks list by hand, in
+# which case Postfix ignores the mynetworks_style setting.
+#
+# Specify an explicit list of network/netmask patterns, where the
+# mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host
+# address.
+#
+# You can also specify the absolute pathname of a pattern file instead
+# of listing the patterns here. Specify type:table for table-based lookups
+# (the value on the table right-hand side is not used).
+#
+#mynetworks = 168.100.189.0/28, 127.0.0.0/8
+#mynetworks = $config_directory/mynetworks
+#mynetworks = hash:/etc/postfix/network_table
+
+
+# The relay_domains parameter restricts what destinations this system will
+# relay mail to. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions description in
+# postconf(5) for detailed information.
+#
+# By default, Postfix relays mail
+# - from "trusted" clients (IP address matches $mynetworks) to any destination,
+# - from "untrusted" clients to destinations that match $relay_domains or
+# subdomains thereof, except addresses with sender-specified routing.
+# The default relay_domains value is $mydestination.
+#
+# In addition to the above, the Postfix SMTP server by default accepts mail
+# that Postfix is final destination for:
+# - destinations that match $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces,
+# - destinations that match $mydestination
+# - destinations that match $virtual_alias_domains,
+# - destinations that match $virtual_mailbox_domains.
+# These destinations do not need to be listed in $relay_domains.
+#
+# Specify a list of hosts or domains, /file/name patterns or type:name
+# lookup tables, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue
+# long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. A file name
+# is replaced by its contents; a type:name table is matched when a
+# (parent) domain appears as lookup key.
+#
+# NOTE: Postfix will not automatically forward mail for domains that
+# list this system as their primary or backup MX host. See the
+# permit_mx_backup restriction description in postconf(5).
+#
+#relay_domains = $mydestination
+
+
+
+# INTERNET OR INTRANET
+
+# The relayhost parameter specifies the default host to send mail to
+# when no entry is matched in the optional transport(5) table. When
+# no relayhost is given, mail is routed directly to the destination.
+#
+# On an intranet, specify the organizational domain name. If your
+# internal DNS uses no MX records, specify the name of the intranet
+# gateway host instead.
+#
+# In the case of SMTP, specify a domain, host, host:port, [host]:port,
+# [address] or [address]:port; the form [host] turns off MX lookups.
+#
+# If you're connected via UUCP, see also the default_transport parameter.
+#
+#relayhost = $mydomain
+#relayhost = [gateway.my.domain]
+#relayhost = [mailserver.isp.tld]
+#relayhost = uucphost
+#relayhost = [an.ip.add.ress]
+relayhost = bastion.vpn.fedoraproject.org
+
+
+# REJECTING UNKNOWN RELAY USERS
+#
+# The relay_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all addresses in the domains that match $relay_domains.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown relay users. This feature is off by default.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify an @domain.tld wild-card, or specify
+# a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#relay_recipient_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_recipients
+
+# INPUT RATE CONTROL
+#
+# The in_flow_delay configuration parameter implements mail input
+# flow control. This feature is turned on by default, although it
+# still needs further development (it's disabled on SCO UNIX due
+# to an SCO bug).
+#
+# A Postfix process will pause for $in_flow_delay seconds before
+# accepting a new message, when the message arrival rate exceeds the
+# message delivery rate. With the default 100 SMTP server process
+# limit, this limits the mail inflow to 100 messages a second more
+# than the number of messages delivered per second.
+#
+# Specify 0 to disable the feature. Valid delays are 0..10.
+#
+#in_flow_delay = 1s
+
+# ADDRESS REWRITING
+#
+# The ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document gives information about
+# address masquerading or other forms of address rewriting including
+# username->Firstname.Lastname mapping.
+
+masquerade_domains = redhat.com
+masquerade_exceptions = root apache
+
+# ADDRESS REDIRECTION (VIRTUAL DOMAIN)
+#
+# The VIRTUAL_README document gives information about the many forms
+# of domain hosting that Postfix supports.
+
+# "USER HAS MOVED" BOUNCE MESSAGES
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# TRANSPORT MAP
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# ALIAS DATABASE
+#
+# The alias_maps parameter specifies the list of alias databases used
+# by the local delivery agent. The default list is system dependent.
+#
+# On systems with NIS, the default is to search the local alias
+# database, then the NIS alias database. See aliases(5) for syntax
+# details.
+#
+# If you change the alias database, run "postalias /etc/aliases" (or
+# wherever your system stores the mail alias file), or simply run
+# "newaliases" to build the necessary DBM or DB file.
+#
+# It will take a minute or so before changes become visible. Use
+# "postfix reload" to eliminate the delay.
+#
+#alias_maps = dbm:/etc/aliases
+alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, nis:mail.aliases
+#alias_maps = netinfo:/aliases
+
+# The alias_database parameter specifies the alias database(s) that
+# are built with "newaliases" or "sendmail -bi". This is a separate
+# configuration parameter, because alias_maps (see above) may specify
+# tables that are not necessarily all under control by Postfix.
+#
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/mail/aliases
+alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases, hash:/opt/majordomo/aliases
+
+# ADDRESS EXTENSIONS (e.g., user+foo)
+#
+# The recipient_delimiter parameter specifies the separator between
+# user names and address extensions (user+foo). See canonical(5),
+# local(8), relocated(5) and virtual(5) for the effects this has on
+# aliases, canonical, virtual, relocated and .forward file lookups.
+# Basically, the software tries user+foo and .forward+foo before
+# trying user and .forward.
+#
+recipient_delimiter = +
+
+# DELIVERY TO MAILBOX
+#
+# The home_mailbox parameter specifies the optional pathname of a
+# mailbox file relative to a user's home directory. The default
+# mailbox file is /var/spool/mail/user or /var/mail/user. Specify
+# "Maildir/" for qmail-style delivery (the / is required).
+#
+#home_mailbox = Mailbox
+#home_mailbox = Maildir/
+
+# The mail_spool_directory parameter specifies the directory where
+# UNIX-style mailboxes are kept. The default setting depends on the
+# system type.
+#
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/mail
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/spool/mail
+
+# The mailbox_command parameter specifies the optional external
+# command to use instead of mailbox delivery. The command is run as
+# the recipient with proper HOME, SHELL and LOGNAME environment settings.
+# Exception: delivery for root is done as $default_user.
+#
+# Other environment variables of interest: USER (recipient username),
+# EXTENSION (address extension), DOMAIN (domain part of address),
+# and LOCAL (the address localpart).
+#
+# Unlike other Postfix configuration parameters, the mailbox_command
+# parameter is not subjected to $parameter substitutions. This is to
+# make it easier to specify shell syntax (see example below).
+#
+# Avoid shell meta characters because they will force Postfix to run
+# an expensive shell process. Procmail alone is expensive enough.
+#
+# IF YOU USE THIS TO DELIVER MAIL SYSTEM-WIDE, YOU MUST SET UP AN
+# ALIAS THAT FORWARDS MAIL FOR ROOT TO A REAL USER.
+#
+#mailbox_command = /usr/bin/procmail
+#mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail -a "$EXTENSION"
+
+# The mailbox_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use after processing aliases and .forward files. This parameter
+# has precedence over the mailbox_command, fallback_transport and
+# luser_relay parameters.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+
+# If using the cyrus-imapd IMAP server deliver local mail to the IMAP
+# server using LMTP (Local Mail Transport Protocol), this is prefered
+# over the older cyrus deliver program by setting the
+# mailbox_transport as below:
+#
+# mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#
+# The efficiency of LMTP delivery for cyrus-imapd can be enhanced via
+# these settings.
+#
+# local_destination_recipient_limit = 300
+# local_destination_concurrency_limit = 5
+#
+# Of course you should adjust these settings as appropriate for the
+# capacity of the hardware you are using. The recipient limit setting
+# can be used to take advantage of the single instance message store
+# capability of Cyrus. The concurrency limit can be used to control
+# how many simultaneous LMTP sessions will be permitted to the Cyrus
+# message store.
+#
+# To use the old cyrus deliver program you have to set:
+#mailbox_transport = cyrus
+
+# The fallback_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use for recipients that are not found in the UNIX passwd database.
+# This parameter has precedence over the luser_relay parameter.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#fallback_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#fallback_transport =
+
+#transport_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/transport
+# The luser_relay parameter specifies an optional destination address
+# for unknown recipients. By default, mail for unknown@$mydestination,
+# unknown@[$inet_interfaces] or unknown@[$proxy_interfaces] is returned
+# as undeliverable.
+#
+# The following expansions are done on luser_relay: $user (recipient
+# username), $shell (recipient shell), $home (recipient home directory),
+# $recipient (full recipient address), $extension (recipient address
+# extension), $domain (recipient domain), $local (entire recipient
+# localpart), $recipient_delimiter. Specify ${name?value} or
+# ${name:value} to expand value only when $name does (does not) exist.
+#
+# luser_relay works only for the default Postfix local delivery agent.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must specify "local_recipient_maps =" (i.e. empty) in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#luser_relay = $user@other.host
+#luser_relay = $local@other.host
+#luser_relay = admin+$local
+
+# JUNK MAIL CONTROLS
+#
+# The controls listed here are only a very small subset. The file
+# SMTPD_ACCESS_README provides an overview.
+
+# The header_checks parameter specifies an optional table with patterns
+# that each logical message header is matched against, including
+# headers that span multiple physical lines.
+#
+# By default, these patterns also apply to MIME headers and to the
+# headers of attached messages. With older Postfix versions, MIME and
+# attached message headers were treated as body text.
+#
+# For details, see "man header_checks".
+#
+header_checks = regexp:/etc/postfix/header_checks
+
+# FAST ETRN SERVICE
+#
+# Postfix maintains per-destination logfiles with information about
+# deferred mail, so that mail can be flushed quickly with the SMTP
+# "ETRN domain.tld" command, or by executing "sendmail -qRdomain.tld".
+# See the ETRN_README document for a detailed description.
+#
+# The fast_flush_domains parameter controls what destinations are
+# eligible for this service. By default, they are all domains that
+# this server is willing to relay mail to.
+#
+#fast_flush_domains = $relay_domains
+
+# SHOW SOFTWARE VERSION OR NOT
+#
+# The smtpd_banner parameter specifies the text that follows the 220
+# code in the SMTP server's greeting banner. Some people like to see
+# the mail version advertised. By default, Postfix shows no version.
+#
+# You MUST specify $myhostname at the start of the text. That is an
+# RFC requirement. Postfix itself does not care.
+#
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name ($mail_version)
+
+# PARALLEL DELIVERY TO THE SAME DESTINATION
+#
+# How many parallel deliveries to the same user or domain? With local
+# delivery, it does not make sense to do massively parallel delivery
+# to the same user, because mailbox updates must happen sequentially,
+# and expensive pipelines in .forward files can cause disasters when
+# too many are run at the same time. With SMTP deliveries, 10
+# simultaneous connections to the same domain could be sufficient to
+# raise eyebrows.
+#
+# Each message delivery transport has its XXX_destination_concurrency_limit
+# parameter. The default is $default_destination_concurrency_limit for
+# most delivery transports. For the local delivery agent the default is 2.
+
+#local_destination_concurrency_limit = 2
+#default_destination_concurrency_limit = 20
+
+# DEBUGGING CONTROL
+#
+# The debug_peer_level parameter specifies the increment in verbose
+# logging level when an SMTP client or server host name or address
+# matches a pattern in the debug_peer_list parameter.
+#
+debug_peer_level = 2
+
+# The debug_peer_list parameter specifies an optional list of domain
+# or network patterns, /file/name patterns or type:name tables. When
+# an SMTP client or server host name or address matches a pattern,
+# increase the verbose logging level by the amount specified in the
+# debug_peer_level parameter.
+#
+#debug_peer_list = 127.0.0.1
+#debug_peer_list = some.domain
+
+# The debugger_command specifies the external command that is executed
+# when a Postfix daemon program is run with the -D option.
+#
+# Use "command .. & sleep 5" so that the debugger can attach before
+# the process marches on. If you use an X-based debugger, be sure to
+# set up your XAUTHORITY environment variable before starting Postfix.
+#
+debugger_command =
+ PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin:/usr/X11R6/bin
+ xxgdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id & sleep 5
+
+# If you can't use X, use this to capture the call stack when a
+# daemon crashes. The result is in a file in the configuration
+# directory, and is named after the process name and the process ID.
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin; export PATH; (echo cont;
+# echo where) | gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id 2>&1
+# >$config_directory/$process_name.$process_id.log & sleep 5
+#
+# Another possibility is to run gdb under a detached screen session.
+# To attach to the screen sesssion, su root and run "screen -r
+# <id_string>" where <id_string> uniquely matches one of the detached
+# sessions (from "screen -list").
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/sbin:/usr/sbin; export PATH; screen
+# -dmS $process_name gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name
+# $process_id & sleep 1
+
+# INSTALL-TIME CONFIGURATION INFORMATION
+#
+# The following parameters are used when installing a new Postfix version.
+#
+# sendmail_path: The full pathname of the Postfix sendmail command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible mail posting interface.
+#
+sendmail_path = /usr/sbin/sendmail.postfix
+
+# newaliases_path: The full pathname of the Postfix newaliases command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible command to build alias databases.
+#
+newaliases_path = /usr/bin/newaliases.postfix
+
+# mailq_path: The full pathname of the Postfix mailq command. This
+# is the Sendmail-compatible mail queue listing command.
+#
+mailq_path = /usr/bin/mailq.postfix
+
+# setgid_group: The group for mail submission and queue management
+# commands. This must be a group name with a numerical group ID that
+# is not shared with other accounts, not even with the Postfix account.
+#
+setgid_group = postdrop
+
+# html_directory: The location of the Postfix HTML documentation.
+#
+html_directory = no
+
+# manpage_directory: The location of the Postfix on-line manual pages.
+#
+manpage_directory = /usr/share/man
+
+# sample_directory: The location of the Postfix sample configuration files.
+# This parameter is obsolete as of Postfix 2.1.
+#
+sample_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/samples
+
+# readme_directory: The location of the Postfix README files.
+#
+readme_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/README_FILES
+
+# add this to new postfix to get it to add proper message-id and other
+# headers to outgoing emails via the gateway.
+
+
+message_size_limit = 20971520
+#inet_protocols = ipv4
+
+non_smtpd_milters = unix:/var/run/pagure/paguresock
+smtpd_milters = unix:/var/run/pagure/paguresock
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.vpn.pagure-stg b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.vpn.pagure-stg
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..95927bf65
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/main.cf/main.cf.vpn.pagure-stg
@@ -0,0 +1,690 @@
+# "false"
+# Global Postfix configuration file. This file lists only a subset
+# of all parameters. For the syntax, and for a complete parameter
+# list, see the postconf(5) manual page (command: "man 5 postconf").
+#
+# For common configuration examples, see BASIC_CONFIGURATION_README
+# and STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README. To find these documents, use
+# the command "postconf html_directory readme_directory", or go to
+# http://www.postfix.org/.
+#
+# For best results, change no more than 2-3 parameters at a time,
+# and test if Postfix still works after every change.
+
+# SOFT BOUNCE
+#
+# The soft_bounce parameter provides a limited safety net for
+# testing. When soft_bounce is enabled, mail will remain queued that
+# would otherwise bounce. This parameter disables locally-generated
+# bounces, and prevents the SMTP server from rejecting mail permanently
+# (by changing 5xx replies into 4xx replies). However, soft_bounce
+# is no cure for address rewriting mistakes or mail routing mistakes.
+#
+#soft_bounce = no
+
+# LOCAL PATHNAME INFORMATION
+#
+# The queue_directory specifies the location of the Postfix queue.
+# This is also the root directory of Postfix daemons that run chrooted.
+# See the files in examples/chroot-setup for setting up Postfix chroot
+# environments on different UNIX systems.
+#
+queue_directory = /var/spool/postfix
+
+# The command_directory parameter specifies the location of all
+# postXXX commands.
+#
+command_directory = /usr/sbin
+
+# The daemon_directory parameter specifies the location of all Postfix
+# daemon programs (i.e. programs listed in the master.cf file). This
+# directory must be owned by root.
+#
+daemon_directory = /usr/libexec/postfix
+
+# QUEUE AND PROCESS OWNERSHIP
+#
+# The mail_owner parameter specifies the owner of the Postfix queue
+# and of most Postfix daemon processes. Specify the name of a user
+# account THAT DOES NOT SHARE ITS USER OR GROUP ID WITH OTHER ACCOUNTS
+# AND THAT OWNS NO OTHER FILES OR PROCESSES ON THE SYSTEM. In
+# particular, don't specify nobody or daemon. PLEASE USE A DEDICATED
+# USER.
+#
+mail_owner = postfix
+
+# The default_privs parameter specifies the default rights used by
+# the local delivery agent for delivery to external file or command.
+# These rights are used in the absence of a recipient user context.
+# DO NOT SPECIFY A PRIVILEGED USER OR THE POSTFIX OWNER.
+#
+#default_privs = nobody
+
+# INTERNET HOST AND DOMAIN NAMES
+#
+# The myhostname parameter specifies the internet hostname of this
+# mail system. The default is to use the fully-qualified domain name
+# from gethostname(). $myhostname is used as a default value for many
+# other configuration parameters.
+#
+#myhostname = host.domain.tld
+#myhostname = virtual.domain.tld
+
+# The mydomain parameter specifies the local internet domain name.
+# The default is to use $myhostname minus the first component.
+# $mydomain is used as a default value for many other configuration
+# parameters.
+#
+#mydomain = domain.tld
+
+# SENDING MAIL
+#
+# The myorigin parameter specifies the domain that locally-posted
+# mail appears to come from. The default is to append $myhostname,
+# which is fine for small sites. If you run a domain with multiple
+# machines, you should (1) change this to $mydomain and (2) set up
+# a domain-wide alias database that aliases each user to
+# user@that.users.mailhost.
+#
+# For the sake of consistency between sender and recipient addresses,
+# myorigin also specifies the default domain name that is appended
+# to recipient addresses that have no @domain part.
+#
+#myorigin = $myhostname
+#myorigin = $mydomain
+
+mydomain = stg.pagure.io
+myorigin = stg.pagure.io
+
+# RECEIVING MAIL
+
+# The inet_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on. By default,
+# the software claims all active interfaces on the machine. The
+# parameter also controls delivery of mail to user@[ip.address].
+#
+# See also the proxy_interfaces parameter, for network addresses that
+# are forwarded to us via a proxy or network address translator.
+#
+# Note: you need to stop/start Postfix when this parameter changes.
+#
+#inet_interfaces = all
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname
+#inet_interfaces = $myhostname, localhost
+inet_interfaces = all
+
+# The proxy_interfaces parameter specifies the network interface
+# addresses that this mail system receives mail on by way of a
+# proxy or network address translation unit. This setting extends
+# the address list specified with the inet_interfaces parameter.
+#
+# You must specify your proxy/NAT addresses when your system is a
+# backup MX host for other domains, otherwise mail delivery loops
+# will happen when the primary MX host is down.
+#
+#proxy_interfaces =
+#proxy_interfaces = 1.2.3.4
+
+# The mydestination parameter specifies the list of domains that this
+# machine considers itself the final destination for.
+#
+# These domains are routed to the delivery agent specified with the
+# local_transport parameter setting. By default, that is the UNIX
+# compatible delivery agent that lookups all recipients in /etc/passwd
+# and /etc/aliases or their equivalent.
+#
+# The default is $myhostname + localhost.$mydomain. On a mail domain
+# gateway, you should also include $mydomain.
+#
+# Do not specify the names of virtual domains - those domains are
+# specified elsewhere (see VIRTUAL_README).
+#
+# Do not specify the names of domains that this machine is backup MX
+# host for. Specify those names via the relay_domains settings for
+# the SMTP server, or use permit_mx_backup if you are lazy (see
+# STANDARD_CONFIGURATION_README).
+#
+# The local machine is always the final destination for mail addressed
+# to user@[the.net.work.address] of an interface that the mail system
+# receives mail on (see the inet_interfaces parameter).
+#
+# Specify a list of host or domain names, /file/name or type:table
+# patterns, separated by commas and/or whitespace. A /file/name
+# pattern is replaced by its contents; a type:table is matched when
+# a name matches a lookup key (the right-hand side is ignored).
+# Continue long lines by starting the next line with whitespace.
+#
+# See also below, section "REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS".
+#
+mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, fedora.redhat.com, localhost, $mydomain
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain
+#mydestination = $myhostname, localhost.$mydomain, localhost, $mydomain,
+# mail.$mydomain, www.$mydomain, ftp.$mydomain
+
+# REJECTING MAIL FOR UNKNOWN LOCAL USERS
+#
+# The local_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all names or addresses of users that are local with respect
+# to $mydestination, $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown local users. This parameter is defined by default.
+#
+# To turn off local recipient checking in the SMTP server, specify
+# local_recipient_maps = (i.e. empty).
+#
+# The default setting assumes that you use the default Postfix local
+# delivery agent for local delivery. You need to update the
+# local_recipient_maps setting if:
+#
+# - You define $mydestination domain recipients in files other than
+# /etc/passwd, /etc/aliases, or the $virtual_alias_maps files.
+# For example, you define $mydestination domain recipients in
+# the $virtual_mailbox_maps files.
+#
+# - You redefine the local delivery agent in master.cf.
+#
+# - You redefine the "local_transport" setting in main.cf.
+#
+# - You use the "luser_relay", "mailbox_transport", or "fallback_transport"
+# feature of the Postfix local delivery agent (see local(8)).
+#
+# Details are described in the LOCAL_RECIPIENT_README file.
+#
+# Beware: if the Postfix SMTP server runs chrooted, you probably have
+# to access the passwd file via the proxymap service, in order to
+# overcome chroot restrictions. The alternative, having a copy of
+# the system passwd file in the chroot jail is just not practical.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify a bare username, an @domain.tld
+# wild-card, or specify a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#local_recipient_maps = unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps = proxy:unix:passwd.byname $alias_maps
+#local_recipient_maps =
+
+# The unknown_local_recipient_reject_code specifies the SMTP server
+# response code when a recipient domain matches $mydestination or
+# ${proxy,inet}_interfaces, while $local_recipient_maps is non-empty
+# and the recipient address or address local-part is not found.
+#
+# The default setting is 550 (reject mail) but it is safer to start
+# with 450 (try again later) until you are certain that your
+# local_recipient_maps settings are OK.
+#
+unknown_local_recipient_reject_code = 550
+
+# TRUST AND RELAY CONTROL
+
+# The mynetworks parameter specifies the list of "trusted" SMTP
+# clients that have more privileges than "strangers".
+#
+# In particular, "trusted" SMTP clients are allowed to relay mail
+# through Postfix. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions parameter
+# in postconf(5).
+#
+# You can specify the list of "trusted" network addresses by hand
+# or you can let Postfix do it for you (which is the default).
+#
+# By default (mynetworks_style = subnet), Postfix "trusts" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP subnetworks as the local machine.
+# On Linux, this does works correctly only with interfaces specified
+# with the "ifconfig" command.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = class" when Postfix should "trust" SMTP
+# clients in the same IP class A/B/C networks as the local machine.
+# Don't do this with a dialup site - it would cause Postfix to "trust"
+# your entire provider's network. Instead, specify an explicit
+# mynetworks list by hand, as described below.
+#
+# Specify "mynetworks_style = host" when Postfix should "trust"
+# only the local machine.
+#
+#mynetworks_style = class
+#mynetworks_style = subnet
+#mynetworks_style = host
+
+# Alternatively, you can specify the mynetworks list by hand, in
+# which case Postfix ignores the mynetworks_style setting.
+#
+# Specify an explicit list of network/netmask patterns, where the
+# mask specifies the number of bits in the network part of a host
+# address.
+#
+# You can also specify the absolute pathname of a pattern file instead
+# of listing the patterns here. Specify type:table for table-based lookups
+# (the value on the table right-hand side is not used).
+#
+#mynetworks = 168.100.189.0/28, 127.0.0.0/8
+#mynetworks = $config_directory/mynetworks
+#mynetworks = hash:/etc/postfix/network_table
+
+
+# The relay_domains parameter restricts what destinations this system will
+# relay mail to. See the smtpd_recipient_restrictions description in
+# postconf(5) for detailed information.
+#
+# By default, Postfix relays mail
+# - from "trusted" clients (IP address matches $mynetworks) to any destination,
+# - from "untrusted" clients to destinations that match $relay_domains or
+# subdomains thereof, except addresses with sender-specified routing.
+# The default relay_domains value is $mydestination.
+#
+# In addition to the above, the Postfix SMTP server by default accepts mail
+# that Postfix is final destination for:
+# - destinations that match $inet_interfaces or $proxy_interfaces,
+# - destinations that match $mydestination
+# - destinations that match $virtual_alias_domains,
+# - destinations that match $virtual_mailbox_domains.
+# These destinations do not need to be listed in $relay_domains.
+#
+# Specify a list of hosts or domains, /file/name patterns or type:name
+# lookup tables, separated by commas and/or whitespace. Continue
+# long lines by starting the next line with whitespace. A file name
+# is replaced by its contents; a type:name table is matched when a
+# (parent) domain appears as lookup key.
+#
+# NOTE: Postfix will not automatically forward mail for domains that
+# list this system as their primary or backup MX host. See the
+# permit_mx_backup restriction description in postconf(5).
+#
+#relay_domains = $mydestination
+
+
+
+# INTERNET OR INTRANET
+
+# The relayhost parameter specifies the default host to send mail to
+# when no entry is matched in the optional transport(5) table. When
+# no relayhost is given, mail is routed directly to the destination.
+#
+# On an intranet, specify the organizational domain name. If your
+# internal DNS uses no MX records, specify the name of the intranet
+# gateway host instead.
+#
+# In the case of SMTP, specify a domain, host, host:port, [host]:port,
+# [address] or [address]:port; the form [host] turns off MX lookups.
+#
+# If you're connected via UUCP, see also the default_transport parameter.
+#
+#relayhost = $mydomain
+#relayhost = [gateway.my.domain]
+#relayhost = [mailserver.isp.tld]
+#relayhost = uucphost
+#relayhost = [an.ip.add.ress]
+relayhost = bastion.vpn.fedoraproject.org
+
+
+# REJECTING UNKNOWN RELAY USERS
+#
+# The relay_recipient_maps parameter specifies optional lookup tables
+# with all addresses in the domains that match $relay_domains.
+#
+# If this parameter is defined, then the SMTP server will reject
+# mail for unknown relay users. This feature is off by default.
+#
+# The right-hand side of the lookup tables is conveniently ignored.
+# In the left-hand side, specify an @domain.tld wild-card, or specify
+# a user@domain.tld address.
+#
+#relay_recipient_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/relay_recipients
+
+# INPUT RATE CONTROL
+#
+# The in_flow_delay configuration parameter implements mail input
+# flow control. This feature is turned on by default, although it
+# still needs further development (it's disabled on SCO UNIX due
+# to an SCO bug).
+#
+# A Postfix process will pause for $in_flow_delay seconds before
+# accepting a new message, when the message arrival rate exceeds the
+# message delivery rate. With the default 100 SMTP server process
+# limit, this limits the mail inflow to 100 messages a second more
+# than the number of messages delivered per second.
+#
+# Specify 0 to disable the feature. Valid delays are 0..10.
+#
+#in_flow_delay = 1s
+
+# ADDRESS REWRITING
+#
+# The ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document gives information about
+# address masquerading or other forms of address rewriting including
+# username->Firstname.Lastname mapping.
+
+masquerade_domains = redhat.com
+masquerade_exceptions = root apache
+
+# ADDRESS REDIRECTION (VIRTUAL DOMAIN)
+#
+# The VIRTUAL_README document gives information about the many forms
+# of domain hosting that Postfix supports.
+
+# "USER HAS MOVED" BOUNCE MESSAGES
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# TRANSPORT MAP
+#
+# See the discussion in the ADDRESS_REWRITING_README document.
+
+# ALIAS DATABASE
+#
+# The alias_maps parameter specifies the list of alias databases used
+# by the local delivery agent. The default list is system dependent.
+#
+# On systems with NIS, the default is to search the local alias
+# database, then the NIS alias database. See aliases(5) for syntax
+# details.
+#
+# If you change the alias database, run "postalias /etc/aliases" (or
+# wherever your system stores the mail alias file), or simply run
+# "newaliases" to build the necessary DBM or DB file.
+#
+# It will take a minute or so before changes become visible. Use
+# "postfix reload" to eliminate the delay.
+#
+#alias_maps = dbm:/etc/aliases
+alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_maps = hash:/etc/aliases, nis:mail.aliases
+#alias_maps = netinfo:/aliases
+
+# The alias_database parameter specifies the alias database(s) that
+# are built with "newaliases" or "sendmail -bi". This is a separate
+# configuration parameter, because alias_maps (see above) may specify
+# tables that are not necessarily all under control by Postfix.
+#
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = dbm:/etc/mail/aliases
+alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases
+#alias_database = hash:/etc/aliases, hash:/opt/majordomo/aliases
+
+# ADDRESS EXTENSIONS (e.g., user+foo)
+#
+# The recipient_delimiter parameter specifies the separator between
+# user names and address extensions (user+foo). See canonical(5),
+# local(8), relocated(5) and virtual(5) for the effects this has on
+# aliases, canonical, virtual, relocated and .forward file lookups.
+# Basically, the software tries user+foo and .forward+foo before
+# trying user and .forward.
+#
+recipient_delimiter = +
+
+# DELIVERY TO MAILBOX
+#
+# The home_mailbox parameter specifies the optional pathname of a
+# mailbox file relative to a user's home directory. The default
+# mailbox file is /var/spool/mail/user or /var/mail/user. Specify
+# "Maildir/" for qmail-style delivery (the / is required).
+#
+#home_mailbox = Mailbox
+#home_mailbox = Maildir/
+
+# The mail_spool_directory parameter specifies the directory where
+# UNIX-style mailboxes are kept. The default setting depends on the
+# system type.
+#
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/mail
+#mail_spool_directory = /var/spool/mail
+
+# The mailbox_command parameter specifies the optional external
+# command to use instead of mailbox delivery. The command is run as
+# the recipient with proper HOME, SHELL and LOGNAME environment settings.
+# Exception: delivery for root is done as $default_user.
+#
+# Other environment variables of interest: USER (recipient username),
+# EXTENSION (address extension), DOMAIN (domain part of address),
+# and LOCAL (the address localpart).
+#
+# Unlike other Postfix configuration parameters, the mailbox_command
+# parameter is not subjected to $parameter substitutions. This is to
+# make it easier to specify shell syntax (see example below).
+#
+# Avoid shell meta characters because they will force Postfix to run
+# an expensive shell process. Procmail alone is expensive enough.
+#
+# IF YOU USE THIS TO DELIVER MAIL SYSTEM-WIDE, YOU MUST SET UP AN
+# ALIAS THAT FORWARDS MAIL FOR ROOT TO A REAL USER.
+#
+#mailbox_command = /usr/bin/procmail
+#mailbox_command = /some/where/procmail -a "$EXTENSION"
+
+# The mailbox_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use after processing aliases and .forward files. This parameter
+# has precedence over the mailbox_command, fallback_transport and
+# luser_relay parameters.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+
+# If using the cyrus-imapd IMAP server deliver local mail to the IMAP
+# server using LMTP (Local Mail Transport Protocol), this is prefered
+# over the older cyrus deliver program by setting the
+# mailbox_transport as below:
+#
+# mailbox_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#
+# The efficiency of LMTP delivery for cyrus-imapd can be enhanced via
+# these settings.
+#
+# local_destination_recipient_limit = 300
+# local_destination_concurrency_limit = 5
+#
+# Of course you should adjust these settings as appropriate for the
+# capacity of the hardware you are using. The recipient limit setting
+# can be used to take advantage of the single instance message store
+# capability of Cyrus. The concurrency limit can be used to control
+# how many simultaneous LMTP sessions will be permitted to the Cyrus
+# message store.
+#
+# To use the old cyrus deliver program you have to set:
+#mailbox_transport = cyrus
+
+# The fallback_transport specifies the optional transport in master.cf
+# to use for recipients that are not found in the UNIX passwd database.
+# This parameter has precedence over the luser_relay parameter.
+#
+# Specify a string of the form transport:nexthop, where transport is
+# the name of a mail delivery transport defined in master.cf. The
+# :nexthop part is optional. For more details see the sample transport
+# configuration file.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must update the "local_recipient_maps" setting in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#fallback_transport = lmtp:unix:/var/lib/imap/socket/lmtp
+#fallback_transport =
+
+#transport_maps = hash:/etc/postfix/transport
+# The luser_relay parameter specifies an optional destination address
+# for unknown recipients. By default, mail for unknown@$mydestination,
+# unknown@[$inet_interfaces] or unknown@[$proxy_interfaces] is returned
+# as undeliverable.
+#
+# The following expansions are done on luser_relay: $user (recipient
+# username), $shell (recipient shell), $home (recipient home directory),
+# $recipient (full recipient address), $extension (recipient address
+# extension), $domain (recipient domain), $local (entire recipient
+# localpart), $recipient_delimiter. Specify ${name?value} or
+# ${name:value} to expand value only when $name does (does not) exist.
+#
+# luser_relay works only for the default Postfix local delivery agent.
+#
+# NOTE: if you use this feature for accounts not in the UNIX password
+# file, then you must specify "local_recipient_maps =" (i.e. empty) in
+# the main.cf file, otherwise the SMTP server will reject mail for
+# non-UNIX accounts with "User unknown in local recipient table".
+#
+#luser_relay = $user@other.host
+#luser_relay = $local@other.host
+#luser_relay = admin+$local
+
+# JUNK MAIL CONTROLS
+#
+# The controls listed here are only a very small subset. The file
+# SMTPD_ACCESS_README provides an overview.
+
+# The header_checks parameter specifies an optional table with patterns
+# that each logical message header is matched against, including
+# headers that span multiple physical lines.
+#
+# By default, these patterns also apply to MIME headers and to the
+# headers of attached messages. With older Postfix versions, MIME and
+# attached message headers were treated as body text.
+#
+# For details, see "man header_checks".
+#
+header_checks = regexp:/etc/postfix/header_checks
+
+# FAST ETRN SERVICE
+#
+# Postfix maintains per-destination logfiles with information about
+# deferred mail, so that mail can be flushed quickly with the SMTP
+# "ETRN domain.tld" command, or by executing "sendmail -qRdomain.tld".
+# See the ETRN_README document for a detailed description.
+#
+# The fast_flush_domains parameter controls what destinations are
+# eligible for this service. By default, they are all domains that
+# this server is willing to relay mail to.
+#
+#fast_flush_domains = $relay_domains
+
+# SHOW SOFTWARE VERSION OR NOT
+#
+# The smtpd_banner parameter specifies the text that follows the 220
+# code in the SMTP server's greeting banner. Some people like to see
+# the mail version advertised. By default, Postfix shows no version.
+#
+# You MUST specify $myhostname at the start of the text. That is an
+# RFC requirement. Postfix itself does not care.
+#
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name
+#smtpd_banner = $myhostname ESMTP $mail_name ($mail_version)
+
+# PARALLEL DELIVERY TO THE SAME DESTINATION
+#
+# How many parallel deliveries to the same user or domain? With local
+# delivery, it does not make sense to do massively parallel delivery
+# to the same user, because mailbox updates must happen sequentially,
+# and expensive pipelines in .forward files can cause disasters when
+# too many are run at the same time. With SMTP deliveries, 10
+# simultaneous connections to the same domain could be sufficient to
+# raise eyebrows.
+#
+# Each message delivery transport has its XXX_destination_concurrency_limit
+# parameter. The default is $default_destination_concurrency_limit for
+# most delivery transports. For the local delivery agent the default is 2.
+
+#local_destination_concurrency_limit = 2
+#default_destination_concurrency_limit = 20
+
+# DEBUGGING CONTROL
+#
+# The debug_peer_level parameter specifies the increment in verbose
+# logging level when an SMTP client or server host name or address
+# matches a pattern in the debug_peer_list parameter.
+#
+debug_peer_level = 2
+
+# The debug_peer_list parameter specifies an optional list of domain
+# or network patterns, /file/name patterns or type:name tables. When
+# an SMTP client or server host name or address matches a pattern,
+# increase the verbose logging level by the amount specified in the
+# debug_peer_level parameter.
+#
+#debug_peer_list = 127.0.0.1
+#debug_peer_list = some.domain
+
+# The debugger_command specifies the external command that is executed
+# when a Postfix daemon program is run with the -D option.
+#
+# Use "command .. & sleep 5" so that the debugger can attach before
+# the process marches on. If you use an X-based debugger, be sure to
+# set up your XAUTHORITY environment variable before starting Postfix.
+#
+debugger_command =
+ PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin:/usr/X11R6/bin
+ xxgdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id & sleep 5
+
+# If you can't use X, use this to capture the call stack when a
+# daemon crashes. The result is in a file in the configuration
+# directory, and is named after the process name and the process ID.
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local/bin; export PATH; (echo cont;
+# echo where) | gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name $process_id 2>&1
+# >$config_directory/$process_name.$process_id.log & sleep 5
+#
+# Another possibility is to run gdb under a detached screen session.
+# To attach to the screen sesssion, su root and run "screen -r
+# <id_string>" where <id_string> uniquely matches one of the detached
+# sessions (from "screen -list").
+#
+# debugger_command =
+# PATH=/bin:/usr/bin:/sbin:/usr/sbin; export PATH; screen
+# -dmS $process_name gdb $daemon_directory/$process_name
+# $process_id & sleep 1
+
+# INSTALL-TIME CONFIGURATION INFORMATION
+#
+# The following parameters are used when installing a new Postfix version.
+#
+# sendmail_path: The full pathname of the Postfix sendmail command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible mail posting interface.
+#
+sendmail_path = /usr/sbin/sendmail.postfix
+
+# newaliases_path: The full pathname of the Postfix newaliases command.
+# This is the Sendmail-compatible command to build alias databases.
+#
+newaliases_path = /usr/bin/newaliases.postfix
+
+# mailq_path: The full pathname of the Postfix mailq command. This
+# is the Sendmail-compatible mail queue listing command.
+#
+mailq_path = /usr/bin/mailq.postfix
+
+# setgid_group: The group for mail submission and queue management
+# commands. This must be a group name with a numerical group ID that
+# is not shared with other accounts, not even with the Postfix account.
+#
+setgid_group = postdrop
+
+# html_directory: The location of the Postfix HTML documentation.
+#
+html_directory = no
+
+# manpage_directory: The location of the Postfix on-line manual pages.
+#
+manpage_directory = /usr/share/man
+
+# sample_directory: The location of the Postfix sample configuration files.
+# This parameter is obsolete as of Postfix 2.1.
+#
+sample_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/samples
+
+# readme_directory: The location of the Postfix README files.
+#
+readme_directory = /usr/share/doc/postfix-2.4.5/README_FILES
+
+# add this to new postfix to get it to add proper message-id and other
+# headers to outgoing emails via the gateway.
+
+
+message_size_limit = 20971520
+#inet_protocols = ipv4
+
+non_smtpd_milters = unix:/var/run/pagure/paguresock
+smtpd_milters = unix:/var/run/pagure/paguresock
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/master.cf/master.cf b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/master.cf/master.cf
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..d6aec2507
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/master.cf/master.cf
@@ -0,0 +1,96 @@
+#
+# Postfix master process configuration file. For details on the format
+# of the file, see the master(5) manual page (command: "man 5 master").
+#
+# ==========================================================================
+# service type private unpriv chroot wakeup maxproc command + args
+# (yes) (yes) (yes) (never) (100)
+# ==========================================================================
+smtp inet n - n - - smtpd
+#submission inet n - n - - smtpd
+# -o smtpd_enforce_tls=yes
+# -o smtpd_sasl_auth_enable=yes
+# -o smtpd_client_restrictions=permit_sasl_authenticated,reject
+#628 inet n - n - - qmqpd
+pickup fifo n - n 60 1 pickup
+cleanup unix n - n - 0 cleanup
+qmgr fifo n - n 300 1 qmgr
+#qmgr fifo n - n 300 1 oqmgr
+tlsmgr unix - - n 1000? 1 tlsmgr
+rewrite unix - - n - - trivial-rewrite
+bounce unix - - n - 0 bounce
+defer unix - - n - 0 bounce
+trace unix - - n - 0 bounce
+verify unix - - n - 1 verify
+flush unix n - n 1000? 0 flush
+proxymap unix - - n - - proxymap
+smtp unix - - n - - smtp
+# When relaying mail as backup MX, disable fallback_relay to avoid MX loops
+relay unix - - n - - smtp
+ -o fallback_relay=
+# -o smtp_helo_timeout=5 -o smtp_connect_timeout=5
+showq unix n - n - - showq
+error unix - - n - - error
+retry unix - - n - - error
+discard unix - - n - - discard
+local unix - n n - - local
+virtual unix - n n - - virtual
+lmtp unix - - n - - lmtp
+anvil unix - - n - 1 anvil
+scache unix - - n - 1 scache
+#
+# ====================================================================
+# Interfaces to non-Postfix software. Be sure to examine the manual
+# pages of the non-Postfix software to find out what options it wants.
+#
+# Many of the following services use the Postfix pipe(8) delivery
+# agent. See the pipe(8) man page for information about ${recipient}
+# and other message envelope options.
+# ====================================================================
+#
+# maildrop. See the Postfix MAILDROP_README file for details.
+# Also specify in main.cf: maildrop_destination_recipient_limit=1
+#
+#maildrop unix - n n - - pipe
+# flags=DRhu user=vmail argv=/usr/local/bin/maildrop -d ${recipient}
+#
+# ====================================================================
+#
+# The Cyrus deliver program has changed incompatibly, multiple times.
+#
+#old-cyrus unix - n n - - pipe
+# flags=R user=cyrus argv=/usr/lib/cyrus-imapd/deliver -e -m ${extension} ${user}
+#
+# ====================================================================
+#
+# Cyrus 2.1.5 (Amos Gouaux)
+# Also specify in main.cf: cyrus_destination_recipient_limit=1
+#
+#cyrus unix - n n - - pipe
+# user=cyrus argv=/usr/lib/cyrus-imapd/deliver -e -r ${sender} -m ${extension} ${user}
+#
+# ====================================================================
+#
+# See the Postfix UUCP_README file for configuration details.
+#
+#uucp unix - n n - - pipe
+# flags=Fqhu user=uucp argv=uux -r -n -z -a$sender - $nexthop!rmail ($recipient)
+#
+# ====================================================================
+#
+# Other external delivery methods.
+#
+#ifmail unix - n n - - pipe
+# flags=F user=ftn argv=/usr/lib/ifmail/ifmail -r $nexthop ($recipient)
+#
+#bsmtp unix - n n - - pipe
+# flags=Fq. user=bsmtp argv=/usr/local/sbin/bsmtp -f $sender $nexthop $recipient
+#
+#scalemail-backend unix - n n - 2 pipe
+# flags=R user=scalemail argv=/usr/lib/scalemail/bin/scalemail-store
+# ${nexthop} ${user} ${extension}
+#
+#mailman unix - n n - - pipe
+# flags=FR user=list argv=/usr/lib/mailman/bin/postfix-to-mailman.py
+# ${nexthop} ${user}
+
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/master.cf/master.cf.gateway b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/master.cf/master.cf.gateway
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..32d395cbb
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/master.cf/master.cf.gateway
@@ -0,0 +1,96 @@
+#
+# Postfix master process configuration file. For details on the format
+# of the file, see the master(5) manual page (command: "man 5 master").
+#
+# ==========================================================================
+# service type private unpriv chroot wakeup maxproc command + args
+# (yes) (yes) (yes) (never) (100)
+# ==========================================================================
+smtp inet n - n - - smtpd
+#submission inet n - n - - smtpd
+# -o smtpd_enforce_tls=yes
+# -o smtpd_sasl_auth_enable=yes
+# -o smtpd_client_restrictions=permit_sasl_authenticated,reject
+#628 inet n - n - - qmqpd
+pickup fifo n - n 60 1 pickup
+cleanup unix n - n - 0 cleanup
+qmgr fifo n - n 300 1 qmgr
+#qmgr fifo n - n 300 1 oqmgr
+tlsmgr unix - - n 1000? 1 tlsmgr
+rewrite unix - - n - - trivial-rewrite
+bounce unix - - n - 0 bounce
+defer unix - - n - 0 bounce
+trace unix - - n - 0 bounce
+verify unix - - n - 1 verify
+flush unix n - n 1000? 0 flush
+proxymap unix - - n - - proxymap
+smtp unix - - n - 300 smtp
+# When relaying mail as backup MX, disable fallback_relay to avoid MX loops
+relay unix - - n - 300 smtp
+ -o fallback_relay=
+# -o smtp_helo_timeout=5 -o smtp_connect_timeout=5
+showq unix n - n - - showq
+error unix - - n - - error
+retry unix - - n - - error
+discard unix - - n - - discard
+local unix - n n - - local
+virtual unix - n n - - virtual
+lmtp unix - - n - - lmtp
+anvil unix - - n - 1 anvil
+scache unix - - n - 1 scache
+#
+# ====================================================================
+# Interfaces to non-Postfix software. Be sure to examine the manual
+# pages of the non-Postfix software to find out what options it wants.
+#
+# Many of the following services use the Postfix pipe(8) delivery
+# agent. See the pipe(8) man page for information about ${recipient}
+# and other message envelope options.
+# ====================================================================
+#
+# maildrop. See the Postfix MAILDROP_README file for details.
+# Also specify in main.cf: maildrop_destination_recipient_limit=1
+#
+#maildrop unix - n n - - pipe
+# flags=DRhu user=vmail argv=/usr/local/bin/maildrop -d ${recipient}
+#
+# ====================================================================
+#
+# The Cyrus deliver program has changed incompatibly, multiple times.
+#
+#old-cyrus unix - n n - - pipe
+# flags=R user=cyrus argv=/usr/lib/cyrus-imapd/deliver -e -m ${extension} ${user}
+#
+# ====================================================================
+#
+# Cyrus 2.1.5 (Amos Gouaux)
+# Also specify in main.cf: cyrus_destination_recipient_limit=1
+#
+#cyrus unix - n n - - pipe
+# user=cyrus argv=/usr/lib/cyrus-imapd/deliver -e -r ${sender} -m ${extension} ${user}
+#
+# ====================================================================
+#
+# See the Postfix UUCP_README file for configuration details.
+#
+#uucp unix - n n - - pipe
+# flags=Fqhu user=uucp argv=uux -r -n -z -a$sender - $nexthop!rmail ($recipient)
+#
+# ====================================================================
+#
+# Other external delivery methods.
+#
+#ifmail unix - n n - - pipe
+# flags=F user=ftn argv=/usr/lib/ifmail/ifmail -r $nexthop ($recipient)
+#
+#bsmtp unix - n n - - pipe
+# flags=Fq. user=bsmtp argv=/usr/local/sbin/bsmtp -f $sender $nexthop $recipient
+#
+#scalemail-backend unix - n n - 2 pipe
+# flags=R user=scalemail argv=/usr/lib/scalemail/bin/scalemail-store
+# ${nexthop} ${user} ${extension}
+#
+#mailman unix - n n - - pipe
+# flags=FR user=list argv=/usr/lib/mailman/bin/postfix-to-mailman.py
+# ${nexthop} ${user}
+
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/master.cf/master.cf.hosted-lists01 b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/master.cf/master.cf.hosted-lists01
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..e505fb55b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/master.cf/master.cf.hosted-lists01
@@ -0,0 +1,97 @@
+#
+# Postfix master process configuration file. For details on the format
+# of the file, see the master(5) manual page (command: "man 5 master").
+#
+# ==========================================================================
+# service type private unpriv chroot wakeup maxproc command + args
+# (yes) (yes) (yes) (never) (100)
+# ==========================================================================
+smtp inet n - n - - smtpd -o content_filter=spamassassin
+#submission inet n - n - - smtpd
+# -o smtpd_enforce_tls=yes
+# -o smtpd_sasl_auth_enable=yes
+# -o smtpd_client_restrictions=permit_sasl_authenticated,reject
+#628 inet n - n - - qmqpd
+pickup fifo n - n 60 1 pickup
+cleanup unix n - n - 0 cleanup
+qmgr fifo n - n 300 1 qmgr
+#qmgr fifo n - n 300 1 oqmgr
+tlsmgr unix - - n 1000? 1 tlsmgr
+rewrite unix - - n - - trivial-rewrite
+bounce unix - - n - 0 bounce
+defer unix - - n - 0 bounce
+trace unix - - n - 0 bounce
+verify unix - - n - 1 verify
+flush unix n - n 1000? 0 flush
+proxymap unix - - n - - proxymap
+smtp unix - - n - - smtp
+# When relaying mail as backup MX, disable fallback_relay to avoid MX loops
+relay unix - - n - - smtp
+ -o fallback_relay=
+# -o smtp_helo_timeout=5 -o smtp_connect_timeout=5
+showq unix n - n - - showq
+error unix - - n - - error
+retry unix - - n - - error
+discard unix - - n - - discard
+local unix - n n - - local
+virtual unix - n n - - virtual
+lmtp unix - - n - - lmtp
+anvil unix - - n - 1 anvil
+scache unix - - n - 1 scache
+#
+# ====================================================================
+# Interfaces to non-Postfix software. Be sure to examine the manual
+# pages of the non-Postfix software to find out what options it wants.
+#
+# Many of the following services use the Postfix pipe(8) delivery
+# agent. See the pipe(8) man page for information about ${recipient}
+# and other message envelope options.
+# ====================================================================
+#
+# maildrop. See the Postfix MAILDROP_README file for details.
+# Also specify in main.cf: maildrop_destination_recipient_limit=1
+#
+#maildrop unix - n n - - pipe
+# flags=DRhu user=vmail argv=/usr/local/bin/maildrop -d ${recipient}
+#
+# ====================================================================
+#
+# The Cyrus deliver program has changed incompatibly, multiple times.
+#
+#old-cyrus unix - n n - - pipe
+# flags=R user=cyrus argv=/usr/lib/cyrus-imapd/deliver -e -m ${extension} ${user}
+#
+# ====================================================================
+#
+# Cyrus 2.1.5 (Amos Gouaux)
+# Also specify in main.cf: cyrus_destination_recipient_limit=1
+#
+#cyrus unix - n n - - pipe
+# user=cyrus argv=/usr/lib/cyrus-imapd/deliver -e -r ${sender} -m ${extension} ${user}
+#
+# ====================================================================
+#
+# See the Postfix UUCP_README file for configuration details.
+#
+#uucp unix - n n - - pipe
+# flags=Fqhu user=uucp argv=uux -r -n -z -a$sender - $nexthop!rmail ($recipient)
+#
+# ====================================================================
+#
+# Other external delivery methods.
+#
+#ifmail unix - n n - - pipe
+# flags=F user=ftn argv=/usr/lib/ifmail/ifmail -r $nexthop ($recipient)
+#
+#bsmtp unix - n n - - pipe
+# flags=Fq. user=bsmtp argv=/usr/local/sbin/bsmtp -f $sender $nexthop $recipient
+#
+#scalemail-backend unix - n n - 2 pipe
+# flags=R user=scalemail argv=/usr/lib/scalemail/bin/scalemail-store
+# ${nexthop} ${user} ${extension}
+#
+#mailman unix - n n - - pipe
+# flags=FR user=list argv=/usr/lib/mailman/bin/postfix-to-mailman.py
+# ${nexthop} ${user}
+
+spamassassin unix - n n - - pipe user=spammy argv=/usr/bin/spamc -e /usr/sbin/sendmail.postfix -oi -f ${sender} ${recipient}
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/master.cf/master.cf.mailman b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/master.cf/master.cf.mailman
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..3d5a2ddb1
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/master.cf/master.cf.mailman
@@ -0,0 +1,102 @@
+#
+# Postfix master process configuration file. For details on the format
+# of the file, see the master(5) manual page (command: "man 5 master").
+#
+# ==========================================================================
+# service type private unpriv chroot wakeup maxproc command + args
+# (yes) (yes) (yes) (never) (100)
+# ==========================================================================
+
+# Mail received from outside: spam checking is enabled.
+smtp inet n - n - - smtpd -o content_filter=spamassassin
+# Mail received from Mailman: only localhost on the submission port, no spam checking.
+localhost:submission inet n - n - - smtpd
+
+#submission inet n - n - - smtpd
+# -o smtpd_enforce_tls=yes
+# -o smtpd_sasl_auth_enable=yes
+# -o smtpd_client_restrictions=permit_sasl_authenticated,reject
+#628 inet n - n - - qmqpd
+pickup fifo n - n 60 1 pickup
+cleanup unix n - n - 0 cleanup
+qmgr fifo n - n 300 1 qmgr
+#qmgr fifo n - n 300 1 oqmgr
+tlsmgr unix - - n 1000? 1 tlsmgr
+rewrite unix - - n - - trivial-rewrite
+bounce unix - - n - 0 bounce
+defer unix - - n - 0 bounce
+trace unix - - n - 0 bounce
+verify unix - - n - 1 verify
+flush unix n - n 1000? 0 flush
+proxymap unix - - n - - proxymap
+smtp unix - - n - - smtp
+# When relaying mail as backup MX, disable fallback_relay to avoid MX loops
+relay unix - - n - - smtp
+ -o fallback_relay=
+# -o smtp_helo_timeout=5 -o smtp_connect_timeout=5
+showq unix n - n - - showq
+error unix - - n - - error
+retry unix - - n - - error
+discard unix - - n - - discard
+local unix - n n - - local
+virtual unix - n n - - virtual
+lmtp unix - - n - - lmtp
+anvil unix - - n - 1 anvil
+scache unix - - n - 1 scache
+#
+# ====================================================================
+# Interfaces to non-Postfix software. Be sure to examine the manual
+# pages of the non-Postfix software to find out what options it wants.
+#
+# Many of the following services use the Postfix pipe(8) delivery
+# agent. See the pipe(8) man page for information about ${recipient}
+# and other message envelope options.
+# ====================================================================
+#
+# maildrop. See the Postfix MAILDROP_README file for details.
+# Also specify in main.cf: maildrop_destination_recipient_limit=1
+#
+#maildrop unix - n n - - pipe
+# flags=DRhu user=vmail argv=/usr/local/bin/maildrop -d ${recipient}
+#
+# ====================================================================
+#
+# The Cyrus deliver program has changed incompatibly, multiple times.
+#
+#old-cyrus unix - n n - - pipe
+# flags=R user=cyrus argv=/usr/lib/cyrus-imapd/deliver -e -m ${extension} ${user}
+#
+# ====================================================================
+#
+# Cyrus 2.1.5 (Amos Gouaux)
+# Also specify in main.cf: cyrus_destination_recipient_limit=1
+#
+#cyrus unix - n n - - pipe
+# user=cyrus argv=/usr/lib/cyrus-imapd/deliver -e -r ${sender} -m ${extension} ${user}
+#
+# ====================================================================
+#
+# See the Postfix UUCP_README file for configuration details.
+#
+#uucp unix - n n - - pipe
+# flags=Fqhu user=uucp argv=uux -r -n -z -a$sender - $nexthop!rmail ($recipient)
+#
+# ====================================================================
+#
+# Other external delivery methods.
+#
+#ifmail unix - n n - - pipe
+# flags=F user=ftn argv=/usr/lib/ifmail/ifmail -r $nexthop ($recipient)
+#
+#bsmtp unix - n n - - pipe
+# flags=Fq. user=bsmtp argv=/usr/local/sbin/bsmtp -f $sender $nexthop $recipient
+#
+#scalemail-backend unix - n n - 2 pipe
+# flags=R user=scalemail argv=/usr/lib/scalemail/bin/scalemail-store
+# ${nexthop} ${user} ${extension}
+#
+#mailman unix - n n - - pipe
+# flags=FR user=list argv=/usr/lib/mailman/bin/postfix-to-mailman.py
+# ${nexthop} ${user}
+
+spamassassin unix - n n - - pipe user=spammy argv=/usr/bin/spamc -e /usr/sbin/sendmail.postfix -oi -f ${sender} ${recipient}
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/master.cf/master.cf.noc02.fedoraproject.org b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/master.cf/master.cf.noc02.fedoraproject.org
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..8131e7dc7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/master.cf/master.cf.noc02.fedoraproject.org
@@ -0,0 +1,97 @@
+#
+# Postfix master process configuration file. For details on the format
+# of the file, see the master(5) manual page (command: "man 5 master").
+#
+# ==========================================================================
+# service type private unpriv chroot wakeup maxproc command + args
+# (yes) (yes) (yes) (never) (100)
+# ==========================================================================
+smtp inet n - n - - smtpd
+#submission inet n - n - - smtpd
+# -o smtpd_enforce_tls=yes
+# -o smtpd_sasl_auth_enable=yes
+# -o smtpd_client_restrictions=permit_sasl_authenticated,reject
+#628 inet n - n - - qmqpd
+pickup fifo n - n 60 1 pickup
+cleanup unix n - n - 0 cleanup
+qmgr fifo n - n 300 1 qmgr
+#qmgr fifo n - n 300 1 oqmgr
+tlsmgr unix - - n 1000? 1 tlsmgr
+rewrite unix - - n - - trivial-rewrite
+bounce unix - - n - 0 bounce
+defer unix - - n - 0 bounce
+trace unix - - n - 0 bounce
+verify unix - - n - 1 verify
+flush unix n - n 1000? 0 flush
+proxymap unix - - n - - proxymap
+smtp unix - - n - - smtp
+smtp-ipv4 unix - - n - - smtp -o inet_protocols=ipv4
+# When relaying mail as backup MX, disable fallback_relay to avoid MX loops
+relay unix - - n - - smtp
+ -o fallback_relay=
+# -o smtp_helo_timeout=5 -o smtp_connect_timeout=5
+showq unix n - n - - showq
+error unix - - n - - error
+retry unix - - n - - error
+discard unix - - n - - discard
+local unix - n n - - local
+virtual unix - n n - - virtual
+lmtp unix - - n - - lmtp
+anvil unix - - n - 1 anvil
+scache unix - - n - 1 scache
+#
+# ====================================================================
+# Interfaces to non-Postfix software. Be sure to examine the manual
+# pages of the non-Postfix software to find out what options it wants.
+#
+# Many of the following services use the Postfix pipe(8) delivery
+# agent. See the pipe(8) man page for information about ${recipient}
+# and other message envelope options.
+# ====================================================================
+#
+# maildrop. See the Postfix MAILDROP_README file for details.
+# Also specify in main.cf: maildrop_destination_recipient_limit=1
+#
+#maildrop unix - n n - - pipe
+# flags=DRhu user=vmail argv=/usr/local/bin/maildrop -d ${recipient}
+#
+# ====================================================================
+#
+# The Cyrus deliver program has changed incompatibly, multiple times.
+#
+#old-cyrus unix - n n - - pipe
+# flags=R user=cyrus argv=/usr/lib/cyrus-imapd/deliver -e -m ${extension} ${user}
+#
+# ====================================================================
+#
+# Cyrus 2.1.5 (Amos Gouaux)
+# Also specify in main.cf: cyrus_destination_recipient_limit=1
+#
+#cyrus unix - n n - - pipe
+# user=cyrus argv=/usr/lib/cyrus-imapd/deliver -e -r ${sender} -m ${extension} ${user}
+#
+# ====================================================================
+#
+# See the Postfix UUCP_README file for configuration details.
+#
+#uucp unix - n n - - pipe
+# flags=Fqhu user=uucp argv=uux -r -n -z -a$sender - $nexthop!rmail ($recipient)
+#
+# ====================================================================
+#
+# Other external delivery methods.
+#
+#ifmail unix - n n - - pipe
+# flags=F user=ftn argv=/usr/lib/ifmail/ifmail -r $nexthop ($recipient)
+#
+#bsmtp unix - n n - - pipe
+# flags=Fq. user=bsmtp argv=/usr/local/sbin/bsmtp -f $sender $nexthop $recipient
+#
+#scalemail-backend unix - n n - 2 pipe
+# flags=R user=scalemail argv=/usr/lib/scalemail/bin/scalemail-store
+# ${nexthop} ${user} ${extension}
+#
+#mailman unix - n n - - pipe
+# flags=FR user=list argv=/usr/lib/mailman/bin/postfix-to-mailman.py
+# ${nexthop} ${user}
+
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/tls_policy b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/tls_policy
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..e69de29bb
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/tls_policy
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/transports.gateway b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/transports.gateway
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..8d28ff188
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/transports.gateway
@@ -0,0 +1,33 @@
+# TRANSPORT(5) TRANSPORT(5)
+#
+# NAME
+# transport - Postfix transport table format
+#
+# SYNOPSIS
+# postmap /etc/postfix/transport
+#
+# postmap -q "string" /etc/postfix/transport
+#
+# postmap -q - /etc/postfix/transport <inputfile
+#
+#
+# EXAMPLES
+# In order to deliver internal mail directly, while using a
+# mail relay for all other mail, specify a null entry for
+# internal destinations (do not change the delivery trans-
+# port or the nexthop information) and specify a wildcard
+# for all other destinations.
+#
+# my.domain :
+# .my.domain :
+# * smtp:outbound-relay.my.domain
+# example.com :[gateway.example.com]
+# .example.com :[gateway.example.com]
+# In the above example, the [] suppress MX lookups. This
+# prevents mail routing loops when your machine is primary
+# MX host for example.com.
+
+fedora.redhat.com :
+redhat.com smtp:[ext-mx.corp.redhat.com]
+.redhat.com smtp:[ext-mx.corp.redhat.com]
+ceylon-lang.org smtp:[ext-mx.corp.redhat.com]
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/transports.mm-smtp b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/transports.mm-smtp
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..582d45567
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/transports.mm-smtp
@@ -0,0 +1,5 @@
+lists.fedoraproject.org smtp:[mailman01.vpn.fedoraproject.org]
+lists.fedorahosted.org smtp:[mailman01.vpn.fedoraproject.org]
+redhat.com smtp:[mailman01.vpn.fedoraproject.org]
+lists2.fedoraproject.org smtp:[mailman01.vpn.fedoraproject.org]
+fedorahosted.org smtp:[bastion.vpn.fedoraproject.org]
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/postfix/transports.noc02.fedoraproject.org b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/transports.noc02.fedoraproject.org
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..54dd656ce
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/postfix/transports.noc02.fedoraproject.org
@@ -0,0 +1,30 @@
+# TRANSPORT(5) TRANSPORT(5)
+#
+# NAME
+# transport - Postfix transport table format
+#
+# SYNOPSIS
+# postmap /etc/postfix/transport
+#
+# postmap -q "string" /etc/postfix/transport
+#
+# postmap -q - /etc/postfix/transport <inputfile
+#
+#
+# EXAMPLES
+# In order to deliver internal mail directly, while using a
+# mail relay for all other mail, specify a null entry for
+# internal destinations (do not change the delivery trans-
+# port or the nexthop information) and specify a wildcard
+# for all other destinations.
+#
+# my.domain :
+# .my.domain :
+# * smtp:outbound-relay.my.domain
+# example.com :[gateway.example.com]
+# .example.com :[gateway.example.com]
+# In the above example, the [] suppress MX lookups. This
+# prevents mail routing loops when your machine is primary
+# MX host for example.com.
+
+gmail.com smtp-ipv4:
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/cloud b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/cloud
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..4d417eea2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/cloud
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+search cloud.fedoraproject.org fedoraproject.org
+nameserver 66.35.62.163
+nameserver 140.211.169.201
+options rotate timeout:1
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/cloud-noc01.cloud.fedoraproject.org b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/cloud-noc01.cloud.fedoraproject.org
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..9661da5d3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/cloud-noc01.cloud.fedoraproject.org
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+search cloud.fedoraproject.org fedoraproject.org
+nameserver 8.8.8.8
+nameserver 8.8.4.4
+options rotate timeout:1
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/coloamer b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/coloamer
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..01d5c0695
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/coloamer
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+search vpn.fedoraproject.org fedoraproject.org
+nameserver 8.8.8.8
+nameserver 8.8.4.4
+options rotate timeout:1
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/dedicatedsolutions b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/dedicatedsolutions
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..01d5c0695
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/dedicatedsolutions
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+search vpn.fedoraproject.org fedoraproject.org
+nameserver 8.8.8.8
+nameserver 8.8.4.4
+options rotate timeout:1
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/fed-cloud09.cloud.fedoraproject.org b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/fed-cloud09.cloud.fedoraproject.org
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..4d417eea2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/fed-cloud09.cloud.fedoraproject.org
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+search cloud.fedoraproject.org fedoraproject.org
+nameserver 66.35.62.163
+nameserver 140.211.169.201
+options rotate timeout:1
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/fedorainfracloud b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/fedorainfracloud
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..377f82a5e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/fedorainfracloud
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+search fedorainfracloud.org cloud.fedoraproject.org fedoraproject.org
+nameserver 66.35.62.163
+nameserver 140.211.169.201
+options rotate timeout:1
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/host1plus b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/host1plus
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..6ed0304cb
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/host1plus
@@ -0,0 +1,5 @@
+search vpn.fedoraproject.org fedoraproject.org
+nameserver 217.69.160.18
+nameserver 8.8.8.8
+nameserver 8.8.4.4
+options rotate timeout:1
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/ibiblio b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/ibiblio
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..0037972e3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/ibiblio
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+search vpn.fedoraproject.org fedoraproject.org
+nameserver 152.2.21.1
+nameserver 152.2.253.100
+options rotate timeout:1
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/internetx b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/internetx
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..01d5c0695
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/internetx
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+search vpn.fedoraproject.org fedoraproject.org
+nameserver 8.8.8.8
+nameserver 8.8.4.4
+options rotate timeout:1
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/jenkins-master b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/jenkins-master
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..18bfb5387
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/jenkins-master
@@ -0,0 +1,3 @@
+nameserver 140.211.169.201
+nameserver 66.35.62.163
+options rotate timeout:1
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/jenkins-slave b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/jenkins-slave
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..18bfb5387
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/jenkins-slave
@@ -0,0 +1,3 @@
+nameserver 140.211.169.201
+nameserver 66.35.62.163
+options rotate timeout:1
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/kojibuilder b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/kojibuilder
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..426f4cd7f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/kojibuilder
@@ -0,0 +1,6 @@
+search phx2.fedoraproject.org vpn.fedoraproject.org fedoraproject.org
+nameserver 10.5.126.21
+nameserver 10.5.126.22
+options rotate timeout:1
+
+
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/osuosl b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/osuosl
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..01d5c0695
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/osuosl
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+search vpn.fedoraproject.org fedoraproject.org
+nameserver 8.8.8.8
+nameserver 8.8.4.4
+options rotate timeout:1
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/phx2 b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/phx2
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..426f4cd7f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/phx2
@@ -0,0 +1,6 @@
+search phx2.fedoraproject.org vpn.fedoraproject.org fedoraproject.org
+nameserver 10.5.126.21
+nameserver 10.5.126.22
+options rotate timeout:1
+
+
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/qa b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/qa
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..5bc8edf5d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/qa
@@ -0,0 +1,6 @@
+search qa.fedoraproject.org phx2.fedoraproject.org vpn.fedoraproject.org fedoraproject.org
+nameserver 10.5.126.21
+nameserver 10.5.126.22
+options rotate timeout:1
+
+
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/rdu b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/rdu
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..ae514ce5c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/rdu
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+search vpn.fedoraproject.org fedoraproject.org
+nameserver 8.8.4.4
+nameserver 8.8.8.8
+options rotate timeout:1
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/resolv.conf b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/resolv.conf
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..01d5c0695
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/resolv.conf
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+search vpn.fedoraproject.org fedoraproject.org
+nameserver 8.8.8.8
+nameserver 8.8.4.4
+options rotate timeout:1
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/serverbeach b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/serverbeach
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..01d5c0695
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/serverbeach
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+search vpn.fedoraproject.org fedoraproject.org
+nameserver 8.8.8.8
+nameserver 8.8.4.4
+options rotate timeout:1
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/staging b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/staging
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..47906d5f6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/staging
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+search stg.phx2.fedoraproject.org phx2.fedoraproject.org fedoraproject.org
+nameserver 10.5.126.21
+nameserver 10.5.126.22
+options rotate timeout:1
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/telia b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/telia
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..11dff40bd
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/telia
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+search vpn.fedoraproject.org fedoraproject.org
+nameserver 213.248.76.210
+nameserver 152.3.182.5
+options rotate timeout:1
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/tummy b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/tummy
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..246626e3f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/resolv.conf/tummy
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+search vpn.fedoraproject.org fedoraproject.org
+nameserver 198.49.126.1
+nameserver 66.35.36.133
+options rotate timeout:1
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/merged-rsyslog b/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/merged-rsyslog
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..f8b7c778a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/merged-rsyslog
@@ -0,0 +1,11 @@
+/var/log/merged/*.log {
+ missingok
+ rotate 1
+ nodateext
+ daily
+ create 0644 root root
+ copytruncate
+ compress
+ compresscmd /bin/gzip
+ uncompresscmd /bin/gzip
+}
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog-audit.conf b/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog-audit.conf
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..b13627bb4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog-audit.conf
@@ -0,0 +1,13 @@
+# monitor auditd log and send out over local6 to central loghost
+$ModLoad imfile.so
+
+# auditd audit.log
+$InputFileName /var/log/audit/audit.log
+$InputFileTag tag_audit_log:
+$InputFileStateFile audit_log
+$InputFileSeverity info
+$InputFileFacility local6
+$InputRunFileMonitor
+
+:msg, !contains, "type=AVC"
+local6.* @@log01:514
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog-disablerate.conf b/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog-disablerate.conf
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..e7c93530c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog-disablerate.conf
@@ -0,0 +1,3 @@
+# Disable rate limiting
+$IMUXSockRateLimitInterval 0
+$SystemLogRateLimitInterval 0
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog-limits.conf b/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog-limits.conf
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..c8d00bc04
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog-limits.conf
@@ -0,0 +1,2 @@
+[Service]
+LimitNOFILE=16384
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog-log01 b/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog-log01
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..370468a48
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog-log01
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+#
+# Send everything on to central log01 logger machines
+#
+cron.*;kern.*;authpriv.*;local7.*;*.info;local6.none;local4.* @@log01:514
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog-log01-nolocal4 b/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog-log01-nolocal4
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..246c6382e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog-log01-nolocal4
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+#
+# Send everything on to central log01 logger machines
+#
+cron.*;kern.*;authpriv.*;local7.*;local6.none @@log01:514
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog-log02 b/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog-log02
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..14343a72b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog-log02
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+#
+# Don't send anything to log02 anymore.
+#
+#cron.*;kern.*;authpriv.*;local7.*;*.info;local6.none;local4.* @@log02:514
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog-log02-nolocal4 b/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog-log02-nolocal4
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..3cca4dfbf
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog-log02-nolocal4
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+#
+# Don't send anything to log02 anymore
+#
+#cron.*;kern.*;authpriv.*;local7.*;*.info;local6.none @@log02:514
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog.conf.default b/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog.conf.default
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..7ed3e1d89
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog.conf.default
@@ -0,0 +1,89 @@
+# rsyslog v5 configuration file
+
+# For more information see /usr/share/doc/rsyslog-*/rsyslog_conf.html
+# If you experience problems, see http://www.rsyslog.com/doc/troubleshoot.html
+
+#### MODULES ####
+
+$ModLoad imuxsock # provides support for local system logging (e.g. via logger command)
+$ModLoad imjournal # provides access to the systemd journal
+#$ModLoad imklog # provides kernel logging support (previously done by rklogd)
+#$ModLoad immark # provides --MARK-- message capability
+
+# Provides UDP syslog reception
+#$ModLoad imudp
+#$UDPServerRun 514
+
+# Provides TCP syslog reception
+#$ModLoad imtcp
+#$InputTCPServerRun 514
+
+
+#### GLOBAL DIRECTIVES ####
+$WorkDirectory /var/lib/rsyslog
+
+# Use default timestamp format
+$ActionFileDefaultTemplate RSYSLOG_TraditionalFileFormat
+
+# File syncing capability is disabled by default. This feature is usually not required,
+# not useful and an extreme performance hit
+#$ActionFileEnableSync on
+
+# Include all config files in /etc/rsyslog.d/
+$IncludeConfig /etc/rsyslog.d/*.conf
+
+
+# Turn off message reception via local log socket;
+# local messages are retrieved through imjournal now.
+$OmitLocalLogging on
+
+# File to store the position in the journal
+$IMJournalStateFile imjournal.state
+
+#### RULES ####
+
+# Log all kernel messages to the console.
+# Logging much else clutters up the screen.
+#kern.* /dev/console
+
+# Log anything (except mail) of level info or higher.
+# Don't log private authentication messages!
+*.info;mail.none;authpriv.none;cron.none /var/log/messages
+
+# The authpriv file has restricted access.
+authpriv.* /var/log/secure
+
+# Log all the mail messages in one place.
+mail.* -/var/log/maillog
+
+
+# Log cron stuff
+cron.* /var/log/cron
+
+# Everybody gets emergency messages
+*.emerg :omusrmsg:*
+
+# Save news errors of level crit and higher in a special file.
+uucp,news.crit /var/log/spooler
+
+# Save boot messages also to boot.log
+local7.* /var/log/boot.log
+
+
+# ### begin forwarding rule ###
+# The statement between the begin ... end define a SINGLE forwarding
+# rule. They belong together, do NOT split them. If you create multiple
+# forwarding rules, duplicate the whole block!
+# Remote Logging (we use TCP for reliable delivery)
+#
+# An on-disk queue is created for this action. If the remote host is
+# down, messages are spooled to disk and sent when it is up again.
+#$WorkDirectory /var/lib/rsyslog # where to place spool files
+#$ActionQueueFileName fwdRule1 # unique name prefix for spool files
+#$ActionQueueMaxDiskSpace 1g # 1gb space limit (use as much as possible)
+#$ActionQueueSaveOnShutdown on # save messages to disk on shutdown
+#$ActionQueueType LinkedList # run asynchronously
+#$ActionResumeRetryCount -1 # infinite retries if host is down
+# remote host is: name/ip:port, e.g. 192.168.0.1:514, port optional
+#*.* @@remote-host:514
+# ### end of the forwarding rule ###
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog.conf.el6 b/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog.conf.el6
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..36cea98f0
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog.conf.el6
@@ -0,0 +1,80 @@
+# rsyslog v5 configuration file
+
+# For more information see /usr/share/doc/rsyslog-*/rsyslog_conf.html
+# If you experience problems, see http://www.rsyslog.com/doc/troubleshoot.html
+
+#### MODULES ####
+
+$ModLoad imuxsock # provides support for local system logging (e.g. via logger command)
+$ModLoad imklog # provides kernel logging support (previously done by rklogd)
+#$ModLoad immark # provides --MARK-- message capability
+
+# Provides UDP syslog reception
+#$ModLoad imudp
+#$UDPServerRun 514
+
+# Provides TCP syslog reception
+#$ModLoad imtcp
+#$InputTCPServerRun 514
+
+
+#### GLOBAL DIRECTIVES ####
+
+# Use default timestamp format
+$ActionFileDefaultTemplate RSYSLOG_TraditionalFileFormat
+
+# File syncing capability is disabled by default. This feature is usually not required,
+# not useful and an extreme performance hit
+#$ActionFileEnableSync on
+
+# Include all config files in /etc/rsyslog.d/
+$IncludeConfig /etc/rsyslog.d/*.conf
+
+
+#### RULES ####
+
+# Log all kernel messages to the console.
+# Logging much else clutters up the screen.
+#kern.* /dev/console
+
+# Log anything (except mail) of level info or higher.
+# Don't log private authentication messages!
+*.info;mail.none;authpriv.none;cron.none /var/log/messages
+
+# The authpriv file has restricted access.
+authpriv.* /var/log/secure
+
+# Log all the mail messages in one place.
+mail.* -/var/log/maillog
+
+
+# Log cron stuff
+cron.* /var/log/cron
+
+# Everybody gets emergency messages
+*.emerg *
+
+# Save news errors of level crit and higher in a special file.
+uucp,news.crit /var/log/spooler
+
+# Save boot messages also to boot.log
+local7.* /var/log/boot.log
+
+
+# ### begin forwarding rule ###
+# The statement between the begin ... end define a SINGLE forwarding
+# rule. They belong together, do NOT split them. If you create multiple
+# forwarding rules, duplicate the whole block!
+# Remote Logging (we use TCP for reliable delivery)
+#
+# An on-disk queue is created for this action. If the remote host is
+# down, messages are spooled to disk and sent when it is up again.
+#$WorkDirectory /var/lib/rsyslog # where to place spool files
+#$ActionQueueFileName fwdRule1 # unique name prefix for spool files
+#$ActionQueueMaxDiskSpace 1g # 1gb space limit (use as much as possible)
+#$ActionQueueSaveOnShutdown on # save messages to disk on shutdown
+#$ActionQueueType LinkedList # run asynchronously
+#$ActionResumeRetryCount -1 # infinite retries if host is down
+# remote host is: name/ip:port, e.g. 192.168.0.1:514, port optional
+#*.* @@remote-host:514
+# ### end of the forwarding rule ###
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog.conf.f20 b/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog.conf.f20
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..6972b4d36
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog.conf.f20
@@ -0,0 +1,91 @@
+# rsyslog v5 configuration file
+
+# For more information see /usr/share/doc/rsyslog-*/rsyslog_conf.html
+# If you experience problems, see http://www.rsyslog.com/doc/troubleshoot.html
+
+#### MODULES ####
+
+# The imjournal module bellow is now used as a message source instead of imuxsock.
+$ModLoad imuxsock # provides support for local system logging (e.g. via logger command)
+$ModLoad imjournal # provides access to the systemd journal
+$ModLoad imklog # provides kernel logging support (previously done by rklogd)
+#$ModLoad immark # provides --MARK-- message capability
+
+# Provides UDP syslog reception
+#$ModLoad imudp
+#$UDPServerRun 514
+
+# Provides TCP syslog reception
+#$ModLoad imtcp
+#$InputTCPServerRun 514
+
+
+#### GLOBAL DIRECTIVES ####
+
+# Where to place auxiliary files
+$WorkDirectory /var/lib/rsyslog
+
+# Use default timestamp format
+$ActionFileDefaultTemplate RSYSLOG_TraditionalFileFormat
+
+# File syncing capability is disabled by default. This feature is usually not required,
+# not useful and an extreme performance hit
+#$ActionFileEnableSync on
+
+# Include all config files in /etc/rsyslog.d/
+$IncludeConfig /etc/rsyslog.d/*.conf
+
+# Turn off message reception via local log socket;
+# local messages are retrieved through imjournal now.
+$OmitLocalLogging on
+
+# File to store the position in the journal
+$IMJournalStateFile imjournal.state
+
+
+#### RULES ####
+
+# Log all kernel messages to the console.
+# Logging much else clutters up the screen.
+#kern.* /dev/console
+
+# Log anything (except mail) of level info or higher.
+# Don't log private authentication messages!
+*.info;mail.none;authpriv.none;cron.none /var/log/messages
+
+# The authpriv file has restricted access.
+authpriv.* /var/log/secure
+
+# Log all the mail messages in one place.
+mail.* -/var/log/maillog
+
+
+# Log cron stuff
+cron.* /var/log/cron
+
+# Everybody gets emergency messages
+*.emerg :omusrmsg:*
+
+# Save news errors of level crit and higher in a special file.
+uucp,news.crit /var/log/spooler
+
+# Save boot messages also to boot.log
+local7.* /var/log/boot.log
+
+
+# ### begin forwarding rule ###
+# The statement between the begin ... end define a SINGLE forwarding
+# rule. They belong together, do NOT split them. If you create multiple
+# forwarding rules, duplicate the whole block!
+# Remote Logging (we use TCP for reliable delivery)
+#
+# An on-disk queue is created for this action. If the remote host is
+# down, messages are spooled to disk and sent when it is up again.
+#$ActionQueueFileName fwdRule1 # unique name prefix for spool files
+#$ActionQueueMaxDiskSpace 1g # 1gb space limit (use as much as possible)
+#$ActionQueueSaveOnShutdown on # save messages to disk on shutdown
+#$ActionQueueType LinkedList # run asynchronously
+#$ActionResumeRetryCount -1 # infinite retries if host is down
+# remote host is: name/ip:port, e.g. 192.168.0.1:514, port optional
+#*.* @@remote-host:514
+# ### end of the forwarding rule ###
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog.conf.log01.phx2.fedoraproject.org b/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog.conf.log01.phx2.fedoraproject.org
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..0da3754b7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/rsyslog/rsyslog.conf.log01.phx2.fedoraproject.org
@@ -0,0 +1,215 @@
+################################################################################
+# RSYSLOG.CONF - central logging server #
+################################################################################
+# N O T E #
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+# This rsyslog configuration is suitable for a central log host. This is not #
+# intended for a normal server. #
+# #
+# This config was built and tested for rsyslog version rsyslog-2.0.0. #
+################################################################################
+
+#%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%#
+# M O D U L E S #
+#%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%#
+$ModLoad immark.so # mark messages
+$MarkMessagePeriod 1200 # every 20 minutes
+$ModLoad imudp.so #udp sockets
+$ModLoad imtcp.so #tcp socks
+$ModLoad imuxsock # local syslog() listener
+#$ModLoad imklog # local klog logging
+$ModLoad imjournal # provides access to the systemd journal
+
+
+#%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%#
+# G L O B A L S E T T I N G S #
+#%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%#
+$umask 0000
+$CreateDirs on
+$DirCreateMode 0755
+$FileCreateMode 0644
+$FileOwner root
+$FileGroup root
+$RepeatedMsgReduction on
+$EscapeControlCharactersOnReceive off
+$UDPServerRun 514
+$InputTCPMaxSessions 2000
+$InputTCPServerRun 514
+$InputTCPServerRun 5000
+$IMUXSockRateLimitInterval 0
+$SystemLogRateLimitInterval 0
+$WorkDirectory /var/lib/rsyslog
+$IMJournalStateFile imjournal.state
+
+#%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%#
+# T E M P L A T E S #
+#%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%#
+
+$template CustomFormat,"%TIMESTAMP% %FROMHOST% %HOSTNAME% %syslogtag%%msg%\n"
+$template TraditionalFormat,"%timegenerated% %HOSTNAME% %syslogtag%%msg%\n"
+$template MergeFormat,"%timegenerated% %FROMHOST% %syslogtag%%msg%\n"
+$template RawMessage,"%msg:2:2048%\n"
+
+
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+# templates for merged remote logging #
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+$template m_messages, "/var/log/merged/messages.log"
+$template m_secure, "/var/log/merged/secure.log"
+$template m_mail, "/var/log/merged/mail.log"
+$template m_cron, "/var/log/merged/cron.log"
+$template m_spooler, "/var/log/merged/spooler.log"
+$template m_boot, "/var/log/merged/boot.log"
+$template m_kern, "/var/log/merged/kernel.log"
+$template m_audit, "/var/log/merged/audit.log"
+$template m_http_error, "/var/log/merged/http_error.log"
+$template m_http_apps, "/var/log/merged/apps.log"
+
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+# templates for remote logging #
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+$template r_messages, "/var/log/hosts/%FROMHOST%/%$YEAR%/%$MONTH%/%$DAY%/messages.log"
+$template r_secure, "/var/log/hosts/%FROMHOST%/%$YEAR%/%$MONTH%/%$DAY%/secure.log"
+$template r_mail, "/var/log/hosts/%FROMHOST%/%$YEAR%/%$MONTH%/%$DAY%/mail.log"
+$template r_cron, "/var/log/hosts/%FROMHOST%/%$YEAR%/%$MONTH%/%$DAY%/cron.log"
+$template r_spooler, "/var/log/hosts/%FROMHOST%/%$YEAR%/%$MONTH%/%$DAY%/spooler.log"
+$template r_boot, "/var/log/hosts/%FROMHOST%/%$YEAR%/%$MONTH%/%$DAY%/boot.log"
+$template r_kern, "/var/log/hosts/%FROMHOST%/%$YEAR%/%$MONTH%/%$DAY%/kernel.log"
+$template r_audit, "/var/log/hosts/%FROMHOST%/%$YEAR%/%$MONTH%/%$DAY%/audit.log"
+$template r_http_error, "/var/log/hosts/%FROMHOST%/%$YEAR%/%$MONTH%/%$DAY%/http_error.log"
+$template r_http_apps, "/var/log/hosts/%FROMHOST%/%$YEAR%/%$MONTH%/%$DAY%/apps.log"
+
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+# templates for http logging #
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+$template HttpAccessTemplate,"/var/log/hosts/%FROMHOST%/%$YEAR%/%$MONTH%/%$DAY%/http/%APP-NAME%"
+$template HttpErrorTemplate,"/var/log/hosts/%FROMHOST%/%$YEAR%/%$MONTH%/%$DAY%/http/%APP-NAME%"
+
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+# templates for local logging #
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+$template l_messages, "/var/log/messages"
+$template l_secure, "/var/log/secure"
+$template l_mail, "/var/log/maillog"
+$template l_cron, "/var/log/cron"
+$template l_spooler, "/var/log/spooler"
+$template l_boot, "/var/log/boot.log"
+$template l_idgaud, "/var/log/idgaudit.log"
+$template l_idgsys, "/var/log/idgsystem.log"
+
+#%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%#
+# R E M O T E L O G G I N G #
+#%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%#
+
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+# remote messages log #
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+*.info;mail.none;authpriv.none;cron.none;local6.none;local5.none;local4.none ?r_messages;TraditionalFormat
+
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+# remote auth/secure log #
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+authpriv.* -?r_secure;TraditionalFormat
+
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+# remote mail log #
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+mail.* -?r_mail;TraditionalFormat
+
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+# remote cron log #
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+cron.* ?r_cron;TraditionalFormat
+
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+# remote spool log #
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+uucp,news.crit ?r_spooler;TraditionalFormat
+
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+# remote audit log #
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+local6.* ?r_audit;TraditionalFormat
+
+
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+# remote http_error log #
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+local5.* ?r_http_error;TraditionalFormat
+
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+# remote http app log #
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+local4.* ?r_http_apps;TraditionalFormat
+
+
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+# remote boot log #
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+local7.* ?r_boot;TraditionalFormat
+
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+# remote kernel log #
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+kern.* ?r_kern;TraditionalFormat
+
+
+
+#%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%#
+# MERGED R E M O T E L O G G I N G #
+#%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%#
+
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+# remote messages log #
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+*.info;mail.none;authpriv.none;cron.none;local6.none;local5.none;local4.none ?m_messages;MergeFormat
+
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+# remote auth/secure log #
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+authpriv.* -?m_secure;MergeFormat
+
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+# remote mail log #
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+mail.* -?m_mail;MergeFormat
+
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+# remote cron log #
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+cron.* ?m_cron;MergeFormat
+
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+# remote spool log #
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+uucp,news.crit ?m_spooler;MergeFormat
+
+
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+# remote boot log #
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+local7.* ?m_boot;MergeFormat
+
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+# remote kernel log #
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+kern.* ?m_kern;MergeFormat
+
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+# remote http_error
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+local5.* ?m_http_error;MergeFormat
+
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+# remote http_apps
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+local4.* ?m_http_apps;MergeFormat
+
+
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+# remote audit log #
+#------------------------------------------------------------------------------#
+#this means: if log message does not contain 'type=AVC' then drop it
+# this is only for the merged logs from auditd
+:msg, !contains, "type=AVC" ~
+local6.* ?m_audit;MergeFormat
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/selinux/rsyslog-audit.pp b/roles/basessh/files/selinux/rsyslog-audit.pp
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..f1a417ff5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/selinux/rsyslog-audit.pp
Binary files differ
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/selinux/rsyslog-audit.te b/roles/basessh/files/selinux/rsyslog-audit.te
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..a8bf497c2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/selinux/rsyslog-audit.te
@@ -0,0 +1,12 @@
+module rsyslog-audit 1.0;
+
+require {
+ type auditd_log_t;
+ type syslogd_t;
+ class file { getattr ioctl open read };
+ class dir { getattr search };
+}
+
+#============= syslogd_t ==============
+allow syslogd_t auditd_log_t:dir { getattr search };
+allow syslogd_t auditd_log_t:file { getattr ioctl open read };
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/setprodps1.sh b/roles/basessh/files/setprodps1.sh
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..6bf55a6bf
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/setprodps1.sh
@@ -0,0 +1,3 @@
+# Set PS1 based on env
+#
+[[ $- =~ i ]] && PS1="[\u@\h \W]\[$(tput setaf 3)\][PROD]\[$(tput sgr0)\]\\$ \[\]"
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/setstgps1.sh b/roles/basessh/files/setstgps1.sh
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..92d02931d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/setstgps1.sh
@@ -0,0 +1,3 @@
+# Set PS1 based on env
+#
+[[ $- =~ i ]] && PS1="[\u@\h \W]\[$(tput setaf 6)\][STG]\[$(tput sgr0)\]\\$ \[\]"
diff --git a/roles/base/files/ssh/sshd_config.7 b/roles/basessh/files/ssh/sshd_config.7
index 0dd16fe48..0dd16fe48 100644
--- a/roles/base/files/ssh/sshd_config.7
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/ssh/sshd_config.7
diff --git a/roles/base/files/ssh/sshd_config.buildhw b/roles/basessh/files/ssh/sshd_config.buildhw
index 8a8e89ad7..8a8e89ad7 100644
--- a/roles/base/files/ssh/sshd_config.buildhw
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/ssh/sshd_config.buildhw
diff --git a/roles/base/files/ssh/sshd_config.default b/roles/basessh/files/ssh/sshd_config.default
index 5045bc7ee..5045bc7ee 100644
--- a/roles/base/files/ssh/sshd_config.default
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/ssh/sshd_config.default
diff --git a/roles/base/files/ssh/sshd_config.el6 b/roles/basessh/files/ssh/sshd_config.el6
index 5045bc7ee..5045bc7ee 100644
--- a/roles/base/files/ssh/sshd_config.el6
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/ssh/sshd_config.el6
diff --git a/roles/base/files/ssh/sshd_config.kojibuilder b/roles/basessh/files/ssh/sshd_config.kojibuilder
index ad3d06888..ad3d06888 100644
--- a/roles/base/files/ssh/sshd_config.kojibuilder
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/ssh/sshd_config.kojibuilder
diff --git a/roles/base/files/ssh/sshd_config.noc01.phx2.fedoraproject.org b/roles/basessh/files/ssh/sshd_config.noc01.phx2.fedoraproject.org
index d9cb0e422..d9cb0e422 100644
--- a/roles/base/files/ssh/sshd_config.noc01.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/ssh/sshd_config.noc01.phx2.fedoraproject.org
diff --git a/roles/base/files/ssh/sshd_config.pkgs b/roles/basessh/files/ssh/sshd_config.pkgs
index c73321c6b..c73321c6b 100644
--- a/roles/base/files/ssh/sshd_config.pkgs
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/ssh/sshd_config.pkgs
diff --git a/roles/base/files/ssh/sshd_config.qa-prod b/roles/basessh/files/ssh/sshd_config.qa-prod
index dec0630a1..dec0630a1 100644
--- a/roles/base/files/ssh/sshd_config.qa-prod
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/ssh/sshd_config.qa-prod
diff --git a/roles/base/files/ssh/sshd_config.qa-stg b/roles/basessh/files/ssh/sshd_config.qa-stg
index dec0630a1..dec0630a1 100644
--- a/roles/base/files/ssh/sshd_config.qa-stg
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/ssh/sshd_config.qa-stg
diff --git a/roles/base/files/ssh/sshd_config.releng b/roles/basessh/files/ssh/sshd_config.releng
index 5045bc7ee..5045bc7ee 100644
--- a/roles/base/files/ssh/sshd_config.releng
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/ssh/sshd_config.releng
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/syncHttpLogs.sh b/roles/basessh/files/syncHttpLogs.sh
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..b51bbedc4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/syncHttpLogs.sh
@@ -0,0 +1,92 @@
+#!/bin/bash
+
+RSYNC_FLAGS='-az --no-motd'
+
+function syncHttpLogs {
+
+ # in case we missed a run or two.. try to catch up the last 3 days.
+ for d in 1 2 3
+ do
+ HOST=$1
+ # some machines store stuff in old format. some new.
+ if [ "$2" = "old" ]; then
+ YESTERDAY=$(/bin/date -d "-$d days" +%Y-%m-%d)
+ else
+ YESTERDAY=$(/bin/date -d "-$d days" +%Y%m%d)
+ fi
+ YEAR=$(/bin/date -d "-$d days" +%Y)
+ MONTH=$(/bin/date -d "-$d days" +%m)
+ DAY=$(/bin/date -d "-$d days" +%d)
+ /bin/mkdir -p /var/log/hosts/$HOST/$YEAR/$MONTH/$DAY/http
+ cd /var/log/hosts/$HOST/$YEAR/$MONTH/$DAY/http/
+
+ for f in $(/usr/bin/rsync $RSYNC_FLAGS --list-only $HOST::log/httpd/*$YESTERDAY* | awk '{ print $5 }')
+ do
+ DEST=$(echo $f | /bin/sed s/-$YESTERDAY//)
+ /usr/bin/rsync $RSYNC_FLAGS $HOST::log/httpd/$f ./$DEST
+ done
+ done
+}
+
+syncHttpLogs proxy01.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs proxy02.vpn.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs proxy03.vpn.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs proxy04.vpn.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs proxy05.vpn.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs proxy06.vpn.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs proxy07.vpn.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs proxy08.vpn.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs proxy09.vpn.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs proxy10.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs proxy11.vpn.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs proxy12.vpn.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs proxy13.vpn.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs proxy14.vpn.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs proxy01.stg.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs fas01.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs fas02.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs fas03.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs fas01.stg.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs fedocal01.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs fedocal02.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs fedocal01.stg.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs datagrepper01.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs datagrepper02.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs datagrepper01.stg.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs ipsilon01.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs ipsilon02.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs ask01.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs ask02.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs ask01.stg.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs badges-web01.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs badges-web02.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs badges-web01.stg.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs elections01.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs elections02.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs elections01.stg.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs tagger01.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs tagger02.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs tagger01.stg.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs bodhi03.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs bodhi04.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs bodhi01.stg.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs packages03.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs packages04.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs packages03.stg.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs blockerbugs01.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs blockerbugs02.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs blockerbugs01.stg.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs value01.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs secondary01
+syncHttpLogs people02.vpn.fedoraproject.org old
+syncHttpLogs noc01.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs download01.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs download02.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs download03.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs download04.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs download05.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs download-rdu01.vpn.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs sundries01.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs sundries02.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+syncHttpLogs sundries01.stg.phx2.fedoraproject.org
+## eof
diff --git a/roles/basessh/files/watchdog.conf b/roles/basessh/files/watchdog.conf
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..92254d82f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/files/watchdog.conf
@@ -0,0 +1,3 @@
+watchdog-device = /dev/watchdog
+realtime = yes
+priority = 1
diff --git a/roles/basessh/handlers/main.yml b/roles/basessh/handlers/main.yml
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..0c4def426
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/basessh/handlers/main.yml
@@ -0,0 +1,3 @@
+---
+- name: restart sshd
+ service: name=sshd state=restarted
diff --git a/roles/base/tasks/sshcerts.yml b/roles/basessh/tasks/main.yml
index 2707f7b0b..20fc6bee1 100644
--- a/roles/base/tasks/sshcerts.yml
+++ b/roles/basessh/tasks/main.yml
@@ -1,3 +1,44 @@
+---
+- name: check if sshd port is already known by selinux
+ shell: semanage port -l | grep ssh
+ register: sshd_selinux_port
+ check_mode: no
+ changed_when: false
+ tags:
+ - sshd_config
+ - config
+ - sshd
+ - selinux
+ - base
+
+- name: allow alternate sshd port
+ command: semanage port -a -t ssh_port_t -p tcp {{ sshd_port }}
+ when: sshd_selinux_port.stdout.find('{{ sshd_port }}') == -1
+ tags:
+ - sshd_config
+ - config
+ - sshd
+ - selinux
+ - base
+
+- name: sshd_config
+ copy: src={{ item }} dest=/etc/ssh/sshd_config mode=0600
+ with_first_found:
+ - "{{ sshd_config }}"
+ - ssh/sshd_config.{{ inventory_hostname }}
+ - ssh/sshd_config.{{ host_group }}
+ - ssh/sshd_config.{{ dist_tag }}
+ - ssh/sshd_config.{{ ansible_distribution }}
+ - ssh/sshd_config.{{ ansible_distribution_version }}
+ - ssh/sshd_config.default
+ notify:
+ - restart sshd
+ tags:
+ - sshd_config
+ - config
+ - sshd
+ - base
+
- name: Determine SSH keys generated by this machine
find: paths=/etc/ssh
file_type=file